2014 Annual Report
CALIFORNIA’S BANK
We are committed to building the top full-service
bank serving California’s diverse private
businesses, entrepreneurs and homeowners.
1,400+
Employees
Largest Bank
Headquartered in
Orange County, CA
$6 Billion
Assets
$5 Billion
2014 Loans Originated
90,000+
Deposit and Lending
Accounts Serviced
100+
Locations in
California
and the West
Business
16%
Multifamily
24%
Full Service Offices
Lending Offices
Commercial
Real Estate
26%
Other 4%
Loan Portfolio
10,000+
Loans Funded in 2014
<1%
Non-performing Loans
Residential
30%
HFI Loan Portfolio
Balances as of 12/31/14
UNITED STATES
SECURITIES AND EXCHANGE COMMISSION
Washington, D.C. 20549
FORM 10-K
(Mark One)
ANNUAL REPORT PURSUANT TO SECTION 13 OR 15(d) OF THE SECURITIES EXCHANGE ACT OF 1934
For the fiscal year ended December 31, 2014
or
TRANSITION REPORT PURSUANT TO SECTION 13 OR 15(d) OF THE SECURITIES EXCHANGE ACT OF 1934
For the transition period from to
Commission file number 001-35522
BANC OF CALIFORNIA, INC.
(Exact name of registrant as specified in its charter)
Maryland
(State or other jurisdiction of
incorporation or organization)
18500 Von Karman Ave, Suite 1100, Irvine, California
(Address of principal executive offices)
04-3639825
(IRS Employer
Identification No.)
92612
(Zip Code)
(Registrant’s telephone number, including area code) (949) 236-5211
Securities Registered Pursuant to Section 12(b) of the Act:
Title of each class
Common Stock, par value $0.01 per share
Depositary Shares each representing a 1/40th
Interest in a share of 8.00% Non-Cumulative
Perpetual Preferred Stock, Series C
7.50% Senior Notes Due April 15, 2020
Name of each exchange on which registered
New York Stock Exchange
New York Stock Exchange
New York Stock Exchange
Securities Registered Pursuant to Section 12(g) of the Act:
None
Indicate by check mark if the registrant is a well-known seasoned issuer, as defined in Rule 405 of the Securities Act. YES
NO
Indicate by check mark if the registrant is not required to file reports pursuant to Section 13 or Section 15(d) of the Act. YES
NO
Indicate by check mark whether the registrant (1) has filed all reports required to be filed by Section 13 or 15(d) of the Securities Exchange Act of
1934 during the preceding 12 months (or for such shorter period that the registrant was required to file such reports) and (2) has been subject to such
filing requirements for the past 90 days. YES
Indicate by check mark whether the registrant has submitted electronically and posted on its corporate Web site, if any, every Interactive Data File
required to be submitted and posted pursuant to Rule 405 of Regulation S-T (§ 232.405 of this chapter) during the preceding 12 months (or for such
shorter period that the registrant was required to submit and post such files). YES
NO
NO
Indicate by check mark if disclosure of delinquent filers pursuant to Item 405 of Regulation S-K (§ 229.405 of this chapter) is not contained herein,
and will not be contained, to the best of registrant’s knowledge, in definitive proxy or information statements incorporated by reference in Part III of
this Form 10-K or any amendment to this Form 10-K.
Indicate by check mark whether the registrant is a large accelerated filer, an accelerated filer, a non-accelerated filer, or a smaller reporting company.
See definition of “large accelerated filer,” “accelerated filer,” “and “smaller reporting company” in Rule 12b-2 of the Exchange Act.
Large accelerated filer
Non-accelerated filer
(Do not check if a smaller reporting company)
Accelerated filer
Smaller reporting company
Indicate by check mark whether the registrant is a shell company (as defined in Rule 12b-2 of the Act). YES
The aggregate market value of the voting stock held by non-affiliates of the registrant, computed by reference to the closing price of such stock on
New York Stock Exchange as of June 30, 2014, was $294.7 million. (The exclusion from such amount of the market value of the shares owned by
any person shall not be deemed an admission by the registrant that such person is an affiliate of the registrant.) As of February 27, 2015, the registrant
had outstanding 34,918,477 shares of voting common stock and 945 shares of Class B non-voting common stock.
NO
PART III of Form 10-K—Portions of the Proxy Statement for the Annual Meeting of Stockholders to be held in 2015.
DOCUMENTS INCORPORATED BY REFERENCE
BANC OF CALIFORNIA, INC.
FORM 10-K
December 31, 2014
Table of Contents
PART I
Item 1.
Business
Item 1.A.
Risk Factors
Item 1.B.
Unresolved Staff Comments
Item 2.
Item 3.
Item 4.
Part II
Item 5.
Item 6.
Item 7.
Properties
Legal Proceedings
Mine Safety Disclosures
Market for Registrant's Common Equity, Related Stockholder Matters and Issuer Purchases of Equity Securities
Selected Financial Data
Management's Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations
Item 7.A.
Quantitative and Qualitative Disclosures About Market Risk
Item 8.
Item 9.
Financial Statements and Supplementary Data
Changes in and Disagreements With Accountants on Accounting and Financial Disclosure
Item 9.A.
Controls and Procedures
Item 9.B.
Other Information
Part III
Item 10.
Directors, Executive Officers and Corporate Governance
Item 11.
Executive Compensation
Item 12.
Security Ownership of Certain Beneficial Owners and Management and Related Stockholder Matters
Item 13.
Certain Relationship and Related Transactions and Director Independence
Item 14.
Principal Accountant Fees and Services
Part IV
Item 15. Exhibits and Financial Statement Schedules
SIGNATURES
EXHIBIT INDEX
Page
5
5
27
45
45
45
45
46
46
49
51
98
100
188
188
191
191
191
191
192
192
192
193
193
197
2
Forward-looking Statements
When used in this report and in public stockholder communications, in other documents of Banc of California, Inc. (the
Company, we, us and our) filed with or furnished to the Securities and Exchange Commission (the SEC), or in oral statements
made with the approval of an authorized executive officer, the words or phrases “believe,” “will,” “should,” “will likely result,”
“are expected to,” “will continue,” “is anticipated,” “estimate,” “project,” “plans,” “guidance” or similar expressions are
intended to identify “forward-looking statements” within the meaning of the Private Securities Litigation Reform Act of 1995.
You are cautioned not to place undue reliance on any forward-looking statements, which speak only as of the date made. These
statements may relate to our future financial performance, strategic plans or objectives, revenue, expense or earnings
projections, or other financial items. By their nature, these statements are subject to numerous uncertainties that could cause
actual results to differ materially from those anticipated in the statements.
Factors that could cause actual results to differ materially from the results anticipated or projected include, but are not limited
to, the following:
i.
ii.
iii.
iv.
v.
vi.
vii.
viii.
ix.
x.
xi.
xii.
xiii.
xiv.
xv.
xvi.
the ability of the Company to successfully integrate the branches its wholly owned bank subsidiary, Banc of
California, N.A. (the Bank), acquired from Banco Popular North America (BPNA or Banco Popular);
risks that the Company’s merger and acquisition activities, including but not limited to the recent acquisition of the
BPNA branches and the acquisitions of The Private Bank of California (PBOC), The Palisades Group, LLC and CS
Financial, Inc., as well as the merger of the Company’s subsidiary banks, may disrupt current plans and operations and
lead to difficulties in customer and employee retention, risks that the amount of the costs, fees, expenses and charges
related to these transactions could be significantly higher than anticipated and risks that the expected revenues, cost
savings, synergies and other benefits of these transactions might not be realized to the extent anticipated, within the
anticipated timetables, or at all;
risks that funds obtained from capital raising activities will not be utilized efficiently or effectively;
a worsening of current economic conditions, as well as turmoil in the financial markets;
the credit risks of lending activities, which may be affected by deterioration in real estate markets and the financial
condition of borrowers, may lead to increased loan and lease delinquencies, losses and nonperforming assets in our
loan and lease portfolio, and may result in our allowance for loan and lease losses not being adequate to cover actual
losses and require us to materially increase our loan and lease loss reserves;
the quality and composition of our securities portfolio;
changes in general economic conditions, either nationally or in our market areas;
continuation of the historically low short-term interest rate environment, changes in the levels of general interest rates,
and the relative differences between short- and long-term interest rates, deposit interest rates, our net interest margin
and funding sources;
fluctuations in the demand for loans and leases, the number of unsold homes and other properties and fluctuations in
commercial and residential real estate values in our market area;
results of examinations of us by regulatory authorities and the possibility that any such regulatory authority may,
among other things, require us to increase our allowance for loan and lease losses, write-down asset values, increase
our capital levels, or affect our ability to borrow funds or maintain or increase deposits, which could adversely affect
our liquidity and earnings;
legislative or regulatory changes that adversely affect our business, including changes in regulatory capital or other
rules;
our ability to control operating costs and expenses;
staffing fluctuations in response to product demand or the implementation of corporate strategies that affect our work
force and potential associated charges;
errors in our estimates in determining fair value of certain of our assets, which may result in significant declines in
valuation;
the network and computer systems on which we depend could fail or experience a security breach;
our ability to attract and retain key members of our senior management team;
xvii.
costs and effects of litigation, including settlements and judgments;
3
xviii.
increased competitive pressures among financial services companies;
xix.
xx.
xxi.
changes in consumer spending, borrowing and saving habits;
adverse changes in the securities markets;
earthquake, fire or other natural disasters affecting the condition of real estate collateral;
xxii.
the availability of resources to address changes in laws, rules or regulations or to respond to regulatory actions;
xxiii.
inability of key third-party providers to perform their obligations to us;
xxiv.
changes in accounting policies and practices, as may be adopted by the financial institution regulatory agencies or the
Financial Accounting Standards Board or their application to our business, including additional guidance and
interpretation on accounting issues and details of the implementation of new accounting methods;
xxv.
war or terrorist activities; and
xxvi.
other economic, competitive, governmental, regulatory, and technological factors affecting our operations, pricing,
products and services and the other risks described in this report and from time to time in other documents that we file
with or furnish to the SEC, including, without limitation, the risks described under “Item 1A. Risk Factors” presented
elsewhere in this report.
The Company undertakes no obligation to update any such statement to reflect circumstances or events that occur after the date
on which the forward-looking statement is made, except as required by law.
4
PART I
Item 1. Business
General
Banc of California, Inc. is a financial holding company and the parent of Banc of California, National Association, a national
bank (the Bank), The Palisades Group, LLC, an SEC-registered investment advisor (The Palisades Group), and PTB Property
Holdings, LLC, an entity formed to hold real estate, cash and fixed income investments (PTB). Prior to October 11, 2013, Banc
of California, Inc. was a multi-bank holding company with two banking subsidiaries, Pacific Trust Bank, a federal savings bank
(PacTrust Bank or Pacific Trust Bank) and The Private Bank of California (Beach Business Bank prior to July 1, 2013). On
October 11, 2013, Banc of California, Inc. became a one-bank holding company when Pacific Trust Bank converted from a
federal savings bank to a national bank and changed its name to Banc of California, National Association, and immediately
thereafter The Private Bank of California was merged into Banc of California, National Association. On January 17, 2014,
Banc of California, Inc. became a financial holding company. Unless the context indicates otherwise, references to the “Bank”
prior to October 11, 2013 mean Pacific Trust Bank and The Private Bank of California (Beach Business Bank prior to July 1,
2013), collectively, and references to the “Bank” on or after October 11, 2013 refer to Banc of California, National Association.
Unless the context indicates otherwise, all references to “Banc of California, Inc.” refer to Banc of California, Inc. excluding its
consolidated subsidiaries and all references to the “Company,” “we,” “us” or “our” refer to Banc of California, Inc. including
its consolidated subsidiaries.
The Company was incorporated under Maryland law in March 2002, and in July 2013, the Company changed its name to
“Banc of California, Inc.” As noted above, in October 2013, the Company’s subsidiary banks merged to form a single, national
bank subsidiary under the name Banc of California, National Association. The Bank has one wholly owned subsidiary, CS
Financial, Inc. (CS Financial), a mortgage banking firm.
Banc of California, Inc. is subject to regulation by the Board of Governors of the Federal Reserve System (the Federal Reserve
Board or FRB), and the Bank is subject to regulation primarily by the Office of the Comptroller of the Currency (OCC). As a
financial holding company, Banc of California, Inc. may engage in activities permissible for bank holding companies and may
engage in other activities that are financial in nature or incidental or complementary to activities that are financial in nature,
primarily securities, insurance and merchant banking activities. See “Regulation and Supervision" below.
Banc of California, Inc.'s assets primarily consist of the outstanding stock of the Bank as well as the outstanding membership
interests of The Palisades Group and PTB. From time to time, Banc of California, Inc. also has purchased impaired loans and
leases, investments and other real estate owned (OREO) from the Bank to assure the Bank’s safety and soundness. At
December 31, 2014, Banc of California, Inc. had no significant liabilities at the holding company level other than $84.8 million
in its 7.50 percent Senior Notes due April 15, 2020 (Senior Notes) and $12.5 million in its junior subordinated amortizing
notes, and related interest payments, compensation of its executive employees and directors, as well as expenses related to
strategic initiatives. Banc of California, Inc. also utilizes the support staff and offices of the Bank and pays the Bank for these
services. If Banc of California, Inc. expands or changes its business in the future, it may hire additional employees of its own.
The Bank offers a variety of financial services to meet the banking and financial needs of the communities we serve. The Bank
is headquartered in Orange County, California and at December 31, 2014, the Bank operated 37 branches in San Diego,
Orange, and Los Angeles Counties in California and 67 loan production offices in California, Arizona, Oregon, Virginia,
Indiana, Maryland, Colorado, Idaho, and Nevada.
The principal business of the Bank consists of attracting deposits from the general public and investing these funds primarily in
commercial, consumer and real estate secured loans. The Bank solicits deposits in its market area and, to a lesser extent, from
institutional depositors nationwide and may accept brokered deposits.
The Bank’s deposit product and service offerings include checking, savings, money market, certificates of deposit, retirement
accounts as well as mobile, online, cash and treasury management, card payment services, remote deposit, ACH origination,
employer/employee retirement planning, telephone banking, automated bill payment, electronic statements, safe deposit boxes,
direct deposit and wire transfers. Bank customers also have the ability to access their accounts through a nationwide network of
over 55,000 surcharge-free ATMs.
The principal executive offices of the Company are located at 18500 Von Karman Avenue, Suite 1100, California, and its
telephone number is (949) 236-5211. Banc of California, Inc.’s voting common stock, the depository shares each representing a
1/40th interest in a share of its 8.00 percent Non-Cumulative Perpetual Preferred Stock, Series C, and its Senior Notes are listed
on the New York Stock Exchange (NYSE) under the symbols BANC, BANC PRC and BOCA, respectively.
5
The reports, proxy statements and other information that Banc of California, Inc. files with the SEC, as well as news releases,
are available free of charge through the Company’s Internet site at http://www.bancofcal.com. This information can be found
on the “News and Events” or “Investor relations” pages of our Internet site. Annual reports on Form 10-K, quarterly reports on
Form 10-Q, current reports on Form 8-K, and amendments to those reports filed and furnished pursuant to Section 13(a) of the
Exchange Act are available as soon as reasonably practicable after they have been filed or furnished to the SEC. Reference to
the Company’s Internet address is not intended to incorporate any of the information contained on our Internet site into this
document.
Operating Segments
Our operations are managed based on the operating results of four reportable segments: Banking, Mortgage Banking, Financial
Advisory and Asset Management and Corporate/Other. Our chief operating decision-makers use financial information from our
four reportable segments to make operating and strategic decisions. For financial information about our reportable segments,
see Note 22 of the Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements in Item 8.
Strategy
The Company is committed to building the top full-service bank serving California’s diverse private businesses, entrepreneurs,
and homeowners, and investing in and growing complementary businesses that enhance stockholder value. Our overall strategy
is comprised of specific growth and operating objectives. The key elements of that strategy are:
Growth Strategies
Build California’s Bank
• Extend branch footprint throughout attractive markets in California.
• Enhance suite of simple, fair products to meet needs of private businesses, entrepreneurs and homeowners, including
Residential Lending, Commercial Real Estate Lending, Private Banking, Entertainment Banking, Small / Middle
Market Lending, Commercial and Industrial Lending, Small Business Administration (SBA) Lending, and Multi-
Family Lending.
• The Company successfully completed two bank acquisitions in 2012, one bank acquisition in 2013 and the acquisition
of Banco Popular's Southern California branch network in 2014, which included teams of local commercial lending
officers which has given us a greater network and far greater capacity to attract commercial and private banking
relationships. The Company will seek to continue to develop its commercial lending activities through strategic “lift
outs” of lending teams in various geographic markets that have particular business “niches” and “specialties.”
• The Company has successfully attracted and launched several new loan origination groups through acquisitions and
the new hire process. These include the acquisitions of RenovationReady and CS Financial, as well as the hiring and
launch of our Financial Institutions Group (which has product offerings such as securities-backed lines of credit,
insurance backed lines of credit and financial advisor acquisition financing), our multi-family and commercial real
estate lending teams, and equipment finance teams. We will seek to continue to diversify our lending capabilities
through our hiring and acquisitions process.
• Develop simple, fair deposit products: checking, certificates of deposit, business analysis and cash management.
•
Implement a robust Community Reinvestment Act (CRA) plan focused on integrating with and investing in our
communities.
Invest in Complementary Financial Services Businesses
• The Company seeks to invest in and grow mutually complementary financial services businesses either as part of its
subsidiary bank or through other non-bank subsidiaries. In 2013, these efforts resulted in the acquisition of The
Palisades Group (an asset management and investment advisory businesses focused on residential mortgage loans,
which became a wholly owned subsidiary of the Company).
Continue as a public company with a common stock that is quoted and traded on a national stock market. In addition to
providing access to growth capital in a diversified approach, such as common or preferred stock and debt, we believe a “public
currency” provides flexibility in structuring acquisitions and will allow us to attract and retain qualified management through
equity-based compensation.
6
Operating Strategies
• Achieve appropriate scale and profitability for each line of business.
• Execute our focused value proposition and marketing to become California’s Bank.
• Enhance the Company’s risk management functions by proactively managing and implementing sound procedures and
committing experienced human resources to this effort. We seek to (i) identify risks in all functions of our business,
including credit, operations and asset and liability management, (ii) evaluate such risks and their trends and (iii) adopt
strategies to manage such risks based upon our evaluations.
• Maintain and improve asset quality through prudent loan underwriting standards and credit risk management practices.
• Actively manage interest rate risk by closely matching the volume and maturity of our interest sensitive assets to our
interest sensitive liabilities in order to mitigate adverse effects of rapid changes in interest rates on either side of our
balance sheet.
• Expand lending, to California’s private businesses, entrepreneurs and homeowners, which may generate deposits that
are a lower cost and/or more stable funding source.
• Align the interests of employees with those of stockholders by establishing the Employee Equity Ownership Plan to
make every employee a stockholder, subject to vesting, as of their 90th day of employment.
Recent Transactions
Banco Popular's California Network Acquisition
Effective November 8, 2014, the Bank acquired 20 full-service branches from Banco Popular North America (BPNA Branch
Acquisition) in the Southern California banking market. The purchase price, net of deposit premiums received of $3.9 million,
was $24.0 million. The transaction added $1.07 billion in loans and $1.08 billion in deposits to the Bank.
The fair value of loans acquired from BPNA was estimated by utilizing a methodology wherein similar loans were aggregated
into pools. Cash flows for each pool were determined by estimating future credit losses and the rate of prepayments. Projected
monthly cash flows were then discounted to present value based on a market rate for similar loans. There was no carryover of
BPNA's allowance for loan losses associated with the acquired loans as the loans were initially recorded at fair value.
Core deposit intangible assets of $15.8 million recognized as part of the BPNA Branch Acquisition was valued using a net cost
savings method and was calculated as the present value of the estimated net cost savings attributable to the core deposit base
over the expected remaining life of the deposits. The cost savings derived from the core deposit balance were calculated as the
difference between the prevailing alternative cost of funds and the estimated actual cost of the core deposits. The core deposit
intangible is being amortized over its estimated useful life of ten years using the sum of years-digits amortization methodology.
The fair value of savings and transaction deposit accounts acquired from BPNA was assumed to approximate the carrying value
as these accounts have no stated maturity and are payable on demand. Certificates of deposit were valued by projecting out the
expected cash flows based on the remaining contractual terms of the certificates of deposit. These cash flows were discounted
based on market rates for certificates of deposit with corresponding remaining maturities.
Direct costs related to the BPNA Branch Acquisition were expensed as incurred and amounted to $4.3 million for the year
ended December 31, 2014. These acquisition integration expenses included technology costs related to system conversion and
professional fees.
Certain valuations related to acquired loans receivable, premises and equipment, and other intangible assets and assumed
deposits are still under review by management and considered preliminary and could differ significantly when management's
review is finalized.
For additional information regarding this transaction, see Note 2 of the Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements in Item 8.
RenovationReady® Acquisition
Effective January 31, 2014, the Company acquired certain assets, including service contracts and intellectual property, of
RenovationReady, a provider of specialized loan services to financial institutions and mortgage bankers that originate agency
eligible residential renovation and construction loan products.
7
The purchased identifiable intangible assets and assumed liabilities were recorded at their estimated fair values as of January
31, 2014. The Company recorded $2.2 million of goodwill and $761 thousand of other intangible assets. The other intangible
assets are related to a customer relationship intangible.
For additional information regarding this transaction, see Note 2 of the Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements in Item 8.
CS Financial Acquisition
Effective October 31, 2013, the Company acquired CS Financial, a California corporation and Southern California based
mortgage banking firm controlled by former Company director and current Bank executive Jeffrey T. Seabold. As a result of
the acquisition, CS Financial became a wholly owned subsidiary of the Bank. CS Financial specializes in higher balance
residential mortgage loans that serve the Bank’s high net worth individual, entrepreneur and family office clients.
The purchased assets, including identifiable intangible assets and assumed liabilities were recorded at their estimated fair
values as of October 31, 2013. The Company recorded $7.2 million of goodwill and $690 thousand of other intangible assets,
which were related to the trade name intangible.
For additional information regarding this transaction, see Notes 2 and 25 of the Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements in
Item 8.
Branch Sales
Effective October 4, 2013, the Company completed the sale of eight branches to AmericanWest Bank, a Washington state
chartered bank (AWB). The transaction provided for the transfer of $464.3 million in deposits and related assets to AWB in
exchange for a deposit premium of 2.3 percent applied to certain deposit balances transferred. Certain other assets related to the
branches included the real estate for three of the branch locations and certain overdraft and other credit facilities related to the
deposit accounts. The branches were located in San Diego, Riverside and Los Angeles Counties. The purpose of the sale was to
reshape the Bank’s branch network to focus on serving small-to-mid sized businesses and high net worth families throughout
Los Angeles, Orange and San Diego counties. The Company recognized a gain of $12.6 million from this transaction, of which
$12.1 million was recognized in 2013.
For additional information regarding this transaction, see Note 2 of the Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements in Item 8.
The Palisades Group, LLC Acquisition
Effective September 10, 2013, the Company acquired The Palisades Group, a Delaware limited liability company and a
registered investment adviser under the Investment Advisers Act of 1940, for $50 thousand. The Palisades Group provides
financial advisory and asset management services to third parties, including the Bank, with respect to the purchase, sale and
management of residential mortgage loans.
The assets and liabilities were recorded at their estimated fair values as of the September 10, 2013 acquisition date. No
goodwill was recognized.
For additional information regarding this transaction, see Notes 2 and 25 of the Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements in
Item 8.
The Private Bank of California Acquisition
Effective July 1, 2013, the Company completed its acquisition of The Private Bank of California (PBOC) pursuant to the terms
of the Agreement and Plan of Merger, dated as of August 21, 2012, as amended (the Merger Agreement), by and between the
Company, Beach Business Bank (Beach) (then a separate subsidiary bank of the Company) and PBOC. PBOC merged with and
into Beach, with Beach continuing as the surviving entity in the merger and a wholly owned subsidiary of the Company, and
changing its name to “The Private Bank of California.” As noted above, on October 11, 2013, The Private Bank of California
was merged with the Company’s other wholly owned banking subsidiary, Banc of California, National Association (formerly
Pacific Trust Bank.)
Pursuant to the terms of the Merger Agreement, the Company paid aggregate merger consideration of (1) 2,082,654 shares of
Company common stock (valued at $28.3 million based on the $13.58 per share closing price of Company common stock on
July 1, 2013), and (2) $25.3 million in cash. Additionally, the Company paid out $2.7 million for certain outstanding options to
acquire PBOC common stock in accordance with the Merger Agreement and converted outstanding PBOC stock options to the
Company’s stock options with an assumed fair value of approximately $30 thousand.
8
In addition, upon completion of the acquisition, each share of preferred stock issued by PBOC as part of the Small Business
Lending Fund (SBLF) program of the United States Department of Treasury (10,000 shares in the aggregate with a liquidation
preference amount of $1,000 per share) was converted automatically into one substantially identical share of preferred stock of
the Company. The terms of the preferred stock issued by the Company in exchange for the PBOC preferred stock are
substantially identical to the preferred stock previously issued by the Company as part of its own participation in the SBLF
program (32,000 shares in aggregate with a liquidation preference amount of $1,000 per share).
PBOC provided a range of financial services, including credit and deposit products as well as cash management services, from
its headquarters located in the Century City area of Los Angeles, California as well as full-service branches in Hollywood and
Irvine, and a loan production office in downtown Los Angeles. PBOC’s target clients included high net worth and high income
individuals, business professionals and their professional service firms, business owners, entertainment service businesses and
non-profit organizations.
For additional information regarding this transaction, see Note 2 of the Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements in Item 8.
Lending Activities
General
The Company offers a number of commercial and consumer loan products, including commercial and industrial loans,
commercial real estate loans, multi-family loans, SBA guaranteed business loans, construction and renovation loans, lease
financing, single family residential (SFR) mortgage loans, warehouse loans, asset or security backed loans, home equity lines
of credit (HELOCs), consumer and business lines of credit, home equity loans and other consumer loans.
Legal lending limits are calculated in conformance with OCC regulations, which prohibit a national bank from lending to any
one individual or entity or its related interests on any amount that exceeds 15 percent of the bank’s capital and surplus, plus an
additional 10 percent of the bank’s capital and surplus, if the amount that exceeds the bank’s 15 percent general limit is fully
secured by readily marketable collateral. At December 31, 2014, the Bank’s authorized legal lending limits for loans to one
borrower were $75.6 million for unsecured loans plus an additional $50.4 million for specific secured loans.
Governance
The Company conducts its lending activities under a system of risk governance controls. Key elements of our risk governance
structure are our risk appetite framework and risk appetite statement. The risk appetite framework adopted by the Company and
the Bank has been developed in conjunction with the Company’s strategic and capital plans. The strategic and capital plans
articulate the Board-approved balance sheet and loan concentration targets and the appropriate level of capital to properly
manage our risks.
The risk appetite framework provides the overall approach, including policies, processes, controls, and systems through which
the risk appetite is established, communicated, and monitored. The risk appetite framework utilizes a risk assessment process to
identify inherent risks across the Company, gauges the effectiveness of our internal controls, and establishes tolerances for
residual risk in each of the regulatory risk categories: credit, market (interest rate and price risks), liquidity, operational,
compliance, strategic, and reputational. Each risk category is assigned risk ratings with a target overall residual risk rating for
the organization. The risk appetite framework includes a risk appetite statement, risk limits, and an outline of roles and
responsibilities of those overseeing the implementation and monitoring of the framework. The risk appetite statement is an
expression of the maximum level of risk that we are prepared to accept in order to achieve our business objectives. Defining,
communicating, and monitoring risk appetite are fundamental to a safe and sound control environment and a risk-focused
culture. The Board of Directors establishes the Company’s strategic objectives and approves the Company’s risk appetite
statement, which is developed in collaboration with the chief executive officer, chief risk officer, general counsel, chief
financial officer, and business unit leaders. The executive team translates the Board approved strategic objectives and the risk
appetite statement into targets and constraints for business lines and legal entities to follow.
The risk appetite framework is supported by an enterprise risk management program. Enterprise risk management at the
Company and Bank integrates all risk efforts under one common framework. Key elements of enterprise risk management that
are intended to support prudent lending activities include:
•
Policies— The Bank's loan policy articulates the credit culture of our lending business and provides clarity around
encouraged and discouraged lending activities. Additional policies cover key business segments of the portfolio, for
example the Bank's Commercial Real Estate Policy, and other important aspects supporting the Bank's lending
activities, for example policies relating to appraisals, risk ratings, fair lending, etc.
9
• Credit Approval Authorities— All material credit exposures of the Bank are approved by a credit risk management
group that is independent of the business units. Above this threshold, credit approvals are made by the chief credit
officer or an executive management credit committee of the Bank. The joint enterprise risk committee of the Company
Board of Directors and the Bank Board of Directors reviews/approves material loan pool purchases/divestitures and
any other transactions as appropriate.
• Concentration Risk Management Policy—To mitigate and manage the risk within the Bank's loan portfolio, the Board
of Directors of the Bank adopted a concentration risk management policy, pursuant to which it expects to review and
revise concentration risk to tolerance thresholds at least annually and otherwise from time to time as appropriate. It is
anticipated that these concentration risk to tolerance thresholds may change at any time when the Board of Directors is
considering material strategic initiatives such as acquisitions, new product launches and terminations of products or
other factors as the Board of Directors believes appropriate. The Company has developed procedures relating to the
appropriate actions to be taken should management seek to increase the concentration guidelines or exceed the
guideline maximum based on various factors. Concentration risk to tolerance thresholds are not meant to be restrictive
limits, but are intended to aid management and the Board to ensure that the Bank’s loan concentrations are consistent
with the Board’s risk appetite.
•
Stress Testing– The Bank has established developed a stress test policy and stress testing methodology as a tool to
evaluate our loan portfolio, capital levels and strategic plan with the objective of ensuring that our loan portfolio and
balance sheet concentrations are consistent with the Board approved risk appetite and strategic and capital plans.
• Loan Portfolio Management— The Bank has an internal asset review committee that formally reviews the loan
portfolio on a regular basis. Risk rating trends, loan portfolio performance, including delinquency status, and the
resolution of problem assets are reviewed and evaluated.
• Commercial Real Estate Loan Pricing, Multi-Family Loan Pricing and Residential Loan Pricing—Regular discussions
occur between the areas of Treasury, Capital Markets, Credit and Risk Management and the business units with regard
to the pricing of our loan products. These pricing committees meet to ensure that the Bank is pricing its products
appropriately to meet our strategic and capital plans while ensuring an appropriate return for stockholders.
Commercial and Industrial Loans
Commercial and industrial loans are made to finance operations, provide working capital, or to finance the purchase of assets,
equipment or inventory. A borrower’s cash flow from operations is generally the primary source of repayment. Accordingly, our
policies provide specific guidelines regarding debt coverage and other important financial ratios. Commercial and industrial
loans include lines of credit and commercial term loans. Lines of credit are extended to businesses or individuals based on the
financial strength and integrity of the borrower and guarantor(s) and generally are collateralized by short-term assets such as
accounts receivable, inventory, equipment or real estate and have a maturity of one year or less. Commercial term loans are
typically made to finance the acquisition of fixed assets or refinance short-term debt originally used to purchase fixed assets.
Commercial term loans generally have terms of one to five years. They may be collateralized by the asset being acquired or
other available assets.
Commercial and industrial loans include short-term secured and unsecured business and commercial loans with maturities
typically ranging up to 5 years (up to 10 years if a SBA loan), accounts receivable financing typically for 1-5 years (up to 10
years if a SBA loan), and equipment leases up to 6 years. The interest rates on these loans generally are adjustable and usually
are indexed to The Wall Street Journal’s prime rate or LIBOR and will vary based on market conditions and be commensurate
to the credit risk. Where it can be negotiated, loans are written with a floor rate of interest. Generally, lines of credit are granted
for no more than a 12-month period.
Commercial and industrial loans, including accounts receivable and inventory financing, generally are made to businesses that
have been in operation for at least 5 years (or less if a SBA loan), including start-ups. To qualify for such loans, prospective
borrowers generally must have debt-to-net worth ratios not exceeding 3.75-to-1, operating cash flow sufficient to demonstrate
the ability to pay obligations as they become due, and good payment histories as evidenced by credit reports. We attempt to
control our risk by generally requiring loan-to-value (LTV) ratios of not more than 80 percent and by closely and regularly
monitoring the amount and value of the collateral in order to maintain that ratio.
The Company’s commercial and industrial business lending policy includes credit file documentation and analysis of the
borrower’s background, capacity to repay the loan, the adequacy of the borrower’s capital and collateral as well as an
evaluation of other conditions affecting the borrower. Analysis of the borrower’s past, present and future cash flows is also an
important aspect of our credit analysis. In order to mitigate the risk of borrower default, we generally require collateral to
support the credit or, in the case of loans made to businesses, personal guarantees from their owners, or both. In addition, all
10
such loans must have well-defined primary and secondary sources of repayment. Nonetheless, these loans are believed to carry
higher credit risk than traditional single-family home loans.
Commercial and industrial loans are typically made on the basis of the borrower’s ability to make repayment from the cash
flow of the borrower’s business. As a result, the availability of funds for the repayment of commercial and industrial loans may
be substantially dependent on the success of the business itself (which, in turn, is often dependent in part upon general
economic conditions). The Company’s commercial business loans are usually, but not always, secured by business assets.
However, the collateral securing the loans may depreciate over time, may be difficult to appraise and may fluctuate in value
based on the success of the business. See “Loans and Leases Receivables - Asset Quality” in Item 7.
Commercial and industrial loan growth also assists in the growth of our deposits because many commercial loan borrowers
establish noninterest-bearing and interest-bearing demand deposit accounts and banking services relationships with us. Those
deposit accounts help us to reduce our overall cost of funds and those banking services relationships provide us with a source of
non-interest income.
At December 31, 2014, commercial and industrial loans totaled $490.9 million, or 12.4 percent of the total loans and leases,
compared to $287.8 million, or 11.8 percent of the total loans and leases at December 31, 2013. This increase was due mainly
to the BPNA Branch Acquisition as well as loan originations in 2014.
Commercial Real Estate Lending and Multi-Family Real Estate Lending
Commercial real estate and multi-family real estate loans are secured primarily by multi-family dwellings, industrial/warehouse
buildings, anchored and non-anchored retail centers, office buildings and hospitality properties, on a limited basis, primarily
located in the Company’s market area, and throughout the West Coast. At December 31, 2014, commercial real estate and
multi-family real estate loans totaled $999.9 million, or 25.3 percent, and $955.7 million, or 24.2 percent, respectively, of the
total loans and leases, as compared to $529.9 million, or 21.7 percent, and $141.6 million, or 5.8 percent, respectively, of the
total loans and leases at December 31, 2013. This increase was due mainly to the BPNA Branch Acquisition as well as loan
originations in 2014.
The Company’s loans secured by multi-family and commercial real estate are originated with either a fixed or adjustable
interest rate. The interest rate on adjustable-rate loans is based on a variety of indices, generally determined through negotiation
with the borrower. Loan-to-value ratios on these loans typically do not exceed 75 percent of the appraised value of the property
securing the loan. These loans typically require monthly payments, may contain balloon payments and generally have
maximum maturities of 30 years.
Loans secured by multi-family and commercial real estate are underwritten based on the income producing potential of the
property and the financial strength of the borrower/guarantor. The net operating income, which is the income derived from the
operation of the property less all operating expenses, must be sufficient to cover the payments related to the outstanding debt.
The Company generally requires an assignment of rents or leases in order to be assured that the cash flow from the project will
be used to repay the debt. Appraisals on properties securing multi-family and commercial real estate loans are performed by
independent state licensed fee appraisers approved by management. See “Loans and Leases Receivable - Loan and Lease
Originations, Purchases, Sales and Repayments” in Item 7. The Company may require the borrower to maintain a tax or
insurance escrow account for loans secured by multi-family and commercial real estate. In order to monitor the adequacy of
cash flows on income-producing properties, the borrower is generally required to provide periodic financial information.
Loans secured by multi-family and commercial real estate properties generally involve a greater degree of credit risk than
single family residential mortgage loans. These loans typically involve large balances to single borrowers or groups of related
borrowers.
Because payments on loans secured by multi-family and commercial real estate properties are often dependent on the
successful operation or management of the properties, repayment of these loans may be subject to adverse conditions in the real
estate market or the economy. If the cash flow from the project is reduced, or if leases are not obtained or renewed, the
borrower’s ability to repay the loan may be impaired. See “Loans and Leases Receivable - Asset Quality” in Item 7.
11
Small Business Administration Loans
The Company provides numerous SBA loan products through the Bank. Beach Business Bank (which was acquired by the
Company in 2012, re-named The Private Bank of California on July 1, 2013 and merged with and into the Bank on October 11,
2013) had approval to access the Preferred Lenders Program (PLP) within the SBA. After the October 11, 2013 subsidiary bank
merger, the Bank received PLP status within the SBA effective as of February 3, 2014. The Bank’s PLP status generally gives it
the authority to make the final credit decision and have most servicing and liquidation authority.
The Company provides the following SBA products:
•
7(a)—These loans provide the Bank with a guarantee from the SBA of the United States Government for up to 85
percent of the loan amount for loans up to $150,000 and 75 percent of the loan amount for loans of more than
$150,000, with a maximum loan amount of $5 million. These are term loans that can be used for a variety of purposes
including expansion, renovation, new construction, and equipment purchases. Depending on collateral, these loans can
have terms ranging from 7 to 25 years. The guaranteed portion of these loans is often sold into the secondary market.
• Cap Lines—In general, these lines are guaranteed up to 75 percent and are typically used for working capital purposes
and secured by accounts receivable and/or inventory. These lines are generally allowed in amounts up to $5 million
and can be issued with maturities of up to 5 years.
•
•
504 Loans—These are real estate loans in which the lender can advance up to 90 percent of the purchase price; retain
50 percent as a first trust deed; and, have a Certified Development Company (CDC) retain the 2nd position for 40
percent of the total cost. CDCs are licensed by the SBA. Required equity of the borrower is 10 percent. Terms of the
first trust deed are typically similar to market rates for conventional real estate loans, while the CDC establishes rates
and terms for the second trust deed loan.
SBA Express—These loans offer a 50 percent guaranty by the SBA and are made in amounts up to a maximum of
$350,000 (although the SBA temporarily increased the maximum limit to $1 million on October 8, 2010 for a period
of one year). These loans are typically revolving lines and have maturities of up to 7 years.
SBA lending is subject to federal legislation that can affect the availability and funding of the program. This dependence on
legislative funding might cause future limitations and uncertainties with regard to the continued funding of such programs,
which could potentially have an adverse financial impact on our business.
The Company’s portfolio of SBA loans is subject to certain risks, including, but not limited to: (i) the effects of economic
downturns on the Southern California economy; (ii) interest rate increases; (iii) deterioration of the value of the underlying
collateral; and (iv) deterioration of a borrower’s or guarantor's financial capabilities. We attempt to reduce the exposure of these
risks through: (a) reviewing each loan request and renewal individually; (b) adhering to written loan policies; (c) adhering to
SBA policies and regulations; (e) obtaining independent third party appraisals; and (f) obtaining external independent credit
reviews. SBA loans normally require monthly installment payments of principal and interest and therefore are continually
monitored for past due conditions. In general, the Company receives and reviews financial statements and other documents of
borrowing customers on an ongoing basis during the term of the relationship and responds to any deterioration identified.
At December 31, 2014, SBA loans totaled $36.2 million, or 0.9 percent of the total loans and leases, compared to $27.4 million,
or 1.1 percent of the total loans and leases at December 31, 2013.
Construction Lending
Our construction lending primarily relates to SFR properties. The Company may in the future originate or purchase loans or
participations in construction, renovation and rehabilitation loans on residential, multi-family and/or commercial real estate
properties. At December 31, 2014, construction loans totaled $42.2 million, or 1.1 percent of the total loans and leases
compared to $24.9 million, or 1.0 percent of the total loans and leases at December 31, 2013. This increase was due mainly to
the BPNA Branch Acquisition as well as loan originations in 2014.
Lease Financing
Commercial equipment leasing and financing was introduced as a product in the third quarter of 2012 to meet the needs of
small and medium sized businesses for growth through investments in commercial equipment. The Company provides full
payout capital leases and equipment finance agreements for essential use equipment to small and medium sized business
nationally. The terms are 1 to 7 years in length and generally provide more flexibility to meet the equipment obsolescence
needs of small and medium sized businesses than traditional business loans.
12
Commercial equipment leases are secured by the business assets being financed. The Company also obtains a commercial
guaranty of the business and generally a personal guaranty of the owner(s) of the business. At December 31, 2014, commercial
equipment leases totaled $85.7 million, or 2.2 percent of the total loans and leases compared to $31.9 million, or 1.3 percent of
the total loans and leases at December 31, 2013. This increase was due mainly to lease originations and purchases in 2014.
Single Family Residential Mortgage Loans
The Company originates mortgage loans secured by a first deed of trust on single family residences throughout California and
the United States.
The Company offers a variety of loan products catering to the specific needs of borrowers, including fixed rate and adjustable
rate mortgages with either 30-year or 15-year terms. The Company offers conventional mortgages eligible for sale to Fannie
Mae or Freddie Mac, government insured Federal Housing Administration (FHA) and Veteran Affairs (VA) mortgages, and
non-conforming loans where the loan amount exceeds Fannie Mae or Freddie Mac limits, or the guidelines do not conform to
Fannie Mae or Freddie Mac guidelines.
The Company’s residential lending activity includes both a direct-to-consumer retail residential lending business and a
wholesale and correspondent mortgage business. The Company has also purchased pools of seasoned SFR mortgage loans,
primarily through The Palisades Group.
In the retail business, Company loan officers are located either in our call center in Irvine, Bank branches in San Diego,
Orange, and Los Angeles Counties, or loan production offices throughout California and in Arizona, Oregon, Virginia, Indiana,
Maryland, Colorado, Idaho, and Nevada, and originate mortgage loans directly to consumers. The wholesale mortgage business
originates residential mortgage loans submitted to the Company by outside mortgage brokers for underwriting and funding. The
correspondent mortgage business acquires residential mortgage loans originated by outside mortgage bankers. The Company
does not originate loans defined as high cost by state or federal regulators.
A majority of residential mortgage loans originated by the Company are made to finance the purchase or the refinance of
existing loans on owner-occupied homes with a smaller percentage used to finance non-owner occupied homes. A majority of
the Company’s loan originations for the held for investment portfolio are collateralized by real properties located in Southern
California; however the Bank originates loans held for sale collateralized by real properties located throughout the United
States.
The Company generally underwrites SFR mortgage loans based on the applicant’s income and credit history and the appraised
value of the subject property. Generally, the Company requires private mortgage insurance for conventional loans with a loan to
value greater than 80 percent of the lesser of the appraised value or purchase price, and FHA insurance or a VA guaranty for
government loans. Properties securing our SFR mortgage loans are appraised by independent fee appraisers approved by
management. The Company requires borrowers to obtain title insurance, hazard insurance, and flood insurance, if necessary.
The Company currently originates SFR mortgage loans on either a fixed or an adjustable rate basis, as consumer demand and
the Bank’s risk management dictates. The Company’s pricing strategy for SFR mortgage loans includes setting interest rates
that are competitive with other local financial institutions and mortgage originators.
Adjustable-rate mortgage (ARM) loans are offered with flexible initial and periodic repricing dates, ranging from one year to
ten years through the life of the loan. The Company uses a variety of indices to reprice ARM loans. During the year ended
December 31, 2014, the Company originated $1.50 billion of SFR ARM loans with terms up to 30 years.
The Company sells a majority of the SFR mortgage loans it originates to various investors in the secondary market and may not
service these loans after sale of the loans. The Company generally retains the right to service adjustable rate mortgage loans
held for investment, as well as conventional loans sold to Fannie Mae and Freddie Mac and FHA and VA loans issued in Ginnie
Mae securities. The Company generally does not retain the right to service loans sold to private investors after sale of the loans.
Loans sold to investors are subject to certain indemnification provisions, including the repurchase of loans sold and the
repayment of sales proceeds to investors under certain conditions. In addition, if a customer defaults on a mortgage payment
within the first few payments after the loan is sold, the Company may be required to repurchase the loan at the full amount and
reimburse any premium paid by the purchaser.
The Company also purchases closed residential mortgage loans that meet the Bank's underwriting guidelines from other banks
or mortgage bankers through its correspondent division. Purchased loans are underwritten by the Bank prior to purchase and
contain representations and warranties from the seller concerning the accuracy of the credit file and compliance with
regulations.
13
At December 31, 2014, SFR mortgage loans totaled $1.17 billion, or 29.7 percent of the total loans and leases compared to
$1.29 billion, or 52.6 percent of the total loans and leases at December 31, 2013. Of the total SFR mortgage loans at December
31, 2014, $272.6 million, or 23.3 percent, were fixed rate, and $899.1 million, or 76.7 percent, were adjustable rate. Of the total
SFR mortgage loans at December 31, 2013, $334.2 million, or 26.0 percent, were fixed rate, and $952.3 million, or 74.0
percent, were adjustable rate. The decrease in total SFR mortgage loans was mainly due to the Company’s sale of three
seasoned SFR loan pools in 2014 with an aggregate carrying value of $82.6 million. The decrease in percentage to the total
loans and leases was mainly due to the amount of commercial and industrial, commercial real estate, and multi-family loans
acquired in the BPNA Branch Acquisition and the Company's strategy to grow and diversify the loan and lease portfolio. The
Company also had $1.19 billion and $714.4 million of SFR mortgage loans held for sale at December 31, 2014 and 2013,
respectively.
Acquisitions of Seasoned SFR Mortgage Loan Pools. The acquisition program implemented and executed by the Company
initially in 2012 and enhanced in 2013 with the acquisition of The Palisades Group involves a proprietary, multifaceted due
diligence process. Prior to acquiring mortgage loans, the Company, its affiliates, sub-advisors or due diligence partners
typically will review the loan portfolio and conduct certain due diligence on a loan by loan basis, preparing a customized
version of its diligence plan for each mortgage loan pool being reviewed that is designed to address certain identified pool
specific risks. The diligence plan generally reviews several factors, including but not limited to, obtaining and reconciling
property value, reviewing chain of titles, reviewing assignments, confirming lien position, reviewing regulatory compliance,
updating borrower credit, certifying collateral, reviewing modification agreements and reviewing servicing notes. In certain
transactions, a portion of the diligence may be provided by the seller. In those instances, the Company reviews the mortgage
loan portfolio to confirm the accuracy of the provided diligence information and supplements as appropriate.
In addition, market conditions, regional mortgage loan information and local trends in home values, coupled with market
knowledge, are used by the Company in calculating the appropriate additional risk discount to compensate for potential
property declines, foreclosures, defaults or other risks associated with the mortgage loan portfolio to be acquired. Typically, the
Company may enter into one or more agreements with affiliates or third parties to perform certain of these due diligence tasks
with respect to acquiring potential mortgage loans.
During the year ended December 31, 2014, the Company did not acquire any additional seasoned SFR mortgage loan pools.
During the year ended December 31, 2013, the Company completed five seasoned SFR mortgage loan pool acquisitions with
unpaid principal balances and fair values of $1.02 billion and $849.9 million at their respective acquisition dates. These loan
pools generally consist of seasoned re-performing residential mortgage loans whose characteristics and payment history were
consistent with borrowers that demonstrated a willingness and ability to remain in the residence pursuant to the current terms of
the mortgage loan agreement. The Company was able to acquire these loans at a significant discount to both current property
value at acquisition and note balance. At December 31, 2014, the unpaid principal balance and carrying value of these loans
were $640.2 million and $571.0 million, respectively. The Company determined that certain loans in these seasoned SFR
mortgage loan acquisitions reflected credit quality deterioration since origination and it was probable, at acquisition, that all
contractually required payments would not be collected. The unpaid principal balances and fair values of these loans at the
respective dates of acquisition were $473.9 million and $342.1 million, respectively. At December 31, 2014, the unpaid
principal balance and carrying value of these loans were $245.7 million and $206.4 million, respectively.
At December 31, 2014 and 2013, approximately 3.46 percent and 5.63 percent of the unpaid principal balance of these loans
were delinquent 60 or more days, respectively, and 0.76 percent and 1.37 percent were in bankruptcy or foreclosure,
respectively. Delinquencies on seasoned SFR loan pools decreased mainly due to sales of portions of these loans.
For each acquisition the Company was able to utilize its background in mortgage credit analysis to re-underwrite the
borrower’s credit to arrive at what it believes to be an attractive risk adjusted return for a highly collateralized investment in
performing mortgage loans. In aggregate, the purchase price of the loans was less than 62 percent of current property value at
the time of acquisition based on a third party broker price opinion, and less than 83 percent of the note balance at the time of
acquisition. At the time of acquisition, approximately 86 percent of the mortgage loans by current principal balance (excluding
any forbearance amounts) had the original terms modified at some point since origination by a prior owner or servicer. The
mortgage loans had a current weighted average interest rate of 4.39 percent, determined by current principal balance. The
weighted average credit score of the borrowers comprising the mortgage loans at or near the time of acquisition determined by
current principal balance and excluding those with no credit score on file was 655. The average property value determined by a
broker price opinion by third party licensed real estate professionals at or around the time of acquisition was $292 thousand.
Approximately 89.6 percent of the borrowers by current principal balance had made at least 12 monthly payments in the 12
months preceding the trade date (or, in some cases calculated as making 11 monthly payments in the 11 months preceding the
trade date), and 94 percent had made nine monthly payments in the nine months preceding the trade date. The mortgage loans
are secured by residences located in all 50 states and Washington DC, with California being the largest state concentration
14
representing 31.0 percent of the note balance, and with no other state concentration exceeding 10.0 percent based upon the
current note balance.
As part of the acquisition program, the Company may sell from time to time seasoned SFR mortgage loans that do not meet the
Company’s investment standards. During 2014, the Company sold seasoned SFR mortgage loans with an unpaid principal
balance of $119.8 million and a carrying value of $82.6 million. During 2013, the Company sold seasoned SFR mortgage loans
with an unpaid principal balance of $176.6 million and a carrying value of $113.0 million. The Company recorded a net gain on
sale of $8.6 million and $3.4 million for the years ended December 31, 2014 and 2013, respectively, from these sales.
Non-Traditional Mortgage Loans. The Bank's non-traditional mortgage portfolio (NTM) is comprised of three interest only
products: the Green Account Loans (Green Loans), the hybrid interest only adjustable rate mortgage (ARM) and negatively
amortizing ARM loans. As of December 31, 2014 and 2013, the non-traditional mortgages totaled $350.6 million or 8.9 percent
and $309.6 million or 12.7 percent of the total loans and leases, respectively, which was an increase of $41.0 million or 13.2
percent.
The initial credit guidelines for the NTM portfolio were established based on borrower Fair Isaac Company (FICO) score, loan-
to-value, property type, occupancy type, loan amount, and geography. Additionally from an ongoing credit risk management
perspective, the Bank has assessed that the most significant performance indicators for NTMs to be loan-to-value and FICO
scores. On a semi-annual basis, the Bank performs loan reviews of the NTM loan portfolio that includes refreshing FICO
scores on the Green Loans and HELOCs and ordering third party automated valuation models (AVM) to confirm collateral
value.
Green Account Loans
Green Loans are SFR mortgage lines of credit with a linked checking account that allows all types of deposits and withdrawals
to be performed. The loans are generally interest only with a 15-year balloon payment due at maturity. Transactions posted to
the checking account are cleared on a daily basis against the loan, effectively bringing the checking account balance to zero on
a daily basis. If the outstanding balance of the loan is paid down to a zero balance, excess funds remain in the linked checking
account. Subsequent debit activity will use these funds before the line of credit is accessed. Although we ceased originating
Green Loan accounts in 2011, existing Green Loan borrowers who continue to meet the Green Loan credit and property value
requirements are entitled to continue to draw on their Green Loans. At December 31, 2014 the balance of Green Loans in our
portfolio was $128.2 million, a decrease of $24.8 million from $153.0 million at December 31, 2013.
The finance charge is calculated based on the current interest rate and daily outstanding principal balance. On the payment due
date, depending on availability on the line of credit, the payment may be paid by an advance to the loan resulting in the
borrower not making a payment. Borrowers who choose to make a payment do so by making a deposit into the linked checking
account that is applied to the loan in a daily sweep.
The Green Loans are similar to HELOCs in that they are collateralized primarily by the equity in single family residential
mortgage loans. However, some Green Loans are subject to differences from HELOCs relating to certain characteristics
including one-action laws. Similar to Green Loans, HELOCs allow the borrower to draw down on the credit line based on an
established loan amount for a period of time, typically 10 years, requiring an interest only payment with an option to pay
principal at any time. A typical HELOC provides that at the end of the term the borrower can continue to make monthly
principal and interest payments based on the loan balance until the maturity date. The Green Loan is an interest only loan with
a maturity of 15 years at which time the loan comes due and payable with a balloon payment. The unique payment structure
also differs from a traditional HELOC in that payments are made through the direct linkage of a personal checking account to
the loan through a nightly sweep of funds into the Green Loan account. This reduces any outstanding balance on the loan by the
total amount deposited into the checking account. As a result, every time a deposit is made, effectively a payment to the Green
Loan is made. HELOCs typically do not cause the loan to be paid down by a borrower's depositing of funds into their checking
account at the same bank.
Credit guidelines for Green Loans were established based on borrower FICO scores, property type, occupancy type, loan
amount, and geography. Property types include single family residences and second trust deeds where the Company owned the
first liens, owner occupied as well as non-owner occupied properties. The Company utilized its underwriting guidelines for first
liens to underwrite the Green Loan secured by second trust deeds as if the combined loans were a single Green Loan.
For SFR properties, the loan sizes ranged up to $7.0 million. As loan size increased, the maximum LTV decreases from 80
percent to 60 percent. Maximum LTVs were adjusted by 5-10 percent for specified property types such as condos. FICOs were
based on the primary wage earners’ mid FICO score and the lower of two mid FICO scores for full and alternative
15
documentation, respectively. Seventy-six percent of the FICO scores exceeded 700 at the time of origination. Loans greater
than $1 million were subject to a second appraisal or third party appraisal review at origination.
Interest Only Mortgage Loans
Interest only mortgage loans are primarily single family residential first mortgage loans with payment features that allow
interest only payments during the first one, three, or five years during which time the interest rate is fixed before converting to
fully amortizing payments. Following the expiration of the fixed interest rate, the interest rate and payment begins to adjust on
an annual basis, with fully amortizing payments that include principal and interest calculated over the remaining term of the
loan. The loan can be secured by owner or non-owner occupied properties that include single family units and second homes.
As of December 31, 2014, our interest only loans increased by $69.3 million, or 49.5 percent, to $209.3 million from $140.0
million at December 31, 2013. The increase was mainly due to originations in 2014.
Loans with the Potential for Negative Amortization
Negative amortization loans decreased by $3.5 million, or 21.2 percent, to $13.1 million as of December 31, 2014 from $16.6
million as of December 31, 2013. The Bank discontinued origination of negative amortization loans in 2007. These loans pose
a potentially higher credit risk because of the lack of principal amortization and potential for negative amortization; however,
management believes the risk is mitigated through the loan terms and underwriting standards, including the Company’s policies
on loan-to-value ratios.
Other Consumer Loans (HELOCs, Home Equity Loans and Other Consumer Credit)
The Company offers a variety of secured consumer loans, including second deed of trust home equity loans and home equity
lines of credit and loans secured by savings deposits. The Company also offers a limited amount of unsecured loans. The
Company originates consumer and other real estate loans primarily in its market area. Consumer loans generally have shorter
terms to maturity or variable interest rates, which reduce our exposure to changes in interest rates, and carry higher rates of
interest than do conventional SFR mortgage loans. Management believes that offering consumer loan products helps to expand
and create stronger ties to the Company’s existing customer base by increasing the number of customer relationships and
providing cross-marketing opportunities.
Other home equity lines of credit have a 7 or 10 year draw period and require the payment of 1.0 percent or 1.5 percent of the
outstanding loan balance per month (depending on the terms) or interest only payment during the draw period. Following
receipt of payments, the available credit includes amounts repaid up to the credit limit. Home equity lines of credit with a 10
year draw period have a balloon payment due at the end of the draw period or then fully amortizing for the remaining term. For
loans with shorter term draw periods, once the draw period has lapsed, generally the payment is fixed based on the loan balance
and prevailing market interest rates at that time.
The Company proactively monitors changes in the market value of all home loans contained in its portfolio. The Company’s
credit risk management policy requires the purchase of independent, third party valuations of every property in its residential
loan portfolio twice during the year. The most recent valuations were completed in December 2014. The Company has the right
to adjust, and has adjusted, existing lines of credit to address current market conditions subject to the terms of the loan
agreement and covenants. At December 31, 2014, unfunded commitments totaled $93.9 million on other consumer lines of
credit. Other consumer loan terms vary according to the type of collateral, length of contract and creditworthiness of the
borrower.
At December 31, 2014, other consumer loans totaled $166.9 million, or 4.2 percent of the total loans and leases compared to
$116.0 million, or 4.7 percent of the total loans and leases at December 31, 2013.
Off-Balance Sheet Commitments
As part of its service to the Bank’s customers, the Bank from time to time issues formal commitments and lines of credit. These
commitments can be either secured or unsecured. They may be in the form of revolving lines of credit for seasonal working
capital needs or may take the form of commercial letters of credit or standby letters of credit. Commercial letters of credit
facilitate import trade. Standby letters of credit are conditional commitments issued by the Bank to guarantee the performance
of a customer to a third party.
16
Loan and Lease Servicing
During 2013, single family residential mortgage loans held in the portfolio were serviced in house, pursuant to secondary
market guidelines. In 2014, the Bank contracted with a nationally known sub-servicer to service these loans. Generally, when a
borrower fails to make a payment on a mortgage loan, a late charge notice is mailed approximately 16 days after the due date.
All delinquent accounts are reviewed by a collector, who attempts to cure the delinquency by contacting the borrower prior to
the loan becoming 30 days past due. If the loan becomes 60 days delinquent, the collector will generally contact the borrower
by phone, send a personal letter and/or engage a field service company to visit the property in order to identify the reason for
the delinquency. Once the loan becomes 90 days delinquent, contact with the borrower is made requesting payment of the
delinquent amount in full, or the establishment of an acceptable repayment plan to bring the loan current. If an acceptable
repayment plan has not been agreed upon and a drive-by inspection is made, a collection officer will generally initiate
foreclosure or refer the account to the Company’s credit counsel to initiate foreclosure proceedings.
For SBA, construction, lease financing and consumer loans a similar process is followed, with the initial written contact being
made once the loan is 10 days past due with a follow-up notice at 16 days past due. Follow-up contacts are generally on an
accelerated basis compared to the SFR mortgage loan procedure.
Allowance for Loan and Lease Losses
The allowance for loan and lease losses (ALLL) represents management’s best estimate of the probable losses inherent in the
existing loan and lease portfolio. The ALLL is increased by the provision for loan losses charged to expense and reduced by
loan and lease charge-offs, net of recoveries.
Management evaluates the Company’s ALLL on a quarterly basis, or more often if needed. Management believes the ALLL is a
“critical accounting estimation” because it is based upon the assessment of various quantitative and qualitative factors affecting
the collectability of loans and leases, including current economic conditions, past credit experience, delinquency status, the
value of the underlying collateral, if any, and a continuing review of the portfolio of loans and leases.
The allowance consists of three elements: (i) specific valuation allowances established for probable losses on impaired loans
and leases, (ii) quantitative valuation allowances calculated using loss experience for like loans and leases with similar
characteristics and trends, adjusted, as necessary to reflect the impact of current conditions; and (iii) qualitative allowances
based on environmental and other factors that may be internal or external to the Company.
During the year ended December 31, 2014, the Company enhanced the current methodologies, processes and controls over the
ALLL, due to the Company's organic and acquisitive growth and changing profile.
The following is a synopsis of the enhancements for each component of ALLL:
• Expand the look-back period to 28 rolling quarters to capture a full economic cycle.
• Utilize net historical losses versus gross historical losses.
• Expand the peer group used to determine industry average loss history to include three industry groups; 1) all U.S.
financial and bank holding companies, 2) all California financial and bank holding companies, 3) the peer group
average from the Uniform Bank Performance Report.
• Apply a segment specific loss emergence period to each segment's loss rate.
• Determine qualitative reserves is calculated at each loan segment level based on a baseline risk weighting adjusted for
current risks, trends and business conditions.
• Disaggregate certain qualitative factors to be determined on the portfolio segment level.
These enhancements resulted in an increase of $264 thousand in the ALLL as compared to what it would have been using the
old methodology at December 31, 2014.
A loan or lease is considered impaired when it is probable that we will be unable to collect all amounts due according to the
original contractual terms of the agreement. Impaired loans and leases are identified at each reporting date based on certain
criteria and the majority of which are individually reviewed for impairment. Nonaccrual loans and leases and all performing
restructured loans are reviewed individually for the amount of impairment, if any. We measure impairment of a loan based upon
the fair value of the loan’s collateral if the loan is collateral-dependent, or the present value of cash flows, discounted at the
loan’s effective interest rate, if the loan is not collateral-dependent. We measure impairment of a lease based upon the present
value of the scheduled lease and residual cash flows, discounted at the lease’s effective interest rate. Increased charge-offs or
additions to specific reserves generally result in increased provisions for credit losses.
17
Our loan and lease portfolio, excluding impaired loans and leases that are evaluated individually, is evaluated by segmentation.
The segmentations we currently evaluate are:
• Commercial and industrial
• Commercial real estate
• Construction
•
SBA
• Leases
•
•
Single family residence — 1st deeds of trust
Single family residence — 2nd deeds of trust
• Other consumer
Within these loan segments, we then evaluate loans and leases not adversely classified, which we refer to as “pass” credits,
separately from adversely classified loans and leases. The adversely classified loans and leases are further grouped into three
credit risk rating categories: “special mention,” “substandard,” and “doubtful.” See “Loans and Leases Receivable - Asset
Quality” in Item 7.
In addition, we may refer to the loans and leases classified as “substandard” and “doubtful” together as “classified” loans and
leases.
Although management believes the level of the ALLL as of December 31, 2014 was adequate to absorb probable losses in the
portfolio, declines in economies of the Company’s primary markets or other factors could result in losses that cannot be
reasonably predicted at this time.
Although we have established an ALLL that we consider appropriate, there can be no assurance that the established ALLL will
be sufficient to offset losses on loans and leases in the future. Management also believes that the reserve for unfunded loan
commitments is appropriate. In making this determination, we use the same methodology for the reserve for unfunded loan
commitments as we do for the allowance for loan and lease losses and consider the same quantitative and qualitative factors, as
well as an estimate of the probability of advances of the commitments correlated to their credit risk rating.
At December 31, 2014, our total ALLL was $29.5 million or 0.75 percent of the total loans and leases, as compared to $18.8
million, or 0.77 percent of the total loans and leases at December 31, 2013. The ALLL that was collectively evaluated for
impairment on originated loans and leases at December 31, 2014 was $25.3 million, which represented 1.34 percent of total
originated loans and leases, as compared to $17.1 million, or 1.46 percent, of total originated loans and leases at December 31,
2013. Including the non-credit impaired loans acquired through the acquisitions, the ALLL that was collectively evaluated for
impairment was $28.2 million, which represents 0.85 percent of total of such loans and leases, as compared to $18.5 million, or
1.13 percent, or total of such loans and leases. The ALLL that was individually evaluated for impairment was $1.3 million at
December 31, 2014 compared to $96 thousand at December 31, 2013. An unallocated ALLL of $0 and $450 thousand was held
at December 31, 2014 and 2013, respectively. Assessing the ALLL is inherently subjective as it requires making material
estimates, including the amount and timing of future cash flows expected to be received on impaired loans and leases that may
be susceptible to significant change. In the opinion of management, the allowance, when taken as a whole, reflects estimated
probable losses presently inherent in our loan and lease portfolios.
Private Banking
The Bank offers loans, deposits, and a full range of other banking services to high net worth individuals and entrepreneurs
including its full suite of credit products discussed above. Private banking loans include working capital lines of credit to
balance the borrower’s business cash flow cycle, loans to finance capital investments or equipment, commercial or residential
real estate loans, or unsecured personal loans, customized to fit the needs of the individual or business borrower, based upon the
relationship with the customer and the net worth of the customer.
18
The Financial Institutions Group
The Company offers loans, deposits and a full range of other banking services to financial institutions, which include registered
investment advisors, broker dealers, family offices, hedge funds, private equity funds and other financial services companies.
The Financial Institution Group offers lending products, which include securities backed lines of credit, insurance backed lines
of credit, alternative asset lines of credit, advisor acquisition finance and leveraged lending to hedge funds and private equity
funds. The Financial Institutions Group also provides tailored deposit solutions to the aforementioned financial institutions.
Investment Activities
The general objectives of our investment portfolio are to provide liquidity when loan and lease demand is high, to assist in
maintaining earnings when loan and lease demand is low and to maximize earnings while satisfactorily managing risk,
including credit risk, reinvestment risk, liquidity risk and interest rate risk. For additional information, see Item 7A.
The Company currently invests in mortgage-backed securities (MBS) as part of our asset/liability management strategy.
Management believes that MBS can represent attractive investment alternatives relative to other investments due to the wide
variety of maturity and repayment options available through such investments. In particular, the Company has concluded that
short and intermediate duration MBS (with an expected average life of less than ten years) represent a combination of rate and
duration that match the Company’s liquidity and risk profile goals. All of the Company’s negotiable securities, including MBS,
are held as “available for sale.”
Sources of Funds
General
The Company’s primary sources of funds are deposits, payments on and maturities of outstanding loans and leases and
investment securities, and other short-term investments and funds provided from operations. While scheduled payments from
the amortization of loans and leases and mortgage-backed securities and maturing securities and short-term investments are
relatively predictable sources of funds, deposit flows and loan and lease prepayments are greatly influenced by general interest
rates, economic conditions, and competition. In addition, the Company invests excess funds in short-term interest-earning
assets, which provide liquidity to meet lending requirements. The Company also generates cash through borrowings. The
Company utilizes Federal Home Loan Bank advances to leverage its capital base, to provide funds for its lending activities, as a
source of liquidity, and to enhance its interest rate risk management.
Deposits
The Bank offers a variety of deposit accounts to both consumers and businesses having a wide range of interest rates and terms.
The Bank's deposits consist of savings accounts, money market deposit accounts, interest and non-interest bearing demand
accounts, and certificates of deposit. The Bank solicits deposits primarily in our market area and from institutional investors.
During 2012, we introduced the “One Account” and the “Preferred Account,” in order to grow a stable, high quality, core
deposit base, and reduce our reliance on brokered deposits, resulting in a lower cost and more stable funding base. Core
deposits, which we define as noninterest-bearing deposits, interest-bearing demand deposits, money market, savings and
certificates of deposit under $100,000, excluding any brokered deposits, grew $999.7 million during 2014 and totaled $3.48
billion at December 31, 2014 and represented 74.4 percent of total deposits. Our One Account is designed to attract and serve
individuals who may not need our loan products or otherwise be familiar with our Bank. We believe our service encourages
them to build a full relationship with us, including lending relationships. Our Preferred Account serves customers who use the
Bank as one of their primary banking relationships. Our relationship managers have successfully learned how to offer full
deposit products to their loan clients and build long-term, deep relationships. Our business banking is also a key source of core
deposits and, more recently, we have begun to attract core deposits from our private banking clients as well.
The Bank held brokered deposits of $763.0 million, or 16.3 percent of total deposits, at December 31, 2014. The Company
primarily relies on competitive pricing policies, marketing and customer service to attract and retain deposits.
The flow of deposits is influenced significantly by general economic conditions, changes in money market and prevailing
interest rates and competition. The variety of deposit accounts the Bank offers has allowed the Bank to be competitive in
obtaining funds and to respond with flexibility to changes in consumer demand. The Bank tries to manage the pricing of our
deposits in keeping with our asset/liability management, liquidity and profitability objectives, subject to market competitive
factors. Based on our experience, the Bank believes that our deposits are relatively stable sources of funds. Despite this
stability, the Bank's ability to attract and maintain these deposits and the rates paid on them has been and will continue to be
significantly affected by market conditions.
19
Borrowings
Although deposits are our primary source of funds, the Bank may utilize borrowings when they are a less costly source of funds
and can be invested at a positive interest rate spread, when the Bank desires additional capacity to fund loan and lease demand
or when they meet our asset/liability management goals to diversify our funding sources and enhance our interest rate risk
management. The Bank’s borrowings historically have included advances to the Bank from the Federal Home Loan Bank of
San Francisco (FHLB). The Bank also has the ability to borrow from the Federal Reserve Bank of San Francisco (Federal
Reserve Bank), as well as through Federal Funds and reverse repurchase agreements. In addition, the Company has borrowed
through the issuance of its Senior Notes and junior subordinated amortizing notes. See Note 12 of the Notes to Consolidated
Financial Statements in Item 8.
The Bank may obtain advances from the FHLB by collateralizing the advances with certain of the Bank’s mortgage loans and
mortgage-backed and other securities. These advances may be made pursuant to several different credit programs, each of
which has its own interest rate, range of maturities and call features. At December 31, 2014, the Bank had $633.0 million in
FHLB advances outstanding and the ability to borrow an additional $501.3 million. The Bank also had the ability to borrow
$102.3 million from the Federal Reserve Bank as of that date. See Note 11 of the Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements in
Item 8 for additional information regarding FHLB advances. All outstanding FHLB borrowings are expected to mature in 2015.
Competition and Market Area
The Company faces strong competition in originating real estate and other loans and in attracting deposits. Competition in
originating real estate loans comes primarily from other commercial banks, savings institutions, credit unions and mortgage
bankers. Other commercial banks, savings institutions, credit unions and finance companies provide vigorous competition in
consumer lending.
The Company attracts deposits through the retail branch network, its loan productions offices, banking teams located in
corporate offices, through its Treasury function, and through the internet. One of the ways the Company has been able to be
competitive in this area is through its retail branch network. A greater understanding for the needs of the client is uncovered
through certain sales processes utilized by the branch network. Consequently, the branches have the ability to service those
needs with a variety of deposit accounts at competitive rates. Competition for deposits is principally from other commercial
banks, savings institutions, and credit unions, as well as mutual funds and other alternative investments. On November 8, 2014,
the Company acquired 20 full-service branches from BPNA in the Southern California banking market. Based on the most
recent branch deposit data as of June 30, 2014 provided by the FDIC, the share of deposits for the Bank in Los Angeles,
Orange, and San Diego counties was as follows:
Los Angeles County
Orange County
San Diego County
Employees
As of
June 30, 2014
0.46%
1.67%
0.79%
At December 31, 2014, we had a total of 1,438 full-time employees and 32 part-time employees. Our employees are not
represented by any collective bargaining group. Management considers its employee relations to be satisfactory.
Regulation and Supervision
General
The Company and the Bank are extensively regulated under federal laws.
As a financial holding company, the Company is subject to the Bank Holding Company Act of 1956, as amended, and its
primary regulator is the Board of Governors of the Federal Reserve System. As a national bank, the Bank is subject to
regulation primarily by the OCC. In addition, the Bank is also subject to backup regulation from the FDIC.
20
Regulation and supervision by the federal banking agencies are intended primarily for the protection of customers and
depositors and the Deposit Insurance Fund administered by the FDIC and not for the benefit of stockholders. Set forth below is
a brief description of material information regarding certain laws and regulations that are applicable to the Company and the
Bank. This description, as well as other descriptions of laws and regulations in this Form 10-K, is not complete and qualified in
its entirety by reference to applicable laws and regulations.
Dodd-Frank Wall Street Reform and Consumer Protection Act
The Dodd-Frank Wall Street Reform and Consumer Protection Act (the Dodd-Frank Act) enacted on July 1, 2010 is one of the
most significant pieces of financial legislation since the 1930s.
The Dodd-Frank Act requires that bank holding companies, such as the Company, act as a source of financial and managerial
strength for their insured depository institution subsidiaries, such as the Bank, particularly when such subsidiaries are in
financial distress. The FDIC has the authority to hold a bank liable for losses it incurs in connection with another commonly
controlled bank.
The FRB has extensive enforcement authority over the Company and the OCC has extensive enforcement authority over the
Bank under federal law. Enforcement authority generally includes, among other things, the ability to assess civil money
penalties, to issue cease-and-desist or removal orders and to initiate injunctive actions. In general, these enforcement actions
may be initiated for violations of laws and regulations and unsafe or unsound practices. Other actions or inactions may provide
the basis for enforcement action, including misleading or untimely filing of reports. Except under certain circumstances, public
disclosure of formal enforcement actions by the FRB and the OCC is required by law.
The Dodd-Frank Act made other significant changes to the regulation of bank holding companies and their subsidiary banks,
which includes the regulation of the Company and the Bank, and other significant changes will continue to occur as rules are
promulgated under the Dodd-Frank Act. These regulatory changes have had and will continue to have a material effect on the
business and results of the Company and the Bank. The Dodd-Frank Act created the Consumer Financial Protection Bureau
(CFPB), with the authority to promulgate regulations intended to protect consumers with respect to financial products and
services, including those provided by the Bank, and to restrict unfair, deceptive or abusive conduct by providers of consumer
financial products and services. The CFPB has issued rules under the Dodd-Frank Act affecting the Bank’s residential mortgage
lending business, including ability-to-repay and qualified mortgage standards, mortgage servicing standards, loan originator
compensation standards, high-cost mortgage requirements, appraisal and escrow standards and requirements for higher-priced
mortgages. The activities of the Bank are also subject to regulation under numerous federal laws and state consumer protection
statutes.
In addition to the Dodd-Frank Act, other legislative and regulatory proposals affecting banks have been made both domestically
and internationally. Among other things, these proposals include significant additional capital and liquidity requirements and
limitations on size or types of activity in which banks may engage.
Legislation is introduced from time to time in the United States Congress that may affect our operations. In addition, the
regulations governing us may be amended from time to time. Any legislative or regulatory changes in the future, including
those resulting from the Dodd-Frank Act, could adversely affect our operations and financial condition.
The Company
The Company became a financial holding company effective January 17, 2014. As a bank holding company that has elected to
become a financial holding company pursuant to the Bank Holding Company Act (BHCA), the Company may engage in
activities permitted for bank holding companies and may affiliate with securities firms and insurance companies and engage in
other activities that are financial in nature or incidental or complementary to activities that are financial in nature. “Financial in
nature” activities include securities underwriting, dealing and market making; sponsoring mutual funds and investment
companies; insurance underwriting and agency; and merchant banking. See “Volcker Rule” below.
The Company is required to register and file reports with, and is subject to regulation and examination by the FRB. The FRB’s
approval is required for acquisition of another financial institution or holding company thereof, and, under certain
circumstances, for the acquisition of other subsidiaries.
As a bank holding company, the Company is subject to the regulations of the FRB imposing capital requirements for a bank
holding company, which, under regulations in effect through December 31, 2014, establishes a capital framework based on Tier
1 and Tier 2 capital generally the same as Tier 1 and a Tier 2 capital for the Bank, as described below. For bank holding
companies, generally the minimum capital ratios (all on a consolidated basis) consist of a Tier 1 risk-based capital ratio of 4
percent, a total risk-based capital ratio of 8 percent and a leverage ratio of 4 percent. On an individual basis, the FRB can
21
impose higher ratios on a bank holding company. To be considered well-capitalized, a bank holding company must have a Tier
1 risk-based capital ratio of at least 6 percent and a total risk-based capital ratio of at least 10 percent, and must not be subject
to a written agreement, order or directive to maintain a specific capital measure. As of December 31, 2014, the Company was
considered well-capitalized, with capital ratios in excess of those required to qualify as such. For information on changes to the
capital regulations effective January 1, 2015, see "New Capital Requirements" below.
Under the FRB’s policy statement on the payment of cash dividends, a bank holding company should pay cash dividends only
to the extent that its net income for the past year is sufficient to cover both the cash dividends and a rate of earnings retention
that is consistent with the Company’s capital needs, asset quality, and overall financial condition. A bank holding company
must give the FRB prior notice of any purchase or redemption of its equity securities if the consideration for the purchase or
redemption, when combined with the consideration for all such purchases or redemptions in the preceding 12 months, is equal
to 10 percent or more of its consolidated net worth. The FRB may disapprove such a purchase or redemption if it determines
that the proposal would be an unsafe or unsound practice or would violate any law, regulation, FRB order, or condition imposed
in writing by the FRB. This notification requirement does not apply to a bank holding company that qualifies as well
capitalized, received a composite rating and a rating for management of “1” or “2” in its last examination and is not subject to
any unresolved supervisory issue. Regarding dividends, see "New Capital Requirements" below.
The Bank
The Bank is subject to a variety of requirements under federal law.
The Bank is required to maintain sufficient liquidity to ensure safe and sound operations. See "Liquidity" in Item 7.
The OCC has adopted guidelines establishing safety and soundness standards on such matters as loan and lease underwriting
and documentation, asset quality, earnings standards, internal controls and audit systems, interest rate risk exposure, and
compensation and other employee benefits. Any institution which fails to comply with these standards must submit a
compliance plan.
The FRB requires all depository institutions to maintain non-interest bearing reserves at specified levels against their
transaction accounts, primarily checking, NOW and Super NOW checking accounts. At December 31, 2014, Bank was in
compliance with these reserve requirements.
FDIC Insurance
The deposits of the Bank are insured up to the applicable limits by the FDIC, and such insurance is backed by the full faith and
credit of the United States. The basic deposit insurance limit is generally $250,000 as specified in FDIC regulations.
As insurer, the FDIC imposes deposit insurance premiums and is authorized to conduct examinations of and to require
reporting by FDIC-insured institutions. The Bank’s deposit insurance premiums for the year ended December 31, 2014 were
$2.9 million. FDIC-insured institutions are required to pay an additional quarterly assessment called the FICO assessment in
order to fund the interest on bonds issued to resolve thrift failures in the 1980s. This assessment will continue until the bonds
mature in the years 2017 through 2019. For the fiscal year ended December 31, 2014, the Bank paid $219 thousand in FICO
assessments.
The FDIC assesses deposit insurance premiums quarterly on each FDIC-insured institution based on annualized rates. Each
institution under $10 billion in assets is assigned to one of four risk categories based on its capital, supervisory ratings and
other factors, with higher risk institutions paying higher premiums. Its deposit insurance premiums are based on the rates
applicable to its risk category, subject to certain adjustments, and as required by the Dodd-Frank Act, are assessed on the
amount of an institution’s total assets minus its Tier 1 capital.
Capital Requirements
The Bank is required to maintain specified levels of regulatory capital under the capital and prompt corrective action
regulations of the OCC. Through December 31, 2014, to be adequately capitalized, an institution must have had a leverage ratio
of at least 4.0 percent, a Tier 1 risk-based capital ratio of at least 4.0 percent and a total risk-based capital ratio of at least 8.0
percent. Through December 31, 2014, to be well-capitalized, an institution must have had a Tier 1 leverage ratio of at least 5.0
percent, a Tier 1 risk-based capital ratio of at least 6.0 percent and total risk-based capital ratio of at least 10.0 percent.
Institutions that are not well-capitalized are subject to certain restrictions on brokered deposits and interest rates on deposits.
The term "leverage ratio" means the ratio of Tier 1 capital to adjusted total leverage assets. The term "Tier 1 risk-based capital
ratio" means the ratio of Tier 1 capital to total risk-weighted assets. The term "total risk-based capital ratio" means the ratio of
total capital to total risk-weighted assets. Tier 1 capital generally consists of common stockholders’ equity and retained earnings
22
and certain noncumulative perpetual preferred stock and related earnings, excluding most intangible assets. Total capital
consists of the sum of an institution’s Tier 1 capital and the amount of its Tier 2 capital up to the amount of its Tier 1 capital.
Tier 2 capital consists generally of certain permanent and maturing capital instruments, the amount of the institution’s
allowance for loan and lease losses up to 1.25 percent of risk-weighted assets and certain unrealized gains on equity securities.
Adjusted total leverage assets consist of total assets as specified for call report purposes, less such certain items as disallowed
servicing assets and accumulated gains/losses on available-for-sale securities. Risk-weighted assets are determined under the
capital regulations, which assign to every asset and off-balance sheet item a risk weight generally ranging from 0 percent to 100
percent based on the inherent risk of the asset. At December 31, 2014, the regulatory capital ratios of the Bank exceeded the
ratios required to qualify as well-capitalized. See “Regulatory Capital” in Item 7.
The OCC has the ability to establish an individual minimum capital requirement for a particular institution, based on its
circumstances, which varies from the capital levels that would otherwise be required. The OCC has not imposed any such
requirement on the Bank.
The OCC is authorized and, under certain circumstances, required to take certain actions against an institution that is less than
adequately capitalized. Such an institution must submit a capital restoration plan, including a specified guarantee by its holding
company, and until the plan is approved by the OCC, the institution may not increase its assets, acquire another institution,
establish a branch or engage in any new activities, and generally may not make capital distributions.
For institutions that are not at least adequately capitalized, progressively more severe restrictions generally apply as capital
ratios decrease, or if the OCC reclassifies an institution into a lower capital category due to unsafe or unsound practices or
unsafe or unsound condition. Such restrictions may cover all aspects of operations and may include a forced merger or
acquisition. An institution that becomes “critically undercapitalized” because it has a tangible equity ratio of 2.0 percent or less
is generally subject to the appointment of the FDIC as receiver or conservator for the institution within 90 days after it becomes
critically undercapitalized. The imposition by the OCC of any of these measures on the Bank may have a substantial adverse
effect on its operations and profitability.
The OCC has adopted substantial revisions to the regulations on capital prompt corrective action for FDIC-insured institutions.
See “New Capital Regulations” below.
Anti-Money Laundering and Suspicious Activity
Several federal laws, including the Bank Secrecy Act, the Money Laundering Control Act and the Uniting and Strengthening
America by Providing Appropriate Tools Required to Intercept and Obstruct Terrorism Act of 2001 (the Patriot Act) require all
financial institutions, including banks, to implement policies and procedures relating to anti-money laundering, compliance,
suspicious activities, and currency transaction reporting and due diligence on customers. The Patriot Act also requires federal
bank regulators to evaluate the effectiveness of an applicant in combating money laundering when determining whether to
approve a proposed bank acquisition.
Community Reinvestment Act
The Bank is subject to the provisions of the Community Reinvestment Act (CRA). Under the terms of the CRA, the Bank has a
continuing and affirmative obligation, consistent with safe and sound operation, to help meet the credit needs of its community,
including providing credit to individuals residing in low- and moderate-income neighborhoods. The CRA does not establish
specific lending requirements or programs for financial institutions, and does not limit an institution’s discretion to develop the
types of products and services that it believes are best suited to its particular community in a manner consistent with the CRA.
The OCC regularly assesses the Bank on its record in meeting the credit needs of the community served by that institution,
including low-income and moderate-income neighborhoods. The Bank received a satisfactory rating in its most recent CRA
evaluation.
The CRA assessment also is considered when the FRB reviews applications by banking institutions to acquire, merge or
consolidate with another banking institution or its holding company, to establish a new branch office that will accept deposits or
to relocate an office. In the case of a bank holding company applying for approval to acquire a bank, the Federal Reserve will
assess the records of each subsidiary depository institution of the applicant bank holding company, and those records may be
the basis for denying the application.
23
Financial Privacy Under the Requirements of the Gramm-Leach-Bliley Act (the GLBA)
The Company and its subsidiaries are required periodically to disclose to their retail customers the Company’s policies and
practices with respect to the sharing of nonpublic customer information with its affiliates and others, and the confidentiality and
security of that information. Under the GLBA, retail customers also must be given the opportunity to “opt out” of information-
sharing arrangements with non-affiliates, subject to certain exceptions set forth in the GLBA.
Limitations on Transactions with Affiliates and Loans to Insiders
Transactions between the Bank and any affiliate are governed by Sections 23A and 23B of the Federal Reserve Act. An affiliate
of a bank is any company or entity which controls, is controlled by or is under common control with the bank but which is not a
subsidiary of the bank. The Company and its subsidiaries are affiliates of the Bank. Generally, Section 23A limits the extent to
which the Bank or its subsidiaries may engage in “covered transactions” with any one affiliate to an amount equal to 10.0
percent of the Bank’s capital stock and surplus, and imposes an aggregate limit on all such transactions with all affiliates in an
amount equal to 20.0 percent of such capital stock and surplus. Section 23B applies to “covered transactions” as well as certain
other transactions and requires that all transactions be on terms substantially the same, or at least as favorable to the Bank, as
those provided to a non-affiliate. The term “covered transaction” includes the making of loans to an affiliate, the purchase of or
investment in the securities issued by an affiliate, the purchase of assets from an affiliate, the acceptance of securities issued by
an affiliate as collateral security for a loan or extension of credit to any person or company, or the issuance of a guarantee,
acceptance or letter of credit on behalf of an affiliate. Loans to an affiliate must be collateralized.
In addition, Sections 22(g) and (h) of the Federal Reserve Act place restrictions on loans to executive officers, directors and
principal stockholders of the Bank and its affiliates. Under Section 22(h), loans to a director, executive officer or greater than
10.0 percent stockholder of the Bank or its affiliates and certain related interests may generally not exceed, together with all
other outstanding loans to such person and related interests, 15.0 percent of the Bank’s unimpaired capital and surplus, plus an
additional 10.0 percent of unimpaired capital and surplus for loans that are fully secured by readily marketable collateral having
a value at least equal to the amount of the loan. Section 22(h) also requires that loans to directors, executive officers and
principal stockholders be made on terms substantially the same as those offered in comparable transactions to other persons,
and not involve more than the normal risk of repayment or present other unfavorable features. There is an exception for loans
that are made pursuant to a benefit or compensation program that (i) is widely available to employees of the Bank or its affiliate
and (ii) does not give preference to any director, executive officer or principal stockholder or certain related interests over other
employees of the Bank or its affiliate. Section 22(h) also requires prior board approval for certain loans. In addition, the
aggregate amount of all loans to all of the executive officers, directors and principal stockholders of the Bank or its affiliates
and certain related interests may not exceed 100.0 percent of the institution’s unimpaired capital and surplus. Furthermore,
Section 22(g) places additional restrictions on loans to executive officers.
The Company and its affiliates, including the Bank, maintain programs to meet the limitations on transactions with affiliates
and restrictions on loans to insiders and the Company believes it is currently in compliance with these requirements.
Identity Theft
Under the Fair and Accurate Credit Transactions Act (FACT Act), the Bank is required to develop and implement a written
Identity Theft Prevention Program to detect, prevent and mitigate identity theft “red flags” in connection with the opening of
certain accounts or certain existing accounts. Under the FACT Act, the Bank is required to adopt “reasonable policies and
procedures” to (i) identify relevant red flags for covered accounts and incorporate those red flags into the program: (ii) detect
red flags that have been incorporated into the program; (iii) respond appropriately to any red flags that are detected to prevent
and mitigate identity theft; and (iv) ensure the program is updated periodically, to reflect changes in risks to customers or to the
safety and soundness of the financial institution or creditor from identity theft.
The Bank maintains a program to meet the requirements of the FACT Act and the Bank believes it is currently in compliance
with these requirements.
Consumer Protection Laws and Regulations; Other Regulations
The Bank and its affiliates are subject to a broad array of federal and state consumer protection laws and regulations that
govern almost every aspect of its business relationships with consumers including but not limited to the Truth-in-Lending Act,
the Truth in Savings Act, the Electronic Funds Transfer Act, the Expedited Funds Availability Act, the Equal Credit Opportunity
Act, the Fair Housing Act, the Secure and Fair Enforcement in Mortgage Licensing Act, the Real Estate Settlement Procedures
Act, the Home Mortgage Disclosure Act, the Fair Credit Reporting Act, the Fair Debt Collection Practices Act, the Service
Members’ Civil Relief Act, the Right to Financial Privacy Act, the Home Ownership and Equity Protection Act, the Consumer
Leasing Act, the Fair Credit Billing Act, the Homeowners Protection Act, the Check Clearing for the 21st Century Act, laws
24
governing flood insurance, federal and state laws prohibiting unfair and deceptive business practices, foreclosure laws and
various regulations that implement some or all of the foregoing. These laws and regulations mandate certain disclosure
requirements and regulate the manner in which financial institutions must deal with customers when taking deposits, making
loans, collecting loans and providing other services. If the Bank fails to comply with these laws and regulations, it may be
subject to various penalties.
The Dodd-Frank Act established the CFPB as a new independent bureau within the Federal Reserve System that is responsible
for regulating consumer financial products and services under federal consumer financial laws. The CFPB has broad
rulemaking authority with respect to these laws. The Company and the Bank are subject to CFBB’s regulation of consumer
financial services and products. The CFPB has issued numerous regulations, and is expected to continue to do so in the next
few years. For the Bank and its affiliates, the CFPB’s regulations are enforced by the federal banking regulators. The CFPB’s
rulemaking, examination and enforcement authority is expected to significantly affect financial institutions involved in the
provision of consumer financial products and services, including the Company and the Bank.
New restrictions on residential mortgages were also promulgated under the Dodd-Frank Act. The provisions include (i) a
requirement that lenders make a determination that at the time a residential mortgage loan is consummated the consumer has a
reasonable ability to repay the loan and related costs; (ii) a ban on loan originator compensation based on the interest rate or
other terms of the loan (other than the amount of the principal); (iii) a ban on prepayment penalties for certain types of loans;
(iv) bans on arbitration provisions in mortgage loans; and (v) requirements for enhanced disclosures in connection with the
making of a loan. The Dodd-Frank Act also imposes a variety of requirements on entities that service mortgage loans.
The OCC must approve the Bank’s acquisition of other financial institutions and certain other acquisitions, and its
establishment of branches. Generally, the Bank may branch de novo nationwide, but branching by acquisition may be restricted
by applicable state law.
The Bank’s general limit on loans to one borrower is 15 percent of its capital and surplus, plus an additional 10 percent of its
capital and surplus if the amount of loans greater than 15 percent of capital and surplus is fully secured by readily marketable
collateral. Capital and surplus means Tier 1 and Tier 2 capital plus the amount of allowance for loan and lease losses not
included in Tier 2 capital. The Bank has no loans in excess of its loans-to-one borrower limit.
OCC regulations impose various restrictions on the ability of a bank to make capital distributions, which include dividends,
stock redemptions or repurchases, and certain other items. Generally, a bank may make capital distributions during any
calendar year equal to up to 100 percent of net income for the year-to-date plus retained net income for the two preceding years
without prior OCC approval. However, the OCC may restrict dividends by an institution deemed to be in need of more than
normal supervision.
The Bank is a member of the FHLB, which makes loans or advances to members. All advances are required to be fully secured
by sufficient collateral as determined by the FHLB, and all long-term advances are required to provide funds for residential
home financing. The Bank is required to purchase and maintain stock in the FHLB. At December 31, 2014, the Bank had $29.8
million in FHLB stock, which was in compliance with this requirement.
New Capital Requirements
Effective January 1, 2015 (with some changes transitioned into full effectiveness over two to four years), the Company and the
Bank became subject to new capital regulations adopted by the FRB and the OCC, which create a new required ratio for
common equity Tier 1 (CET1) capital, increase the minimum leverage and Tier 1 capital ratios, change the risk-weightings of
certain assets for purposes of the risk-based capital ratios, create an additional capital conservation buffer over the required
capital ratios, and change what qualifies as capital for purposes of meeting the capital requirements.
Under the new capital regulations, the minimum capital ratios are: (i) a CET1 capital ratio of 4.5 percent of risk-weighted
assets; (ii) a Tier 1 capital ratio of 6.0 percent of risk-weighted assets; (iii) a total capital ratio of 8.0 percent of risk-weighted
assets; and (iv) a leverage ratio (the ratio of Tier 1 capital to average total adjusted assets) of 4.0 percent. CET1 generally
consists of common stock, retained earnings, accumulated other comprehensive income (AOCI) unless we elect to exclude
AOCI from regulatory capital, as discussed below, and certain minority interests; all subject to applicable regulatory
adjustments and deductions.
There are a number of changes in what constitutes regulatory capital, subject to transition periods. These changes include the
phasing-out of certain instruments as qualifying capital. Mortgage servicing and deferred tax assets over designated
percentages of CET1 will be deducted from capital. In addition, Tier 1 capital will include AOCI, which includes all unrealized
gains and losses on available for sale debt and equity securities. Because of our asset size, we have the one-time option of
25
deciding in the first quarter of 2015 whether to permanently opt-out of the inclusion of unrealized gains and losses on available
for sale debt and equity securities in our capital calculations. We are considering whether to elect this option.
The new requirements also include changes in the risk-weighting of assets to better reflect credit risk and other risk exposure.
These include a 150 percent risk weight (up from 100 percent ) for certain high volatility commercial real estate acquisition,
development and construction loans and for non-residential mortgage loans that are 90 days past due or otherwise in nonaccrual
status, a 20 percent (up from 0 percent) credit conversion factor for the unused portion of a commitment with an original
maturity of one year or less that is not unconditionally cancellable (currently set at 0 percent ), and a 250 percent risk weight
(up from 100 percent) for mortgage servicing and deferred tax assets that are not deducted from capital.
In addition to the minimum CET1, Tier 1 and total capital ratios, the Company and the Bank will have to maintain a capital
conservation buffer consisting of additional CET1 capital greater than 2.5 percent of risk-weighted assets above the required
minimum levels in order to avoid limitations on paying dividends, engaging in share repurchases, and paying discretionary
bonuses. The new capital conservation buffer requirement is to be phased in beginning on January 1, 2016 when a buffer
greater than 0.625 percent of risk-weighted assets will be required, which amount will increase each year until the buffer
requirement is fully implemented on January 1, 2019.
The OCC’s prompt corrective action standards changed when these new capital regulations became effective. Under the new
standards, in order to be considered well-capitalized, the Bank must have a ratio of CET1 capital to risk-weighted assets of 6.5
percent (new), a ratio of Tier 1 capital to risk-weighted assets of 8 percent (increased from 6 percent), a ratio of total capital to
risk-weighted assets of 10 percent (unchanged), and a leverage ratio of 5 percent (unchanged), and in order to be considered
adequately capitalized, it must have the minimum capital ratios described above.
Although we continue to evaluate the impact that the new capital rules will have on the Company and the Bank, we anticipate
that the Company and the Bank will remain well-capitalized under the new capital rules, and will meet the capital conservation
buffer requirement.
Volcker Rule
The federal banking agencies have adopted regulations, which became effective April 15, 2014 with a conformance period for
certain features lasting until July 21, 2015, to implement the provisions of the Dodd-Frank Act known as the Volcker Rule.
Under the regulations, FDIC-insured depository institutions, their holding companies, subsidiaries and affiliates (collectively,
banking entities), are generally prohibited, subject to certain exemptions, from proprietary trading of securities and other
financial instruments and from acquiring or retaining an ownership interest in a “covered fund.”
Trading in certain government obligations is not prohibited. These include, among others, obligations of or guaranteed by the
United States or an agency or government-sponsored entity of the United States, obligations of a State of the United States or a
political subdivision thereof, and municipal securities. Proprietary trading generally does not include transactions under
repurchase and reverse repurchase agreements, securities lending transactions and purchases and sales for the purpose of
liquidity management if the liquidity management plan meets specified criteria; nor does it generally include transactions
undertaken in a fiduciary capacity.
The term “covered fund” can include, in addition to many private equity and hedge funds and other entities, certain
collateralized mortgage obligations, collateralized debt obligations and collateralized loan obligations, and other items, but it
does not include wholly owned subsidiaries, certain joint ventures, or loan securitizations generally, if the underlying assets are
solely loans. The term “ownership interest” includes not only an equity interest or a partnership interest, but also an interest that
has the right to participate in selection or removal of a general partner, managing member, director, trustee or investment
manager or advisor; to receive a share of income, gains or profits of the fund; to receive underlying fund assets after all other
interests have been redeemed; to receive all or a portion of excess spread; or to receive income on a pass-through basis or
income determined by reference to the performance of fund assets. In addition, “ownership interest” includes an interest under
which amounts payable can be reduced based on losses arising from underlying fund assets.
Activities eligible for exemptions include, among others, certain brokerage, underwriting and marketing activities, and risk-
mitigating hedging activities with respect to specific risks and subject to specified conditions.
Future Legislation or Regulation
In light of recent conditions in the United States economy and the financial services industry, the Obama administration,
Congress, the regulators and various states continue to focus attention on the financial services industry. Additional proposals
that affect the industry have been and will likely continue to be introduced. We cannot predict whether any of these proposals
will be enacted or adopted or, if they are, the effect they would have on our business, our operations or our financial condition.
26
Item 1A. Risk Factors
An investment in our securities is subject to certain risks. These risk factors should be considered by prospective and current
investors in our securities when evaluating the disclosures in this Annual Report on Form 10-K. The risks and uncertainties not
presently known to us or that we currently deem immaterial also may impair our business operations. If any of the following
risks actually occur, our business, results of operations and financial condition could suffer. In that event, the value of our
securities could decline, and you may lose all or part of your investment.
Risks Relating to Our Recently Completed Branch Acquisition from Banco Popular North America
The success of our recently completed acquisition of branches from Banco Popular North America will depend on a
number of uncertain factors.
The success of our recently completed acquisition of branches (the BPNA Branch Acquisition) from Banco Popular North
America (BPNA) will depend on a number of factors, including, without limitation:
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
our ability to successfully integrate the BPNA branches into our current operations;
our ability to limit outflow of deposits held by our new customers in the BPNA branches and to retain interest-earning
assets (i.e., loans) acquired in the BPNA Branch Acquisition;
the credit quality of loans acquired as part of the BPNA Branch Acquisition;
our ability to attract new deposits and to generate new interest-earning assets;
our success in deploying the cash received in the BPNA Branch Acquisition, on a timely basis, into assets, including
loans and investment securities, bearing sufficiently high yields without incurring unacceptable credit or interest rate
risk;
our ability to control the incremental noninterest expense from the BPNA branches in a manner that enables us to
maintain a favorable overall efficiency ratio;
our ability to retain and attract appropriate personnel to staff the BPNA branches; and
our ability to earn acceptable levels of noninterest income, including fee income, from the BPNA branches.
No assurance can be given that we will be able to integrate the BPNA branches successfully, that the BPNA Branch Acquisition
will not expose us to unknown material liabilities, that the operation of the BPNA branches will not adversely affect our results
of operations, that we will be able to achieve results in the future similar to those achieved by our existing banking business,
that we will be able to compete effectively in new market areas, or that we will be able to manage growth resulting from the
BPNA Branch Acquisition effectively. The difficulties or costs we may encounter in the integration could materially and
adversely affect our results of operations and financial condition.
The pricing of deposits and loan run-off rates could be substantially different than what we have projected in
connection with our planning for the BPNA Branch Acquisition and the integration of the acquired branches.
It is not known whether we will be able to retain loan and deposit relationships acquired in the BPNA Branch Acquisition over
time.
We will need to convert customer loan and deposit data from BPNA’s data processing system to our data processing systems.
Problems or errors in the customer account conversion process, and customer interface required to replace certain BPNA
products and services with comparable products and services of the Bank, could adversely affect customer relationships,
increase run-off of deposit and loan customers and result in unexpected charges and costs. Similarly, run-off could increase if
we are not able to cost effectively service particular BPNA loan or deposit products with special features. An unanticipated
increase in the run-off rate could increase the effective cost to us of the BPNA Branch Acquisition.
The credit quality of loans associated with the BPNA Branch Acquisition may be poorer than expected, which would
require us to increase our allowance for loan losses and negatively affect our operating results.
The Bank acquired $1.07 billion of loans related to the BPNA branches. As part of our due diligence on the BPNA branches,
we reviewed a sample of these loans in various categories and found them to be of acceptable credit quality. Our examination
of these loans was made using the same criteria, analyses and collateral evaluations that we have traditionally used in the
ordinary course of our business. Although we believe the loans we acquired are of acceptable credit quality, and nonperforming
loans, non-accrual loans or other real estate owned were generally excluded from the BPNA Branch Acquisition, no assurance
can be given as to the future performance of these loans.
27
We may fail to realize the growth prospects and cost savings anticipated as a result of the BPNA Branch Acquisition.
The success of the BPNA Branch Acquisition will depend, in part, on our ability to realize the anticipated business
opportunities and growth prospects we expect to result from the addition of the BPNA branches. We may never realize these
business opportunities and growth prospects. Integrating operations will be complex and will require significant efforts and
expenditures on the part of both us and BPNA. Our management might have its attention diverted while trying to integrate
operations and corporate and administrative infrastructures and the cost of integration may exceed our expectations. We may
also be required to make unanticipated capital expenditures or investments in order to maintain, improve or sustain the BPNA
branches we acquired or take write-offs or impairment charges or recognize amortization expenses resulting from the BPNA
Branch Acquisition and may be subject to unanticipated or unknown liabilities relating to the BPNA branches we acquired. We
might experience increased competition that limits our ability to expand our business, and we might not be able to capitalize on
expected business opportunities, including retaining current customers of BPNA. If any of these factors limit our ability to
integrate the new branches successfully or on a timely basis, the expectations of future results of operations following the
BPNA Branch Acquisition might not be met.
It is possible that the integration process could result in the loss of key employees, the disruption of our ongoing businesses, tax
costs or inefficiencies, or inconsistencies in standards, controls, information technology systems, procedures and policies, any
of which could adversely affect our ability to maintain relationships with customers, employees or other third parties or our
ability to achieve the anticipated benefits of the BPNA Branch Acquisition and could harm our financial performance.
We have incurred and will continue to incur significant transaction and acquisition-related integration costs in
connection with the BPNA Branch Acquisition.
We have developed a plan to integrate the BPNA branches we acquired. Although we anticipate achieving cost synergies in
connection with the BPNA Branch Acquisition, we also expect to incur costs to implement such cost savings measures. We
have incurred, and anticipate that we will continue to incur certain non-recurring charges in connection with this integration,
including charges associated with integrating processes and systems. At this time, we cannot identify the timing, nature and
amount of all such charges. Further, we have incurred, and currently expect to continue to incur significant transaction costs
that will be charged as an expense in the period incurred. The significant transaction costs and acquisition-related integration
costs could materially adversely affect our results of operations in the period in which such charges are recorded or our cash
flow in the period in which any related costs are actually paid. The net benefit associated with the anticipated elimination of
duplicative costs, as well as the realization of other efficiencies related to the integration of the BPNA branches, may not be
achieved in the near term, or at all. Accordingly, the cost and operational savings may not be achievable in our anticipated
amount or timeframe or at all. Investors should not place undue reliance on the anticipated benefits of the BPNA Branch
Acquisition in making an investment decision with respect to our securities.
Risks Relating to Our Internal Control Over Financial Reporting
We have recently taken a number of actions to remediate a material weakness in our internal control over financial
reporting. We may be at risk for future material weaknesses, particularly if the new control measures we implemented
do not continue to operate effectively.
Our management is responsible for establishing and maintaining adequate internal control over our financial reporting, as such
term is defined in Rule 13a-15(f) under the Securities Exchange Act of 1934. In 2014, as disclosed in our Annual Report on
Form 10-K/A for the year ended December 31, 2013, our quarterly report on Form 10-Q/A for the quarterly period ended
March 31, 2014 and our quarterly reports on Form 10-Q for the quarterly periods ended June 30, 2014 and September 30, 2014,
management identified immaterial errors related to prior financial reporting periods that indicated certain deficiencies existed in
our internal control over financial reporting. Management concluded that, for the 2013 reporting period, these deficiencies,
when aggregated, could have resulted in a material misstatement of the consolidated financial statements that would not have
been prevented or detected on a timely basis, and as such, these control deficiencies resulted in a material weakness.
A material weakness is defined as a deficiency, or a combination of deficiencies, in internal control over financial reporting,
such that there is a reasonable possibility that a material misstatement of our annual or interim financial statements will not be
prevented or detected on a timely basis. As described in Item 9A of this Annual Report on Form 10-K, we have recently taken a
number of actions to remediate the material weakness referred to above. Our management has determined that these
remediation actions were effectively designed and demonstrated effective operations for a sufficient period of time to enable us
to conclude that this material weakness had been remediated as of December 31, 2014. However, we must continue to monitor
and evaluate the new control measures we implemented to ensure that they continue to operate effectively and we may be at
risk for future material weaknesses, particularly if these measures do not continue to operate effectively. If additional material
weaknesses in our internal control over financial reporting are discovered or occur in the future, this could result in material
28
misstatements in our consolidated financial statements and/or adversely affect our ability to timely file our annual and quarterly
reports under the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, either of which could have a negative effect on the trading prices of our
securities and our ability to access the capital markets.
Risks Relating to Our Business and Operating Environment
Our business strategy includes significant growth plans, and our financial condition and results of operations could be
negatively affected if we fail to grow or fail to manage our growth effectively.
We have pursued and intend to continue to pursue an organic and acquisition growth strategy for our business. We regularly
evaluate potential acquisitions and expansion opportunities. If appropriate opportunities present themselves, we expect to
engage in selected acquisitions of financial institutions, branch acquisitions and other business growth initiatives or
undertakings. There can be no assurance that we will successfully identify appropriate opportunities, that we will be able to
negotiate or finance such activities or that such activities, if undertaken, will be successful.
There are risks associated with our growth strategy. To the extent that we grow through acquisitions, we cannot ensure that we
will be able to adequately or profitably manage this growth. Acquiring other banks, branches or other assets, as well as other
expansion activities, involves various risks including the risks of incorrectly assessing the credit quality of acquired assets,
encountering greater than expected costs of integrating acquired banks or branches, the risk of loss of customers and/or
employees of the acquired institution or branch, executing cost savings measures, not achieving revenue enhancements and
otherwise not realizing the transaction’s anticipated benefits. Our ability to address these matters successfully cannot be
assured. In addition, our strategic efforts may divert resources or management’s attention from ongoing business operations,
may require investment in integration and in development and enhancement of additional operational and reporting processes
and controls, and may subject us to additional regulatory scrutiny. To finance an acquisition, we may borrow funds, thereby
increasing our leverage and diminishing our liquidity, or raise additional capital, which could dilute the interests of our existing
stockholders.
Our growth initiatives may also require us to recruit experienced personnel to assist in such initiatives. Accordingly, the failure
to identify and retain such personnel would place significant limitations on our ability to successfully execute our growth
strategy. In addition, to the extent we expand our lending beyond our current market areas, we could incur additional risks
related to those new market areas. We may not be able to expand our market presence in our existing market areas or
successfully enter new markets.
If we do not successfully execute our acquisition growth plan, it could adversely affect our business, financial condition, results
of operations, reputation and growth prospects. In addition, if we were to conclude that the value of an acquired business had
decreased and that the related goodwill had been impaired, that conclusion would result in an impairment of goodwill charge to
us, which would adversely affect our results of operations. While we believe we will have the executive management resources
and internal systems in place to successfully manage our future growth, there can be no assurance growth opportunities will be
available or that we will successfully manage our growth.
In addition to the risks presented by the recently completed BPNA Branch Acquisition, our acquisitions of PBOC, The
Palisades Group, RenovationReady and CS Financial may present certain risks to our business and operations.
We completed our acquisitions of PBOC and The Palisades Group on July 1, 2013 and September 11, 2013, respectively, and
our wholly owned subsidiary, the Bank completed the acquisitions of RenovationReady and CS Financial on January 31, 2014
and October 31, 2013, respectively. Difficulties in capitalizing on the opportunities presented by these acquisitions may prevent
us from fully achieving the expected benefits from the acquisitions, or may cause the achievement of such expected benefits to
take longer than expected.
Further, the assimilation of PBOC’s customers and markets could result in higher than expected deposit attrition, loss of key
employees, disruption of our businesses, or otherwise adversely affect our ability to maintain relationships with customers and
employees or achieve the anticipated benefits of the acquisitions. These matters could have an adverse effect on us for an
undetermined period. We will likely be subject to similar risks and difficulties in connection with any future acquisitions.
Our financial condition and results of operations are dependent on the economy, particularly in the Bank’s market
areas. A deterioration in economic conditions in the market areas we serve may impact our earnings adversely and
could increase the credit risk of our loan and lease portfolio.
Our primary market area is concentrated in the greater San Diego, Orange, and Los Angeles counties. Adverse economic
conditions in any of these, market areas can reduce our rate of growth, affect our customers’ ability to repay loans and leases
29
and adversely impact our financial condition and earnings. General economic conditions, including inflation, unemployment
and money supply fluctuations, also may affect our profitability adversely.
A deterioration in economic conditions in the market areas we serve could result in the following consequences, any of which
could have a material adverse effect on our business, financial condition and results of operations:
• Demand for our products and services may decline;
• Loan and lease delinquencies, problem assets and foreclosures may increase;
• Collateral for our loans and leases may further decline in value; and
• The amount of our low-cost or non-interest-bearing deposits may decrease.
We cannot accurately predict the effect of the weakness in the national economy on our future operating results.
The national economy in general and the financial services sector in particular continue to face significant challenges. We
cannot accurately predict the possibility of the economy’s return to recessionary conditions or to a period of economic
weakness, which would adversely impact the markets we serve. Any deterioration in national or local economic conditions
would have an adverse effect, which could be material, on our business, financial condition, results of operations and prospects,
and any economic weakness could present substantial risks for the banking industry and for us.
There are risks associated with our lending activities and our allowance for loan and lease losses may prove to be
insufficient to absorb probable incurred losses in our loan and lease portfolio.
Lending money is a substantial part of our business. Every loan and lease carries a certain risk that it will not be repaid in
accordance with its terms or that any underlying collateral will not be sufficient to assure repayment. This risk is affected by,
among other things:
In the case of a collateralized loan or lease, the changes and uncertainties as to the future value of the collateral;
• Cash flow of the borrower and/or the project being financed;
•
• The credit history of a particular borrower;
• Changes in economic and industry conditions; and
• The duration of the loan or lease.
We maintain an allowance for loan and lease losses which we believe is appropriate to provide for probable incurred losses in
our loan and lease portfolio. The amount of this allowance is determined by our management through a periodic review and
consideration of several factors, including, but not limited to:
• An ongoing review of the quality, size and diversity of the loan and lease portfolio;
• Evaluation of non-performing loans and leases;
• Historical default and loss experience;
• Historical recovery experience;
• Existing economic conditions;
• Risk characteristics of the various classifications of loans and leases; and
• The amount and quality of collateral, including guarantees, securing the loans and leases.
If our loan and lease losses exceed our allowance for loan and lease losses, our business, financial condition and
profitability may suffer.
The determination of the appropriate level of the allowance for loan and lease losses inherently involves a high degree of
subjectivity and requires us to make various assumptions and judgments about the collectability of our loan and lease portfolio,
including the creditworthiness of our borrowers and the value of the real estate and other assets serving as collateral for the
repayment of many of our loans and leases. In determining the amount of the allowance for loan and lease losses, we review
our loans and leases and the loss and delinquency experience, and evaluate economic conditions and make significant estimates
of current credit risks and future trends, all of which may undergo material changes. If our estimates are incorrect, the
allowance for loan and lease losses may not be sufficient to cover losses inherent in our loan and lease portfolio, resulting in the
need for additions to our allowance through an increase in the provision for loan and lease losses. Deterioration in economic
conditions affecting borrowers, new information regarding existing loans and leases, identification of additional problem loans
and leases and other factors, both within and outside of our control, may require an increase in the allowance for loan and lease
losses. Our allowance for loan and lease losses was 0.75 percent of total loans and leases held for investment and 76.81 percent
of nonperforming loans and leases at December 31, 2014. In addition, bank regulatory agencies periodically review our
allowance for loan and lease losses and may require an increase in the provision for loan and lease losses or the recognition of
further charge-offs, based on judgments different than that of management. If charge-offs in future periods exceed the
30
allowance for loan and lease losses, we will need additional provisions to increase the allowance for loan and lease losses. Any
increases in the provision for loan and lease losses will result in a decrease in net income and may have a material adverse
effect on our financial condition and results of operations.
Our business may be adversely affected by credit risk associated with residential property and declining property
values.
At December 31, 2014, $1.30 billion, or 33.0 percent of our total loans and leases, was secured by single family residential
mortgage loans and home equity lines of credit. This type of lending is generally sensitive to regional and local economic
conditions that significantly impact the ability of borrowers to meet their loan payment obligations, making loss levels difficult
to predict. The decline in residential real estate values as a result of the downturn in the California housing markets has reduced
the value of the real estate collateral securing these types of loans and increased the risk that we would incur losses if borrowers
default on their loans. Residential loans with high combined loan-to-value ratios generally will be more sensitive to declining
property values than those with lower combined loan-to-value ratios and therefore may experience a higher incidence of default
and severity of losses. In addition, if the borrowers sell their homes, the borrowers may be unable to repay their loans in full
from the sale proceeds. As a result, these loans may experience higher rates of delinquencies, defaults and losses, which will in
turn adversely affect our financial condition and results of operations.
Our loan portfolio possesses increased risk due to our level of adjustable rate loans.
A substantial majority of our real estate secured loans held are adjustable-rate loans. Any rise in prevailing market interest rates
may result in increased payments for borrowers who have adjustable rate mortgage loans, increasing the possibility of defaults
that may adversely affect our profitability.
Our underwriting practices may not protect us against losses in our loan portfolio.
We seek to mitigate the risks inherent in our loan portfolio by adhering to specific underwriting practices, including: analyzing
a borrower’s credit history, financial statements, tax returns and cash flow projections; valuing collateral based on reports of
independent appraisers; and verifying liquid assets. Although we believe that our underwriting criteria are, and historically have
been, appropriate for the various kinds of loans we make, we have incurred losses on loans that have met these criteria, and
may continue to experience higher than expected losses depending on economic factors and consumer behavior. In addition,
our ability to assess the creditworthiness of our customers may be impaired if the models and approaches we use to select,
manage, and underwrite our customers become less predictive of future behaviors. Finally, we may have higher credit risk, or
experience higher credit losses, to the extent our loans are concentrated by loan type, industry segment, borrower type, or
location of the borrower or collateral. At December 31, 2014, 80.4 percent of our commercial real estate loans and 93.4 percent
of our originated SFR mortgage loans were secured by collateral in Southern California. Deterioration in real estate values and
underlying economic conditions in Southern California could result in significantly higher credit losses to our portfolio.
Our non-traditional and interest-only single-family residential loans expose us to increased lending risk.
Many of the residential mortgage loans we have originated for investment consisted of non-traditional SFR mortgage loans that
do not conform to Fannie Mae or Freddie Mac underwriting guidelines as a result of loan-to-value ratios or debt-to-income
ratios, loan terms, loan size (exceeding agency limits) or other exceptions from agency underwriting guidelines.
Moreover, many of these loans do not meet the qualified mortgage definition established by the Consumer Financial Protection
Bureau (the CFPB), and therefore contain additional regulatory and legal risks. See "-Rulemaking changes by the CFPB in
particular are expected to result in higher regulatory and compliance costs that may adversely affect our financial condition and
results of operations.” In addition, the secondary market demand for nonconforming mortgage loans generally is limited, and
consequently, we may have a difficult time selling the nonconforming loans in our portfolio were we to decide to do so.
In the case of interest-only loans, a borrower’s monthly payment is subject to change when the loan converts to fully-
amortizing status. Since the borrower’s monthly payment may increase by a substantial amount, even without an increase in
prevailing market interest rates, the borrower might not be able to afford the increased monthly payment. In addition, interest-
only loans have a large, balloon payment at the end of the loan term, which the borrower may be unable to pay. Negative
amortization involves a greater risk to us because credit risk exposure increases when the loan incurs negative amortization and
the value of the home serving as collateral for the loan does not increase proportionally. Negative amortization is only
permitted up to 110 percent of the original loan to value ratio during the first five years the loan is outstanding, with payments
adjusting periodically as provided in the loan documents, potentially resulting in higher payments by the borrower. The
adjustment of these loans to higher payment requirements can be a substantial factor in higher loan delinquency levels because
the borrowers may not be able to make the higher payments. Also, real estate values may decline, and credit standards may
31
tighten in concert with the higher payment requirement, making it difficult for borrowers to sell their homes or refinance their
loans to pay off their mortgage obligations. For these reasons, interest-only loans and negative amortization loans are
considered to have an increased risk of delinquency, default and foreclosure than conforming loans and may result in higher
levels of realized losses.
Our income property loans, consisting of commercial and multi-family real estate loans, involve higher principal
amounts than other loans and repayment of these loans may be dependent on factors outside our control or the control
of our borrowers.
We originate commercial and multi-family real estate loans for individuals and businesses for various purposes, which are
secured by commercial properties. These loans typically involve higher principal amounts than other types of loans, and
repayment is dependent upon income generated, or expected to be generated, by the property securing the loan in amounts
sufficient to cover operating expenses and debt service, which may be adversely affected by changes in the economy or local
market conditions. For example, if the cash flow from the borrower’s project is reduced as a result of leases not being obtained
or renewed in a timely manner or at all, the borrower’s ability to repay the loan may be impaired. Commercial and multi-family
real estate loans also expose us to greater credit risk than loans secured by residential real estate because the collateral securing
these loans typically cannot be sold as easily as residential real estate. In addition, many of our commercial and multi-family
real estate loans are not fully amortizing and contain large balloon payments upon maturity. Such balloon payments may
require the borrower to either sell or refinance the underlying property in order to make the payment, which may increase the
risk of default or non-payment.
If we foreclose on a commercial or multi-family real estate loan, our holding period for the collateral typically is longer than
for residential mortgage loans because there are fewer potential purchasers of the collateral. Additionally, commercial and
multi-family real estate loans generally have relatively large balances to single borrowers or groups of related borrowers.
Accordingly, if we make any errors in judgment in the collectability of our commercial and multi-family real estate loans, any
resulting charge-offs may be larger on a per loan basis than those incurred with our residential or consumer loan portfolios. As
of December 31, 2014, our commercial and multi-family real estate loans totaled $1.96 billion, or 49.5 percent of our total
loans and leases.
Our portfolio of Green Loans subjects us to greater risks of loss.
We have a portfolio of Green Account home equity loans which generally have a fifteen year draw period with interest-only
payment requirements, and a balloon payment requirement at the end of the draw period. The Green Loans include an
associated “clearing account” that allows all types of deposit and withdrawal transactions to be performed by the borrower
during the term. We ceased originating new Green Loans in 2011; however, existing Green Loan borrowers are entitled to
continue to draw on their Green Loans. At December 31, 2014, the balance of Green Loans in our portfolio totaled $128.2
million, or 3.2 percent of our total loans and leases.
In 2011, we implemented an information reporting system which allowed us to capture more detailed information than was
previously possible, including transaction level data concerning our Green Loans. Although such transaction level data would
have enabled us to more closely monitor trends in the credit quality of our Green Loans, we do not possess the enhanced
transaction level data relating to the Green Loans for periods prior to the implementation of those enhanced systems. Although
we do not believe that the absence of such historical data itself represents a material impediment to our current mechanisms for
monitoring the credit quality of the Green Loans, until we compile sufficient transaction level data going forward we are
limited in our ability to use historical information to monitor trends in the portfolio that might assist us in anticipating credit
problems. Green Loans expose us to greater credit risk than other residential mortgage loans because they are non- amortizing
and contain large balloon payments upon maturity. Although the loans require the borrower to make monthly interest payments,
we are also subject to an increased risk of loss in connection with the Green Loans because payments due under the loans can
be made by means of additional advances drawn by the borrower, up to the amount of the credit limit, thereby increasing our
overall loss exposure due to negative amortization. The balloon payment due on maturity may require the borrower to either
sell or refinance the underlying property in order to make the payment, which may increase the risk of default or non-payment.
Our ability to take remedial actions in response to these additional risks of loss is limited by the terms and conditions of the
Green Loans and our alternatives consist primarily of the ability to curtail additional borrowing when we determine that either
the collateral value of the underlying real property or the credit worthiness of the borrower no longer supports the level of
credit originally extended. Additionally, many of our Green Loans have larger balances than traditional residential mortgage
loans, and accordingly, if the loans go into default either during the draw period or at maturity, any resulting charge-offs may be
larger on a per loan basis than those incurred with traditional residential loans.
32
If our investments in other real estate owned are not properly valued or sufficiently reserved to cover actual losses, or if
we are required to increase our valuation reserves, our earnings could be reduced.
We obtain updated valuations in the form of appraisals and broker price opinions when a loan has been foreclosed upon and the
property is taken in as other real estate owned (OREO), and at certain other times during the asset’s holding period. Our net
book value (NBV) in the loan at the time of foreclosure and thereafter is compared to the updated market value (fair value) of
the foreclosed property less estimated selling costs. A charge-off is recorded for any excess in the asset’s NBV over its fair
value. If our valuation process is incorrect, the fair value of our investments in OREO may not be sufficient to recover our
NBV in such assets, resulting in the need for additional write-downs. Additional write-downs to our investments in OREO
could have a material adverse effect on our financial condition and results of operations. Our bank regulators periodically
review our OREO and may require us to recognize further write-downs. Any increase in our write-downs, as required by such
regulator, may have a material adverse effect on our financial condition and results of operations. As of December 31, 2014, we
had OREO of $423 thousand.
Our portfolio of “re-performing” loans subjects us to a greater risk of loss.
We have a portfolio of re-performing residential mortgage loans which we purchased in several large pools at a discount to the
outstanding principal balance on the loans. These re-performing loans were discounted because either (i) the borrower was
delinquent at the time of the loan purchase or had previously been delinquent and had become current prior to our purchase of
the loan, or (ii) because the loan had been modified from its original terms. We purchased the loans because we believe that we
can successfully service the loans and have the borrowers consistently meet their obligations under the loan, which will
increase the value of the loans. However, re-performing loans expose us to greater credit risk than other residential mortgage
loans because they have a higher risk of delinquency, default and foreclosure than other residential mortgage loans and may
result in higher levels of realized losses.
Repayment of our commercial and industrial loans is often dependent on the cash flows of the borrower, which may be
unpredictable, and the collateral securing these loans may not be sufficient to repay the loan in the event of default.
We make our commercial and industrial loans primarily based on the identified cash flow of the borrower and secondarily on
the underlying collateral provided by the borrower. Collateral securing commercial and industrial loans may depreciate over
time, be difficult to appraise and fluctuate in value. In the case of loans secured by accounts receivable, the availability of funds
for the repayment of these loans may be substantially dependent on the ability of the borrower to collect the amounts due from
its customers. As of December 31, 2014, our commercial and industrial loans totaled $490.9 million, or 12.4 percent of our
total loans and leases.
We are exposed to risk of environmental liabilities with respect to real properties which we may acquire.
In recent years, due to weakness of the U.S. economy and, more specifically, the California economy, including higher levels of
unemployment than the nationwide average and declines in real estate values, many borrowers have been unable to meet their
loan repayment obligations and, as a result, we have had to initiate foreclosure proceedings with respect to and take title to an
increased number of real properties that had collateralized their loans. As an owner of such properties, we could become subject
to environmental liabilities and incur substantial costs for any property damage, personal injury, investigation and clean-up that
may be required due to any environmental contamination that may be found to exist at any of those properties, even though we
did not engage in the activities that led to such contamination. In addition, if we are the owner or former owner of a
contaminated site, we may be subject to common law claims by third parties seeking damages for environmental contamination
emanating from the site. If we were to become subject to significant environmental liabilities or costs, our business, financial
condition, results of operations and prospects could be adversely affected.
The expansion of our single family residential mortgage loan originations could adversely affect our business, financial
condition and results of operations.
A significant portion of our loan originations business consists of providing purchase money loans to homebuyers and
refinancing existing loans. The origination of purchase money mortgage loans is greatly influenced by independent third parties
involved in the home buying process such as realtors and builders. As a result, our ability to secure relationships with such
independent third parties will affect our ability to grow our purchase money mortgage loan volume and, thus, our loan
originations business. Our retail branches and retail call center also originate refinancings of existing mortgage loans, which are
very sensitive to increases in interest rates, and may decrease significantly if interest rates rise.
33
Our wholesale originations business operates largely through third party mortgage brokers who are not contractually obligated
to do business with us. Further, our competitors also have relationships with our brokers and actively compete with us in our
efforts to expand our broker networks. Accordingly, we may not be successful in maintaining our existing relationships or
expanding our broker networks.
We have made substantial investments to grow our residential mortgage lending business in recent quarters, including adding
experienced mortgage loan officers and administrators and management, leasing additional space at our headquarters, opening
additional loan production offices, and investing in technology. Our residential mortgage lending business may not generate
sufficient revenues to enable us to recover our substantial investment in our residential mortgage lending business, or may not
grow sufficiently to contribute to earnings in relation to our investment. Moreover, we may be unable to sell the mortgage loans
we originate into the secondary mortgage market at a profit due to changes in interest rates or a reduction in the demand for
mortgage loans in the secondary mortgage market. Accordingly, our investment in and expansion of our residential mortgage
lending business could adversely affect our business, financial condition and results of operations.
An increase in interest rates, change in the programs offered by governmental sponsored entities (GSE) or our ability to
qualify for such programs may reduce our mortgage revenues, which would negatively impact our non-interest income.
Our mortgage banking operations provide a significant portion of our non-interest income. We generate mortgage revenues
primarily from gains on the sale of single-family residential loans pursuant to programs currently offered by Fannie Mae,
Freddie Mac, Ginnie Mae and other investors. These entities account for a substantial portion of the secondary market in
residential mortgage loans. Any future changes in these programs, our eligibility to participate in such programs, the criteria for
loans to be accepted or laws that significantly affect the activity of such entities could, in turn, materially adversely affect our
results of operations. Further, in a rising or higher interest rate environment, our originations of mortgage loans may decrease,
resulting in fewer loans that are available to be sold to investors. This would result in a decrease in mortgage revenues and a
corresponding decrease in non-interest income. In addition, our results of operations are affected by the amount of non-interest
expense associated with mortgage banking activities, such as salaries and employee benefits, occupancy, equipment and data
processing expense and other operating costs. During periods of reduced loan demand, our results of operations may be
adversely affected to the extent that we are unable to reduce expenses commensurate with the decline in loan originations.
Secondary mortgage market conditions could have a material adverse impact on our financial condition and earnings.
In addition to being affected by interest rates, the secondary mortgage markets are subject to investor demand for single-family
residential loans and mortgage-backed securities and investor yield requirements for those loans and securities. These
conditions may fluctuate or even worsen in the future. Our business strategy is to originate conforming conventional and
government residential mortgage loans and a portion of our nonconforming jumbo conventional residential mortgage loans for
sale in the secondary market. Originating loans for sale enables us to earn revenue from fees and gains on loan sales, while
reducing our credit risk on the loans as well as our liquidity requirements. We also can use the loan sale proceeds to generate
new loans.
We rely on government sponsored entities- Fannie Mae, Freddie Mac and Ginnie Mae - to purchase residential mortgage loans
that meet their loan requirements and on other capital markets investors to purchase a portion of our residential mortgage loans
that do not meet those requirements – referred to as “nonconforming” loans. Our ability to sell residential mortgage loans
readily also is dependent upon our ability to remain eligible for the programs offered by GSEs and other market participants.
Any significant impairment of our eligibility to participate in the programs offered by the GSEs and other market participants
could materially and adversely affect us. Further, the criteria for loans to be accepted under such programs may be changed
from time-to-time by the sponsoring entity which could result in a lower volume of corresponding loan originations or other
administrative costs. Reduced demand in the capital markets could cause us to retain more nonconforming loans. In addition,
no assurance can be given that GSEs will not materially limit their purchases of conforming loans, including because of capital
constraints, or change their criteria for conforming loans (e.g., maximum loan amount or borrower eligibility). Each of the
GSEs is currently in conservatorship, with its primary regulator, the Federal Housing Agency acting as conservator. We cannot
predict if, when or how the conservatorship will end, or any associated changes to the GSEs business structure and operations
that could result. In addition, there are various proposals to reform the role of the GSEs in the U.S. housing finance market. The
extent and timing of any such regulatory reform regarding the housing finance market and the GSEs, including whether the
GSEs will continue to exist in their current form, as well as any effect on the Company’s business and financial results, are
uncertain.
Significant changes in the secondary mortgage market or a prolonged period of secondary market illiquidity may reduce our
loan production volumes and could have a material adverse impact on our future earnings and financial condition.
34
In addition, the secondary market demand for nonconforming jumbo loans generally is not as strong as the demand for
conventional loans and can be volatile, reducing the demand or pricing for those loans; consequently, we may have a more
difficult time selling the nonconforming jumbo loans that we originate.
Changes in interest rates may change the value of our mortgage servicing rights, which may increase the volatility of our
earnings.
As a result of our sales of mortgage loans to Fannie Mae, Freddie Mac and Ginnie Mae, we have a growing portfolio of mortgage
servicing rights. A mortgage servicing right is the right to service a mortgage loan - collect principal, interest and escrow amounts
- for a fee. Our mortgage servicing rights support our mortgage banking strategies and diversify revenue streams from our mortgage
banking segment.
We measure and carry all of our residential mortgage servicing rights using the fair value measurement method. Fair value is
determined as the present value of estimated future net servicing income, calculated based on a number of variables, including
assumptions about the likelihood of prepayment by borrowers.
The primary risk associated with mortgage servicing rights is that in a declining interest rate environment, they will likely lose a
substantial portion of their value as a result of higher than anticipated prepayments. Moreover, if prepayments are greater than
expected, the cash we receive over the life of the mortgage loans would be reduced. Conversely, these assets generally increase
in value in a rising interest rate environment to the extent that prepayments are slower than previously estimated. Although our
mortgage servicing rights diversify the revenue streams from our mortgage banking segment, the increasing size of our mortgage
servicing rights portfolio may increase our interest rate risk and correspondingly, the volatility of our earnings.
At December 31, 2014 and 2013, our mortgage servicing rights had fair values of $19.1 million and $13.5 million, respectively.
Changes in fair value of our mortgage servicing rights are recorded to earnings in each period. Depending on the interest rate
environment, it is possible that the fair value of our mortgage servicing rights may be reduced in the future. If such changes in
fair value significantly reduce the carrying value of our mortgage servicing rights, our financial condition and results of operations
would be negatively affected.
Certain hedging strategies that we use to manage investment in mortgage loans held for sale and interest rate lock
commitments may be ineffective to offset any adverse changes in the fair value of these assets due to changes in interest
rates and market liquidity.
We use derivative instruments to hedge the interest rate risks associated with the fair value of certain mortgage loans held for sale
and interest rate lock commitments. Our hedging strategies are highly susceptible to basis risk, market volatility and changes in
the shape of the yield curve, among other factors. In addition, hedging strategies rely on assumptions and projections regarding
assets and general market factors. If these assumptions and projections prove to be incorrect or our hedging strategies do not
adequately mitigate the impact of changes in interest rates, we may incur losses that would adversely impact earnings.
Any breach of representations and warranties made by us to our residential mortgage loan purchasers or credit default
on our loan sales may require us to repurchase residential mortgage loans we have sold.
We sell a majority of the residential mortgage loans we originate in the secondary market pursuant to agreements that generally
require us to repurchase loans in the event of a breach of a representation or warranty made by us to the loan purchaser. Any
fraud or misrepresentation during the mortgage loan origination process, whether by us, the borrower, mortgage broker, or
other party in the transaction, or, in some cases, upon any early payment default on such mortgage loans, may require us to
repurchase such loans.
We believe that, as a result of the increased defaults and foreclosures during the past several years resulting in increased
demand for repurchases and indemnification in the secondary market, many purchasers of residential mortgage loans are
particularly aware of the conditions under which originators must indemnify or repurchase loans and would benefit from
enforcing any repurchase remedies they may have. We believe that our exposure to repurchases under our representations and
warranties includes the current unpaid balance of all loans we have sold. During the years ended December 31, 2014, 2013 and
2012, we sold residential mortgage loans aggregating $2.75 billion, $1.86 billion and $477 million, respectively.
To recognize the potential loan repurchase or indemnification losses, we recorded a total reserve of $8.3 million at December
31, 2014. Increases to this reserve reduce mortgage banking revenue. The determination of the appropriate level of the reserve
inherently involves a high degree of subjectivity and requires us to make estimates of repurchase and indemnification risks and
expected losses. The estimates used could be inaccurate, resulting in a level of reserve that is less than actual losses.
35
Deterioration in the economy, an increase in interest rates or a decrease in home values could increase customer defaults on
loans that were sold and increase demand for repurchases and indemnification and increase our losses from loan repurchases
and indemnification. If we are required to indemnify loan purchasers or repurchase loans and incur losses that exceed our
reserve, this could adversely affect our business, financial condition and results of operations. In addition, any claims asserted
against us in the future by loan purchasers may result in liabilities or legal expenses that could have a material adverse effect on
our results of operations and financial condition.
We may not be able to maintain a strong core deposit base or other low-cost funding sources.
We expect to depend on checking, savings and money market deposit account balances and other forms of customer deposits as
the primary source of funding for our lending activities. Our future growth will largely depend on our ability to maintain a
strong core deposit base, to provide a less costly and more stable source of funding. It may prove difficult to maintain our core
deposit base. There may be competitive pressures to pay higher interest rates on deposits, which would increase our funding
costs. If customers move money out of bank deposits and into other investments (or into similar products at other institutions
that may provide a higher rate of return), we could lose a relatively low cost source of funds, increasing our funding costs and
reducing our net interest income and net income. Additionally, any such loss of funds could result in reduced loan originations,
which could materially negatively impact our growth strategy and results of operations.
Other-than-temporary impairment charges in our investment securities portfolio could result in losses and adversely
affect our continuing operations.
As of December 31, 2014, the Company’s investment securities portfolio consisted of 92 securities, 49 of which were in an
unrealized loss position. The majority of unrealized losses are related to the Company’s private label residential mortgage-
backed securities and agency residential mortgage-backed securities, as discussed below.
The Company’s private label residential mortgage-backed securities that are in a loss position had a fair value of $1.7 million
with unrealized losses of $13 thousand at December 31, 2014. The Company’s agency residential mortgage-backed securities
that are in a loss position had a fair value of $90.4 million with unrealized losses of approximately $605 thousand at December
31, 2014. The Company monitors to ensure it has adequate credit support and as of December 31, 2014, the Company believes
there is no other than temporary impairment (OTTI) and did not have the intent to sell these securities and it is likely that it will
not be required to sell the securities before their anticipated recovery. The portfolio is evaluated using either OTTI guidance
provided by ASC 320 or ASC 325. Investment securities classified as available for sale or held to maturity are generally
evaluated for OTTI under ASC 320. However, certain residential mortgage-backed securities that had credit ratings at time of
purchase below AA are evaluated using guidance provided by ASC 325. The residential mortgage-backed securities in the
Company’s portfolio referenced above were rated AA or above at purchase and are not within the scope of ASC 325. For more
information about ASC 320 and ASC 325, see Note 1 of the Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements in Item 8.
We closely monitor our investment securities for changes in credit risk. The valuation of our investment securities also is
influenced by external market and other factors, including implementation of SEC and Financial Accounting Standards Board
guidance on fair value accounting. Accordingly, if market conditions deteriorate further and we determine our holdings of other
investment securities are OTTI, our future earnings, stockholders’ equity, regulatory capital and continuing operations could be
materially adversely affected.
Rising interest rates may hurt our profits.
To be profitable, we have to earn more money in interest that we receive on loans and investments than we pay to our
depositors and lenders in interest. If interest rates rise, our net interest income and the value of our assets could be reduced if
interest paid on interest-bearing liabilities, such as deposits and borrowings, increases more quickly than interest received on
interest-earning assets, such as loans, other mortgage-related investments and investment securities. This is most likely to occur
if short-term interest rates increase at a faster rate than long-term interest rates, which would cause net income to go down. In
addition, rising interest rates may hurt our income, because that may reduce the demand for loans and the value of our
securities. In a rapidly changing interest rate environment, we may not be able to manage our interest rate risk effectively,
which would adversely impact our financial condition and results of operations.
We face significant operational risks.
We operate many different financial service functions and rely on the ability of our employees, third-party vendors and systems
to process a significant number of transactions. Operational risk is the risk of loss from operations, including fraud by
36
employees or outside persons, employees’ execution of incorrect or unauthorized transactions, data processing and technology
errors or hacking and breaches of internal control systems.
Our enterprise risk management framework may not be effective in mitigating risk and reducing the potential for losses.
Our enterprise risk management framework seeks to mitigate risk and loss to us. We have established comprehensive policies
and procedures and an internal control framework designed to provide a sound operational environment for the types of risk to
which we are subject, including credit risk, market risk (interest rate and price risks), liquidity risk, operational risk, compliance
risk, strategic risk, and reputational risk. However, as with any risk management framework, there are inherent limitations to
our current and future risk management strategies, including risks that we have not appropriately anticipated or identified. In
certain instances, we rely on models to measure, monitor and predict risks. However, these models are inherently limited
because they involve techniques, including the use of historical data in some circumstances, and judgments that cannot
anticipate every economic and financial outcome in the markets in which we operate, nor can they anticipate the specifics and
timing of such outcomes. There is no assurance that these models will appropriately capture all relevant risks or accurately
predict future events or exposures. Accurate and timely enterprise-wide risk information is necessary to enhance management’s
decision-making in times of crisis. If our enterprise risk management framework proves ineffective or if our enterprise-wide
management information is incomplete or inaccurate, we could suffer unexpected losses, which could materially adversely
affect our results of operations or financial condition.
In addition, our businesses and the markets in which we operate are continuously evolving. We may fail to fully understand the
implications of changes in our businesses or the financial markets or fail to adequately or timely enhance our enterprise risk
framework to address those changes. If our enterprise risk framework is ineffective, either because it fails to keep pace with
changes in the financial markets, regulatory requirements, our businesses, our counterparties, clients or service providers or for
other reasons, we could incur losses, suffer reputational damage or find ourselves out of compliance with applicable regulatory
or contractual mandates.
An important aspect of our enterprise risk management framework is creating a risk culture in which all employees fully
understand that there is risk in every aspect of our business and the importance of managing risk as it relates to their job
functions. We continue to enhance our enterprise risk management program to support our risk culture, ensuring that it is
sustainable and appropriate to our role as a major financial institution. Nonetheless, if we fail to create the appropriate
environment that sensitizes all of our employees to managing risk, our business could be adversely impacted. For more
information on our risk management framework, see “Item 1. Business-Lending Activities-Governance.”
Managing reputational risk is important to attracting and maintaining customers, investors and employees.
Threats to our reputation can come from many sources, including adverse sentiment about financial institutions generally,
unethical practices, employee misconduct, failure to deliver minimum standards of service or quality, compliance deficiencies
and questionable or fraudulent activities of our customers. We have policies and procedures in place to promote ethical conduct
and protect our reputation. However, these policies and procedures may not be fully effective. Negative publicity regarding our
business, employees, or customers, with or without merit, may result in the loss of customers, investors and employees, costly
litigation, a decline in revenues and increased governmental oversight.
Liquidity risk could impair our ability to fund operations and jeopardize our financial condition.
Liquidity is essential to our business. An inability to raise funds through deposits, borrowings, the sale of loans and other
sources could have a substantial negative effect on our liquidity. Our access to funding sources in amounts adequate to finance
our activities or on terms that are acceptable to us could be impaired by factors that affect us specifically or the financial
services industry or economy in general. Factors that could detrimentally impact our access to liquidity sources include a
decrease in the level of our business activity as a result of a downturn in the markets in which our loans are concentrated or
adverse regulatory action against us. Our ability to borrow could also be impaired by factors that are not specific to us, such as
a disruption in the financial markets or negative views and expectations about the prospects for the financial services industry.
The held for sale loan balance in our mortgage banking business represents mortgage loans that are in the process of being sold
to various investors. Loan balances steadily accumulate and then decrease at the time of sale. We fund these balances through
short term funding, primarily through FHLB advances, which require collateral. In the event we experience a significant
increase in our held for sale loan balances, our liquidity could be negatively impacted as we increase our short term borrowings
and therefore our required collateral. Although we have access to other sources of contingent liquidity, we could be materially
and adversely affected if we fail to effectively manage this risk.
37
We depend on our key employees.
Our future prospects are and will remain highly dependent on our directors and executive officers. Our success will, to some
extent, depend on the continued service of our directors and continued employment of the executive officers. The unexpected
loss of the services of any of these individuals could have a detrimental effect on our business. Although we have entered into
employment agreements with members of our senior management team, no assurance can be given that these individuals will
continue to be employed by us. The loss of any of these individuals could negatively affect our ability to achieve our growth
strategy and could have a material adverse effect on our results of operations and financial condition.
We currently hold a significant amount of bank-owned life insurance.
At December 31, 2014, we held $19.1 million of bank-owned life insurance (BOLI) on certain key and former employees and
executives, with a cash surrender value of $19.1 million. The eventual repayment of the cash surrender value is subject to the
ability of the various insurance companies to pay death benefits or to return the cash surrender value to us if needed for
liquidity purposes. We continually monitor the financial strength of the various companies with whom we carry these policies.
However, any one of these companies could experience a decline in financial strength, which could impair its ability to pay
benefits or return our cash surrender value. If we need to liquidate these policies for liquidity purposes, we would be subject to
taxation on the increase in cash surrender value and penalties for early termination, both of which would adversely impact
earnings.
If our investment in the Federal Home Loan Bank of San Francisco becomes impaired, our earnings and stockholders’
equity could decrease.
At December 31, 2014, we owned $29.8 million in Federal Home Loan Bank (FHLB) stock. We are required to own this stock
to be a member of and to obtain advances from our FHLB. This stock is not marketable and can only be redeemed by our
FHLB. Our FHLB’s financial condition is linked, in part, to the eleven other members of the FHLB System and to accounting
rules and asset quality risks that could materially lower their capital, which would cause our FHLB stock to be deemed
impaired, resulting in a decrease in our earnings and assets.
We rely on numerous external vendors.
We rely on numerous external vendors to provide us with products and services necessary to maintain our day-to-day
operations. Accordingly, our operations are exposed to risk that these vendors will not perform in accordance with the
contracted arrangements under service level agreements. The failure of an external vendor to perform in accordance with the
contracted arrangements under service level agreements because of changes in the vendor's organizational structure, financial
condition, support for existing products and services or strategic focus or for any other reason, could be disruptive to our
operations, which in turn could have a material negative impact on our financial condition and results of operations. We also
could be adversely affected to the extent such an agreement is not renewed by the third party vendor or is renewed on terms
less favorable to us.
We are subject to certain risks in connection with our use of technology.
Our security measures may not be sufficient to mitigate the risk of a cyber attack or cyber theft.
Communications and information systems are essential to the conduct of our business, as we use such systems to manage our
customer relationships, our general ledger and virtually all other aspects of our business. Our operations rely on the secure
processing, storage, and transmission of confidential and other information in our computer systems and networks. Although
we take protective measures and endeavor to modify them as circumstances warrant, the security of our computer systems,
software, and networks may be vulnerable to breaches, unauthorized access, misuse, computer viruses, or other malicious code
and cyber attacks that could have a security impact. If one or more of these events occur, this could jeopardize our or our
customers' confidential and other information processed and stored in, and transmitted through, our computer systems and
networks, or otherwise cause interruptions or malfunctions in our operations or the operations of our customers or
counterparties. We may be required to expend significant additional resources to modify our protective measures or to
investigate and remediate vulnerabilities or other exposures, and we may be subject to litigation and financial losses that are
either not insured against or not fully covered through any insurance maintained by us. We could also suffer significant
reputational damage.
Security breaches in our internet banking activities could further expose us to possible liability and damage our reputation. Any
compromise of our security also could deter customers from using our internet banking services that involve the transmission
38
of confidential information. We rely on standard internet security systems to provide the security and authentication necessary
to effect secure transmission of data. These precautions may not protect our systems from compromises or breaches of our
security measures, which could result in significant legal liability and significant damage to our reputation and our business.
Our security measures may not protect us from systems failures or interruptions.
While we have established policies and procedures to prevent or limit the impact of systems failures and interruptions, there
can be no assurance that such events will not occur or that they will be adequately addressed if they do. In addition, we
outsource certain aspects of our data processing and other operational functions to certain third-party providers. If our third-
party providers encounter difficulties, or if we have difficulty in communicating with them, our ability to adequately process
and account for transactions could be affected, and our business operations could be adversely impacted. Threats to information
security also exist in the processing of customer information through various other vendors and their personnel.
The occurrence of any systems failure or interruption could damage our reputation and result in a loss of customers and
business, could subject us to additional regulatory scrutiny, or could expose us to legal liability. Any of these occurrences could
have a material adverse effect on our financial condition and results of operations.
We rely on communications, information, operating and financial control systems technology from third-party service
providers, and we may suffer an interruption in those systems.
We rely heavily on third-party service providers for much of our communications, information, operating and financial control
systems technology, including our online banking services and data processing systems. Any failure or interruption, or breaches
in security, of these systems could result in failures or interruptions in our customer relationship management, general ledger,
deposit, servicing and/or loan origination systems and, therefore, could harm our business, operating results and financial
condition. Additionally, interruptions in service and security breaches could lead existing customers to terminate their banking
relationships with us and could make it more difficult for us to attract new banking customers.
We operate in a highly regulated environment and our operations and income may be affected adversely by changes in
laws, rules and regulations governing our operations.
We are subject to extensive regulation and supervision by the Federal Reserve Board, the OCC and the FDIC. The Federal
Reserve Board regulates the supply of money and credit in the United States. Its fiscal and monetary policies determine in a
large part our cost of funds for lending and investing and the return that can be earned on those loans and investments, both of
which affect our net interest margin. Federal Reserve Board policies can also materially affect the value of financial
instruments that we hold, such as debt securities, certain mortgage loans held for sale and mortgage servicing rights (MSRs). Its
policies also can affect our borrowers, potentially increasing the risk that they may fail to repay their loans or satisfy their
obligations to us. Changes in policies of the Federal Reserve Board are beyond our control and the impact of changes in those
policies on our activities and results of operations can be difficult to predict.
The Company and the Bank are heavily regulated. This regulation is to protect depositors, federal deposit insurance funds and
the banking system as a whole, and not stockholders. These regulatory authorities have extensive discretion in connection with
their supervisory and enforcement activities, including the ability to impose restrictions on a bank’s operations, reclassify
assets, determine the adequacy of a bank’s allowance for loan and lease losses and determine the level of deposit insurance
premiums assessed.
The federal banking regulatory agencies have adopted rules to implement a new global regulatory standard on bank capital
adequacy referred to as Basel III, as well as to implement the capital requirements under the Dodd-Frank Act. The new rules
increase minimum capital ratios, add a new minimum common equity ratio, add a new capital conservation buffer, and change
the risk-weightings of certain assets. The new rules became effective January 1, 2015, with some changes transitioned to full
effectiveness over two to four years.
Congress and federal agencies continually review banking laws, regulations and policies for possible changes. Any change in
such regulation and oversight, whether in the form of regulatory policy, new regulations or legislation or additional deposit
insurance premiums could have a material adverse impact on our operations. Because our business is highly regulated, the laws
and applicable regulations are subject to frequent change. Any new laws, rules and regulations could make compliance more
difficult or expensive or otherwise adversely affect our business, financial condition or growth prospects. Such changes could
subject us to additional costs, limit the types of financial services and products we may offer and/or increase the ability of non-
banks to offer competing financial services and products, among other things.
39
The Dodd-Frank Act and supporting regulations could have a material adverse effect on us.
The Dodd-Frank Act provides for, among other things, new restrictions and an expanded framework of regulatory oversight for
financial institutions and their holding companies. These changes may result in additional restrictions on investments and other
activities.
Regulations under the Dodd-Frank Act significantly impact our operations, and we expect to continue to face increased
regulation. These regulations may affect the manner in which we do business and the products and services that we provide,
affect or restrict our ability to compete in our current businesses or our ability to enter into or acquire new businesses, reduce or
limit our revenue or impose additional fees, assessments or taxes on us, intensify the regulatory supervision of us and the
financial services industry, and adversely affect our business operations. The Dodd-Frank Act, among other things, established
a Consumer Financial Protection Bureau (the CFPB) with broad authority to administer and enforce a new federal regulatory
framework of consumer financial regulation. Many of the provisions of the Dodd-Frank Act have extended implementation
periods and require extensive additional rulemaking, guidance and interpretation by various regulatory agencies. The Dodd-
Frank Act calls for many administrative rulemakings by various federal agencies to implement various parts of the legislation.
While some rules have been finalized or issued in proposed form, many have yet to be proposed. It is impossible to predict
when all such additional rules will be issued or finalized, and what the content of such rules will be. We will have to apply
resources to ensure that we are in compliance with all applicable provisions of the Dodd-Frank Act and any implementing
rules, which may increase our costs of operations and adversely impact our earnings. We expect that the Dodd-Frank Act,
including current and future rules implementing its provisions and the interpretations of those rules, will reduce our revenues,
increase our expenses, require us to change certain of our business practices, increase the regulatory supervision of us, increase
our capital requirements and impose additional assessments and costs on us, and otherwise adversely affect our business.
Rulemaking changes implemented by the CFPB in particular are expected to result in higher regulatory and compliance
costs that may adversely affect our financial condition and results of operations.
As indicated above, the Dodd-Frank Act created the CFPB, a new, independent federal agency with broad rulemaking,
supervisory and enforcement powers under various federal consumer financial protection laws, including the laws referenced
above, fair lending laws and certain other statutes. The CFPB has examination and primary enforcement authority with respect
to depository institutions with $10 billion or more in assets, their service providers and certain non-depository entities such as
debt collectors and consumer reporting agencies. In the case of banks, such as the Bank, with total assets of less than $10
billion, this examination and enforcement authority is held by the institution’s primary federal banking regulator (the OCC, in
the case of the Bank).
The CFPB has authority to prevent unfair, deceptive or abusive practices in connection with the offering of consumer financial
products. The Dodd-Frank Act authorizes the CFPB to establish certain minimum standards for the origination of residential
mortgages including a determination of the borrower’s ability to repay. In addition, the Dodd-Frank Act allows borrowers to
raise certain defenses to foreclosure if they receive any loan other than a “qualified mortgage” as defined by the CFPB. The
Dodd-Frank Act permits states to adopt consumer protection laws and standards that are more stringent than those adopted at
the federal level and, in certain circumstances, permits state attorneys general to enforce compliance with both the state and
federal laws and regulations.
The CFPB has finalized a number of significant rules which impact nearly every aspect of the lifecycle of a residential
mortgage loan. Among other things, the rules adopted by the CFPB require banks to: (i) develop and implement procedures to
ensure compliance with a “reasonable ability to repay” test and identify whether a loan meets a new definition for a “qualified
mortgage,” in which case a rebuttable presumption exists that the creditor extending the loan has satisfied the reasonable ability
to repay test; (ii) implement new or revised disclosures, policies and procedures for originating and servicing mortgages
including, but not limited to, pre-loan counseling, early intervention with delinquent borrowers and specific loss mitigation
procedures for loans secured by a borrower's principal residence; (iii) comply with additional restrictions on mortgage loan
originator hiring and compensation; (iv) comply with new disclosure requirements and standards for appraisals and certain
financial products; and (v) maintain escrow accounts for higher-priced mortgage loans for a longer period of time.
In order to comply with the CFPB rules, we have made significant changes to our residential mortgage business, including
investments in technology, training of our personnel, changes in the loan products we offer, changes in compensation of our
loan originators and mortgage brokers that do business with us, and a reduction in fees that we charge, We are continuing to
analyze the impact that such rules may have on our business. In addition to the exercise of its rulemaking authority, the CFPB’s
supervisory powers entitle the CFPB to examine institutions for violations of consumer lending laws, even in the absence of
consumer complaints or damages.
40
Compliance with the rules and policies adopted by the CFPB has limited the products we may permissibly offer to some or all
of our customers, or limit the terms on which those products may be issued, or may adversely affect our ability to conduct our
business as previously conducted, including our residential mortgage lending business. We may also be required to add
compliance personnel or incur other significant compliance-related expenses. Our business, financial condition, results of
operations and/or competitive position may be adversely affected as a result.
The short-term and long-term impact of the changing regulatory capital requirements and new capital rules is
uncertain.
In July 2013, the FRB and the other federal bank regulatory agencies issued a final rule to revise their risk-based and leverage
capital requirements and their method for calculating risk-weighted assets to make them consistent with the agreements that
were reached by the Basel Committee on Banking Supervision and certain provisions of the Dodd-Frank Act. The final rule
applies to all banking organizations. Among other things, the rule establishes a new common equity Tier 1 minimum capital
requirement (4.5 percent of risk-weighted assets) and a higher minimum Tier 1 risk-based capital requirement (6 percent of
risk-weighted assets) and assigns higher risk weightings (150 percent) to exposures that are more than 90 days past due or are
on nonaccrual status and certain commercial real estate facilities that finance the acquisition, development or construction of
real property. The final rule also limits a banking organization’s capital distributions and certain discretionary bonus payments
if the banking organization does not hold a “capital conservation buffer” of 2.5 percent of common equity tier 1 capital to risk-
weighted assets, which is in addition to the amount necessary to meet its minimum risk-based capital requirements. The final
rule became effective for the Company and the Bank on January 1, 2015. The capital conservation buffer requirement will be
phased in beginning January 1, 2016, and ending January 1, 2019, when the full capital conservation buffer requirement will be
effective. An institution will be subject to limitations on paying dividends, engaging in share repurchases, and paying
discretionary bonuses if its capital level falls below the buffer amount. These limitations will establish a maximum percentage
of eligible retained income that can be utilized for such activities.
While our current capital levels exceed the new capital requirements, our capital levels could decrease in the future as a result
of factors such as acquisitions, faster than anticipated growth, reduced earnings levels, operating losses and other factors. The
application of more stringent capital requirements for us could, among other things, result in lower returns on equity, require
the raising of additional capital, and result in our inability to pay dividends or repurchase shares if we were to be unable to
comply with such requirements.
We are subject to federal and state and fair lending laws, and failure to comply with these laws could lead to material
penalties.
Federal and state fair lending laws and regulations, such as the Equal Credit Opportunity Act and the Fair Housing Act, impose
nondiscriminatory lending requirements on financial institutions. The Department of Justice, CFPB and other federal and state
agencies are responsible for enforcing these laws and regulations. Private parties may also have the ability to challenge an
institution’s performance under fair lending laws in private class action litigation. A successful challenge to our performance
under the fair lending laws and regulations could adversely impact our rating under the CRA and result in a wide variety of
sanctions, including the required payment of damages and civil money penalties, injunctive relief, imposition of restrictions on
merger and acquisition activity and restrictions on expansion activity, which could negatively impact our reputation, business,
financial condition and results of operations.
Non-compliance with the Patriot Act, Bank Secrecy Act, or other laws and regulations could result in fines or sanctions or
operating restrictions.
The Patriot and Bank Secrecy Acts require financial institutions to develop programs to prevent financial institutions from
being used for money laundering and terrorist activities. If such activities are detected, financial institutions are obligated to file
suspicious activity reports with the U.S. Treasury’s Office of Financial Crimes Enforcement Network. These rules require
financial institutions to establish procedures for identifying and verifying the identity of customers seeking to open new
financial accounts. Failure to comply with these regulations could result in fines or sanctions or restrictions that could have a
material adverse effect on our strategic initiatives. Several banking institutions have received large fines, or suffered limitations
on their operations, for non-compliance with these laws and regulations. Although we have developed policies and procedures
designed to assist in compliance with these laws and regulations, no assurance can be given that these policies and procedures
will be effective in preventing violations of these laws and regulations.
41
Increases in deposit insurance premiums and special FDIC assessments will negatively impact our earnings.
We may pay higher FDIC premiums in the future. The Dodd-Frank Act increased the minimum FDIC deposit insurance reserve
ratio from 1.15 percent to 1.35 percent. The FDIC has adopted a plan under which it will meet this ratio by the statutory
deadline of December 31, 2020. The Dodd-Frank Act requires the FDIC to offset the effect of the increase in the minimum
reserve ratio on institutions with assets less than $10.0 billion. The FDIC has not announced how it will implement this offset.
In addition to the minimum reserve ratio, the FDIC must set a designated reserve ratio. The FDIC has set a designated reserve
ratio of 2.0, which exceeds the minimum reserve ratio.
As required by the Dodd-Frank Act, the FDIC has adopted final regulations, under which insurance premiums are based on an
institution’s total assets minus its Tier 1 capital instead of its deposits. Although our FDIC insurance premiums were initially
reduced by these regulations, it is possible that our future insurance premiums will increase.
Our holding company relies on dividends from the Bank and The Palisades Group for substantially all of its income and
the net proceeds of capital raising transactions are currently the primary source of funds for cash dividends to our
preferred and common stockholders.
Our primary source of revenue at the holding company level is earnings of available cash and securities and dividends from the
Bank and The Palisades Group and we currently rely on the net proceeds of capital raising transactions as the primary source of
funds for cash dividends to our preferred and common stockholders. To the extent we are limited in our ability to raise capital
in the future, our ability to pay cash dividends to our stockholders could likewise be limited, especially if we are unable to
increase the amount of dividends the Bank pays to us. The OCC regulates and, in some cases, must approve the amounts the
Bank pays as dividends to us. If either the Bank or The Palisades Group is unable to pay dividends to us, then we may not be
able to service our debt, including our Senior Notes and junior subordinated amortizing notes, pay our other obligations or pay
cash dividends on our preferred and common stock. Our inability to service our debt, pay our other obligations or pay
dividends to our stockholders could have a material adverse impact on our financial condition and the value of your investment
in our securities.
We may elect or be compelled to seek additional capital in the future, but that capital may not be available when it is
needed.
We are required by federal regulatory authorities to maintain adequate levels of capital to support our operations. At some
point, we may need to raise additional capital to support continued growth, both organically and through acquisitions.
Our ability to raise additional capital, if needed, will depend on conditions in the capital markets, economic conditions and a
number of other factors, many of which are outside our control, and on our financial performance. Accordingly, we cannot
assure you of our ability to raise additional capital if needed or on terms acceptable to us. If we cannot raise additional capital
when needed, our ability to further expand our operations through organic growth and acquisitions could be materially impaired
and our financial condition and liquidity could be materially and adversely affected.
The Company has a significant deferred tax asset that may or may not be fully realized.
The Company has a significant deferred tax asset (DTA) and cannot assure that it will be fully realized. Deferred tax assets and
liabilities are the expected future tax amounts for the temporary differences between the carrying amounts and the tax basis of
assets and liabilities computed using enacted tax rates. If we determine that we will not achieve sufficient future taxable income
to realize our net deferred tax asset, we are required under generally accepted accounting principles to establish a full or partial
valuation allowance. If we determine that a valuation allowance is necessary, we are required to incur a charge to operations.
We regularly assess available positive and negative evidence to determine whether it is more likely than not that our net
deferred tax asset will be realized. Realization of a deferred tax asset requires us to apply significant judgment and is inherently
speculative because it requires estimates that cannot be made with certainty. At December 31, 2014, the Company had a net
deferred tax asset of $16.4 million.
Our ability to utilize our DTA to offset future taxable income may be significantly limited if the Company experiences
an “ownership change” under the Internal Revenue Code.
At December 31, 2014, the Company had net DTA of $16.4 million. The Company’s ability to utilize its DTA to offset future
taxable income may be significantly limited if the Company experiences an “ownership change” as defined in Section 382 of
the Internal Revenue Code of 1986, as amended, referred to herein as the Code. In general, an ownership change will occur if
there is a cumulative change in the Company’s ownership by “5-percent or more stockholders” (as defined in the Code) that
exceeds 50 percentage points over a rolling three-year period. If this were to occur, the Company would be subject to an annual
42
limitation on its pre-ownership change DTA equal to the value of the corporation immediately before the ownership change,
provided that the annual limitation would be increased each year to the extent that there is an unused limitation in a prior year.
We may experience future goodwill impairment.
If our estimates of the fair value of our goodwill change as a result of changes in our business or other factors, we may
determine that an impairment charge is necessary. Estimates of fair value are based on a complex model using, among other
things, estimated cash flows and industry pricing multiples. Based on the Company's 2014 goodwill impairment testing, the fair
values of the three reporting units, commercial banking, mortgage banking and financial advisory and asset management, were
in excess of their carrying value. If the fair values of the three reporting units were less than their book value of total common
stockholders' equity for an extended period of time, the Company would consider this and other factors, including the
anticipated cash flows of each of the reporting units, to determine whether goodwill is impaired. No assurance can be given that
the Company will not record an impairment loss on goodwill in the future and any such impairment loss could have a material
adverse effect on our results of operations and financial condition.
Changes in accounting standards may affect our performance.
Our accounting policies and methods are fundamental to how we record and report our financial condition and results of
operations. From time to time there are changes in the financial accounting and reporting standards that govern the preparation
of our financial statements. These changes can be difficult to predict and can materially impact how we report and record our
financial condition and results of operations. In some cases, we could be required to apply a new or revised standard
retroactively, resulting in a retrospective adjustment to prior financial statements.
New lines of business or new products and services may subject us to additional risks.
From time to time, we may seek to implement new lines of business or offer new products and services within existing lines of
business. There are substantial risks and uncertainties associated with these efforts, particularly in instances where the markets
are not fully developed. In developing and marketing new lines of business and/or new products and services, we may invest
significant time and resources. Initial timetables for the introduction and development of new lines of business and/or new
products or services may not be achieved, and price and profitability targets may not prove feasible, which could in turn have a
material negative effect on our operating results. New lines of business and/or new products or services also could subject us to
additional regulatory requirements, increased scrutiny by our regulators and other legal risks.
Strong competition within our market areas may limit our growth and profitability.
Competition in the banking and financial services industry is intense. In our market areas, we compete with commercial banks,
savings institutions, mortgage brokerage firms, credit unions, finance companies, mutual funds, insurance companies, and
brokerage and investment banking firms operating locally and elsewhere. Many of these competitors have substantially greater
name recognition, resources and lending limits than we do and may offer certain services or prices for services that we do not
or cannot provide. Our profitability depends upon our continued ability to successfully compete in our markets. In addition, our
future success will depend, in part, upon our ability to address the needs of our clients by using technology to provide products
and services that will satisfy client demands for convenience, as well as to create additional efficiencies in our operations.
Many of our competitors have substantially greater resources to invest in technological improvements. We may not be able to
effectively implement new technology-driven products and services or be successful in marketing these products and services
to our clients.
Anti-takeover provisions could negatively impact our stockholders.
Provisions in our charter and bylaws, the corporate law of the State of Maryland and federal regulations could delay, defer or
prevent a third party from acquiring us, despite the possible benefit to our stockholders, or otherwise adversely affect the
market price of any class of our equity securities. These provisions include: a prohibition on voting shares of common stock
beneficially owned in excess of 10 percent of total shares outstanding, supermajority voting requirements for certain business
combinations with any person who beneficially owns more than 10 percent of our outstanding common stock; the election of
directors to staggered terms of three years; advance notice requirements for nominations for election to our Board of Directors
and for proposing matters that stockholders may act on at stockholder meetings, a requirement that only directors may fill a
vacancy in our Board of Directors, supermajority voting requirements to remove any of our directors and the other provisions
of our charter. Our charter also authorizes our Board of Directors to issue preferred stock, and preferred stock could be issued
as a defensive measure in response to a takeover proposal. In addition, pursuant to federal banking regulations, as a general
43
matter, no person or company, acting individually or in concert with others, may acquire more than 10 percent of our common
stock without prior approval from the our federal banking regulator.
These provisions may discourage potential takeover attempts, discourage bids for our common stock at a premium over market
price or adversely affect the market price of, and the voting and other rights of the holders of, our common stock. These
provisions could also discourage proxy contests and make it more difficult for holders of our common stock to elect directors
other than the candidates nominated by our Board of Directors.
We may not be able to generate sufficient cash to service our debt obligations, including our obligations under the
Senior Notes and junior subordinated amortizing notes.
Our ability to make payments on and to refinance our indebtedness, including the Senior Notes and junior subordinated
amortizing notes, will depend on our financial and operating performance, which is subject to prevailing economic and
competitive conditions and to certain financial, business and other factors beyond our control. We may be unable to maintain a
level of cash flows from operating activities sufficient to permit us to pay the principal, premium, if any, and interest on our
indebtedness, including the Senior Notes and junior subordinated amortizing notes.
If our cash flows and capital resources are insufficient to fund our debt service obligations, we may be unable to provide new
loans, other products or to fund our obligations to existing customers and otherwise implement our business plans, or to sell
assets, seek additional capital or restructure or refinance our indebtedness, including the Senior Notes and junior subordinated
amortizing notes. As a result, we may be unable to meet our scheduled debt service obligations. In the absence of sufficient
operating results and resources, we could face substantial liquidity problems and might be required to dispose of material assets
or operations to meet our debt service and other obligations. We may not be able to consummate those dispositions of assets or
to obtain the proceeds that we could realize from them and these proceeds may not be adequate to meet any debt service
obligations then due.
Our debt level may harm our financial condition and results of operations.
As of December 31, 2014, we had $633.0 million of advances from the Federal Home Loan Bank, $84.8 million in Senior
Notes and $12.5 million in junior subordinated amortizing notes. We also had 82,250 shares of preferred stock outstanding,
with a liquidation preference of $1,000 per share, issued and outstanding. Our level of indebtedness could have important
consequences to you, because:
•
It could affect our ability to satisfy our financial obligations, including those relating to the Senior Notes and junior
subordinated amortizing notes;
• A portion of our cash flows from operations will have to be dedicated to interest and principal payments and may not
be available for operations, working capital, capital expenditures, expansion, acquisitions or general corporate or other
purposes;
It may impair our ability to obtain additional financing in the future;
It may limit our flexibility in planning for, or reacting to, changes in our business and industry; and
It may make us more vulnerable to downturns in our business, our industry or the economy in general.
•
•
•
Our business could be negatively affected as a result of actions of activist stockholders.
Campaigns by stockholders to effect changes at publicly traded companies are sometimes led by investors seeking to increase
short-term stockholder value through various corporate actions. We have had activist investors acquire ownership positions in
our common stock and initiate communications with us or others in order to pursue action we believe is designed to benefit
them in a manner that may come at our expense or be to the detriment of other stockholders. Responding to actions by activist
stockholders can disrupt our operations, adversely affect our profitability or business prospects, and divert the attention of
management and our employees from executing our strategic plan discussed under “Item 1. Business-Strategy.” Any perceived
uncertainties as to our future direction or strategy arising from activist stockholder initiatives could also cause increased
reputational, operational, financial, regulatory and other risks, harm our ability to raise new capital, or adversely affect the
market price or increase the volatility of our securities.
44
Item 1B. Unresolved Staff Comments
Not applicable.
Item 2. Properties
As of December 31, 2014, the Company conducts its operations from its main and executive offices at 18500 Von Karman
Avenue, Suite 1100, Irvine, California, 37 branch offices in Los Angeles, Orange and San Diego counties, and 67 loan
production offices in California, Arizona, Oregon, Virginia, Indiana, Maryland, Colorado, Idaho, and Nevada. On November 8,
2014, the Company acquired 20 full-service branches with certain real properties from BPNA in the Southern California
banking market. See further discussion in Note 6 of the Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements in Item 8.
Item 3. Legal Proceedings
From time to time we are involved as plaintiff or defendant in various legal actions arising in the normal course of business. We
do not anticipate incurring any material liability as a result of such currently pending litigation.
As previously reported in the Company’s Annual Report on Form 10-K for the year ended December 31, 2013, on December
14, 2011, CMG Financial Services, Inc. (CMG) initiated a patent lawsuit against Pacific Trust Bank, the predecessor of the
Bank, in the United States District Court for the Central District of California (the Court) alleging infringement of U.S. Patent
No. 7,627,509 (the Action) relating to the origination and servicing of loans with characteristics similar to the Bank’s Green
Accounts, a product that the Bank no longer originates. On September 19, 2014, the Court entered final judgment in favor of
the Bank, declaring CMG’s patent invalid and dismissing the suit against the Bank, with prejudice. On September 25, 2014,
CMG filed a notice of appeal of the final judgment with the U.S. Court of Appeals for the Federal Circuit. On January 27,
2015, CMG filed its opening brief in the appeal and the Bank’s opposition to the appeal is due April 16, 2015. The Company
and its counsel believe the appeal is without merit and the resolution of the matter is not expected to have a material impact on
the Company’s business, financial condition or results of operations, though no assurance can be given in this regard.
Item 4. Mine Safety Disclosures
Not applicable
45
PART II
Item 5. Market for Registrant’s Common Equity, Related Stockholder Matters and Issuer Purchases of Equity
Securities
The Company’s voting common stock (symbol BANC) has been listed on the NYSE since May 29, 2014 and prior to that date
was listed on the NASDAQ Global Market. The Company’s Class B Non-Voting Common Stock is not listed or traded on any
national securities exchange or automated quotation system, and there currently is no established trading market for such stock.
The approximate number of holders of record of the Company’s voting common stock as of December 31, 2014 was 1,824.
Certain shares are held in “nominee” or “street” name and accordingly, the number of beneficial owners of such shares is not
known or included in the foregoing number. There was one holder of record of the Company’s Class B Non-Voting Common
Stock as of December 31, 2014. At December 31, 2014 there were 35,829,763 shares and 34,190,740 shares of voting common
stock issued and outstanding, respectively, and 609,195 shares of Class B non-voting common stock issued and outstanding.
The following table presents quarterly market information for the Company’s voting common stock for the two years ended
December 31, 2014 and 2013.
Quarter ended December 31, 2014
Quarter ended September 30, 2014
Quarter ended June 30, 2014
Quarter ended March 31, 2014
Quarter ended December 31, 2013
Quarter ended September 30, 2013
Quarter ended June 30, 2013
Quarter ended March 31, 2013
Dividend Policy
Market Price Range
High
Low
Dividends
$
$
$
$
$
$
$
$
11.85
12.28
12.71
13.84
14.57
15.54
13.86
12.33
$
$
$
$
$
$
$
$
10.47
10.64
9.78
12.00
12.45
13.24
11.06
10.26
$
$
$
$
$
$
$
$
$
$
0.12
0.12
0.12
0.12
0.48
0.12
0.12
0.12
0.12
0.48
The timing and amount of cash dividends paid to the Company’s preferred and common stockholders depends on the
Company’s earnings, capital requirements, financial condition and other relevant factors. The ability of Banc of California, Inc.
to pay cash dividends to its preferred and common stockholders depends, in large part, upon its receipt of dividends from the
Bank and The Palisades Group, because Banc of California, Inc. has limited sources of income other than dividends from the
Bank and The Palisades Group. There were no dividends paid from the Bank to Banc of California, Inc. during 2014. For a
description of the regulatory restrictions on the ability of the Bank to pay dividends to Banc of California, Inc., and on the
ability of Banc of California, Inc. to pay dividends to its stockholders, see “Regulation and Supervision” in Item 1.
As of December 31, 2014, the Company had 82,250 shares of preferred stock issued and outstanding, consisting of 32,000
shares of Senior Non-Cumulative Perpetual Preferred Stock, Series A, liquidation amount $1,000 per share (Series A Preferred
Stock), 10,000 shares of Non-Cumulative Perpetual Preferred Stock, Series B, liquidation amount $1,000 per share (Series B
Preferred Stock), and 40,250 shares of 8.00 percent Non-Cumulative Perpetual Preferred Stock, Series C, liquidation amount
$1,000 per share (Series C Preferred Stock and together with the Series A Preferred Stock and Series B Preferred Stock, the
Preferred Stock). Each series of the Preferred Stock ranks equally (pari passu) with each other series of the Preferred Stock and
senior to our common stock in the payment of dividends and in the distribution of assets on any liquidation, dissolution or
winding up of Banc of California, Inc.
46
Issuer Purchases of Equity Securities
The following table presents information for the three months ended December 31, 2014 with respect to repurchases by the
Company of its common stock:
Period
From October 1, 2014 to October 31, 2014
From November 1, 2014 to November 30, 2014
From December 1, 2014 to December 31, 2014
Total
Purchases of Equity Securities by the Issuer
Total Number
of Shares
Purchased
Weighted
Average
Price Paid
Per Share
— $
— $
— $
— $
—
—
—
—
Total Number
of Shares
Purchased as
Part of
Publicly
Announced
Plans
—
—
—
—
Total Number
of Shares
That May Yet
be Purchased
Under the
Plan
897,958
897,958
897,958
The Company has a practice of buying back stock for tax purposes pertaining to employee benefit plans, and does not count
these purchases toward the allotment of the shares. The Company has not purchased any shares during the three months ended
December 31, 2014 related to tax liability sales for employee stock benefit plans.
Issuance of Shares Related to CS Financial Acquisition
Effective October 31, 2013, the Company acquired CS Financial, a California corporation and Southern California-based
mortgage banking firm controlled by former Company director and current Bank executive Jeffrey T. Seabold and in which
certain relatives and entities affiliated with the Company’s Chairman and Chief Executive Officer Steven A. Sugarman also
owned certain minority, non-controlling interests. As part of the acquisition consideration, upon achievement of certain
performance targets by the Bank’s lending activities following the acquisition of CS Financial, the Company is obligated to
issue up to 92,781 shares (Performance Shares). On October 31, 2014, the Company issued an aggregate of 30,925 of the
Performance Shares. The issuance and sale of the 30,925 shares was exempt from registration under the Securities Act of 1933,
as amended (the Securities Act), pursuant to Section 4(a)(2) of the Securities Act as a transaction not involving any public
offering. For additional information regarding this transaction and the individuals who received the 30,925 Performance Shares
on October 31, 2014, see Note 25 of the Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements in Item 8.
47
Stock Performance Graph
The following graph and related discussion are being furnished solely to accompany this Annual Report on Form 10-K
pursuant to Item 201(e) of Regulation S-K and shall not be deemed to be “soliciting materials” or to be “filed” with the SEC
(other than as provided in Item 201) nor shall this information be incorporated by reference into any future filing under the
Securities Act or the Exchange Act, whether made before or after the date hereof and irrespective of any general incorporation
language contained therein, except to the extent that the Company specifically incorporates it by reference into a filing.
The following graph shows a comparison of stockholder return on Banc of California, Inc.’s voting common stock with the
cumulative total returns for: (i) the NYSE Composite Index; (ii) the NASDAQ Composite (U.S.) Index; (iii) the Standard and
Poor’s (S&P) 500 Financials Index; and (iv) the KBW Bank Index. The graph assumes an initial investment of $100 and
reinvestment of dividends. The graph is historical only and may not be indicative of possible future performance.
Total Return Performance
Banc of California, Inc.
NYSE Composite
NASDAQ Composite
S&P 500 Financials
KBW Bank Index
e
u
l
a
V
x
e
d
n
I
350
300
250
200
150
100
50
12/31/2009
12/31/2010
12/31/2011
12/31/2012
12/31/2013
12/31/2014
Index
Banc of California, Inc.
NYSE Composite
NASDAQ Composite (1)
S&P 500 Financials
KBW Bank Index
Period Ending
12/31/2009
12/31/2010
12/31/2011
12/31/2012
12/31/2013
12/31/2014
100.00
100.00
100.00
100.00
100.00
254.88
110.84
116.91
112.12
122.24
203.60
104.07
114.81
93.00
92.20
253.80
117.52
133.07
119.79
120.07
287.92
144.75
184.06
162.47
162.16
256.51
150.86
208.71
187.17
173.87
(1) The NASDAQ Composite (U.S.) Index was used in the Company's last performance graph, and is used again in this performance
graph, because the listing of the Company's voting common stock moved from the NASDAQ Global Market to the New York Stock
Exchange effective May 29, 2014.
48
Item 6. Selected Financial Data
The following table sets forth certain consolidated financial and other data of the Company at the dates and for the periods
indicated. The information set forth below should be read in conjunction with “Management’s Discussion and Analysis of
Financial Condition and Results of Operations” included herein at Item 7 and the Consolidated Financial Statements and Notes
thereto included herein at Item 8.
Selected financial condition data:
Total assets
Cash and cash equivalents
Loans and leases receivable, net
Loans held for sale
Other real estate owned, net
Securities available-for-sale
Bank owned life insurance
Time deposits in financial institutions
FHLB and other bank stock
Deposits
Total borrowings
Total stockholders' equity
Selected operations data:
Total interest income
Total interest expense
Net interest income
Provision for loan and lease losses
Net interest income after provision for loan and
lease losses
Total non-interest income
Total non-interest expense
Income/(loss) before income taxes
Income tax (benefit)/expense
Net income/(loss)
Dividends paid on preferred stock
Net income/(loss) available to common
stockholders
Basic earnings/(loss) per total common share
Diluted earnings/(loss) per total common share
$
$
Performance ratios:
Return on average assets (1)
Return on average equity
Dividend payout ratio (2)
Net interest spread
Net interest margin (3)
Ratio of operating expense to average total assets
Efficiency ratio (4)
Ratio of average interest-earning assets to average
interest-bearing liabilities
Asset quality ratios:
2014 (5)
As of or For the Year Ended December 31,
2012 (7)
2013 (6)
($ in thousands, except per share data)
2011
2010
$
5,971,571
$ 3,628,023
$
1,682,702
$
999,041
$
861,621
231,199
3,919,642
1,187,090
423
345,695
19,095
1,900
42,241
110,118
2,427,306
716,733
—
170,022
18,881
1,846
22,600
108,643
1,234,023
113,158
4,527
121,419
18,704
5,027
8,842
4,671,831
2,918,644
1,306,342
726,569
503,589
332,320
324,869
156,935
188,757
44,475
775,609
—
14,692
101,616
18,451
—
6,972
786,334
20,000
184,495
$
188,139
$
120,511
$
55,031
$
35,177
$
32,862
155,277
10,976
144,301
145,637
264,161
25,777
(4,541)
30,318
3,640
26,678
0.91
0.91
0.70%
7.33%
52.75%
3.54%
3.72%
6.07%
87.79%
23,282
97,229
7,963
89,266
96,743
178,670
7,339
7,260
79
2,185
(2,106)
(0.14)
(0.14)
$
$
$
$
—%
0.03%
—%
3.49%
3.67%
6.44%
8,479
46,552
5,500
41,052
36,619
71,560
6,111
115
5,996
1,359
4,637
0.40
0.40
0.45%
3.17%
120.00%
3.49%
3.69%
5.33%
$
$
6,037
29,140
5,388
23,752
4,913
31,689
(3,024)
(296)
(2,728)
534
(3,262)
(0.31)
(0.31)
(0.31)%
(1.71)%
— %
3.31 %
3.48 %
3.54 %
$
$
92.11%
86.04%
93.06 %
59,100
678,175
—
6,562
64,790
18,151
—
8,323
646,308
75,000
136,009
40,944
10,788
30,156
8,957
21,199
4,879
22,217
3,861
1,036
2,825
960
1,865
0.37
0.37
0.32%
2.59%
67.57%
3.38%
3.58%
2.50%
63.41%
122.06%
121.07%
127.14%
124.20 %
115.23%
Allowance for loan and lease losses (ALLL)
Nonperforming loans and leases
$
$
29,480
38,381
$
$
18,805
31,648
$
$
14,448
22,993
$
$
12,780
19,254
$
$
14,637
38,830
49
Nonperforming assets
Nonperforming assets to total assets
ALLL to nonperforming loans and leases
ALLL to total loans and leases
Capital Ratios:
Total stockholders' equity to total assets
Average equity to average assets
$
38,804
$
31,648
$
27,520
$
33,946
$
45,392
0.65%
76.81%
0.75%
8.43%
9.51%
0.87%
59.42%
0.77%
8.95%
9.55%
1.64%
62.84%
1.16%
11.22%
14.11%
3.40 %
66.38 %
1.62 %
18.47 %
17.89 %
5.27%
37.70%
2.11%
15.79%
12.25%
(1) Not meaningful for the year ended December 31, 2013 due to the amount of net income for the year.
(2) Ratio of dividends declared per common shares to basic earnings per common share. Not applicable for the years ended
December 31, 2013 and 2011 due to the net loss attributable to common stockholders for the years.
(3) Net interest income divided by average interest-earning assets.
(4) Efficiency ratio represents noninterest expense as a percentage of net interest income plus noninterest income.
(5) The Company completed its acquisition of RenovationReady and the BPNA Branch Acquisition on January 31, 2014 and November 8,
2014, respectively.
(6) The Company completed its acquisitions of PBOC, The Palisades Group and CS Financial on July 1, 2013, September 10, 2013 and
October 31, 2013, respectively.
(7) The Company completed its acquisitions of Beach and Gateway on July 1, 2012 and August 18, 2012, respectively.
Non-GAAP Financial Measures
Return on Average Tangible Common Equity
Return on average tangible common equity is supplemental financial information determined by a method other than in
accordance with U.S. generally accepted accounting principles (GAAP). This non-GAAP measure is used by management in its
analysis of the Company's performance. Average tangible common equity is calculated by subtracting average preferred stock,
average goodwill, and average other intangible assets from average stockholders’ equity. Banking and financial institution
regulators also exclude goodwill and other intangible assets from stockholders’ equity when assessing the capital adequacy of a
financial institution. Management believes the presentation of this financial measure excluding the impact of these items
provides useful supplemental information that is essential to a proper understanding of the financial results of the Company, as
it provides a method to assess management’s success in utilizing tangible capital. This disclosure should not be viewed as a
substitution for results determined in accordance with GAAP, nor is it necessarily comparable to non-GAAP performance
measures that may be presented by other companies.
The following table reconciles this non-GAAP performance measure to the GAAP performance measure for the periods
indicated:
2014
2013
2012
2011
2010
Year Ended December 31,
($ in thousands)
Average total shareholders' equity
$
413,454
$
264,818
$
189,411
$
159,959
$
108,969
Less average preferred stock
Less average goodwill
Less average other intangible assets
Average tangible common equity
Net income (loss)
Less preferred stock dividends
Add amortization of intangible assets, net of tax (1)
Add impairment on intangible assets, net of tax (1)
Adjusted net income (loss)
Return on average equity
Return on average tangible common equity
(1) Utilized a 35 percent tax rate
$
$
(79,877)
(32,326)
(11,739)
289,512
30,318
(3,640)
2,651
31
$
$
$
29,360
$
(56,284)
(15,872)
(9,580)
183,082
79
(2,185)
1,723
690
307
$
$
$
(31,934)
(3,517)
(2,723)
151,237
5,996
(1,359)
452
—
(10,849)
(15,955)
$
$
—
—
149,110
(2,728)
(534)
—
—
$
$
—
—
93,014
2,825
(960)
—
—
5,089
$
(3,262)
$
1,865
7.33%
10.14%
0.03%
0.17%
3.17%
3.36%
(1.71)%
(2.19)%
2.59%
2.01%
50
Item 7. Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations
Critical Accounting Policies
The Company follows accounting and reporting policies and procedures that conform, in all material respects, to U.S. generally
accepted accounting principles and to practices generally applicable to the financial services industry, the most significant of
which are described in Note 1 of the Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements in Item 8. The preparation of Consolidated
Financial Statements in conformity with U.S. generally accepted accounting principles requires management to make
judgments and accounting estimates that affect the amounts reported for assets, liabilities, revenues and expenses in the
Consolidated Financial Statements and accompanying notes, and amounts disclosed as contingent assets and liabilities. While
the Company bases estimates on historical experience, current information and other factors deemed to be relevant, actual
results could differ from those estimates.
Accounting estimates are necessary in the application of certain accounting policies and procedures that are particularly
susceptible to significant change. Critical accounting policies are defined as those that require the most complex or subjective
judgment and are reflective of significant uncertainties, and could potentially result in materially different results under
different assumptions and conditions. Management has identified the Company's most critical accounting policies and
accounting estimates, which have been discussed with the appropriate committees of the Board of Directors, as follows:
Securities
Under FASB Codification Topic 320 (ASC 320), Investments-Debt and Equity Securities, investment securities must be
classified as held-to-maturity, available-for-sale or trading. Management determines the appropriate classification at the time of
purchase. The classification of securities is significant since it directly impacts the accounting for unrealized gains and losses
on securities. Debt securities are classified as held-to-maturity and carried at amortized cost when management has the positive
intent and the Company has the ability to hold the securities to maturity. Securities not classified as held-to-maturity are
classified as available-for-sale and are carried at fair value, with the unrealized holding gains and losses, net of tax, reported in
other comprehensive income (loss) and do not affect earnings until realized unless a decline in fair value below amortized cost
is considered to be other than temporarily impaired (OTTI).
The fair values of the Company’s securities are generally determined by reference to quoted prices from reliable independent
sources utilizing observable inputs. Certain of the Company’s fair values of securities are determined using models whose
significant value drivers or assumptions are unobservable and are significant to the fair value of the securities. These models
are utilized when quoted prices are not available for certain securities or in markets where trading activity has slowed or
ceased. When quoted prices are not available and are not provided by third party pricing services, management judgment is
necessary to determine fair value. As such, fair value is determined using discounted cash flow analysis models, incorporating
default rates, estimation of prepayment characteristics and implied volatilities.
The Company evaluates all securities on a quarterly basis, and more frequently when economic conditions warrant additional
evaluations, for determining if other-than-temporary impairment (OTTI) exists pursuant to guidelines established in ASC 320.
In evaluating the possible impairment of securities, consideration is given to the length of time and the extent to which the fair
value has been less than cost, the financial conditions and near-term prospects of the issuer, and the ability and intent of the
Company to retain its investment in the issuer for a period of time sufficient to allow for any anticipated recovery in fair value.
In analyzing an issuer’s financial condition, the Company may consider whether the securities are issued by the federal
government or its agencies or government sponsored agencies, whether downgrades by bond rating agencies have occurred,
and the results of reviews of the issuer’s financial condition.
If management determines that an investment experienced an OTTI, management must then determine the amount of the OTTI
to be recognized in earnings. If management does not intend to sell the security and it is more likely than not that the Company
will not be required to sell the security before recovery of its amortized cost basis less any current period loss, the OTTI will be
separated into the amount representing the credit loss and the amount related to all other factors. The amount of OTTI related to
the credit loss is determined based on the present value of cash flows expected to be collected and is recognized in earnings.
The amount of the OTTI related to other factors will be recognized in other comprehensive income (loss), net of applicable
taxes. The previous amortized cost basis less the OTTI recognized in earnings will become the new amortized cost basis of the
investment. If management intends to sell the security or more likely than not will be required to sell the security before
recovery of its amortized cost basis less any current period credit loss, the OTTI will be recognized in earnings equal to the
entire difference between the investment’s amortized cost basis and its fair value at the balance sheet date. Any recoveries
related to the value of these securities are recorded as an unrealized gain (as other comprehensive income (loss) in
stockholders’ equity) and not recognized in income until the security is ultimately sold.
51
The Company from time to time may dispose of an impaired security in response to asset/liability management decisions,
future market movements, business plan changes, or if the net proceeds can be reinvested at a rate of return that is expected to
recover the loss within a reasonable period of time.
Purchased Credit-Impaired Loans and Leases
The Company purchases loans and leases with and without evidence of credit quality deterioration since origination. Evidence
of credit quality deterioration as of the purchase date may include statistics such as prior loan or lease modification history,
updated borrower credit scores and updated loan or lease-to-value (LTV) ratios, some of which are not immediately available as
of the purchase date. Purchased loans and leases with evidence of credit quality deterioration where the Company estimates that
it will not receive all contractual payments are accounted for as purchased credit impaired loans and leases (PCI loans and
leases). The excess of the cash flows expected to be collected on PCI loans and leases, measured as of the acquisition date, over
the estimated fair value is referred to as the accretable yield and is recognized in interest income over the remaining life of the
loan or lease using a level yield methodology. The difference between contractually required payments as of the acquisition
date and the cash flows expected to be collected is referred to as the non-accretable difference. PCI loans and leases that have
similar risk characteristics, primarily credit risk, collateral type and interest rate risk, are pooled and accounted for as a single
asset with a single composite interest rate and an aggregate expectation of cash flows.
The Company estimates cash flows expected to be collected over the life of the loan or lease using management’s best estimate
of current key assumptions such as default rates, loss severity and payment speeds. If, upon subsequent evaluation, the
Company determines it is probable that the present value of the expected cash flows have decreased, the PCI loan or lease is
considered further impaired which will result in a charge to the provision for loan and lease losses and a corresponding increase
to a valuation allowance included in the allowance for loan and lease losses. If, upon subsequent evaluation, it is probable that
there is an increase in the present value of the expected cash flows, the Company will reduce any remaining valuation
allowance. If there is no remaining valuation allowance, the Company will recalculate the amount of accretable yield as the
excess of the revised expected cash flows over the current carrying value resulting in a reclassification from nonaccretable
difference to accretable yield. The present value of the expected cash flows for PCI purchased loan pools is determined using
the PCI loans’ effective interest rate, adjusted for changes in the PCI loans’ interest rate indexes. The present value of the
expected cash flows for PCI loans and leases acquired through mergers with other banks includes, in addition to the above, an
evaluation of the credit worthiness of the borrower. Loan and lease dispositions, which may include sales of loans and leases,
receipt of payments in full from the borrower or foreclosure, result in removal of the loan or lease from the PCI loan or lease
pool. Write-downs are not recorded on the PCI loan or lease pool until actual losses exceed the remaining nonaccretable
difference.
Allowance for Loan and Lease Losses
The allowance for loan and lease losses is a reserve established through a provision for loan and lease loses charged to expense,
and represents management’s best estimate of probable losses that may be incurred within the existing loan and lease portfolio
as of the balance sheet date. Subsequent recoveries, if any, are credited to the allowance. The Company performs an analysis of
the adequacy of the allowance at least on a quarterly basis. Management estimates the allowance balance required using past
loan and lease loss experience, the nature and volume of the portfolio, information about specific borrower situations and
estimated collateral values, economic conditions, and other factors. Allocations of the allowance may be made for specific
loans and leases, but the entire allowance is available for any loan or lease that, in management’s judgment, should be charged
off. While management utilizes its best judgment and information available, the ultimate adequacy of the allowance for loan
and lease losses is dependent upon a variety of factors beyond the Company’s control, including performance of the Company’s
loan portfolio, the economy, changes in interest rates, and regulatory authorities altering their loan classification guidance.
The allowance consists of three elements: (i) specific valuation allowances established for probable losses on impaired loans
and leases, (ii) quantitative valuation allowances calculated using loss experience for like loans and leases with similar
characteristics and trends, adjusted, as necessary to reflect the impact of current conditions; and (iii) qualitative allowances
based on environmental and other factors that may be internal or external to the Company.
During the year ended December 31, 2014, the Company enhanced the current methodologies, processes and controls over the
allowance for loan and lease losses (ALLL), due to the Company's organic and acquisitive growth and changing profile.
The following is a synopsis of the enhancements for each component of ALLL:
• Expand the look-back period to 28 rolling quarters to capture a full economic cycle.
• Utilize net historical losses versus gross historical losses.
52
• Expand the peer group used to determine industry average loss history to include three industry groups; 1) all U.S.
financial and bank holding companies, 2) all California financial and bank holding companies, 3) the peer group
average from the Uniform Bank Performance Report.
• Apply a segment specific loss emergence period to each segment's loss rate.
• Determine qualitative reserves is calculated at each loan segment level based on a baseline risk weighting adjusted for
current risks, trends and business conditions.
• Disaggregate certain qualitative factors to be determined on the portfolio segment level.
These enhancements resulted in an increase of $264 thousand in the ALLL as compared to what it would have been using the
old methodology at December 31, 2014.
Mortgage Loan Repurchase Obligations and Reserve for Loss on Repurchased Loans
In the ordinary course of business, as loans held for sale are sold, the Bank makes standard industry representations and
warranties about the loans. The Bank may have to subsequently repurchase certain loans or reimburse certain investor losses
due to defects that occurred in the origination of the loans. Such defects include documentation or underwriting errors. In
addition, certain investor contracts require the Bank to repurchase loans from previous whole loan sales transactions that
experience early payment defaults. If there are no such defects or early payment defaults, the Bank has no commitment to
repurchase loans that it has sold. The level of reserve for loss on repurchased loans is an estimate that requires considerable
management judgment. The Bank’s reserve is based upon the expected future repurchase trends for loans already sold in whole
loan sale transactions and the expected valuation of such loans when repurchased, and include first and second trust deed loans.
At the point the loans are repurchased, the associated reserves are transferred to the allowance for loan and lease losses. At the
point when loss reimbursements are made directly to the investor, the reserve for loss on repurchased loans is charged for the
losses incurred.
Goodwill and Other Intangible Assets
Goodwill resulting from business combinations is generally determined as the excess of the fair value of the consideration
transferred, plus the fair value of any noncontrolling interests in the acquiree, over the fair value of the net assets acquired and
liabilities assumed as of the acquisition date. Goodwill and intangible assets acquired in a purchase business combination and
determined to have an indefinite useful life are not amortized, but are periodically evaluated for impairment at the reporting
unit level. Intangible assets with definite useful lives are amortized over their estimated useful lives to their estimated residual
values.
In accordance with ASU 2011-08 Intangibles—Goodwill and Other (Topic 350), an entity is not required to calculate the fair
value of a reporting unit unless the entity determines that it is more likely than not that its fair value is less than its carrying
amount. In other words, before the first step of the existing guidance, the entity has the option to first assess qualitative factors
to determine whether the existence of events or circumstances leads to a determination that the fair value of goodwill is less
than carrying value. The qualitative assessment includes adverse events or circumstances identified that could negatively affect
the reporting units’ fair value as well as positive and mitigating events. Such indicators may include, among others: a
significant change in legal factors or in the general business climate; significant change in the Company’s stock price and
market capitalization; unanticipated competition; and an action or assessment by a regulator. If, after assessing the totality of
events or circumstances, an entity determines it is not more likely than not that the fair value of a reporting unit is less than its
carrying amount, then performing the two-step process is unnecessary. The entity has the option to bypass the qualitative
assessment step for any reporting unit in any period and proceed directly to the first step of the exiting two-step process. The
entity can resume performing the qualitative assessment in any subsequent period.
The first step of the goodwill impairment test is performed, when considered necessary, by comparing the reporting unit’s
aggregate fair value to its carrying value. Absent other indicators of impairment, if the aggregate fair value exceeds the carrying
value, goodwill is not considered impaired and no additional analysis is necessary. If the carrying value of the reporting unit
were to exceed the aggregate fair value, a second step would be performed to measure the amount of impairment loss, if any. To
measure any impairment loss the implied fair value would be determined in the same manner as if the reporting unit were being
acquired in a business combination. If the implied fair value of goodwill is less than the recorded goodwill, an impairment
charge would be recorded for the difference.
The Company tests its goodwill for impairment annually as of August 31 (the Measurement Date). At the Measurement Date,
the Company, in accordance with ASC 350-20-35-3, evaluated, based on the weight of evidence, the significance of all
qualitative factors to determine whether it is more likely than not that the fair value of the reporting unit is less than its carrying
53
amount. The assessment of qualitative factors at the Measurement Date indicated that it is not more likely than not that
impairment existed; as a result no further testing was performed.
The Company realigned its management reporting structure at December 31, 2014 and, accordingly, its segment reporting
structure and goodwill reporting units. In connection with the realignment, management reallocated goodwill to the new
reporting unit using a relative fair value approach. The carrying value of goodwill allocated to the reportable segments was
$29.5 million and $2.1 million to Commercial Banking segment and Mortgage Banking segment, respectively, at December 31,
2014.
Determining the fair value of a reporting unit involves several management estimates, including developing a discounted cash
flow valuation model which utilizes variables such as revenue growth rates, expense trends, discount rates, and terminal values.
Based upon an evaluation of key data and market factors, management selects from a range, the specific variables to be
incorporated into the valuation model. Projected future cash flows are discounted using estimated rates based on the Capital
Asset Pricing Model, which considers the risk-free interest rate, market risk premium, beta, and unsystematic risk and size
premium adjustments specific to the reporting unit. The Company utilizes both an income approach and a market approach to
arrive at an indicated fair value range for the reporting unit. The comparable company method and transaction method is used
to corroborate the income approach, giving an indication of the fair value of equity of the reporting units, by including banks
with significant geographic or product line overlap to the Company and its reporting units.
There was no impairment indicated as a result of the Step 1 test performed as of December 31, 2014. The fair value of the
Commercial Banking and Mortgage Banking reporting units where goodwill resides significantly exceeded the carrying value
at December 31, 2014.
Even though there was no goodwill impairment at December 31, 2014, adverse events may impact the recoverability of
goodwill and could result in a future impairment charge which could have a material impact on the Company’s consolidated
financial statements.
Other intangible assets consist of core deposit intangibles, customer relationship intangibles, and trade name intangibles arising
from whole bank and their subsidiaries acquisitions, and are generally amortized on an accelerated method over their estimated
useful lives of 2-10 years and 1-20 years, respectively. Trade name intangibles are indefinite lived and evaluated for impairment
on an annual basis or more if necessary.
Deferred Income Taxes
Deferred income tax assets and liabilities are computed for differences between the financial statement and tax basis of assets
and liabilities that will result in taxable or deductible amounts in the future based on enacted tax laws and rates applicable to
the periods in which the differences are expected to affect taxable income. Deferred tax assets are also recognized for operating
loss and tax credit carryforwards. Accounting guidance requires that companies assess whether a valuation allowance should be
established against the deferred tax assets based on the consideration of all available evidence using a “more likely than not”
standard.
Deferred tax assets are reduced by a valuation allowance when, in the opinion of management, it is more likely than not that
some portion, or all, of the deferred tax asset will not be realized. In assessing the realization of deferred tax assets,
management evaluates both positive and negative evidence, including the existence of any cumulative losses in the current year
and the prior two years, the amount of taxes paid in available carry-back years, the forecasts of future income and tax planning
strategies.
At December 31, 2014, the Company had no valuation allowance and had a net deferred tax asset of $16.4 million. At
December 31, 2013, the Company had a valuation allowance of $17.3 million, resulting in a net deferred tax asset of $0.
54
Executive Overview
This overview of management’s discussion and analysis highlights selected information in the financial results of the Company.
For a more complete understanding of trends, commitments, uncertainties, liquidity, capital resources and critical accounting
policies and estimates, you should carefully read this entire document. Each of these items could have an impact on the
Company’s financial condition and results of operations.
Banc of California, Inc. is a financial holding company and the parent of Banc of California, National Association, a national
bank (the Bank), The Palisades Group, LLC, an SEC-registered investment advisor that provides financial advisory and asset
management services to third parties, including the Bank, with respect to the purchase, sale and management of residential
mortgage loans (The Palisades Group), and PTB Property Holdings, LLC, an entity formed to hold real estate, cash and fixed
income investments (PTB). Prior to October 11, 2013, Banc of California, Inc. was a multi-bank holding company with two
banking subsidiaries, Pacific Trust Bank, a federal savings bank (PacTrust Bank or Pacific Trust Bank) and The Private Bank of
California (Beach Business Bank prior to July 1, 2013). On October 11, 2013, Banc of California, Inc. became a one-bank
holding company when Pacific Trust Bank converted from a federal savings bank to a national bank and changed its name to
Banc of California, National Association, and immediately thereafter The Private Bank of California was merged into Banc of
California, National Association. On January 17, 2014, Banc of California, Inc. became a financial holding company.
The Company was incorporated under Maryland law in March 2002, and in July 2013, the Company changed its name from
“First PacTrust Bancorp, Inc.” to “Banc of California, Inc.” As noted above, in October 2013, the Company’s subsidiary banks
merged to form a single, national bank subsidiary under the name Banc of California, National Association. The Bank has one
wholly owned subsidiary, CS Financial, Inc., which was acquired on October 31, 2013.
Banc of California, Inc. is subject to regulation by the Board of Governors of the Federal Reserve System (the Federal Reserve
Board or FRB), and the Bank is subject to regulation primarily by the Office of the Comptroller of the Currency (OCC). As a
financial holding company, Banc of California, Inc. may engage in activities permissible for bank holding companies and may
engage in other activities that are financial in nature or incidental or complementary to activities that are financial in nature,
primarily securities, insurance and merchant banking activities.
The Bank offers a variety of financial services to meet the banking and financial needs of the communities we serve. The Bank
is headquartered in Orange County, California and as of December 31, 2014, the Bank operated 37 branches in San Diego,
Orange, and Los Angeles Counties in California and 67 loan production offices in California, Arizona, Oregon, Virginia,
Indiana, Maryland, Colorado, Idaho, and Nevada.
The principal business of the Bank consists of attracting retail deposits from the general public and investing these funds
primarily in commercial, consumer and real estate secured loans. The Bank solicits deposits in its market area and, to a lesser
extent, from institutional depositors nationwide and may accept brokered deposits.
The Bank’s deposit product and service offerings include checking, savings, money market, certificates of deposit, retirement
accounts as well as mobile, online, cash and treasury management, card payment services, remote deposit, ACH origination,
employer/employee retirement planning, telephone banking, automated bill payment, electronic statements, safe deposit boxes,
direct deposit and wire transfers. Bank customers also have the ability to access their accounts through a nationwide network of
over 55,000 surcharge-free ATMs.
55
2014 Highlights
• Completed the acquisition of RenovationReady® on January 31, 2014.
• Completed underwritten public offerings of common stock for gross proceeds of $57.9 million and 8.00% tangible
equity units for gross proceeds of $69.0 million on May 21, 2014.
• Completed the private placement of common stock to OCM BOCA Investor, LLC and Patriot Financial Partners, L.P.
for gross proceeds of $49.9 million on November 7, 2014.
• Completed the BPNA Branch Acquisition on November 8, 2014.
• Total interest and dividend income for the year ended December 31, 2014 increased by $67.6 million, or 56.1 percent,
to $188.1 million from $120.5 million for the year ended December 31, 2013.
• Net interest margin was 3.72 percent and 3.67 percent for the years ended December 31, 2014 and 2013, respectively.
• Net interest income for the year ended December 31, 2014 increased by $58.0 million, or 59.7 percent, to $155.3
million from $97.2 million for the year ended December 31, 2013.
• Noninterest income for the year ended December 31, 2014 increased by $48.9 million, or 50.5 percent, to $145.6
million from $96.7 million for the year ended December 31, 2013. The Company recognized net revenue on mortgage
banking activities of $95.4 million and $67.9 million for the years ended December 31, 2014 and 2013, respectively.
• Noninterest expense for the year ended December 31, 2014 increased by $85.5 million, or 47.8 percent, to $264.2
million from $178.7 million for the year ended December 31, 2013. The increase relates predominantly to a higher
salaries and employee benefits expense related to increased headcount as a result of growth and the acquisitions the
Company completed during 2014.
• Total assets increased by $2.34 billion, or 64.6 percent, to $5.97 billion at December 31, 2014 from $3.63 billion at
December 31, 2013, due primarily to the BPNA Branch Acquisition, an increase in loans held for sale and an increase
in cash and cash equivalents. Average total assets increased to $4.35 billion for the year ended December 31, 2014
from $2.77 billion for the year ended December 31, 2013, due mainly to the BPNA Branch Acquisition and the effect
of a full year following the acquisitions the Company completed during 2013.
• Loans and leases receivable, net of allowance for loan and lease losses, increased by $1.49 billion, or 61.5 percent, to
$3.92 billion at December 31, 2014 from $2.43 billion at December 31, 2013 as a result of increased loan production
and the BPNA Branch Acquisition. Loans held for sale increased by $470.4 million, 65.6 percent, to $1.19 billion at
December 31, 2014 from $716.7 million at December 31, 2013 due to more originations than sales during the year.
Average total loans and leases increased to $3.81 billion for the year ended December 31, 2014 from $2.22 billion for
the year ended December 31, 2013, due mainly to the BPNA Branch Acquisition and the effect of a full year following
the PBOC acquisition, which was completed on July 1, 2013.
• Total deposits increased by $1.75 billion, or 60.1 percent, to $4.67 billion at December 31, 2014 from $2.92 billion at
December 31, 2013, due mainly to the BPNA Branch Acquisition. Average total deposits increased to $3.53 billion for
the year ended December 31, 2014 from $2.31 billion for the year ended December 31, 2013, due mainly to the BPNA
Branch Acquisition and the effect of a full year following the PBOC acquisition, which was completed on July 1,
2013.
56
RESULTS OF OPERATIONS
The following table presents condensed statements of operations for the periods indicated:
Interest and dividend income
Interest expense
Net interest income
Provision for loan and lease losses
Noninterest income
Noninterest expense
Income before income taxes
Income tax (benefit) expense
Net income
Preferred stock dividends
Net income (loss) available to common stockholders
Basic earnings (loss) per common share
Diluted earnings (loss) per common share
Basic earnings (loss) per class B common share
Diluted earnings (loss) per class B common share
Year Ended December 31,
2014
2013
2012
(In thousands, except per share data)
$
188,139
$
120,511
$
32,862
155,277
10,976
145,637
264,161
25,777
(4,541)
30,318
3,640
26,678
0.91
0.91
0.91
0.91
$
$
$
$
$
23,282
97,229
7,963
96,743
178,670
7,339
7,260
79
2,185
(2,106) $
(0.14) $
(0.14) $
(0.14) $
(0.14) $
$
$
$
$
$
55,031
8,479
46,552
5,500
36,619
71,560
6,111
115
5,996
1,359
4,637
0.40
0.40
0.40
0.40
For the year ended December 31, 2014, the Company recorded net income of $30.3 million, an increase of $30.2 million from
net income of $79 thousand for the year ended December 31, 2013 and an increase of $24.3 million from net income of $6.0
million for the year ended December 31, 2012. Preferred stock dividends were $3.6 million, $2.2 million and $1.4 million for
the years ended December 31, 2014, 2013 and 2012, respectively, and net income (loss) available to common stockholders was
$26.7 million, $(2.1) million and $4.6 million for the years ended December 31, 2014, 2013 and 2012, respectively.
57
Net Interest Income
The following table presents interest income, average interest-earning assets, interest expense, average interest-bearing
liabilities, and their correspondent yields and costs expressed both in dollars and rates for the years indicated:
2014
Year Ended December 31,
2013
2012
Average
Balance
Interest
Yield/
Cost
Average
Balance
Interest
Yield/
Cost
Average
Balance
Interest
Yield/
Cost
($ in thousands)
$ 3,805,239
$180,761
4.75 % $ 2,217,421
$ 116,673
5.26 % $ 1,053,240
$ 51,942
225,182
146,097
5,158
2,220
4,176,518
188,139
2.29 %
1.52 %
4.50 %
153,229
276,420
2,632
1,206
2,647,070
120,511
1.72 %
0.44 %
4.55 %
115,467
97,902
2,736
353
1,266,609
55,031
4.93 %
2.37 %
0.36 %
4.34 %
(22,354)
194,462
$ 4,348,626
$
967,803
735,156
692,464
662,183
267,816
(17,332)
143,538
$ 2,773,276
(11,968)
88,203
$ 1,342,844
9,121
7,629
2,788
4,873
527
0.94 % $
756,625
1.04 %
0.40 %
0.74 %
0.20 %
339,731
371,058
558,994
74,712
7,994
2,041
1,901
4,115
269
1.06 % $
261,667
1,096
0.60 %
0.51 %
0.74 %
0.36 %
29,802
67,569
556,326
54,030
99
271
4,494
348
0.42 %
0.33 %
0.40 %
0.81 %
0.64 %
96,279
7,924
8.23 %
85,333
6,962
8.16 %
26,840
2,171
8.09 %
3,421,701
32,862
0.96 %
2,186,453
23,282
1.06 %
468,077
45,394
3,935,172
413,454
287,325
34,680
2,508,458
264,818
8,479
0.85 %
996,234
141,573
15,626
1,153,433
189,411
Interest-earning assets:
Total loans and leases (1)
Securities
Other interest-earning assets (2)
Total interest-earning assets
Allowance for loan and lease
losses
BOLI and non-interest earning
assets (3)
Total assets
Interest-bearing liabilities:
Savings
Interest-bearing checking
Money market
Certificates of deposit
FHLB advances
Long-term debt and other
interest-bearing liabilities
Total interest-bearing
liabilities
Noninterest-bearing deposits
Non-interest-bearing liabilities
Total liabilities
Total stockholders’ equity
Total liabilities and
stockholders’ equity
$ 4,348,626
$ 2,773,276
$ 1,342,844
Net interest income/spread
Net interest margin (4)
Ratio of interest-earning assets to
interest-bearing liabilities
$155,277
3.54%
3.72%
$
97,229
3.49%
3.67%
$ 46,552
3.49%
3.69%
122.06%
121.07%
127.14%
(1) Total loans and leases are net of deferred fees, related direct cost and discounts, but exclude the allowance for loan and lease losses.
Non-accrual loans and leases are included in the average balance. Loan fees of $71 thousand, $1.7 million and $615 thousand and
accretion of discount on purchased loans of $34.8 million, $20.3 million and $2.2 million for the years ended December 31, 2014,
2013 and 2012, respectively, are included in the interest income.
(2) Includes average balance of FHLB stock at cost and average time deposits with other financial institutions.
(3) Includes average balance of bank-owned life insurance of $19.0 million, $18.8 million and $18.6 million for the years ended
December 31, 2014, 2013 and 2012, respectively.
(4) Net interest income divided by average interest-earning assets.
58
Rate/Volume Analysis
The following table presents the changes in interest income and interest expense for major components of interest-earning
assets and interest-bearing liabilities. Information is provided on changes attributable to (1) changes in volume multiplied by
the prior rate, and (2) changes in rate multiplied by the prior volume. Changes attributable to both rate and volume which
cannot be segregated have been allocated proportionately to the change due to volume and the change due to rate.
Year Ended December 31,
2014 vs. 2013
Year Ended December 31,
2013 vs. 2012
Increase (Decrease)
Due to
Net
Increase
Increase (Decrease)
Due to
Net
Increase
Volume
Rate
(Decrease)
Volume
Rate
(Decrease)
(In thousands)
$
76,396
$
(12,308) $
64,088
$
61,036
$
3,695
$
64,731
1,477
(794)
77,079
2,057
3,439
1,364
759
427
900
8,946
1,049
1,808
(9,451)
(930)
2,149
(477)
(1)
(169)
62
634
2,526
1,014
67,628
1,127
5,588
887
758
258
962
9,580
761
765
62,562
3,822
1,802
1,535
22
106
4,772
12,059
(865)
88
2,918
3,076
140
95
(401)
(185)
19
2,744
(104)
853
65,480
6,898
1,942
1,630
(379)
(79)
4,791
14,803
50,677
Interest-earning assets:
Total loans and leases
Securities
Other interest-earning assets
Total interest-earning assets
Interest-bearing liabilities:
Savings
Interest-bearing checking
Money market
Certificates of deposit
FHLB advances
Long-term debt and other interest-
bearing liabilities
Total interest-bearing liabilities
Net interest income
$
68,133
$
(10,085) $
58,048
$
50,503
$
174
$
Year Ended December 31, 2014 Compared to Year Ended December 31, 2013
Net interest income was $155.3 million for the year ended December 31, 2014, an increase of $58.0 million, or 59.7 percent,
from $97.2 million for the year ended December 31, 2013.
Interest income on total loans and leases was $180.8 million for the year ended December 31, 2014, an increase of $64.1
million, or 54.9 percent, from $116.7 million for the year ended December 31, 2013. The increase in interest income on total
loans and leases was due to a $1.59 billion increase in total average total loans and leases, partially offset by a 51 basis points
(bps) decrease in average yield. The increase in average balance was due mainly to acquired loans of $1.07 billion from the
BPNA Branch Acquisition and increases in originations of residential mortgage loans held for sale, multi-family loans, and
lease financing. The decrease in average yield was mainly due to the lower yields on originated loans and leases in 2014 and a
decrease in the proportion of seasoned SFR mortgage loan pools to total loans and leases where discounts on these pools
generate additional interest income. Such discount accretion totaled $34.8 million and $20.3 million for the years ended
December 31, 2014 and 2013.
Interest income on securities was $5.2 million for the year ended December 31, 2014, an increase of $2.5 million, or 96.0
percent, from $2.6 million for the year ended December 31, 2013. The increase in interest income on securities was due to a
$72.0 million increase in average balance and a 57 bps increase in average yield. The increases were mainly due to purchases
of $327.1 million of securities to reduce excess liquidity from the common stock and tangible equity units offerings, partially
offset by principal payments, paydowns, calls and sales of $153.0 million during 2014.
Dividends and interest income on other interest-earning assets was $2.2 million for the year ended December 31, 2014, an
increase of $1.0 million, or 84.1 percent, from $1.2 million for the year ended December 31, 2013. The increase in dividends
and interest income on other interest-earning assets was due to a 108 bps increase in average yield, partially offset by a $130.3
million decrease in average balance. The increase in average yield was mainly due to a $1.3 million increase in dividend
income on FHLB and other bank stocks. The decrease in average balance was mainly due to the usage of excess cash to support
the growth in loans and leases and to fund the BPNA Branch Acquisition.
59
Interest expense on interest-bearing deposits was $24.4 million for the year ended December 31, 2014, an increase of $8.4
million, or 52.1 percent, from $16.1 million for the year ended December 31, 2013. The increase in interest expense on interest-
bearing deposits was a $1.03 billion increase in average balance and a 1 bp increase in average cost. The increase in average
balance was mainly due to interest-bearing deposits of $924.5 million assumed in the BPNA Branch Acquisition and $1.65
billion of deposits generated through strategic plans aiming to increase core deposits by launching interest-bearing core deposit
products with enhanced features to attract high net worth depositors. The increase in average cost was due mainly to the higher
interest rates on those deposits generated through strategic plans.
Interest expense on FHLB advances was $527 thousand for the year ended December 31, 2014, an increase of $258 thousand,
or 95.9 percent, from $269 thousand for the year ended December 31, 2013. The increase in interest expense on FHLB
advances was due mainly to a $193.1 million increase in average balance, partially offset by a 16 bps decrease in average cost.
The decrease in average cost resulted from the replacement of matured long-term advances with short-term advances at lower
rates.
Interest expense on long-term debt and other interest-bearing liabilities was $7.9 million for the year ended December 31, 2014,
an increase of $962 thousand, or 13.8 percent, from $7.0 million for the year ended December 31, 2013. The increase was due
mainly to the utilization of federal funds sold and repurchase agreements and additional interest expense incurred on the junior
subordinated amortizing notes issued in the second quarter of 2014 as part of the tangible equity units.
Year Ended December 31, 2013 Compared to Year Ended December 31, 2012
Net interest income was $97.2 million for the year ended December 31, 2013, an increase of $50.7 million, or 108.9 percent,
from $46.6 million for the year ended December 31, 2012. The growth in net interest income from prior periods was largely
due to higher interest income from loans partially offset by higher interest expense on deposits.
Interest income on total loans and leases was $116.7 million for the year ended December 31, 2013, an increase of $64.7
million, or 124.6 percent, from $51.9 million for the year ended December 31, 2012. The increase in interest income on total
loans and leases was mainly due to a $1.16 billion increase in average balance and a 33 bps increase in average yield. The
increase in average balance was due mainly to acquired loans of $385.3 million from the PBOC acquisition and purchases of
the seasoned SFR mortgage loan pools with unpaid principal balances and fair values of $1.02 billion and $849.9 million at the
respective acquisition dates. The increase in average yield was mainly due to the higher yields on the acquired loans from
PBOC, which had a high concentration of commercial and industrial loans that generally had higher yields than mortgage
loans, and on seasoned SFR mortgage loan pools where discounts on these pools generate additional interest income. Such
discount accretion totaled $20.3 million and $2.2 million for the year ended December 31, 2013 and 2012, respectively.
Interest income on securities was $2.6 million for the year ended December 31, 2013, a decrease of $104 thousand, or 3.80
percent, from $2.7 million for the year ended December 31, 2012. The decrease in interest income on securities was due mainly
to a 65 bps decrease in average yield, partially offset by a $37.8 million increase in average balance. The decrease in average
yield was mainly due to the low interest-rate environment and the increase in average balance was mainly due to acquired
securities of $219.3 million from the PBOC acquisition and purchases of $71.1 million, partially offset by sales, calls, paid offs,
and pay-downs of $237.9 million during the period.
Interest expense on interest-bearing deposits was $16.1 million for the year ended December 31, 2013, an increase of $10.1
million, or 169.3 percent, from $6.0 million for the year ended December 31, 2012. The increase in interest expense on interest-
bearing deposits was due to a $1.11 billion increase in average balance and a 14 bps increase in average cost. The increase in
average balance was mainly due to the addition of interest-bearing deposits of $325.8 million from the PBOC acquisition and
$1.37 billion of deposits generated through strategic plans aiming to increase core deposits by launching interest-bearing core
deposit products with enhanced features to attract high net worth depositors, partially offset by $464.3 million of deposits sold
to AWB. The increase in average cost was due mainly to the higher interest rates on those deposits generated through strategic
plans.
Interest expense on FHLB advances was $269 thousand for the year ended December 31, 2013, a decrease of $79 thousand, or
22.7 percent, from $348 thousand for the year ended December 31, 2012. The decrease in interest expense on FHLB advances
was due mainly to 28 bps decrease in average cost, partially offset by a $20.7 million increase in average balance. The decrease
in average cost resulted from the replacement of matured long-term advances with short-term advances at lower rates.
Interest expense on long-term debt and other interest-bearing liabilities was $7.0 million for the year ended December 31, 2013,
an increase of $4.8 million, or 220.7 percent, from $2.2 million for the year ended December 31, 2012. The increase was due
mainly to the full-year impact on average balances of two issuances of the Company’s Senior Notes, in April and December of
2012.
60
Provision for Loan and Lease Losses
Provisions for loan and lease losses are charged to operations at a level required to reflect probable incurred credit losses in the
loan and lease portfolio. The Company provided $11.0 million, $8.0 million and $5.5 million, respectively, for the years ended
December 31, 2014, 2013 and 2012 to its provision for loan and lease losses.
On a quarterly basis, the Company evaluates the PCI loans and the loan pools for potential impairment. The Company provided
$0, $707 thousand and $0, respectively, for the years ended December 31, 2014, 2013 and 2012 to the provision for loan losses
for the PCI loans. The provision for losses on PCI loans is the result of changes in expected cash flows, both amount and
timing, due to loan payments and the Company’s revised loss forecasts. The revisions of the loss forecasts were based on the
results of management’s review of the credit quality of the outstanding loans/loan pools and the analysis of the loan
performance data since the acquisition of these loans. The Company will continue updating cash flow projections on PCI loans
on a quarterly basis. Due to the uncertainty in the future performance of the PCI loans, additional impairments may be
recognized in the future.
See further discussion in "Allowance for Loan and Lease Losses" in Item 7.
61
Noninterest Income
The following table presents the breakdown of non-interest income for the periods indicated:
Customer service fees
Loan servicing income
Income from bank owned life insurance
Net gain (loss) on sale of securities available for sale
Net gain on sale of loans
Net revenue on mortgage banking activities
Advisory service fees
Loan brokerage income
Gain on sale of branches
Bargain purchase gain
Other income
Year Ended December 31,
2014
2013
2012
(In thousands)
$
1,490
$
1,942
$
1,883
4,199
224
1,183
19,828
95,430
12,904
8,674
456
—
1,249
2,049
177
331
8,700
67,890
377
1,356
12,104
—
1,817
92
253
(83)
1,106
21,310
—
1
—
11,627
430
36,619
Total noninterest income
$
145,637
$
96,743
$
Year Ended December 31, 2014 Compared to Year Ended December 31, 2013
Noninterest income was $145.6 million for the year ended December 31, 2014, an increase of $48.9 million, or 50.5 percent,
from $96.7 million for the year ended December 31, 2013. The increase in noninterest income related predominantly to
increases in net revenue on mortgage banking activities, net gain on sale of loans, net gain on sale of securities available for
sale, advisory service fees, loan brokerage income, and loan servicing income, partially offset by lower customer service fees
and lower other income in 2014 and gain on sale of branches in 2013.
Customer service fees were $1.5 million for the year ended December 31, 2014, a decrease of $452 thousand, or 23.3 percent,
from $1.9 million for the year ended December 31, 2013. The decrease was due mainly to the lower average number of
customer deposit accounts as a result of the AWB branch sale in the fourth quarter of 2013, partially offset by an increase in
number of deposit accounts from the BPNA Branch Acquisition in the fourth quarter of 2014.
Loan servicing income was $4.2 million for the year ended December 31, 2014, an increase of $2.2 million, or 104.9 percent,
from $2.0 million for the year ended December 31, 2013. The increase was due mainly to a larger unpaid aggregate principal
balance of loans being serviced as well as a sale of mortgage servicing rights of $17.8 million with a gain on sale of $2.3
million, partially offset by a loss of $1.6 million from change of fair value on mortgage servicing rights during the year ended
December 31, 2014.
Net gain on the sale of securities available for sale was $1.2 million for the year ended December 31, 2014, an increase of $852
thousand, or 257.4 percent, from $331 thousand for the year ended December 31, 2013. During the year ended December 31,
2014, the Company was able to recognize higher realized gains during the period due to the current low interest rate
environment, while the Company sold more undesirable investment securities to reduce risk within its investment portfolio by
adjusting the mix of the portfolio to reduce private label mortgage-backed securities and increase agency mortgage-backed
securities during the year ended December 31, 2013. The Company sold investment securities of $110.6 million and $127.0
million during the years ended December 31, 2014 and 2013, respectively.
Net gain on the sale of loans was $19.8 million for the year ended December 31, 2014, an increase of $11.1 million, or 127.9
percent, from $8.7 million for the year ended December 31, 2013. During the year ended December 31, 2014, the Company
sold SFR mortgage loans of $916.4 million with a gain of $10.3 million, seasoned SFR mortgage loan pools of $82.6 million
with a gain of $8.6 million, and SBA loans of $11.4 million with a gain of $874 thousand. During the year ended December 31,
2013, the Company sold SFR mortgage loans of $260.3 million with a gain of $2.7 million, seasoned SFR mortgage loan pools
of $113.0 million with a gain of $3.4 million, SBA loans of $2.5 million with a gain of $120 thousand, and other loans of $733
thousand with a gain of $2.5 million.
Net revenue on mortgage banking activities was $95.4 million for the year ended December 31, 2014, an increase of $27.5
million, or 40.6 percent, from $67.9 million for the year ended December 31, 2013. During the year ended December 31, 2014,
the Bank originated $2.82 billion and sold $2.75 billion of conforming single family residential mortgage loans in the
secondary market. The net gain and margin were $84.1 million and 3.0 percent, respectively, and loan origination fees were
62
$11.3 million for the year ended December 31, 2014. Included in the net gain was the initial capitalized value of our MSRs,
which totaled $25.2 million on loans sold to Fannie Mae, Freddie Mac and Ginnie Mae for the year ended December 31, 2014.
During the year ended December 31, 2013, the Bank originated $1.94 billion of conforming single family residential mortgage
loans and sold $1.86 billion of loans in the secondary market. The net gain and margin were $58.0 million and 3.0 percent,
respectively, and loan origination fees were $9.9 million for the year ended December 31, 2013. Included in the net gain was
the initial capitalized value of our MSRs, which totaled $10.9 million, on loans sold to Fannie Mae, Freddie Mac and Ginnie
Mae for the year ended December 31, 2013.
Advisory service fees were $12.9 million for the year ended December 31, 2014, an increase of $12.5 million from $377
thousand for the year ended December 31, 2013. The increase was mainly due to a full year income generation from The
Palisades Group, which was acquired during the third quarter of 2013.
Loan brokerage income was $8.7 million for the year ended December 31, 2014, an increase of $7.3 million, or 539.7 percent,
from $1.4 million for the year ended December 31, 2013. The increase was mainly due to a full year income generation from
CS Financial, which was acquired by the Bank during the fourth quarter of 2013.
Gain on sale of branches of $456 thousand and $12.1 million was recognized for the years ended December 31, 2014 and 2013,
respectively, for the branch sale transaction to AWB on October 4, 2013. In the AWB branch sale transaction, the Bank sold sell
eight branches and related assets and deposit liabilities to AWB. The transaction was completed with a transfer of $464.3
million deposits to AWB in exchange for a deposit premium of 2.3 percent.
Other income was $1.2 million for the year ended December 31, 2014, a decrease of $568 thousand, or 31.3 percent, from $1.8
million for the year ended December 31, 2013.
Year Ended December 31, 2013 Compared to Year Ended December 31, 2012
Noninterest income was $96.7 million for the year ended December 31, 2013, an increase of $60.1 million from $36.6 million
for the year ended December 31, 2012. The increase in noninterest income relates predominantly to increases in net revenue on
mortgage banking activities, net gain on sale of loans, and gain on sale of branches, partially offset by the absence in 2013 of a
bargain purchase gain recognized in 2012 for the acquisition of Gateway.
Customer service fees were $1.9 million for the year ended December 31, 2013, an increase of $59 thousand, or 3.1 percent,
from $1.9 million for the year ended December 31, 2012. The change for 2013 was flat despite the increase in deposits from the
PBOC acquisition, due to the sale of eight branches, which reduced the number of overall transaction accounts in this deposit
category, which was the primary source of service fees.
Loan servicing income was $2.0 million for the year ended December 31, 2013, an increase of $2.0 million, or 2,127.2 percent,
from $92 thousand for the year ended December 31, 2012. The increase was due mainly to the expansion of the mortgage
banking activities.
Net gain on sales of securities available for sale was $331 thousand for the year ended December 31, 2013, an increase of $414
thousand, or 498.8 percent, from net loss of $83 thousand for the year ended December 31, 2012. During the year ended
December 31, 2013, the Company was able to profitably reduce risk within its investment portfolio by adjusting the mix of the
portfolio to reduce private label mortgage-backed securities and increase agency mortgage-backed securities.
Net gain on the sale of loans was $8.7 million for the year ended December 31, 2013, an increase of $7.6 million, or 686.6
percent, from $1.1 million for the year ended December 31, 2012. During the year ended December 31, 2013, the Company
sold SFR mortgage loans of $260.3 million with a gain of $2.7 million, seasoned SFR mortgage loan pools of $113.0 million
with a gain of $3.4 million, SBA loans of $2.5 million with a gain of $120 thousand, and other loans of $733 thousand with a
gain of $2.5 million. During the year ended December 31, 2012, the Company sold SFR mortgage loans of $70.7 million with a
gain of $626 thousand and SBA loans of $7.1 million with a gain of $647 thousand.
Net revenue on mortgage banking activities was $67.9 million for the year ended December 31, 2013, an increase of $46.6
million, or 218.6 percent, from $21.3 million for the year ended December 31, 2012. During the year ended December 31,
2013, the Bank originated $1.94 billion of conforming single family residential mortgage loans and sold $1.86 billion of loans
in the secondary market. The net gain and margin were $58.0 million and 3.0 percent, respectively, and loan origination fees
were $9.9 million for the year ended December 31, 2013. Included in the net gain was the initial capitalized value of our MSRs,
which totaled $10.9 million, on loans sold to Fannie Mae, Freddie Mac and Ginnie Mae for the year ended December 31, 2013.
During the year ended December 31, 2012, the Bank originated $518 million of conforming single family residential mortgage
loans and sold $477 million of loans in the secondary market. The net gain and margin were $18.9 million and 3.7 percent,
respectively, and loan origination fees were $2.8 million for the year ended December 31, 2012. Included in the net gain was
63
the initial capitalized value of our MSRs, which totaled $441 thousand, on loans sold to Fannie Mae for the year ended
December 31, 2013.
Advisory service fees were $377 thousand for the year ended December 31, 2013. The income was generated from The
Palisades Group, which was acquired during the third quarter of 2013.
Loan brokerage income was $1.4 million for the year ended December 31, 2013. The income was generated from CS Financial,
which was acquired by the Bank during the fourth quarter of 2013.
Gain on sale of branches of $12.1 million was recognized for the year ended December 31, 2013. On October 4, 2013, the Bank
completed a branch sale transaction to AWB. In the transaction, the Bank sold eight branches and related assets and deposit
liabilities to AWB. The transaction was completed with a transfer of $464.3 million deposits to AWB in exchange for a deposit
premium of 2.3 percent.
Bargain purchase gain of $11.6 million was recognized for the year ended December 31, 2012 from the Gateway acquisition.
Other income was $1.8 million for the year ended December 31, 2013, an increase of $1.4 million, or 322.6 percent, from $430
thousand for the year ended December 31, 2012.
64
Noninterest Expense
The following table presents the breakdown of non-interest expense for the periods indicated:
Year Ended December 31,
2014
2013
2012
(In thousands)
Salaries and employee benefits, excluding commissions
$
127,223
$
87,239
$
Commissions for mortgage banking activities
Salaries and employee benefits
Occupancy and equipment
Professional fees
Data processing
Advertising
Regulatory assessments
Loan servicing and foreclosure expense
Operating loss on equity investment
Valuation allowance for other real estate owned
Net (gain) loss on sales of other real estate owned
Provision for loan repurchases
Amortization of intangible assets
Impairment on intangible assets
All other expense
Total noninterest expense
35,656
162,879
33,443
19,247
5,231
5,016
4,182
1,066
689
32
(66)
2,808
4,079
48
25,507
23,448
110,687
19,662
13,864
4,710
4,361
2,535
905
569
97
(464)
2,383
2,651
1,061
15,649
$
264,161
$
178,670
$
36,446
5,445
41,891
7,902
7,888
3,011
1,046
1,519
980
364
703
(464)
256
696
—
5,768
71,560
Year Ended December 31, 2014 Compared to Year Ended December 31, 2013
Noninterest expense was $264.2 million for the year ended December 31, 2014, an increase of $85.5 million, or 47.8 percent,
from $178.7 million for the year ended December 31, 2013. The increase in noninterest expense relates predominantly to the
bank and non-bank acquisitions by the Company along with growth related to the mortgage banking strategy.
Total salaries and employee benefits including commissions was $162.9 million for the year ended December 31, 2014, an
increase of $52.2 million, or 47.2 percent, from $110.7 million for the year ended December 31, 2013. The increase was due
mainly to additional compensation expense from an increase in the number of full-time employees resulting from the
RenovationReady acquisition and BPNA Branch Acquisition, an increase in share-based compensation expense, as well as
expansion in mortgage banking activities. Commission expense, which is a loan origination variable expense, related to
mortgage banking activities, totaled $35.7 million and $23.4 million for the years ended December 31, 2014 and 2013,
respectively. Total originations of single family residential mortgage loans for the years ended December 31, 2014 and 2013
totaled $2.82 billion and $1.94 billion, respectively.
Occupancy and equipment expenses were $33.4 million for the year ended December 31, 2014, an increase of $13.8 million, or
70.1 percent, from $19.7 million for the year ended December 31, 2013. The increase was due mainly to increased building and
maintenance costs resulting from a full year of branch costs associated with the 2013 acquisitions of PBOC, The Palisades
Group and CS Financial, and new branch locations associated with the BPNA Branch Acquisition and new loan production
offices.
Professional fees were $19.2 million for the year ended December 31, 2014, an increase of $5.4 million, or 38.8 percent, from
$13.9 million for the year ended December 31, 2013. The increases were mainly due to higher accounting, legal and consulting
costs associated with the Company’s recent acquisitions and growth.
Data processing expenses were $5.2 million for the year ended December 31, 2014, an increase of $521 thousand, or 11.1
percent, from $4.7 million for the year ended December 31, 2013. The increases were mainly due to a higher volume of
transactions related to loan and deposit growth.
Advertising costs were $5.0 million for the year ended December 31, 2014, an increase of $655 thousand, or 15.0 percent, from
$4.4 million for the year ended December 31, 2013. The increase was mainly due to the Company's higher overall marketing
cost associated with the continued expansion of its business footprint.
65
Regulatory assessment was $4.2 million for the year ended December 31, 2014, an increase of $1.6 million, or 65.0 percent,
from $2.5 million for the year ended December 31, 2013. The increase was due to year-over-year balance sheet growth.
Provision for loan repurchases was $2.8 million and $2.4 million for the years ended December 31, 2014 and 2013,
respectively. Additionally, the Company recorded initial provision for loan repurchases of $1.4 million against net revenue on
mortgage banking activities during the year ended December 31, 2014. The increase was mainly due to increased volume of
mortgage loan originations and sales.
Amortization of intangible assets was $4.1 million for the year ended December 31, 2014, an increase of $1.4 million, or 53.9
percent, from $2.7 million for the year ended December 31, 2013. The increase was due to the acquisitions in 2013 and 2014.
Impairment of intangible assets of $48 thousand and $1.1 million was recognized for the years ended December 31, 2014 and
2013, respectively. During the year ended December 31, 2014, the Company wrote off a portion of core deposit intangibles
related to Beach acquisition of $48 thousand due to lower remaining deposit balances than forecasted. During the year ended
December 31, 2013, the Company wrote off all remaining trade name intangibles of Beach, Gateway and PBOC of $976
thousand due to the merger of the Company's two banking subsidiaries into a single bank and a portion of core deposit
intangibles on deposits acquired from Gateway of $85 thousand due to the lower remaining balance than projected.
Other expenses were $25.5 million for the year ended December 31, 2014, an increase of $9.9 million, or 63.0 percent, from
$15.6 million for the year ended December 31, 2013. The increase was mainly due to costs associated with the growth in
mortgage banking activities and an increase in loan sub-servicing expenses due to the growth in the loan portfolio.
Year Ended December 31, 2013 Compared to Year Ended December 31, 2012
Noninterest expense was $178.7 million for the year ended December 31, 2013, an increase of $107.1 million, or 149.7 percent,
from $71.6 million for the year ended December 31, 2012. The increase in noninterest expense relates predominantly to the
bank and non-bank acquisitions by the Company along with growth related to the mortgage banking strategy.
Total salaries and employee benefits including commissions was $110.7 million for the year ended December 31, 2013, an
increase of $68.8 million, or 164.2 percent, from $41.9 million for the year ended December 31, 2012. The increase was due
mainly to additional compensation expense related to an increase in the number of full-time employees resulting from the
acquisitions of Beach, Gateway, PBOC, The Palisades Group, and CS Financial and expansion in mortgage banking activities.
Commission expense, which is a loan origination variable expense related to mortgage banking activities, totaled $23.4 million
and $5.4 million for the year ended December 31, 2013 and 2012, respectively. Total originations of single family residential
mortgage loans for the year ended December 31, 2013 and 2012 were $1.94 billion and $515.3 million, respectively.
Occupancy and equipment expenses were $19.7 million for the year ended December 31, 2013, an increase of $11.8 million, or
148.8 percent, from $7.9 million for the year ended December 31, 2012. The increase was due mainly to increased building and
maintenance costs associated with moving the Company headquarters to Irvine, a full year of branch costs associated with the
2012 acquisitions of Beach and Gateway, new branch locations associated with the PBOC acquisition, additional facilities costs
associated with The Palisades Group and CS Financial acquisitions and new loan production offices.
Professional fees were $13.9 million for the year ended December 31, 2013, an increase of $6.0 million, or 75.8 percent, from
$7.9 million for the year ended December 31, 2012. The increases were mainly due to higher accounting, legal and consulting
costs associated with the Company’s acquisitions and the branch sale to AWB, costs associated with core system integration,
and costs associated with information technology infrastructure updates for the year ended December 31, 2013.
Advertising costs were $4.4 million for the year ended December 31, 2013, an increase of $3.3 million, or 316.9 percent, from
$1.0 million for the year ended December 31, 2012. The increases were mainly due to the overall expansion of the Company’s
business footprint, print media costs associated with deposit campaign and the Company's rebranding.
Data processing expenses were $4.7 million for the year ended December 31, 2013, an increase of $1.7 million, or 56.4 percent,
from $3.0 million for the year ended December 31, 2012. The increases were mainly due to a higher volume of transactions
related to loan and deposit growth.
Regulatory assessment was $2.5 million for the year ended December 31, 2013, an increase of $1.0 million, or 66.9 percent,
from $1.5 million for the year ended December 31, 2012. The increase was due to year-over-year balance sheet growth.
Provision for loan repurchases was $2.4 million for the year ended December 31, 2013, an increase of $2.1 million, or 830.9
percent, from $256 thousand for the year ended December 31, 2012. The increase was mainly due to increased volume of
mortgage loan originations and sales at the Bank.
66
Amortization of intangible assets was $2.7 million for the year ended December 31, 2013, an increase of $2.0 million, or 280.9
percent, from $696 thousand for the year ended December 31, 2012. The increase was due to the acquisitions in 2012 and 2013.
Impairment of intangible assets of $1.1 million was recognized for the year ended December 31, 2013. The Company wrote off
all remaining trade name intangibles of Beach, Gateway and PBOC of $976 thousand due to merger of the Company's two
banking subsidiaries into a single bank and a portion of core deposit intangibles on deposits acquired from Gateway of $85
thousand due to the lower remaining balance than projected. The Company did not recognize any impairment of intangible
assets for the year ended December 31, 2012.
Other expenses were $15.6 million for the year ended December 31, 2013, an increase of $9.9 million, or 171.3 percent, from
$5.8 million for the year ended December 31, 2012. The increase was mainly due to costs associated with the growth in
mortgage banking activity and an increase in loan sub-servicing expenses due to the increase in the size of the loan portfolio.
Income Tax Expense
For the years ended December 31, 2014, 2013 and 2012, income tax (benefit) expense was $(4.5) million, $7.3 million and
$115 thousand, respectively, and the effective tax rate was (17.6) percent, 98.9 percent and 2.1 percent, respectively. The
Company’s effective tax rate decreased in 2014 due to the release of the valuation allowance.
The Company accounts for income taxes by recognizing deferred tax assets and liabilities based upon temporary differences
between the amounts for financial reporting purposes and tax basis of its assets and liabilities. A valuation allowance is
established when necessary to reduce deferred tax assets when it is more-likely-than-not that a portion or all of the net deferred
tax asset will not be realized. In assessing the realization of deferred tax assets, management evaluates both positive and
negative evidence, including the existence of any cumulative losses in the current year and the prior two years, the amount of
taxes paid in available carry-back years, the ability to forecast future income, applicable tax planning strategies, and
assessments of current and future economic and business conditions. This analysis is updated quarterly and adjusted as
necessary. As of December 31, 2014, the Company had a net deferred tax asset of $16.4 million, net of a $0 valuation
allowance and as of December 31, 2013, the Company had a net deferred tax asset of $0, net of a $17.3 million valuation
allowance.
On January 1, 2007, the Company adopted the provisions of ASC 740-10-25 (formerly FIN 48), which relates to the accounting
for uncertainty in income taxes recognized in an enterprise’s financial statements. ASC 740-10-25 prescribes a threshold and a
measurement process for recognizing in the financial statements a tax position taken or expected to be taken in a tax return and
also provides guidance on de-recognition, classification, interest and penalties, accounting in interim periods, disclosure and
transition. The Company had unrecognized tax benefits of $5.4 million and $2.2 million at December 31, 2014 and 2013,
respectively. The Company does not expect the total amount of unrecognized tax benefits to significantly change in the next
twelve months. At December 31, 2014, the total unrecognized tax benefit that, if recognized, would impact the effective tax rate
is $172 thousand. At December 31, 2014 and 2013, the Company had $23 thousand and $0 accrued interest or penalties.
The Company and its subsidiaries are subject to U.S. Federal income tax as well as income tax in multiple state jurisdictions.
The Company is no longer subject to examination by U.S. Federal taxing authorities for years before 2010 (with the exception
of Gateway Bancorp, a predecessor entity, which is currently under exam by the Internal Revenue Service for the 2008 and
2009 tax years). The statute of limitations for the assessment of California Franchise taxes has expired for tax years before
2010 (other state income and franchise tax statutes of limitations vary by state).
67
Operating Segment Results
The Company utilizes an internal reporting system to measure the performance of various operating segments within the Bank
and the Company overall. The Company has identified four operating segments for purposes of management reporting: 1)
Banking; 2) Mortgage Banking; 3) Financial Advisory and Asset Management; and 4) Corporate/Other. Each of these four
business divisions meets the criteria of an operating segment, as each segment engages in business activities from which it
earns revenues and incurs expenses and its operating results are regularly reviewed by the Company’s chief operating decision-
maker, the Company's President and Chief Executive Officer or his delegate, to make decisions about resources to be allocated
to the segment and assess its performance and for which discrete financial information is available.
The principal business of the Banking segment consists of attracting deposits and investing these funds primarily in
commercial, consumer and real estate secured loans. The principal business of the Mortgage Banking segment is originating
conforming SFR loans and selling these loans in the secondary market. The Financial Advisory and Asset Management
segment is operated by The Palisades Group and provides services of purchase, sale and management of SFR mortgage loans.
The Corporate/Other segment includes the holding company and PTB, an entity formed to hold real estate. The Corporate/
Other operating segment engages in business activities through the sale of other real estate owned and loans held at the holding
company and incurs interest expense on debt as well as non-interest expense for corporate related activities. The operating
segment results do not include allocation of centralized costs that are currently recorded in the Banking and Corporate/Other
segment. The Company is currently in the process of determining the basis for calculating allocations.
The prior periods’ measurement of operating segment performance may be restated for comparability for changes in the
Company’s management structure or reporting methodologies unless it is not deemed practicable to do so. The following table
represents the operating segments’ financial results and other key financial measures as of or for the years ended December 31,
2014, 2013, and 2012:
As of or For the Year Ended
Banking
Mortgage
Banking
Financial
Advisory and
Asset
Management
Corporate/
Other
Inter-segment
Elimination
Consolidated
December 31, 2014
Net interest income
Provision for loan and lease losses
Noninterest income
Noninterest expense
Income (loss) before income taxes
Total assets
December 31, 2013
Net interest income
Provision for loan and lease losses
Noninterest income
Noninterest expense
Income (loss) before income taxes
Total assets
December 31, 2012
Net interest income
Provision for loan and lease losses
Noninterest income
Noninterest expense
Income (loss) before income taxes
Total assets
Banking Segment
$
154,322
10,976
34,122
151,228
$
26,240
$ 5,649,260
$
96,222
7,963
26,740
89,018
$
25,981
$ 3,395,954
$
47,593
5,500
15,785
48,215
9,663
$
$ 1,556,099
$
$
$
$
$
$
$
$
$
8,455
—
98,322
96,103
10,674
309,241
7,792
—
69,687
76,210
1,269
222,269
1,017
—
21,220
15,291
6,946
119,243
$
$
$
$
$
$
$
$
$
(In thousands)
— $
—
19,697
11,071
8,626
14,957
$
$
— $
—
2,832
2,339
493
2,876
$
$
— $
—
—
—
— $
— $
(7,500) $
—
217
12,480
(19,763) $
$
60,593
(6,785) $
—
5
13,624
(20,404) $
$
33,974
(2,058) $
—
48
8,488
(10,498) $
$
71,469
— $
—
(6,721)
(6,721)
155,277
10,976
145,637
264,161
25,777
(62,480) $ 5,971,571
— $
— $
—
(2,521)
(2,521)
97,229
7,963
96,743
178,670
7,339
(27,050) $ 3,628,023
— $
— $
—
(434)
(434)
46,552
5,500
36,619
71,560
6,111
(64,109) $ 1,682,702
— $
Income before income taxes from the Banking segment was $26.2 million, $26.0 million, $9.7 million for the years ended
December 31, 2014, 2013, and 2012, respectively. The increases were mainly due to increases in net interest income and
noninterest income, partially offset by increases in provision for loan and lease losses and noninterest expense for the years
ended December 31, 2014 and 2013.
68
Net interest income was $154.3 million, $96.2 million, and $47.6 million for the years ended December 31, 2014, 2013, and
2012, respectively. For the year ended December 31, 2014, the increase was mainly due to an increase in average balance of
total interest-earning assets, partially offset by a decrease in yield. For the year ended December 31, 2013, the increase was
mainly due to increases in both average balance of total earnings assets and yield. The yield increased mainly due to the
increase in accretion of discount of seasoned SFR mortgage loan pools.
Provision for loan and lease losses was $11.0 million, $8.0 million, and $5.5 million for the years ended December 31, 2014,
2013, and 2012, respectively. The increases were mainly due to the increases in total loans and leases during the years ended
December 31, 2014 and 2013.
Noninterest income was $34.1 million, $26.7 million, and $15.8 million for the years ended December 31, 2014, 2013, and
2012, respectively. For the year ended December 31, 2014, the increase was mainly due to increases in net gain on sale of loans
and securities, loan brokerage income, and servicing fee income, partially offset by a gain on sale of branches of $12.1 million
in 2013. For the year ended December 31, 2013, the increase was mainly due to increases in net gain on sale of loans and
securities, loan brokerage income, and servicing fee income, partially offset by a bargain purchase gain of $11.6 million in
2012.
Noninterest expense was $151.2 million, $89.0 million, and $48.2 million for the years ended December 31, 2014, 2013, and
2012, respectively. The increases were mainly due to acquisitions and expansion of the business footprint.
Mortgage Banking Segment
Income before income taxes from the Mortgage Banking segment was $10.7 million, $1.3 million, and $6.9 million for the
years ended December 31, 2014, 2013, and 2012, respectively. For the year ended December 31, 2014, the increase was mainly
due to increases in originations and sales in 2014. For the year ended December 31, 2013, the decrease was mainly due to an
expansion of Mortgage Banking segment and adverse market conditions associated with interest rate fluctuations and falling
mortgage volumes per a loan officer, which significantly increased noninterest expense as described below, partially offset by
an increase in originations and sales.
Net interest income was $8.5 million, $7.8 million, and $1.0 million, and noninterest income was $98.3 million, $69.7 million,
and $21.2 million for the years ended December 31, 2014, 2013, and 2012, respectively. The increases in net interest income
and noninterest income were the result of increases in origination and sales of conforming SFR mortgage loans during the years
ended December 31, 2014 and 2013.
Noninterest expense was $96.1 million, $76.2 million, $15.3 million for the years ended December 31, 2014, 2013, and 2012,
respectively. The increases were mainly due to expansion of the Mortgage Banking segment, which incurred additional
compensation expense related to an increase in the number of full-time employees, and a loan origination variable commission
expense, and occupancy cost related to an increase in number of loan production offices.
Financial Advisory and Asset Management Segment
Income before income taxes on the Financial Advisory and Asset Management segment was $8.6 million and $493 thousand
for the years ended December 31, 2014 and 2013, respectively. The Palisades Group was acquired during the third quarter of
2013.
Noninterest income, which was mainly advisory service fees, was $19.7 million and $2.8 million and noninterest expense was
$11.1 million and $2.3 million for the years ended December 31, 2014 and 2013, respectively.
Corporate/Other Segment
Loss before income taxes on the Corporate/Other segment was $19.8 million, $20.4 million, and $10.5 million for the years
ended December 31, 2014, 2013, and 2012, respectively. Expenses in the Corporate/Other segment were related to interest
expense on the Senior Notes and junior subordinated amortizing notes, compensation expense relating to the Banc of
California, Inc. employees and directors and professional expense relating to bank and non-bank acquisitions. Total interest
expense was $7.9 million, $6.9 million, and $2.2 million, and total noninterest expense was $12.5 million, $13.6 million, and
$8.5 million for the years ended December 31, 2014, 2013 and 2012, respectively.
69
FINANCIAL CONDITION
Total assets increased by $2.34 billion, or 64.6 percent, to $5.97 billion at December 31, 2014, compared to $3.63 billion at
December 31, 2013. The increase in total assets was due primarily to a $470.4 million increase in loans held for sale, a $1.49
billion increase in loans and leases receivable, net of allowance, a $175.7 million increase in securities available for sale and a
$121.1 million increase in cash and cash equivalents.
Securities Available For Sale
The primary goal of our investment securities portfolio is to provide a relatively stable source of income while maintaining an
appropriate level of liquidity. Investment securities provide a source of liquidity as collateral for repurchase agreements and for
certain public funds deposits. Investment securities classified as available-for-sale are carried at their estimated fair values with
the changes in fair values recorded in accumulated other comprehensive income, as a component of stockholders’ equity. All
investment securities have been classified as available-for-sale securities as of December 31, 2014 and 2013.
Total investment securities available-for-sale increased by $175.7 million, or 103.3 percent, to $345.7 million at December 31,
2014, from $170.0 million at December 31, 2013, due to purchases of $327.1 million, partially offset by sales of $110.6
million, principal payments of $41.1 million, and calls and pay-offs of $1.2 million. Investment securities had a net unrealized
gain of $817 thousand at December 31, 2014, compared to a net unrealized loss of $1.5 million at December 31, 2013.
The following table presents the amortized cost and fair value of the available-for-sale investment securities portfolio and the
corresponding amounts of gross unrealized gains and losses recognized in accumulated other comprehensive income (loss) as
of the dates indicated:
Amortized
Cost
Gross
Unrealized
Gains
Gross
Unrealized
Losses
(In thousands)
Fair Value
December 31, 2014
Available for sale
SBA loan pool securities
U.S. government-sponsored entities and agency securities
Private label residential mortgage-backed securities
Agency mortgage-backed securities
Total securities available for sale
December 31, 2013
Available for sale
SBA loan pool securities
U.S. government-sponsored entities and agency securities
Private label residential mortgage-backed securities
Agency mortgage-backed securities
Total securities available for sale
December 31, 2012
Available for sale
SBA loan pool securities
U.S. government-sponsored entities and agency securities
Private label residential mortgage-backed securities
Agency mortgage-backed securities
Total securities available for sale
1,697
$
1,940
3,169
338,072
18
42
12
1,363
$
— $
—
(13)
(605)
344,878
$
1,435
$
(618) $
1,794
$
— $
(58) $
1,928
14,653
153,134
171,509
$
—
135
299
434
(8)
(36)
(1,819)
$
(1,921) $
2,706
$
4
$
— $
9,660
41,499
66,818
284
475
335
—
(128)
(234)
1,715
1,982
3,168
338,830
345,695
1,736
1,920
14,752
151,614
170,022
2,710
9,944
41,846
66,919
120,683
$
1,098
$
(362) $
121,419
$
$
$
$
$
$
70
The following table presents the composition and maturities of the securities portfolio as of December 31, 2014:
One year or less
More than One
Year through
Five Years
More than Five
Years through
Ten Years
More than Ten
Years
Amortized
Cost
Weighted
Average
Yield
Amortized
Cost
Weighted
Average
Yield
Amortized
Cost
Weighted
Average
Yield
Amortized
Cost
Weighted
Average
Yield
Amortized
Cost
Total
Fair
Value
Weighted
Average
Yield
($ in thousands)
Available-for-sale
SBA loan pools
securities
U.S. government-
sponsored
entities and
agency
securities
Private label
residential
mortgage-
backed
securities
Agency mortgage-
backed
securities
Total securities
$
—
— % $
—
— % $
—
— % $
1,697
2.69 % $
1,697
$
1,715
2.69 %
—
— %
1,940
2.35 %
—
— %
—
— %
1,940
1,982
2.35 %
671
1.11 %
1,371
3.81 %
—
— %
1,127
4.94 %
3,169
3,168
3.64 %
826
0.91 %
3
(0.83)%
9,276
1.53 %
327,967
2.29 %
338,072
338,830
2.26 %
available for sale
$
1,497
1.00% $
3,314
2.95 % $
9,276
1.53% $ 330,791
2.30% $ 344,878
$ 345,695
2.28%
At December 31, 2014 and 2013, there were no holdings of any one issuer, other than the U.S. Government and its agencies, in
an amount greater than 10 percent of stockholders’ equity.
The following table presents proceeds from sales and calls of securities and the associated gross gains and losses realized
through earnings upon the sale of available for sale securities for the periods indicated:
Gross realized gains on sales of securities available for sale
Gross realized losses on sales of securities available for sale
Net realized gains (losses) on sales of securities available for sale
Proceeds from sales of securities available for sale
Tax expense on sales of securities available for sale
Year Ended December 31,
2014
2013
2012
(In thousands)
$
$
$
$
1,221
(38)
1,183
111,764
498
$
$
$
$
438
(107)
331
127,298
$
$
$
— $
19
(102)
(83)
11,940
—
Securities available for sale with carrying values of $27.1 million and $63.0 million as of December 31, 2014 and 2013,
respectively, were pledged to secure FHLB advances, public deposits and for other purposes as required or permitted by law.
71
The following table summarizes the investment securities with unrealized losses at December 31, 2014 and 2013 by security
type and length of time in a continuous unrealized loss position:
Less Than 12 Months
12 Months or Longer
Total
Fair Value
Gross
Unrealized
Losses
Fair Value
Gross
Unrealized
Losses
Fair Value
Gross
Unrealized
Losses
(In thousands)
December 31, 2014
Available for sale
$
$
$
SBA loan pool securities
U.S. government-sponsored entities
and agency securities
Private label residential mortgage-
backed securities
Agency mortgage-backed securities
Total securities available for sale
December 31, 2013
Available for sale
SBA loan pool securities
U.S. government-sponsored entities
and agency securities
Private label residential mortgage-
backed securities
Agency mortgage-backed securities
— $
— $
— $
— $
— $
—
372
68,200
—
(9)
(332)
—
1,355
22,212
—
(4)
(273)
—
1,727
90,412
68,572
$
(341) $
23,567
$
(277) $
92,139
$
1,736
$
(58) $
— $
— $
1,736
$
1,920
(8)
2,064
114,104
(11)
(1,790)
—
3,913
1,821
—
(25)
(29)
1,920
5,977
115,925
Total securities available for sale
$
119,824
$
(1,867) $
5,734
$
(54) $
125,558
$
—
—
(13)
(605)
(618)
(58)
(8)
(36)
(1,819)
(1,921)
The Company did not record other-than-temporary impairment (OTTI) for securities available for sale for the years ended
December 31, 2014 and 2013.
At December 31, 2014, the Company’s securities available for sale portfolio consisted of 92 securities, 49 of which were in an
unrealized loss position. The unrealized losses are related to an overall increase in interest rates and a decrease in prepayment
speeds of the agency mortgage-backed securities.
The Company monitors to ensure it has adequate credit support and as of December 31, 2014, the Company does not have the
intent to sell these securities and it is not likely that it will be required to sell the securities before their anticipated recoveries.
Of the Company’s $345.7 million securities portfolio, $344.4 million were rated AAA, AA or A, $1.1 million were rated BBB,
and a private label residential mortgage-backed security of $181 thousand was rated BB based on the most recent credit rating
from the rating agencies as of December 31, 2014. The BB rated private label residential mortgage-backed security was
subsequently sold during January 2015. The Company considers the lowest credit rating for identification of potential OTTI.
Loans Held for Sale
Loans held for sale totaled $1.19 billion at December 31, 2014 compared to $716.7 million at December 31, 2013. The loans
held for sale consisted of $278.7 million and $192.6 million carried at fair value, and $908.3 million and $524.1 million carried
at lower of cost or fair value as of December 31, 2014 and 2013, respectively.
The loans carried at fair value represent conforming single family residential mortgage loans originated by the Bank that are
sold into the secondary market on a whole loan basis. Some of these loans are expected to be sold to Fannie Mae, Freddie Mac
and Ginnie Mae on a servicing retained basis. The servicing of these loans is performed by a third party sub-servicer. These
loans increased by $86.1 million to $278.7 million at December 31, 2014 due mainly to originations of $3.01 billion, partially
offset by sales of $2.94 billion.
Loans held for sale carried at the lower of cost or fair value are mainly non-conforming jumbo mortgage loans that are
originated to sell in pools, unlike the loans individually originated to sell into the secondary market on a whole loan basis.
These loans increased by $384.2 million to $908.3 million at December 31, 2014, due mainly to originations of $1.25 billion,
loans transferred from loans and leases held for investment of $66.3 million, and partially offset by sales of $732.9 million and
other net amortizations and loans transferred back to loans and leases held for investment of $200.1 million.
72
Loans and Leases Receivable
The following table presents the composition of the Company’s loan and lease portfolio as of the dates indicated:
2014
2013
December 31,
2012
2011
2010
Amount
Percent
Amount
Percent
Amount
Percent
Amount
Percent
Amount
Percent
($ in thousands)
Commercial:
Commercial and industrial $ 490,900
12.4 % $ 287,771
11.8 % $
80,387
6.4 % $
9,019
1.1 % $
6,743
Commercial real estate
Multi-family
SBA
Construction
Lease financing
Consumer:
Single family residential
mortgage
999,857
955,683
36,155
42,198
85,749
25.3 %
24.2 %
0.9 %
1.1 %
2.2 %
529,883
141,580
27,428
24,933
31,949
21.7 %
5.8 %
1.1 %
1.0 %
1.3 %
338,900
115,082
36,076
6,623
11,203
27.1 %
125,830
9.2 %
2.9 %
0.5 %
0.9 %
87,196
—
—
—
16.0 %
11.1 %
— %
— %
— %
61,314
32,911
—
—
—
1,171,662
29.7 % 1,286,541
52.6 %
638,667
51.3 %
548,522
69.5 %
570,892
Other consumer
166,918
4.2 %
116,026
4.7 %
21,533
1.7 %
17,822
2.3 %
20,952
1.0 %
8.9 %
4.8 %
— %
— %
— %
82.3 %
3.0 %
Total loans and leases
3,949,122
100.0 % 2,446,111
100.0 % 1,248,471
100.0 %
788,389
100.0 %
692,812
100.0 %
Allowance for loan and
lease losses
Total loans and leases
receivable, net
(29,480)
(18,805)
(14,448)
(12,780)
(14,637)
$3,919,642
$2,427,306
$1,234,023
$ 775,609
$ 678,175
Total loans and leases increased by $1.50 billion to $3.95 billion at December 31, 2014 compared to $2.45 billion at December
31, 2013, due to the BPNA Branch Acquisition and the Company's continuous effort to grow and diversify the loan and lease
portfolio, partially offset by a decrease in single family residential mortgage loans from the sale of seasoned SFR mortgage
loan pools and the transfer of loans to loans held for sale.
The following table presents the contractual maturity and repricing information with the weighted average contractual yield of
the loan and lease portfolio as of December 31, 2014:
One Year or Less
More Than One Year
Through Five Years
More than Five
Years through
Ten Years
More than Ten
Years
Total
Amount
Weighted
Average
Yield
Amount
Weighted
Average
Yield
Amount
Weighted
Average
Yield
Amount
Weighted
Average
Yield
Amount
Weighted
Average
Yield
($ in thousands)
Commercial:
Commercial and industrial $ 364,908
3.7 % $ 101,390
3.9 % $
20,120
4.6 % $
4,482
4.3 % $ 490,900
Commercial real estate
Multi-family
SBA
Construction
Lease financing
Consumer:
Single family residential
mortgage
Other consumer
145,095
141,381
21,275
40,101
2,426
4.5 %
4.5 %
5.4 %
4.6 %
8.7 %
564,286
548,854
7,494
1,427
72,396
4.8 %
4.0 %
4.6 %
6.2 %
7.4 %
266,016
257,532
4,506
—
10,927
4.7 %
4.4 %
5.5 %
— %
5.9 %
24,460
7,916
2,880
670
—
5.0 %
4.6 %
6.0 %
3.6 %
— %
999,857
955,683
36,155
42,198
85,749
573,284
151,640
3.3 %
3.7 %
210,916
11,397
3.5 %
4.5 %
125,733
1,737
4.1 %
4.8 %
261,729
5.0 % 1,171,662
2,144
7.0 %
166,918
Total
$1,440,110
3.7% $1,518,160
4.4% $ 686,571
4.5% $ 304,281
5.0% $3,949,122
3.8 %
4.8 %
4.2 %
5.3 %
4.6 %
7.3 %
3.8 %
3.8 %
4.2%
73
The following table presents the interest rate profile of the loan and lease portfolio due after one year at December 31, 2014:
Commercial:
Commercial and industrial
Commercial real estate
Multi-family
SBA
Construction
Lease financing
Consumer:
Single family residential mortgage
Other consumer
Total
Due After One Year
Fixed Rate
Floating Rate
Total
(In thousands)
$
88,564
$
144,257
$
465,638
101,537
5,384
2,097
83,323
270,595
15,278
510,345
841,423
30,564
6,563
—
892,879
127,317
232,821
975,983
942,960
35,948
8,660
83,323
1,163,474
142,595
$
1,032,416
$
2,553,348
$
3,585,764
Loan and Lease Originations, Purchases and Repayments
The Company originates real estate secured loans primarily through its retail channel under its DBA Banc Home Loans and
under the Bank’s name, and through its wholesale and correspondent channels through other mortgage brokers and banking
relationships. Loans originated are either: eligible for sale to Fannie Mae and Freddie Mac, government insured FHA or VA,
held by the Company, or sold to private investors.
The Company also originates consumer and real estate loans on a direct basis through our marketing efforts and our existing
and walk-in customers. The Company originates both adjustable and fixed-rate loans; however, the ability to originate loans is
dependent upon customer demand for loans in our market areas. Demand is affected by competition and the interest rate
environment. During the last few years, the Company has significantly increased origination of ARM loans. The Company has
also purchased ARM loans secured by single family residences and participations in construction and commercial real estate
loans in the past. Loans and participations purchased must conform to the Company’s underwriting guidelines or guidelines
acceptable to the management loan committee.
74
The following table presents loan and lease originations, purchases, sales, and repayment activities excluding the conforming
residential mortgage loans originated for sale, for the periods indicated:
Origination by rate type:
Floating rate:
Commercial and industrial
Commercial real estate and multi family
SBA
Construction
Lease financing
Single family residential mortgage
Other consumer
Total floating rate
Fixed rate:
Commercial and industrial
Commercial real estate and multi family
SBA
Construction
Lease financing
Single family residential mortgage
Other consumer
Total fixed rate
Total loans and leases originated
Purchases:
Single family residential mortgage
Commercial real estate and multi-family
Lease financing
Total loans and leases purchased
Acquired in business combinations
Transferred to loans held for sale
Repayments:
Principal repayments
Sales
Increase (decrease) in other items, net
Net increase (decrease)
Year Ended December 31,
2014
2013
2012
(In thousands)
$
80,119
$
81,048
$
397,271
12,223
1,167
1,091
130,251
46,407
668,529
51,949
61,145
3,691
—
44,590
—
8,414
169,789
838,318
—
—
38,572
38,572
1,072,449
(66,334)
(1,885,128)
(90,390)
1,595,524
120,631
1,474
6,226
—
390,499
21,282
621,160
10,962
117,666
772
1,136
16,952
3,464
307
151,259
772,419
849,883
—
7,850
857,733
385,256
(182,803)
(461,223)
(263,554)
89,812
$
1,503,011
$
1,197,640
$
32,329
72,142
5,216
16,961
—
183,343
5,268
315,259
2,103
95,640
2,970
—
—
2,382
150
103,245
418,504
66,718
18,674
14,487
99,879
361,044
—
(349,158)
(70,438)
(1,417)
458,414
The increases in changes from principal repayments and other items were mainly due to increased advances and repayments in
commercial lines of credit and warehouse lines of credit during 2014.
75
Seasoned SFR Mortgage Loan Acquisitions
In 2014, the Company did not acquire any additional seasoned SFR mortgage loan pools.
During the year ended December 31, 2013, the Company completed five seasoned SFR mortgage loan pool acquisitions with
unpaid principal balances and fair values of $1.02 billion and $849.9 million, respectively, at their respective acquisition dates.
These loan pools had unpaid principal balances and fair values of $640.2 million and $571.0 million, respectively, at
December 31, 2014. These loan pools generally consist of re-performing residential mortgage loans whose characteristics and
payment history were consistent with borrowers that demonstrated a willingness and ability to remain in the residence pursuant
to the current terms of the mortgage loan agreement. The Company was able to acquire these loans at a significant discount to
both current property value at acquisition and note balance. The Company determined that certain loans in these seasoned SFR
mortgage loan acquisitions reflected credit quality deterioration since origination and it was probable, at acquisition, that all
contractually required payments would not be collected. The unpaid principal balances and fair values of these loans at the
respective dates of acquisition were $473.9 million and $342.1 million, respectively. At December 31, 2014, the unpaid
principal balance and carrying value of these loans were $245.7 million and $206.4 million, respectively.
For each acquisition the Company was able to utilize its background in mortgage credit analysis to re-underwrite the
borrower’s credit to arrive at what it believes to be an attractive risk adjusted return for a highly collateralized investment in
performing mortgage loans. The acquisition program implemented and executed by the Company involved a multifaceted due
diligence process that included compliance reviews, title analyses, review of modification agreements, updated property
valuation assessments, collateral inventory and other undertakings related to the scope of due diligence. In aggregate, the
purchase price of the loans was less than 61.1 percent of current property value at the time of acquisition based on a third party
broker price opinion, and less than 83.1 percent of note balance at the time of acquisition. At the time of acquisition,
approximately 86.3 percent of the mortgage loans by current principal balance (excluding any forbearance amounts) had the
original terms modified at some point since origination by a prior owner or servicer. The mortgage loans had a current weighted
average interest rate of 3.96 percent, determined by current principal balance. The weighted average credit score of the
borrowers comprising the mortgage loans at or near the time of acquisition determined by current principal balance and
excluding those with no credit score on file was 655. The average property value determined by a broker price opinion obtained
by third party licensed real estate professionals at or around the time of acquisition was $292 thousand. Approximately 89.6
percent of the borrowers by current principal balance had made at least 12 monthly payments in the 12 months preceding the
trade date (or, in some cases calculated as making 11 monthly payments in the 11 months preceding the trade date), and 94.0
percent had made nine monthly payments in the nine months preceding the trade date. The mortgage loans are secured by
residences located in all 50 states and Washington DC, with California being the largest state concentration representing 31.0
percent of the note balance, and with no other state concentration exceeding 10.0 percent based upon the current note balance.
At December 31, 2014 and 2013, approximately 3.46 percent and 5.63 percent of unpaid principal balance of these loans were
delinquent 60 or more days, respectively, and 0.76 percent and 1.37 percent were in bankruptcy or foreclosure, respectively.
Delinquencies on seasoned SFR loan pools decreased due to sales of portions of these loans.
As part of the acquisition program, the Company may sell from time to time seasoned SFR mortgage loans that do not meet the
Company’s investment standards. During the year ended December 31, 2014, the Company sold seasoned SFR mortgage loans
with an unpaid principal balance of $119.8 million and a carrying value of $82.6 million. During the year ended December 31,
2013, the Company sold seasoned SFR mortgage loans with an unpaid principal balance of $176.6 million and a carrying value
of $113.0 million. The Company recorded net gain on sale of $8.6 million and $3.4 million for the years ended December 31,
2014 and 2013, respectively, from these sales.
76
The following table presents the outstanding balance and carrying amount of PCI loans as of dates indicated:
Commercial:
Commercial and industrial
Commercial real estate
SBA
Consumer:
Single family residential mortgage
Other consumer
Total
December 31,
2014
2013
Outstanding
Balance
Carrying
Amount
Outstanding
Balance
Carrying
Amount
(In thousands)
$
1,767
$
1,134
$
5,838
$
13,708
4,220
11,527
3,157
283,067
231,079
—
—
17,682
4,940
414,341
2,134
4,028
15,014
3,688
314,820
1,736
$
302,762
$
246,897
$
444,935
$
339,286
Seasoned SFR Mortgage Loan Acquisition Due Diligence
The acquisition program implemented and executed by the Company involves a multifaceted due diligence process that
includes compliance reviews, title analyses, review of modification agreements, updated property valuation assessments,
collateral inventory and other undertakings related to the scope of due diligence. Prior to acquiring mortgage loans, the
Company, its affiliates, sub-advisors or due diligence partners typically will review the loan portfolio and conduct certain due
diligence on a loan by loan basis according to its proprietary diligence plan. This due diligence encompasses analyzing the title,
subordinate liens and judgments as well as a comprehensive reconciliation of current property value. The Company, its
affiliates, and its sub-advisors prepare a customized version of its diligence plan for each mortgage loan pool being reviewed
that is designed to address certain identified pool specific risks. The diligence plan generally reviews several factors, including
but not limited to, obtaining and reconciling property value, confirming chain of titles, reviewing assignments, confirming lien
position, confirming regulatory compliance, updating borrower credit, certifying collateral, and reviewing servicing notes. In
certain transactions, a portion of the diligence may be provided by the seller. In those instances, the Company reviews the
mortgage loan portfolio to confirm the accuracy of the provided diligence information and supplements as appropriate.
As part of the confirmation of property values in the diligence process, the Company conducts independent due diligence on
the individual properties and borrowers prior to the acquisition of the mortgage loans. In addition, market conditions, regional
mortgage loan information and local trends in home values, coupled with market knowledge, are used by the Company in
calculating the appropriate additional risk discount to compensate for potential property declines, foreclosures, defaults or other
risks associated with the mortgage loan portfolio to be acquired. Typically, the Company may enter into one or more
agreements with affiliates or third parties to perform certain of these due diligence tasks with respect to acquiring potential
mortgage loans.
77
Non-Traditional Mortgage Portfolio
The Company’s non-traditional mortgage (NTM) portfolio is comprised of three interest only products: Green Account Loans
(Green Loans), hybrid interest only fixed or adjustable rate mortgage (Interest Only) loans and a small number of additional
loans with the potential for negative amortization. As of December 31, 2014 and 2013, the non-traditional mortgage loans
totaled $350.6 million, or 8.9 percent of the total loans and leases, and $309.6 million, or 12.7 percent of the total loans and
leases, respectively. The total NTM portfolio increased by $41.0 million, or 13.2 percent during the period.
The following table presents the composition of the NTM portfolio as of the dates indicated:
2014
2013
December 31,
2012
2011
2010
Count
Amount
Percent
Count
Amount
Percent
Count
Amount
Percent
Count
Amount
Percent
Count
Amount
Percent
($ in thousands)
Green Loans
(HELOC) -
first liens
Interest only -
first liens
Negative
148
$ 123,177
35.1%
173
$ 147,705
47.7%
212
$ 198,720
53.9%
245
$ 219,502
58.9%
253
$ 215,395
53.4%
207
209,207
59.7%
244
139,867
45.2%
187
142,426
38.7%
199
123,134
33.0%
262
148,185
36.8%
amortization
32
13,099
3.7%
37
16,623
5.4%
40
19,341
5.3%
45
21,525
5.8%
52
30,142
7.5%
Total NTM -
first liens
Green Loans
(HELOC) -
second liens
Interest only -
second liens
Total NTM -
second liens
Total NTM
loans
% of NTM to
total gross
loan portfolio
387
345,483
98.5%
454
304,195
98.3%
439
360,487
97.9%
489
364,161
97.7%
567
393,722
97.7%
19
1
20
4,979
1.4%
113
0.1%
5,092
1.5%
23
1
24
5,289
1.7%
113
—%
5,402
1.7%
27
1
28
7,659
2.1%
114
—%
7,773
2.1%
32
1
33
8,703
2.3%
114
—%
8,817
2.3%
35
2
37
9,260
2.3%
182
—%
9,442
2.3%
407
$ 350,575
100.0%
478
$ 309,597
100.0%
467
$ 368,260
100.0%
522
$ 372,978
100.0%
604
$ 403,164
100.0%
8.9%
12.7%
29.5%
47.3%
58.2%
The initial credit guidelines for the non-traditional mortgage portfolio were established based on borrower Fair Isaac &
Company (FICO) score, loan-to-value (LTV), property type, occupancy type, loan amount, and geography. Additionally, from
an ongoing credit risk management perspective, the Company has determined the most significant performance indicators for
NTMs to be loan-to-value and FICO scores. On a semi-annual basis, the Company performs loan reviews of the NTM loan
portfolio, which includes refreshing FICO scores on the Green Loans and HELOCs and ordering third party automated
valuation models (AVM) to confirm collateral values.
78
LTV represents estimated current loan to value ratio, determined by dividing current unpaid principal balance by latest
estimated property value received per the Company policy. The following table presents the single family residential NTM first
lien portfolio by LTV at the dates indicated:
Green
Interest Only
Negative Amortization
Total
Count
Amount
Percent
Count
Amount
Percent
Count
Amount
Percent
Count
Amount
Percent
($ in thousands)
77
45
18
8
$
58,856
46,177
11,846
6,298
47.8 %
37.5 %
9.6 %
5.1 %
60
54
33
60
$
93,254
81,472
14,927
19,554
44.7 %
38.9 %
7.1 %
9.3 %
148
$
123,177
100.0%
207
$
209,207
100.0%
90
38
26
19
$
78,807
33,604
14,917
20,377
53.3 %
22.8 %
10.1 %
13.8 %
80
51
43
70
$
65,181
28,999
21,474
24,213
46.6 %
20.7 %
15.4 %
17.3 %
$
$
$
15
12
4
1
32
13
13
8
3
6,023
5,901
781
394
46.0 %
45.0 %
6.0 %
3.0 %
152
111
55
69
$
158,133
133,550
27,554
26,246
45.8 %
38.6 %
8.0 %
7.6 %
13,099
100.0%
387
$
345,483
100.0%
4,930
7,643
3,277
773
29.7 %
45.9 %
19.7 %
4.7 %
183
102
77
92
$
148,918
70,246
39,668
45,363
49.0 %
23.1 %
13.0 %
14.9 %
173
$
147,705
100.0%
244
$
139,867
100.0%
37
$
16,623
100.0%
454
$
304,195
100.0%
December 31, 2014
< 61
61 – 80
81 – 100
> 100
Total
December 31, 2013
< 61
61 – 80
81 – 100
> 100
Total
The decrease in Green Loans was due mainly to reductions in principal balances and payoffs and the increase in interest only
loans was due to increased originations. During the year ended December 31, 2014, overall improvement on LTV of the
Company’s SFR NTM first lien portfolio was due to the improvement in the real estate market and the economy in Southern
California. The Company updates LTV on a semi-annual basis, typically in the second and fourth quarters or as needed in
conjunction with proactive portfolio management.
The following table presents the contractual maturity with number of loans of the NTM portfolio as of December 31, 2014:
One Year or Less
More Than One Year
Through Five Years
More than Five
Years through
Ten Years
More than Ten
Years
Total
Amount
Count
Amount
Count
Amount
Count
Amount
Count
Amount
Count
($ in thousands)
Green Loans (HELOC) -
first liens (1)
$
Interest only - first liens (2)
Negative amortization
Total NTM - first liens
Green Loans (HELOC) -
second liens (1)
Interest only - second
liens (2)
Total NTM - second liens
Total NTM loans
$
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
$
$
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
$ 111,402
134
$
11,775
14
$ 123,177
991
—
5
0
112,393
139
208,216
13,099
233,090
4,979
113
5,092
19
1
20
—
—
—
202
32
248
0
0
0
209,207
13,099
345,483
4,979
113
5,092
148
207
32
387
19
1
20
$ 117,485
159
$ 233,090
248
$ 350,575
407
(1) Green Loans typically have a 15 year balloon maturity
(2) Interest only loans typically switch to an amortizing basis after 3, 5, or 7 years
At December 31, 2014, all negative amortization loans had outstanding balances less than their original principal balances.
Green Loans
Green Loans are single family residential first and second mortgage lines of credit with a linked checking account that allows
all types of deposits and withdrawals to be performed. The loans are generally interest only with a 15 year balloon payment due
at maturity. The Company initiated the Green Loan products in 2005 and proactively refined underwriting and credit
management practices and credit guidelines in response to changing economic environments, competitive conditions and
portfolio performance. The Company continues to manage credit risk, to the extent possible, throughout the borrower’s credit
cycle. The Company discontinued the origination of Green Loan products in 2011.
At December 31, 2014, Green Loans totaled $128.2 million, a decrease of $24.8 million, or 16.2 percent from $153.0 million at
December 31, 2013, primarily due to reductions in principal balance and payoffs. As of December 31, 2014 and 2013, $12.5
79
million and $5.7 million, respectively, of the Company’s Green Loans were non-performing. As a result of their unique
payment feature, Green Loans possess higher credit risk due to the potential of negative amortization; however, management
believes the risk is mitigated through the Company’s loan terms and underwriting standards, including its policies on loan-to-
value ratios and the Company’s contractual ability to curtail loans when the value of underlying collateral declines.
The Green Loans are similar to HELOCs in that they are collateralized primarily by the borrower's equity in the borrower's
home. However, some Green Loans are subject to differences from HELOCs relating to certain characteristics including one-
action laws. Similar to Green Loans, HELOCs allow the borrower to draw down on the credit line based on an established loan
amount for a period of time, typically 10 years, requiring an interest only payment with an option to pay principal at any time.
A typical HELOC provides that at the end of the term the borrower can continue to make monthly principal and interest
payments based on loan balance until the maturity date. The Green Loan is an interest only loan with a maturity of 15 years at
which time the loan comes due and payable with a balloon payment due at maturity. The unique payment structure also differs
from a traditional HELOC in that payments are made through the direct linkage of a personal checking account to the loan
through a nightly sweep of funds into the Green Loan Account. This reduces any outstanding balance on the loan by the total
amount deposited into the checking account. As a result, every time a deposit is made, effectively a payment to the Green Loan
is made. HELOCs typically do not cause the loan to be paid down by a borrower’s depositing of funds into their checking
account at the same bank.
Credit guidelines for Green Loans were established based on borrower FICO scores, property type, occupancy type, loan
amount, and geography. Property types include single family residences and second trust deeds where the Company owned the
first liens, owner occupied as well as non-owner occupied properties. The Company utilized its underwriting guidelines for first
liens to underwrite the Green Loan secured by second trust deeds as if the combined loans were a single Green Loan. For all
Green Loans, the loan income was underwritten using either full income documentation or alternative income documentation.
For single family properties the loan sizes ranged up to $7.0 million. For two-to-four family properties, the loan sizes ranged up
to $7.5 million. As loan size increased, the maximum LTV decreased from 80 percent to 60 percent. Maximum LTVs were
adjusted by 5-10 percent for specified property types such as condos. FICOs were based on the primary wage earners’ mid
FICO score and the lower of two mid FICO scores for full and alternative documentation, respectively. 76 percent of the FICO
scores exceeded 700 at the time of origination. Loans greater than $1 million were subject to a second appraisal or third party
appraisal review at origination.
The following table presents the Company’s non-traditional SFR mortgage Green Loans first lien portfolio at December 31,
2014 by FICO scores that were obtained during the quarter ended December 31, 2014, compared to the FICO scores for those
same loans that were obtained during the quarter ended December 31, 2013:
By FICO Scores Obtained
During the Quarter Ended
December 31, 2014
December 31, 2014
By FICO Scores Obtained
During the Quarter Ended
December 31, 2013
Change
Count
Amount
Percent
Count
Amount
Percent
Count
Amount
Percent
($ in thousands)
FICO Score
800+
700-799
600-699
<600
No FICO
Totals
$
28
72
29
8
11
20,248
52,532
31,053
11,893
7,451
16.4 %
42.7 %
25.2 %
9.7 %
6.0 %
$
13
87
30
8
10
8,263
66,493
26,438
7,001
14,982
6.7 %
53.9 %
21.5 %
5.7 %
12.2 %
(15)
(1)
—
1
15
$
11,985
9.7 %
(13,961)
(11.2)%
4,615
4,892
(7,531)
3.7 %
4.0 %
(6.2)%
— %
148
$
123,177
100.0%
148
$
123,177
100.0%
— $
—
The Company updates FICO scores on a semi-annual basis, typically in the second and fourth quarters or as needed in
conjunction with proactive portfolio management.
Interest Only Loans
Interest only loans are primarily SFR mortgage loans with payment features that allow interest only payment in initial periods
before converting to a fully amortizing loan. As of December 31, 2014, our interest only loans increased by $69.3 million, or
49.5 percent, to $209.3 million from $140.0 million at December 31, 2013, primarily due to originations of $69.5 million and
transfers from loans held for sale of $77.1 million, partially offset by transfers to loans held for sale of $25.3 million and net
80
amortization of $51.9 million. As of December 31, 2014 and 2013, $2.0 million and $752 thousand of the interest only loans
were non-performing, respectively.
Loans with the Potential for Negative Amortization
Negative amortization loans decreased by $3.5 million, or 21.2 percent, to $13.1 million as of December 31, 2014 from $16.6
million as of December 31, 2013. The Company discontinued origination of negative amortization loans in 2007. As of
December 31, 2014 and 2013, $0 and $1.2 million of the loans that had the potential for negative amortization were non-
performing, respectively. These loans pose a potentially higher credit risk because of the lack of principal amortization and
potential for negative amortization; however, management believes the risk is mitigated through the loan terms and
underwriting standards, including the Company’s policies on loan-to-value ratios.
Non-Traditional Mortgage Loan Credit Risk Management
The Company performs detailed reviews of collateral values on loans collateralized by residential real property including its
non-traditional mortgage portfolio based on appraisals or estimates from third party automated valuation models (AVMs) to
analyze property value trends on a semi-annual basis or as needed. AVMs are used to identify loans that have experienced
potential collateral deterioration. Once a loan has been identified that may have experienced collateral deterioration, the
Company will obtain updated drive by or full appraisals in order to confirm the valuation. This information is used to update
key monitoring metrics such as LTV. Additionally, FICO scores are obtained bi-annually in conjunction with the collateral
analysis. In addition to LTV and FICO, the Company evaluates the portfolio on a specific loan basis through delinquency and
portfolio charge-offs to determine whether any risk mitigation or portfolio management actions are warranted. The borrowers
may be contacted as necessary to discuss material changes in loan performance or credit metrics.
The Company’s risk management policy and credit monitoring includes reviewing delinquency, FICO scores, and collateral
values on the non-traditional mortgage loan portfolio. We also continuously monitor market conditions for our geographic
lending areas. The Company has determined that the most significant performance indicators for non-traditional mortgages to
be LTV and FICO scores. The loan review provides an effective method of identifying borrowers who may be experiencing
financial difficulty before they fail to make a loan payment. Upon receipt of the updated FICO scores, an exception report is
run to identify loans with a decrease in FICO of 10 percent or more and a resulting FICO of 620 or less. The loans are then
further analyzed to determine if the risk rating should be downgraded that will increase the ALLL the Company will establish
for potential losses. A report of the semi-annual loan reviews is published and regularly monitored.
On the interest only loans, the Company projects future payment changes to determine if there will be an increase in payment
of 3.50 percent or greater and then monitors the loans for possible delinquencies. The individual loans are monitored for
possible downgrading of risk rating, and trends within the portfolio are identified that could affect other interest only loans
scheduled for payment changes in the near future.
As these loans are revolving lines of credit, the Company, based on the loan agreement and loan covenants of the particular
loan, as well as applicable rules and regulations, could suspend the borrowing privileges or reduce the credit limit at any time
the Company reasonably believes that the borrower will be unable to fulfill their repayment obligations under the agreement or
certain other conditions are met. In many cases, the decrease in FICO is the first red flag that the borrower may have difficulty
in making their future payment obligations.
As a result, the Company proactively manages the portfolio by performing a detailed analysis with emphasis on the non-
traditional mortgage portfolio. The Company’s Internal Asset Review Committee (IARC) conducts monthly meetings to review
the loans classified as special mention, substandard, or doubtful and determines whether suspension or reduction in credit limit
is warranted. If the line has been suspended and the borrower would like to have their credit privileges reinstated, they would
need to provide updated financials showing their ability to meet their payment obligations. From the most recent review
completed in the fourth quarter of 2014, the Company did not freeze or reduce any additional commitments.
Consumer and non-traditional mortgage loans may entail greater risk than do traditional SFR mortgage loans, particularly in
the case of consumer loans that are secured by rapidly depreciable assets, such as automobiles and recreational vehicles. In
these cases, any repossessed collateral for a consumer and non-traditional mortgage loan are more dependent on the borrower‘s
continued financial stability and, thus, are more likely to be adversely affected by job loss, divorce, illness, or personal
bankruptcy.
81
Asset Quality
Past Due Loans and Lease
The following table presents a summary of loans and leases, excluding PCI loans, that were past due at least 30 days but less
than 90 days past due as of the dates indicated:
Commercial:
Commercial and industrial
Commercial real estate
Multi-family
SBA
Construction
Lease financing
Consumer:
Single family residential mortgage
Other consumer
Total
2014
2013
2012
2011
2010
December 31,
(In thousands)
$
116
$
287
$
2,237
1,280
82
—
1,091
35,496
392
5,748
602
62
—
363
30,318
319
255
775
—
136
—
118
$
— $
291
—
—
—
—
7,797
27
10,669
4
—
3,901
540
—
—
—
27,070
6
$
40,694
$
37,699
$
9,108
$
10,964
$
31,517
The loans and leases, excluding PCI loans, that were past due at least 30 days but less than 90 days past due increased by $3.0
million to $40.7 million at December 31, 2014 from $37.7 million at December 31, 2013. The increase in SFR mortgage loan
delinquencies in 2014 was due mainly to a delinquency increase in portfolio SFR mortgage loans, partially offset by a
delinquency decrease in seasoned SFR mortgage loan pools. The increase in SFR mortgage loan delinquencies in 2013 was due
mainly to a delinquency increase in seasoned SFR mortgage loan pools from purchased pools in 2013. The total amount that
were past due at least 30 days but less than 90 days past due in seasoned SFR mortgage loan pools was $22.9 million and $28.1
million at December 31, 2014 and 2013, respectively.
The following table presents a summary of NTM loans that were past due at least 30 days but less than 90 days past due as of
the dates indicated:
Green Loans (HELOC) - first liens
Interest only - first liens
Negative amortization
Total NTM - first liens
Green Loans (HELOC) - second liens
Interest only - second liens
Total NTM - second liens
Total NTM loans
December 31,
2014
2013
Count
Amount
Count
Amount
($ in thousands)
2
8
—
10
1
—
1
11
$
8,853
1,580
—
10,433
294
—
294
$
10,727
1
6
1
8
—
—
—
8
$
653
1,723
1,134
3,510
—
—
—
$
3,510
The NTM loans that were past due at least 30 days but less than 90 days past due increased by $7.2 million to $10.7 million at
December 31, 2014 from $3.5 million at December 31, 2013, due mainly to a Green Loan with an outstanding balance of $8.2
million that was delinquent at December 31, 2014.
82
The following table presents a summary of PCI loans that were past due at least 30 days but less than 90 days past due as of the
dates indicated:
Commercial:
Commercial and industrial
Commercial real estate
Multi-family
SBA
Construction
Lease financing
Consumer:
Single family residential mortgage
Other consumer
Total
2014
2013
2012
2011
2010
December 31,
(In thousands)
$
— $
— $
— $
— $
—
—
878
—
—
—
—
46
—
—
16,763
—
30,468
—
1,457
—
380
—
—
2,090
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
$
17,641
$
30,514
$
3,927
$
— $
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
The PCI loans that were past due at least at least 30 days but less than 90 days past due decreased by $12.9 million to $17.6
million at December 31, 2014 from $30.5 million at December 31, 2013. The decrease in SFR mortgage loans was due mainly
to sales of seasoned SFR mortgage loan pools that did not meet the Company's investment standards. During the year ended
December 31, 2014, the Company sold seasoned SFR mortgage loans with an unpaid principal balance of $119.8 million and a
carrying value of $82.6 million, of which an unpaid principal balance and carrying value of $91.9 million and $56.7 million,
respectively, were PCI loans.
Non-Accrual Loans
Non-performing assets consist of (i) loans on non-accrual status which are loans on which the accrual of interest has been
discontinued and include restructured loans when there has not been a history of past performance on debt service in
accordance with the contractual terms of the restructured loans, (ii) loans 90 days or more past due and still accruing interest,
and (iii) other real estate owned, or OREO, which consists of real properties which have been acquired by foreclosure or
similar means and which the Company holds for sale.
Loans are placed on non-accrual status when, in the opinion of the Company’s management, the full timely collection of
principal or interest is in doubt. Generally, the accrual of interest is discontinued when principal or interest payments become
more than 90 days past due, unless the Company believes the loan is adequately collateralized and the loan is in the process of
collection. However, in certain instances, the Company may place a particular loan on non-accrual status earlier, depending
upon the individual circumstances involved in the loan’s delinquency. When a loan is placed on non-accrual status, previously
accrued but unpaid interest is reversed against current income. Subsequent collections of unpaid amounts on such a loan are
applied to reduce principal when received, except when the ultimate collectability of principal is probable, in which case
interest payments are credited to income. Non-accrual loans may be restored to accrual status if and when principal and interest
become current and full repayment is expected. Interest income is recognized on the accrual basis for impaired loans not
meeting the criteria for non-accrual treatment.
83
The following table presents a summary of non-performing assets as of the dates indicated:
Commercial:
Commercial and industrial
Commercial real estate
Multi-family
SBA
Construction
Lease financing
Consumer:
Single family residential mortgage
Other consumer
Total non-accrual loans and leases
Loans past due over 90 days or more and still on
accrual
Other real estate owned
Total non-performing assets
Performing troubled debt restructured loans
2014
2013
December 31,
2012
(In thousands)
2011
2010
$
$
$
7,143
1,017
1,834
285
—
100
27,753
249
38,381
—
423
38,804
6,346
$
$
$
33
3,868
1,972
10
—
—
25,514
251
31,648
—
—
31,648
6,117
$
— $
— $
2,906
5,442
141
—
—
14,503
1
22,993
—
4,527
27,520
6,646
$
$
1,887
3,090
—
—
—
14,272
5
19,254
—
14,692
33,946
5,417
$
$
$
$
—
9,715
8,502
—
—
—
20,611
2
38,830
—
6,562
45,392
17,678
The increase in non-accrual loans and leases in 2014 was mainly due to an increase in total loans and leases. Percentage of total
non-accrual loans and leases to total loans and leases decreased to 0.97 percent at December 31, 2014, compared to 1.29
percent at December 31, 2013.
With respect to loans that were on non-accrual status as of December 31, 2014, the gross interest income that would have been
recorded during 2014 had such loans and leases been current in accordance with their original terms and been outstanding
throughout 2014 (or since origination, if held for part of 2014), was $1.3 million. The amount of interest income on such loans
that was included in net income for 2014 was $445 thousand.
The following table presents a summary of non-accrual NTM loans as of the dates indicated:
Green Loans (HELOC) - first liens
Interest only - first liens
Negative amortization
Total NTM - first liens
Green Loans (HELOC) - second liens
Interest only - second liens
Total NTM - second liens
Total NTM loans
December 31,
2014
2013
Count
Amount
Count
Amount
($ in thousands)
5
7
—
12
1
—
1
13
$
12,334
2,049
—
14,383
209
—
209
$
14,592
4
5
2
11
2
—
2
13
$
$
5,482
752
1,248
7,482
216
—
216
7,698
Non-accrual NTM loans increased by $6.9 million to $14.6 million at December 31, 2014 from $7.7 million at December 31,
2013, due mainly to a Green Loan with an outstanding balance of $8.2 million that became non-accrual during 2014.
84
Troubled Debt Restructured Loans (TDRs)
Loans that the Company modifies or restructures where the debtor is experiencing financial difficulties and makes a concession
to the borrower in the form of changes in the amortization terms, reductions in the interest rates, the acceptance of interest only
payments and, in limited cases, concessions to the outstanding loan balances are classified as troubled debt restructurings
(TDRs). TDRs are loans modified for the purpose of alleviating temporary impairments to the borrower’s financial condition. A
workout plan between a borrower and the Company is designed to provide a bridge for the cash flow shortfalls in the near term.
If the borrower works through the near term issues, in most cases, the original contractual terms of the loan will be reinstated.
As of December 31, 2014, the Company had 18 loans with an aggregate balance of $8.0 million classified as TDRs. When a
loan or lease becomes a TDR the Company ceases accruing interest, and classifies it as non-accrual until the borrower
demonstrates that the loan or lease is again performing.
As of December 31, 2014, of the 18 loans and leases classified as TDRs, 14 loans totaling $6.3 million are making payments
according to their modified terms and are less than 90-days delinquent under the modified terms. Of the aforementioned $6.3
million in TDRs, $6.1 million are SFR mortgage loans and $294 thousand are other consumer loans. There are 2 TDR loans
with an aggregate balance of $492 thousand that are over 90 days delinquent.
The following table presents the composition of TDRs as of the dates indicated:
2014
Traditional
Loans
NTM Loans
December 31,
Total
NTM Loans
(In thousands)
2013
Traditional
Loans
Total
Commercial:
Commercial real estate
$
— $
SBA
Consumer:
Single family residential mortgage
Green Loans (HELOC) - first liens
Green Loans (HELOC) - second liens
—
—
3,442
294
— $
6
— $
6
4,269
—
—
4,269
3,442
294
— $
194
$
—
—
3,468
—
10
3,605
—
—
Total
$
3,736
$
4,275
$
8,011
$
3,468
$
3,809
$
194
10
3,605
3,468
—
7,277
Risk Ratings
Federal regulations provide for the classification of loans and leases and other assets, such as debt and equity securities
considered to be of lesser quality, as substandard, doubtful or loss. An asset is considered substandard if it is inadequately
protected by the current net worth and paying capacity of the obligor or of the collateral pledged, if any. Substandard assets
include those characterized by the distinct possibility that the insured institution will sustain some loss if the deficiencies are
not corrected. Assets classified as doubtful have all of the weaknesses inherent in those classified substandard, with the added
characteristic that the weaknesses present make collection or liquidation in full, on the basis of currently existing facts,
conditions, and values, highly questionable and improbable. Assets classified as loss are those considered uncollectible and of
such little value that their continuance as assets without the establishment of a specific loss reserve or charge-off is not
warranted.
When an insured institution classifies problem assets as either substandard or doubtful, it may establish general allocation
allowances for loan and lease losses in an amount deemed prudent by management and approved by the Board of Directors.
General allocation allowances represent loss allowances which have been established to recognize the inherent risk associated
with lending activities, but, unlike specific allowances, have not been allocated to particular problem assets. When an insured
institution classifies problem assets as loss, it is required either to establish a specific allocation allowance for losses equal to
100 percent of that portion of the asset so classified or to charge off such amount. An institution’s determination as to the
classification of its assets and the amount of its specific allocation allowances is subject to review by the OCC, which may
order the establishment of additional general or specific loss allocation allowances.
In connection with the filing of the Bank’s periodic reports with the OCC and in accordance with policies for our classification
of assets, we regularly review the problem assets in our portfolio to determine whether any assets require classification in
accordance with applicable regulations. On the basis of management’s review of assets, at December 31, 2014, the Company
85
had classified assets (including OREO) totaling $96.1 million, all of which were classified as substandard. The total amount
classified represented 1.61 percent of the Company’s total assets at December 31, 2014.
When accrual of income on a pool of purchased credit impaired loans with common risk characteristics is appropriate in
accordance with ASC 310-30, individual loans in those pools are not risk-rated. The credit criteria evaluated are FICO scores,
loan-to-value, delinquency, and actual cash flows versus expected cash flows of the loan pools.
The following table presents the Company’s risk categories as of December 31, 2014:
Pass
Special
Mention
Substandard
Doubtful
Not-Rate
Total
December 31, 2014
(In thousands)
NTM loans:
Single family residential mortgage
$
219,747
$
Green Loans (HELOC) - first liens
Green Loans (HELOC) - second liens
Other consumer
Total NTM loans
Traditional loans:
Commercial:
Commercial and industrial
Commercial real estate
Multi-family
SBA
Construction
Lease financing
Consumer:
104,640
4,770
113
329,270
477,319
943,645
932,438
32,171
42,198
85,613
Single family residential mortgage
Other consumer
Total traditional loans
569,871
161,701
3,244,956
PCI loans:
Commercial:
Commercial and industrial
Commercial real estate
SBA
Consumer:
Single family residential mortgage
Other consumer
Total PCI loans
Total
104
6,676
677
—
—
279
399
—
—
678
117
14,281
6,684
—
—
36
10,395
85
31,598
—
985
351
—
—
$
2,280
$
— $
— $
222,306
18,138
209
—
20,627
12,330
30,404
16,561
827
—
100
14,834
40
75,096
1,030
3,866
2,129
268
—
7,293
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
123,177
4,979
113
350,575
489,766
988,330
955,683
32,998
42,198
85,749
595,100
161,826
3,351,650
1,134
11,527
3,157
230,811
231,079
—
—
230,811
246,897
7,457
1,336
$ 3,581,683
$
33,612
$
103,016
$
— $
230,811
$ 3,949,122
86
The following table presents the Company’s risk categories as of December 31, 2013:
NTM loans:
Single family residential mortgage
Green Loans (HELOC) - first liens
Green Loans (HELOC) - second liens
Other consumer
Total NTM loans
Traditional loans:
Commercial:
Commercial and industrial
Commercial real estate
Multi-family
SBA
Construction
Lease financing
Consumer:
Single family residential mortgage
Other consumer
Total traditional loans
PCI loans:
Commercial:
Commercial and industrial
Commercial real estate
SBA
Consumer:
Single family residential mortgage
Other consumer
Total PCI loans
Total
Pass
Special
Mention
Substandard
Doubtful
Not-Rate
Total
December 31, 2013
(In thousands)
$
151,728
$
2,321
$
2,441
$
— $
— $
156,490
129,679
11,470
5,073
113
—
—
286,593
13,791
280,527
510,117
139,608
23,714
24,933
31,949
640,701
108,745
1,760,294
—
10,148
844
—
—
1
—
—
—
—
—
6,350
108
6,459
969
—
605
—
—
10,992
1,574
6,556
216
—
9,213
3,215
4,752
1,972
26
—
—
20,475
33
30,473
3,059
4,866
2,239
287
1,736
12,187
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
2
2
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
314,533
—
314,533
147,705
5,289
113
309,597
283,743
514,869
141,580
23,740
24,933
31,949
667,526
108,888
1,797,228
4,028
15,014
3,688
314,820
1,736
339,286
$ 2,057,879
$
21,824
$
51,873
$
2
$
314,533
$ 2,446,111
The increase in special mention and substandard loans was mainly due to those loans acquired in the BPNA Branch
Acquisition.
Allowance for Loan and Lease Losses
The Company maintains an allowance for loan and lease losses (ALLL) to absorb probable incurred losses inherent in the loan
and lease portfolio at the balance sheet date. The ALLL is based on ongoing assessment of the estimated probable losses
presently inherent in the loan portfolio. In evaluating the level of the ALLL, management considers the types of loans and
leases and the amount of loans and leases in the portfolio, peer group information, historical loss experience, adverse situations
that may affect the borrower’s ability to repay, estimated value of any underlying collateral, and prevailing economic
conditions. This methodology takes into account many factors, including the Company’s own historical and peer loss trends,
loan and lease-level credit quality ratings, loan and lease specific attributes along with a review of various credit metrics and
trends. The process involves subjective as well as complex judgments. The Company uses a three year loss experience of the
Company and seven year industry average loss experience in analyzing an appropriate reserve factor for all loans. In addition,
the Company uses adjustments for numerous factors including those found in the Interagency Guidance on ALLL, which
include current economic conditions, loan and lease seasoning, underwriting experience, and collateral value changes among
87
others. The Company evaluates all impaired loans and leases individually using guidance from ASC 310 primarily through the
evaluation of cash flows or collateral values.
The Company acquired the BPNA branches in 2014, PBOC in 2013, and Beach and Gateway in 2012, and their loans and
leases are treated under ASC 805, accounting for acquisitions. The acquired loans and leases include loans and leases that are
accounted for under ASC 310-30, accounting for purchase credit impaired loans and leases. In addition, the Company acquired
three pools of credit impaired re-performing seasoned SFR mortgage loan pools during 2012 and five pools of seasoned SFR
mortgage loan pools, which were partially ASC 310-30 loans, during 2013. The Company may recognize provision for loan
and lease losses in the future should there be further deterioration in these loans after the purchase date should the impairment
exceed the non-accretable yield and purchased discount. On a quarterly basis, the Company re-forecasts its expected cash flows
for the PCI loans relating to the PBOC, Beach and Gateway acquisitions, and the eight loan pools acquired in 2012 and 2013 to
be evaluated for potential impairment. The provision for loans and leases losses on PCI loans reflected a decrease in expected
cash flows on PCI loans compared to those previously estimated. The impairment reserve for PCI loans at December 31, 2014
was $23 thousand.
The ALLL that was collectively evaluated for impairment on originated loans and leases at December 31, 2014 was $25.3
million, which represented 1.34 percent of total originated loans and leases, as compared to $17.1 million, or 1.46 percent, of
total originated loans and leases at December 31, 2013. Including the non-credit impaired loans acquired through acquisitions,
ALLL that was collectively evaluated for impairment was $28.2 million as of December 31, 2014, which represents 0.85
percent of total of such loans and leases, as compared to $18.5 million, or 1.13 percent, or total of such loans and leases at
December 31, 2013. The ALLL that was individually evaluated for impairment was $1.3 million at December 31, 2014
compared to $96 thousand at December 31, 2013. An unallocated ALLL of $0 and $450 thousand was held at December 31,
2014 and 2013, respectively. The ALLL plus market discount for originated and acquired non-credit impaired loans and leases
to the total amount of such loans and leases was 1.38 percent at December 31, 2014 versus 1.63 percent at December 31, 2013.
The Company provided $11.0 million to its provision for loan and lease losses during the year ended December 31, 2014,
related primarily to new commercial and industrial, multifamily, other consumer, lease financing, construction and SFR
mortgage loan production.
The following table presents information regarding activity in the ALLL for the periods indicated:
2014
2013
December 31,
2012
($ in thousands)
2011
2010
Loans past due over 90 days or more still on accrual $
Non-accrual loans and leases
Total non-performing loans and leases
Other real estate owned
Total non-performing loans and leases
Allowance for loan and lease losses (ALLL)
Balance at beginning of year
Charge-offs
Recoveries
Transfer of loans to held-for-sale
Provision for loan and lease losses
Balance at end of year
Non-performing loans and leases to total loans and
leases
Non-performing assets to total assets
Non-performing loans and leases to ALLL
ALLL to non-performing loans and leases
ALLL to total loans and leases
Net charge-offs to total loans and leases
$
$
$
—
38,830
38,830
6,562
45,392
13,079
(7,531)
132
—
8,957
14,637
5.60%
5.27%
265.29%
37.70%
2.11%
1.07%
— $
— $
— $
— $
$
$
$
31,648
31,648
—
31,648
14,448
(3,013)
850
(1,443)
7,963
18,805
1.29%
0.87%
168.30%
59.42%
0.77%
0.09%
$
$
$
22,993
22,993
4,527
27,520
12,780
(4,071)
239
—
5,500
14,448
1.84%
1.64%
159.14%
62.84%
1.16%
0.31%
$
$
$
19,254
19,254
14,692
33,946
14,637
(7,512)
267
—
5,388
12,780
2.44%
3.40%
150.66%
66.38%
1.62%
0.92%
$
$
$
38,381
38,381
423
38,804
18,805
(923)
1,235
(613)
10,976
29,480
0.97 %
0.65 %
130.19 %
76.81 %
0.75 %
(0.01)%
88
The following table presents the ALLL allocation among loans and leases portfolio as of the dates indicated:
2014
2013
December 31,
2012
2011
2010
% of
Loans
to Total
Loans
ALLL
Amount
% of
Loans
to Total
Loans
ALLL
Amount
% of
Loans
to Total
Loans
ALLL
Amount
% of
Loans
to Total
Loans
ALLL
Amount
% of
Loans
to Total
Loans
ALLL
Amount
($ in thousands)
Commercial:
Commercial and industrial $
Commercial real estate
Multi-family
SBA
Construction
Lease financing
Consumer:
Single family residential
mortgage
Other consumer
Unallocated
Total
6,910
3,840
7,179
335
846
873
7,192
2,305
—
12.4 % $
25.3 %
24.2 %
0.9 %
1.1 %
2.2 %
29.7 %
4.2 %
1,822
5,484
2,566
235
244
428
7,044
532
450
11.8 % $
21.7 %
5.8 %
1.1 %
1.0 %
1.3 %
52.6 %
4.7 %
263
3,178
1,478
118
21
261
8,855
274
—
6.4 % $
27.1 %
9.2 %
2.9 %
0.5 %
0.9 %
51.3 %
1.7 %
128
2,234
1,541
—
—
—
8,635
242
—
1.1 % $
16.0 %
11.1 %
— %
— %
— %
69.5 %
2.3 %
50
1,399
2,389
—
—
—
10,191
608
—
1.0 %
8.9 %
4.8 %
— %
— %
— %
82.3 %
3.0 %
$
29,480
100.0% $
18,805
100.0% $
14,448
100.0% $
12,780
100.0% $
14,637
100.0%
89
The following table presents the ALLL allocation among loan and lease origination types as of the dates indicated:
December 31,
2014
2013
2012
2011
2010
($ in thousands)
Loan breakdown by ALLL evaluation type:
Originated loans
Individually evaluated for impairment
$
29,287
$
16,704
$
28,859
$
27,538
$
49,915
Collectively evaluated for impairment
1,892,240
1,168,195
894,952
760,851
642,897
Acquired loans through business acquisitions -
non-impaired
Individually evaluated for impairment
Collectively evaluated for impairment
Seasoned SFR mortgage loan pools - non-
impaired
Acquired with deteriorated credit quality
Total loans
ALLL breakdown:
Originated loans
4,191
1,411,927
364,580
246,897
2,243
469,916
449,767
339,286
4,669
219,771
—
100,220
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
$
3,949,122
$
2,446,111
$
1,248,471
$
788,389
$
692,812
Individually evaluated for impairment
$
1,288
$
96
$
1,187
$
Collectively evaluated for impairment
25,263
17,103
13,208
$
3,714
9,066
4,363
10,274
Acquired loans through business acquisitions -
non-impaired
Individually evaluated for impairment
Collectively evaluated for impairment
Seasoned SFR mortgage loan pools - non-
impaired
Acquired with deteriorated credit quality
Total ALLL
Discount on purchased/acquired Loans:
Acquired loans through business acquisitions -
non-impaired
Seasoned SFR mortgage loan pools - non-
impaired
Acquired with deteriorated credit quality
$
$
—
2,906
—
23
29,480
16,441
29,955
55,865
$
$
—
1,410
—
196
18,805
8,354
38,240
105,650
$
$
Total discount
$
102,261
$
152,244
$
Ratios:
To originated loans and leases:
Individually evaluated for impairment
Collectively evaluated for impairment
Total ALLL
To originated and acquired non-impaired
loans:
Individually evaluated for impairment
Collectively evaluated for impairment
Total ALLL
Total ALLL and discount (1)
To total loans and leases:
Individually evaluated for impairment
Collectively evaluated for impairment
Total ALLL
Total ALLL and discount (1)
4.40%
1.34%
1.38%
3.85%
0.85%
0.88%
1.38%
3.85%
0.77%
0.75%
3.34%
0.57%
1.46%
1.45%
0.51%
1.13%
1.12%
1.63%
0.51%
0.89%
0.77%
6.99%
53
—
—
—
14,448
3,019
—
51,572
54,591
$
$
$
4.11%
1.48%
1.56%
3.70%
1.18%
1.26%
1.52%
3.70%
1.18%
1.16%
5.53%
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
12,780
$
14,637
— $
—
—
— $
13.49%
1.19%
1.62%
13.49%
1.19%
1.62%
1.62%
13.49%
1.19%
1.62%
1.62%
—
—
—
—
8.74%
1.60%
2.11%
8.74%
1.60%
2.11%
2.11%
8.74%
1.60%
2.11%
2.11%
(1) The ratios were calculated by dividing the sum of ALLL and discounts by carrying value of loans.
90
Servicing Rights
Total mortgage and SBA servicing rights were $19.6 million and $13.9 million at December 31, 2014 and 2013, respectively.
The fair value of the mortgage servicing rights (MSRs) amounted to $19.1 million and $13.5 million and the amortized cost of
the SBA servicing rights was $484 thousand and $348 thousand at December 31, 2014 and 2013, respectively. The Company
retains servicing rights from certain of its sales of SFR mortgage loans and SBA loans. The principal balance of the loans
underlying our total MSRs and SBA servicing rights was $1.92 billion and $22.2 million, respectively, at December 31, 2014
and $1.37 billion and $20.0 million, respectively, at December 31, 2013. The recorded amount of the MSR and SBA servicing
rights as a percentage of the unpaid principal balance of the loans we are servicing was 0.99 percent and 2.18 percent,
respectively, at December 31, 2014 as compared to 1.00 percent and 1.74 percent, respectively, at December 31, 2013.
Other Real Estate Owned
Other real estate owned (OREO) totaled $423 thousand at December 31, 2014 compared to $0 at December 31, 2013. The
increase in OREO relates to new foreclosures of $653 thousand, partially offset by OREO property sales of $198 thousand and
a $32 thousand increase in the OREO valuation allowance.
Premises and equipment, net
Premises and equipment, net of accumulated depreciation, increased $12.4 million to $78.7 million at December 31, 2014 from
$66.3 million at December 31, 2013. The increase was primarily due to $8.8 million of premises and equipment acquired as
part of the BPNA Branch Acquisition. The Company recognized depreciation expense of $6.8 million, $4.3 million and $1.7
million for years ended December 31, 2014, 2013, and 2012, respectively.
Goodwill and other intangible assets
The Company had goodwill of $31.6 million and $30.1 million at December 31, 2014 and 2013, respectively, The increase in
goodwill relates to the RenovationReady acquisition, and represents the excess of consideration paid over the fair value of the
net assets acquired at the acquisition date, as discussed in Note 2 of the Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements in Item 8.
The Company tests its goodwill for impairment annually as of August 31 (the Measurement Date). At the Measurement Date,
the Company, in accordance with ASC 350-20-35-3, evaluated, based on the weight of evidence, the significance of all
qualitative factors to determine whether it is more likely than not that the fair value of the reporting unit is less than its carrying
amount. The assessment of qualitative factors at the Measurement Date indicated that it is not more likely than not that
impairment exists, as a result no futher testing was performed.
The Company had core deposit intangibles of $23.9 million, customer relationship intangibles of $547 thousand, and trade
name intangibles of $780 thousand at December 31, 2014. Core deposit intangibles are amortized over their useful lives
ranging from 4 to 10 years. As of December 31, 2014, the weighted average remaining amortization period for core deposit
intangibles was approximately 8.2 years. Customer relationship intangible, related to the RenovationReady acquisition, is
amortized over its useful life of 5.0 years. As of December 31, 2014, the remaining amortization period for customer
relationship intangible was approximately 4.1 years. Trade name intangibles, related to the RenovationReady and CS Financial
acquisitions, have indefinite useful lives.
During the year ended December 31, 2014, the Company wrote off $48 thousand of core deposit intangibles related to the
Beach acquisition due to lower remaining deposit balances than forecast. During the year ended December 31, 2013, the
Company wrote off all remaining trade name intangible assets of Beach, Gateway and PBOC totaling $976 thousand due to the
merger of the Company’s two banking subsidiaries into a single bank and a portion of core deposit intangibles related to the
Gateway acquisition of $85 thousand due to lower remaining deposit balances than forecast.
91
Deposits
Total deposits increased by $1.75 billion, or 60.1 percent, to $4.67 billion at December 31, 2014 from $2.92 billion at
December 31, 2013. The increase is mainly due to $1.08 billion in deposits assumed in the BPNA Branch Acquisition and a
$277.4 million increase in deposits generated through strategic plans aiming to increase core deposits by launching interest-
bearing core deposit products with enhanced features to attract high net worth depositors in the Company’s target markets while
reducing the reliance on certificates of deposit.
As of December 31, 2014, the Bank had brokered deposits of $763.0 million, which represented 12.8 percent of total assets.
The Bank has an asset/liability management policy that limits brokered deposit balances to no more than 45 percent of total
assets, with an operating target of less than 20 percent of total assets. The following table presents the composition of deposits
as of December 31, 2014 and 2013:
December 31,
Change
2014
2013
Amount
Percentage
Noninterest-bearing deposits
Interest-bearing demand deposits
Money market accounts
Savings accounts
Certificates of deposit under $100,000
Certificates of deposit of $100,000 or more
$
662,295
$
429,158
$
(In thousands)
1,054,828
1,074,432
985,646
449,580
445,050
539,098
518,696
963,536
27,921
440,235
233,137
515,730
555,736
22,110
421,659
4,815
Total deposits
$
4,671,831
$
2,918,644
$
1,753,187
The following table presents the scheduled maturities of certificates of deposit as of December 31, 2014:
54.3 %
95.7 %
107.1 %
2.3 %
1,510.2 %
1.1 %
60.1%
Three Months
or Less
Over Three
Months
Through
Six Months
Over Six
Months
Through
Twelve
Months
(In thousands)
Over
One Year
Total
Certificates of deposit under $100,000
Certificates of deposit of $100,000 or more
Total certificates of deposit
$
$
270,896
113,325
384,221
$
$
85,446
64,933
150,379
$
$
37,361
70,433
107,794
$
$
55,877
196,359
252,236
$
$
449,580
445,050
894,630
92
Federal Home Loan Bank Advances
FHLB advances were $633.0 million at December 31, 2014 as compared to $250.0 million at December 31, 2013. The $383.0
million increase was used as a source of funding for the origination of loans for sale in the secondary market and for providing
duration specific short-term and medium-term financing. The outstanding balance of FHLB advances fluctuates from time to
time depending on our current inventory of mortgage loans held-for-sale and the availability of lower cost funding. At
December 31, 2014, $400.0 million of the Bank’s advances from the FHLB were fixed and had interest rates ranging from 0.19
percent to 0.82 percent with a weighted average rate of 0.31 percent. At December 31, 2014, $233.0 million of the Bank’s
advances from the FHLB were variable and had a weighted average interest rate of 0.27 percent. At December 31, 2013, $25.0
million of the Bank’s advances from the FHLB were fixed-rate and had interest rates ranging from 0.59 percent to 0.82 percent
with a weighted average rate of 0.73 percent and $225.0 million of Bank’s advances from the FHLB advances were variable-
rate and had a weighted average interest rate of 0.06 percent. The contractual maturities by year of the Bank’s advances were as
follows at December 31, 2014:
2015
2016
2017
2018
(In thousands)
2019 and
After
Total
Fixed rate
Variable rate
Total FHLB advances
$
$
400,000
233,000
633,000
$
$
— $
—
— $
— $
—
— $
— $
—
— $
— $
400,000
—
233,000
— $
633,000
Each advance is payable at its maturity date. Advances paid early are subject to a prepayment penalty. At December 31, 2014
and 2013, the Bank’s advances from the FHLB were collateralized by certain real estate loans of an aggregate unpaid principal
balance of $1.84 billion and $740.1 million, respectively, and the Bank’s investment of capital stock of the FHLB of San
Francisco totaled $29.8 million and $14.4 million, respectively. Based on this collateral and the Bank’s holding of FHLB stock,
the Bank was eligible to borrow and additional $501.3 million at December 31, 2014. In addition, the Bank had available lines
of credit with the Federal Reserve Bank totaling $102.3 million at December 31, 2014.
The following table presents financial data of FHLB advances:
Weighted-average interest rate at end of year
Average interest rate during the year
Average balance
Maximum amount outstanding at any month-end
Balance at end of the year
Year Ended December 31,
2014
2013
2012
($ in thousands)
0.29%
0.20%
267,816
633,000
633,000
$
$
$
0.13%
0.36%
74,712
250,000
250,000
$
$
$
$
$
$
0.44%
0.64%
54,030
100,000
75,000
93
Long Term Debt
Senior Notes
On April 23, 2012, the Company completed the public offering of $33.0 million aggregate principal amount of its 7.50 percent
Senior Notes due April 15, 2020 (the Senior Notes) at a price to the public of $25.00 per Senior Note. Net proceeds after
discounts were approximately $31.7 million. The Senior Notes were issued under the Senior Debt Securities Indenture, dated as
of April 23, 2012 (the Base Indenture), as supplemented by the First Supplemental Indenture, dated as of April 23, 2012 (the
Supplemental Indenture, and together with the Base Indenture, the Indenture), between the Company and U.S. Bank National
Association, as trustee.
On December 6, 2012, the Company completed the issuance and sale of an additional $45.0 million aggregate principal amount
of the Senior Notes at a price to the public of $25.00 per Senior Note, plus accrued interest from October 15, 2012. Net
proceeds after discounts, including a full exercise of the $6.8 million underwriters’ overallotment option on December 7, 2012,
were approximately $50.1 million.
The Senior Notes are the Company’s senior unsecured debt obligations and rank equally with all of the Company’s other
present and future unsecured unsubordinated obligations. The Senior Notes bear interest at a per-annum rate of 7.50 percent.
The Company makes interest payments on the Notes quarterly in arrears.
The Senior Notes will mature on April 15, 2020. However, the Company may, at the Company’s option, on April 15, 2015, or
on any scheduled interest payment date thereafter, redeem the Senior Notes in whole or in part on not less than 30 nor more
than 60 days’ prior notice. The Senior Notes will be redeemable at a redemption price equal to 100 percent of the principal
amount of the Senior Notes to be redeemed plus accrued and unpaid interest to the date of redemption.
The Indenture contains several covenants which, among other things, restrict the Company’s ability and the ability of the
Company’s subsidiaries to dispose of or incur liens on the voting stock of certain subsidiaries and also contains customary
events of default.
Tangible Equity Units – Amortizing Notes
On May 21, 2014, the Company issued $69,000,000 8.00% tangible equity units (TEUs) in an underwritten public offering. A
total of 1,380,000 TEUs were issued, including 180,000 issued to the underwriter upon exercise of its overallotment option,
with each TEU having a stated amount of $50.00. Each TEU is comprised of (i) a prepaid stock purchase contract (each a
Purchase Contract) that will be settled by delivery of a specific number of shares of Company Common Stock and (ii) a junior
subordinated amortizing note due May 15, 2017 (each an Amortizing Note) that has an initial principal amount of $10.604556
per Amortizing Note, bears interest at a rate of 7.50% per annum and has a scheduled final installment payment date of May 15,
2017. The Company has the right to defer installment payments on the Amortizing Notes at any time and from time to time,
subject to certain restrictions, so long as the deferral period does not extend beyond May 15, 2019.
The Purchase Contracts and Amortizing Notes are accounted for separately. The Purchase Contract component of the TEUs is
recorded in Additional Paid in Capital on the Consolidated Statements of Financial Condition. The Amortizing Note is recorded
in Notes Payable on the Consolidated Statements of Financial Condition. The relative fair values of the Amortizing Notes and
Purchase Contracts were estimated to be approximately $14,634,000 and $54,366,000, respectively. Total issuance costs
associated with the TEUs were $4,041,000 (including the underwriter discount of $3,278,000), of which $857,000 was
allocated to the liability component and $3,184,000 was allocated to the equity component of the TEUs. The portion of the
issuance costs allocated to the debt component of the TEUs is being amortized over the term of the amortizing note. Net
proceeds of $64,959,000 from the issuance of the TEUs were designated to partially finance the Company’s previously
announced acquisition of 20 California branches from BPNA and for general corporate purposes. Additional information
regarding the TEUs is provided under the heading “Tangible Equity Units” in Note 18 of the Notes to Consolidated Financial
Statements in Item 8.
Reserve for Unfunded Loan Commitments
The Company maintains a reserve for unfunded loan commitments at a level that is considered adequate to cover the estimated
and known inherent risks. The probability of usage of the unfunded loan commitments and credit risk factors determined based
on outstanding loan balance of same customer or outstanding loans that shares similar credit risk exposure are used to
determine the adequacy of the reserve. As of December 31, 2014 and 2013, the reserve for unfunded loan commitments was
$1.9 million and $1.4 million, respectively.
94
Reserve for Loss on Repurchased Loans
Reserve for loss reimbursements on sold loans was $8.3 million and $5.4 million at December 31, 2014 and 2013, respectively.
This reserve relates to our SFR mortgage business. We sell most of the residential mortgage loans that we originate into the
secondary mortgage market. When we sell mortgage loans, we make customary representations and warranties to the
purchasers about various characteristics of each loan, such as the manner of origination, the nature and extent of underwriting
standards applied and the types of documentation being provided. Typically, these representations and warranties are in place
for the life of the loan. If a defect in the origination process is identified, we may be required to either repurchase the loan or
indemnify the purchaser for losses it sustains on the loan. If there are no such defects, generally we have no liability to the
purchaser for losses it may incur on such loan. We maintain a reserve for loss reimbursements on sold loans to account for the
expected losses related to loans we might be required to repurchase (or the indemnity payments we may have to make to
purchasers). The reserve takes into account both our estimate of expected losses on loans sold during the current accounting
period, as well as adjustments to our previous estimates of expected losses on loans sold. In each case, these estimates are
based on the most recent data available to us, including data from third parties, regarding demands for loan repurchases, actual
loan repurchases, and actual credit losses on repurchased loans, among other factors. Provisions added to the reserve for loss
reimbursements on sold loans are recorded in Provision for Loan Repurchases on the Consolidated Statements of Operations.
The following table presents a summary of activity in the reserve for loss reimbursements on sold loans for the periods
indicated:
Balance at beginning of year
Acquired in business combination
Provision for loan repurchases
Payments made for loss reimbursement on sold loans
Balance at end of year
Stockholders’ Equity
Year Ended December 31,
2014
2013
2012
(In thousands)
5,427
$
3,485
$
—
4,243
(1,367)
314
2,383
(755)
8,303
$
5,427
$
$
$
—
3,254
256
(25)
3,485
Total stockholders’ equity increased by $178.7 million, or 55.0 percent to $503.6 million at December 31, 2014 from $324.9
million at December 31, 2013. The increase was due mainly to the issuance of common stock of $104.7 million, the issuance of
purchase contracts, as part of the TEUs, of $51.2 million, and net income of $30.3 million, partially offset by cash dividends for
common stock of $12.4 million and cash dividends for preferred stock of $3.6 million. For additional information, see Note 18
of the Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements in Item 8.
95
Liquidity
The Bank is required to have enough liquid assets in order to maintain sufficient liquidity to ensure a safe and sound operation.
Liquidity may increase or decrease depending upon availability of funds and comparative yields on investments in relation to
the return on loans. Historically, the Bank has maintained liquid assets above levels believed to be adequate to meet the
requirements of normal operations, including potential deposit outflows. Cash flow projections are regularly reviewed and
updated to ensure that adequate liquidity is maintained.
The Bank’s liquidity, represented by cash and cash equivalents and securities available for sale, is a product of its operating,
investing, and financing activities. The Bank’s primary sources of funds are deposits, payments and maturities of outstanding
loans and investment securities; and other short-term investments and funds provided from operations. While scheduled
payments from the amortization of loans and mortgage-backed securities and maturing securities and short-term investments
are relatively predictable sources of funds, deposit flows and loan prepayments are greatly influenced by general interest rates,
economic conditions, and competition. In addition, the Bank invests excess funds in short-term interest-earning assets, which
provide liquidity to meet lending requirements. The Bank also generates cash through borrowings. The Bank utilizes FHLB
advances to leverage its capital base, to provide funds for its lending activities, as a source of liquidity, and to enhance its
interest rate risk management. The Bank also has the ability to obtain brokered certificates of deposit. Liquidity management is
both a daily and long-term function of business management. Any excess liquidity would be invested in federal funds or
authorized investments such as mortgage-backed or U.S. agency securities. On a longer-term basis, the Bank maintains a
strategy of investing in various lending products. The Bank uses its sources of funds primarily to meet its ongoing
commitments, to pay maturing certificates of deposit and savings withdrawals, to fund loan commitments, and to maintain its
portfolio of mortgage-backed securities and investment securities.
At December 31, 2014, there were $170.3 million of approved loan origination commitments, $316.3 million of unused lines of
credit and $11.2 million of outstanding letters of credit. Certificates of deposit maturing in the next twelve months totaled
$642.4 million and $633.0 million of FHLB advances had maturities of less than twelve months at December 31, 2014.
Based on the competitive deposit rates offered and on historical experience, management believes that a significant portion of
maturing deposits will remain with the Bank, although no assurance can be given in this regard. At December 31, 2014, the
Company maintained $231.2 million of cash and cash equivalents that was 3.9 percent to total assets. In addition, the Bank had
the ability at December 31, 2014 to borrow an additional $501.3 million from the FHLB and $102.3 million from the Federal
Reserve Bank.
Commitments
The following table presents information as of December 31, 2014 regarding the Company’s commitments and contractual
obligations:
Commitments and Contractual Obligations
Total
Amount
Committed
Less Than
One Year
More Than
One Year
Through
Three Years
(In thousands)
More Than
Three Year
Through
Five Years
Over Five
Years
Commitments to extend credit
Unused lines of credit
Standby letters of credit
Total commitments
FHLB advances
Long-term debt
Operating and capital lease obligations
Certificates of deposit
$
$
$
170,335
$
125,387
$
21,656
$
8,935
$
$
$
316,257
11,236
497,828
633,000
134,853
48,376
894,630
$
$
175,587
8,133
309,107
633,000
14,544
13,744
642,394
14,357
78,286
853
23,473
1,500
38,911
750
46,629
$
48,596
$
93,496
— $
— $
20,993
19,080
198,905
12,713
8,491
52,580
—
86,603
7,061
751
Total contractual obligations
$
1,710,859
$
1,303,682
$
238,978
$
73,784
$
94,415
96
Regulatory Capital
The regulations of the FRB in effect through December 31, 2014 required bank holding companies such as the Company to
maintain a minimum ratio of qualifying total capital to risk-weighted assets of 8.0 percent and a minimum ratio of Tier 1 capital
to risk-weighted assets of 4.0 percent. In addition to the risk-based guidelines, through December 31, 2014 the regulations of
the FRB required bank holding companies to maintain a minimum ratio of Tier 1 capital to average total assets, referred to as
the leverage ratio, of 4.0 percent. Through December 31, 2014, in order to be considered “well capitalized,” federal bank
regulatory agencies required depository institutions such as the Bank to maintain a minimum ratio of qualifying total capital to
risk-weighted assets of 10.0 percent, a minimum ratio of Tier 1 capital to risk-weighted assets of 6.0 percent and a minimum
ratio of Tier 1 capital to average total assets, referred to as the leverage ratio, of 5.0 percent.
The following table presents the capital amounts and ratios for the Company and the Bank as of dates indicated:
Amount
Ratio
Minimum
Capital
Requirement
Ratio
($ in thousands)
Minimum
Required
to Be Well
Capitalized
Under
Prompt
Corrective
Action
Provisions
Ratio
$
$
$
$
473,656
442,307
442,307
503,727
472,378
472,378
307,457
281,786
281,786
360,634
334,963
334,963
11.28% $
10.54%
8.57%
12.04% $
11.29%
9.17%
335,829
167,914
206,502
334,834
167,417
206,095
8.00%
4.00%
4.00%
N/A
N/A
N/A
8.00% $
4.00%
4.00%
418,543
251,126
257,619
12.45% $
197,503
11.41%
8.02%
98,752
140,463
8.00%
4.00%
4.00%
14.65% $
196,998
8.00% $
13.60%
9.58%
98,499
139,874
4.00%
4.00%
N/A
N/A
N/A
246,247
147,748
174,842
N/A
N/A
N/A
10.00%
6.00%
5.00%
N/A
N/A
N/A
10.00%
6.00%
5.00%
December 31, 2014
Banc of California, Inc.
Total risk-based capital ratio
Tier 1 risk-based capital ratio
Tier 1 leverage ratio
Banc of California, NA
Total risk-based capital ratio
Tier 1 risk-based capital ratio
Tier 1 leverage ratio
December 31, 2013
Banc of California, Inc.
Total risk-based capital ratio
Tier 1 risk-based capital ratio
Tier 1 leverage ratio
Banc of California, NA
Total risk-based capital ratio
Tier 1 risk-based capital ratio
Tier 1 leverage ratio
Effective January 1, 2015 (with some changes transitioned into full effectiveness over two to four years), the Company and the
Bank became subject to new capital regulations adopted by the FRB and the OCC. See “Regulation and Supervision - New
Capital Rules” in Item 1.
Recent Accounting Pronouncements
Please see Note 1 of the Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements in Item 8.
97
Item 7A. Quantitative and Qualitative Disclosures About Market Risk
Our Risk When Interest Rates Change. The rates of interest we earn on assets and pay on liabilities generally are established
contractually for a period of time. Market interest rates change over time. Accordingly, our results of operations, like those of
other financial institutions, are impacted by changes in interest rates and the interest rate sensitivity of our assets and liabilities.
The risk associated with changes in interest rates and our ability to adapt to these changes is known as interest rate risk and is
our most significant market risk.
How We Measure Our Risk of Interest Rate Changes. As part of our attempt to manage our exposure to changes in interest
rates and comply with applicable regulations, we monitor our interest rate risk. In monitoring interest rate risk we continually
analyze and manage assets and liabilities based on their payment streams and interest rates, the timing of their maturities and/or
prepayments, and their sensitivity to actual or potential changes in market interest rates.
In order to manage the potential for adverse effects of material and prolonged increases in interest rates on our results of
operations, we adopted asset and liability management policies to better align the maturities and repricing terms of our interest-
earning assets and interest-bearing liabilities. These policies are implemented by the asset and liability management committee.
The asset and liability management committee is chaired by the treasurer and is comprised of members of our senior
management. An asset and liability management policy establishes guidelines for the volume and mix of assets and funding
sources taking into account relative costs and spreads, interest rate sensitivity and liquidity needs, while the asset liability
management committee monitors adherence to these guidelines. The objectives are to manage assets and funding sources to
produce results that are consistent with liquidity, capital adequacy, growth, risk, and profitability goals. The asset and liability
management committee meets periodically to review, among other things, economic conditions and interest rate outlook,
current and projected liquidity needs and capital position, anticipated changes in the volume and mix of assets and liabilities
and interest rate risk exposure limits versus current projections pursuant to our net present value of equity analysis. At each
meeting, the asset and liability management committee recommends appropriate strategy changes based on this review. The
treasurer or his designee is responsible for reviewing and reporting on the effects of the policy implementations and strategies
to the board of directors on a regular basis.
In order to manage our assets and liabilities and achieve the desired liquidity, credit quality, interest rate risk, profitability and
capital targets, we have focused our strategies on:
• Originating and purchasing adjustable-rate mortgage loans,
• Originating shorter-term consumer loans,
• Acquiring short duration securities for the investment portfolio,
• Managing our deposits to establish stable deposit relationships,
• Using FHLB advances and/or certain derivatives such as swaps to align maturities and repricing terms, and
• Attempting to limit the percentage of fixed-rate loans in our portfolio.
At times, depending on the level of general interest rates, the relationship between long- and short-term interest rates, market
conditions and competitive factors, the asset and liability management committee may determine to increase the Company’s
interest rate risk position within the asset liability tolerance set by the Bank’s policies.
As part of its procedures, the asset and liability management committee regularly reviews interest rate risk by forecasting the
impact of alternative interest rate environments on net interest income and market value of portfolio equity, which is defined as
the net present value of an institution’s existing assets, liabilities and off-balance sheet instruments, and evaluating such
impacts against the maximum potential changes in net interest income and market value of portfolio equity that are authorized
by the Board of Directors of the Company.
98
Interest Rate Sensitivity of Economic Value of Equity and Net Interest Income
The following table presents the projected change in the Bank’s net portfolio value at December 31, 2014 that would occur
upon an immediate change in interest rates based on independent analysis, but without giving effect to any steps that
management might take to counteract that change:
Change in
Interest Rates in
Basis Points (bp) (1)
+100 bp
0 bp
-100 bp
December 31, 2014
Economic Value of Equity
Net Interest Income
Amount
Amount
Change
Percentage
Change
Amount
Amount
Change
Percentage
Change
($ in thousands)
$
681,021
$
(32,267)
(4.5)% $
198,432
$
(3,353)
(1.7)%
713,288
726,223
12,935
1.8 %
201,785
200,835
(950)
(0.5)%
(1) Assumes an instantaneous uniform change in interest rates at all maturities
As with any method of measuring interest rate risk, certain shortcomings are inherent in the method of analysis presented in the
foregoing table. For example, although certain assets and liabilities may have similar maturities or periods to repricing, they
may react in different degrees to changes in market interest rates. Also, the interest rates on certain types of assets and liabilities
may fluctuate in advance of changes in market interest rates, while interest rates on other types may lag behind changes in
market rates. Additionally, certain assets, such as adjustable rate mortgage loans, have features which restrict changes in
interest rates on a short-term basis and over the life of the asset. Further, if interest rates change, expected rates of prepayments
on loans and early withdrawals from certificates of deposit could deviate significantly from those assumed in calculating the
table.
The Company does not maintain any securities for trading purposes. The Company does not currently engage in trading
activities. The Company does use derivative instruments to hedge its mortgage banking risks. In addition, interest rate risk is
the most significant market risk affecting the Company. Other types of market risk, such as foreign currency exchange risk and
commodity price risk, do not arise in the normal course of the Company’s business activities and operations.
99
Item 8. Financial Statements and Supplementary Data
BANC OF CALIFORNIA, INC.
CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
December 31, 2014, 2013, and 2012
Contents
MANAGEMENT’S REPORT ON INTERNAL CONTROL OVER FINANCIAL REPORTING
REPORTS OF INDEPENDENT REGISTERED PUBLIC ACCOUNTING FIRM
CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF FINANCIAL CONDITION
CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF OPERATIONS
CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF COMPREHENSIVE INCOME (LOSS)
CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF STOCKHOLDERS’ EQUITY
CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF CASH FLOWS
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
101
102
103
105
106
107
109
111
100
MANAGEMENT’S REPORT ON INTERNAL CONTROL OVER FINANCIAL REPOPRTING
The management of Banc of California, Inc. (the Company) is responsible for establishing and maintaining adequate internal
control over financial reporting, as such term is defined in Exchange Act Rule 13a-15(f). The Company’s internal control over
financial reporting is a process designed to provide reasonable assurance regarding the reliability of financial reporting and the
preparation of the financial statements for external purposes in accordance with accounting principles generally accepted in the
United States of America. The Company’s internal control over financial reporting includes those policies and procedures that
(i) pertain to the maintenance of records that, in reasonable detail, accurately and fairly reflect the transactions and dispositions
of the assets of the Company; (ii) provide reasonable assurance that transactions are recorded as necessary to permit
preparation of financial statements in accordance with accounting principles generally accepted in the United States of
America, and that receipts and expenditures of the Company are being made only in accordance with authorizations of
management and directors of the Company; and (iii) provide reasonable assurance regarding prevention or timely detection of
unauthorized acquisition, use, or disposition of the Company’s assets that could have a material effect on the financial
statements.
Because of its inherent limitations, internal control over financial reporting may not prevent or detect misstatements. All
internal control systems, no matter how well designed, have inherent limitations, including the possibility of human error and
the circumvention of overriding controls. Accordingly, even effective internal control over financial reporting can only provide
reasonable assurance with respect to financial statement preparation. Also, projections of any evaluation of effectiveness to
future periods are subject to the risk that controls may become inadequate because of changes in conditions, or that degree of
compliance with the policies or procedures may deteriorate.
Management has assessed the effectiveness of the Company’s internal control over financial reporting as of December 31,
2014, based on the framework set forth by the Committee of Sponsoring Organizations of the Treadway Commission (COSO)
in Internal Control—Integrated Framework (1992). Based on that assessment, management concluded that, as of December 31,
2014, the Company’s internal control over financial reporting was effective based on the criteria established in Internal Control
—Integrated Framework (1992).
The effectiveness of the Company’s internal control over financial reporting as of December 31, 2014, has been audited by
KPMG LLP, an independent registered public accounting firm.
/s/ Steven A. Sugarman
Steven A. Sugarman
Chairman, President and
Chief Executive Officer
/s/ Ronald J. Nicolas, Jr.
Ronald J. Nicolas, Jr.
Executive Vice President and
Chief Financial Officer
101
REPORT OF INDEPENDENT REGISTERED PUBLIC ACCOUNTING FIRM
The Board of Directors and Stockholders
Banc of California, Inc.:
We have audited the accompanying consolidated statements of financial condition of Banc of California, Inc. and subsidiaries (the
Company) as of December 31, 2014 and 2013, and the related consolidated statements of operations, comprehensive income (loss),
stockholders’ equity, and cash flows for each of the years in the three-year period ended December 31, 2014. These consolidated
financial statements are the responsibility of the Company’s management. Our responsibility is to express an opinion on these
consolidated financial statements based on our audits.
We conducted our audits in accordance with the standards of the Public Company Accounting Oversight Board (United States).
Those standards require that we plan and perform the audit to obtain reasonable assurance about whether the financial statements
are free of material misstatement. An audit includes examining, on a test basis, evidence supporting the amounts and disclosures
in the financial statements. An audit also includes assessing the accounting principles used and significant estimates made by
management, as well as evaluating the overall financial statement presentation. We believe that our audits provide a reasonable
basis for our opinion.
In our opinion, the consolidated financial statements referred to above present fairly, in all material respects, the financial position
of Banc of California, Inc. and subsidiaries as of December 31, 2014 and 2013, and the results of their operations and their cash
flows for each of the years in the three-year period ended December 31, 2014, in conformity with U.S. generally accepted accounting
principles.
We also have audited, in accordance with the standards of the Public Company Accounting Oversight Board (United States),
Banc of California, Inc.’s internal control over financial reporting as of December 31, 2014, based on criteria established in
Internal Control - Integrated Framework (1992) issued by the Committee of Sponsoring Organizations of the Treadway
Commission (COSO), and our report dated March 16, 2015, expressed an unqualified opinion on the effectiveness of the
Company’s internal control over financial reporting.
Irvine, California
March 16, 2015
/s/ KPMG LLP
KPMG LLP
102
ITEM 1 – FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
BANC OF CALIFORNIA, INC.
CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF FINANCIAL CONDITION
(Amounts in thousands, except share and per share data)
ASSETS
Cash and due from banks
Interest-bearing deposits
Total cash and cash equivalents
Time deposits in financial institutions
Securities available for sale, carried at fair value
Loans held for sale, carried at fair value
Loans held for sale, carried at lower of cost or fair value
Loans and leases receivable, net of allowance of $29,480 and $18,805 at December 31, 2014 and
2013, respectively
Federal Home Loan Bank and other bank stock, at cost
Servicing rights, net ($13,135 and $13,535 measured at fair value at December 31, 2014 and 2013,
respectively)
Servicing rights held for sale, carried at fair value
Accrued interest receivable
Other real estate owned, net
Premises, equipment, and capital leases, net
Bank-owned life insurance
Goodwill
Affordable housing fund investment
Deferred income tax
Income tax receivable
Other intangible assets, net
Other assets
Total Assets
LIABILITIES AND STOCKHOLDERS’ EQUITY
Noninterest-bearing deposits
Interest-bearing deposits
Total deposits
Advances from Federal Home Loan Bank
Notes payable, net
Reserve for loss on repurchased loans
Income taxes payable
Accrued expenses and other liabilities
Total liabilities
Commitments and contingent liabilities
Preferred stock, $0.01 par value per share, 50,000,000 shares authorized:
Series A, non-cumulative perpetual preferred stock, $1,000 per share liquidation preference,
32,000 shares authorized, 32,000 shares issued and outstanding at December 31, 2014
and 2013
Series B, non-cumulative perpetual preferred stock, $1,000 per share liquidation preference,
10,000 shares authorized, 10,000 shares issued and outstanding at December 31,2014 and
2013
Series C, 8.00% non-cumulative perpetual preferred stock, $1,000 per share liquidation
preference, 40,250 shares authorized, 40,250 shares issued and outstanding at December
31, 2014 and 2013
103
As of December 31,
2014
2013
$
14,364
$
216,835
231,199
1,900
345,695
278,749
908,341
4,937
105,181
110,118
1,846
170,022
192,613
524,120
3,919,642
42,241
2,427,306
22,600
13,619
5,947
15,113
423
78,685
19,095
31,591
4,939
16,445
—
25,252
32,695
$
$
$
$
5,971,571
662,295
4,009,536
4,671,831
633,000
93,569
8,303
56
61,223
13,883
—
10,866
—
66,260
18,881
30,143
5,628
—
2,995
12,152
18,590
3,628,023
429,158
2,489,486
2,918,644
250,000
82,320
5,427
—
46,763
5,467,982
3,303,154
31,934
31,934
10,000
10,000
37,943
37,943
Common stock, $0.01 par value per share, 446,863,844 shares authorized; 35,829,763 shares issued
and 34,190,740 shares outstanding at December 31, 2014; 20,959,286 shares issued and
19,561,469 shares outstanding at December 31, 2013
Class B non-voting non-convertible Common stock, $0.01 par value per share, 3,136,156 shares
authorized; 609,195 shares issued and outstanding at December 31, 2014 and 584,674 shares
issued and outstanding at December 31, 2013
Additional paid-in capital
Retained earnings
Treasury stock, at cost (1,639,023 shares and 1,397,817 shares at December 31, 2014 and 2013,
respectively)
Accumulated other comprehensive income (loss), net
Total stockholders’ equity
Total liabilities and stockholders’ equity
358
210
6
422,910
29,863
(29,798)
373
503,589
6
256,306
16,981
(27,911)
(600)
324,869
$
5,971,571
$
3,628,023
See accompanying notes to consolidated financial statements.
104
BANC OF CALIFORNIA, INC.
CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF OPERATIONS
(Amounts in thousands, except per share data)
Interest and dividend income
Loans, including fees
Securities
Dividends and other interest-earning assets
Total interest and dividend income
Interest expense
Deposits
Federal Home Loan Bank advances
Notes payable and other interest-bearing liabilities
Total interest expense
Net interest income
Provision for loan and lease losses
Net interest income after provision for loan and lease losses
Noninterest income
Customer service fees
Loan servicing income
Income from bank owned life insurance
Net gain (loss) on sale of securities available for sale
Net gain on sale of loans
Net revenue on mortgage banking activities
Advisory service fees
Loan brokerage income
Gain on sale of branches
Bargain purchase gain
Other income
Total noninterest income
Noninterest expense
Salaries and employee benefits
Occupancy and equipment
Professional fees
Data processing
Advertising
Regulatory assessments
Loan servicing and foreclosure expense
Operating loss on equity investment
Valuation allowance for other real estate owned
Net gain on sales of other real estate owned
Provision for loan repurchases
Amortization of intangible assets
Impairment on intangible assets
All other expense
Total noninterest expense
Income before income taxes
Income tax (benefit) expense
Net income
Preferred stock dividends
Net income (loss) available to common stockholders
Basic earnings (loss) per common share
Diluted earnings (loss) per common share
Basic earnings (loss) per class B common share
Diluted earnings (loss) per class B common share
Year Ended December 31,
2013
2012
2014
$
$
$
$
$
$
180,761
5,158
2,220
188,139
24,411
527
7,924
32,862
155,277
10,976
144,301
1,490
4,199
224
1,183
19,828
95,430
12,904
8,674
456
—
1,249
145,637
162,879
33,443
19,247
5,231
5,016
4,182
1,066
689
32
(66)
2,808
4,079
48
25,507
264,161
25,777
(4,541)
30,318
3,640
26,678
0.91
0.91
0.91
0.91
$
$
116,673
2,632
1,206
120,511
16,051
269
6,962
23,282
97,229
7,963
89,266
1,942
2,049
177
331
8,700
67,890
377
1,356
12,104
—
1,817
96,743
110,687
19,662
13,864
4,710
4,361
2,535
905
569
97
(464)
2,383
2,651
1,061
15,649
178,670
7,339
7,260
79
2,185
(2,106) $
(0.14) $
(0.14) $
(0.14) $
(0.14) $
$
$
$
$
$
51,942
2,736
353
55,031
5,960
348
2,171
8,479
46,552
5,500
41,052
1,883
92
253
(83)
1,106
21,310
—
1
—
11,627
430
36,619
41,891
7,902
7,888
3,011
1,046
1,519
980
364
703
(464)
256
696
—
5,768
71,560
6,111
115
5,996
1,359
4,637
0.40
0.40
0.40
0.40
See accompanying notes to consolidated financial statements.
105
BANC OF CALIFORNIA, INC.
CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF COMPREHENSIVE INCOME (LOSS)
(Amounts in thousands)
Net income
Other comprehensive income (loss), net of tax:
Unrealized gain (loss) on available-for-sale securities:
Unrealized gain (loss) arising during the period
Reclassification adjustment for gain included in net income
Total change in unrealized loss (gain) on available-for-sale
securities
Unrealized gain (loss) on cash flow hedge:
Unrealized gain (loss) arising during the period
Total change in unrealized gain (loss) on cash flow hedge
Total other comprehensive income (loss)
Comprehensive income (loss)
Year Ended December 31,
2014
2013
2012
$
30,318
$
79
$
5,996
2,020
(685)
1,335
(362)
(362)
973
$
31,291
$
(1,892)
(331)
(2,223)
226
226
(1,997)
(1,918) $
2,253
83
2,336
—
—
2,336
8,332
See accompanying notes to consolidated financial statements.
106
l
a
t
o
T
)
s
s
o
L
(
e
m
o
c
n
I
k
c
o
t
S
d
e
t
a
l
u
m
u
c
c
A
r
e
h
t
O
e
v
i
s
n
e
h
e
r
p
m
o
C
y
r
u
s
a
e
r
T
d
e
n
i
a
t
e
R
s
g
n
i
n
r
a
E
l
a
n
o
i
t
i
d
d
A
-
d
i
a
P
k
c
o
t
S
n
o
m
m
o
C
k
c
o
t
S
d
e
r
r
e
f
e
r
P
l
a
t
i
p
a
C
n
i
B
s
s
a
l
C
A
s
s
a
l
C
C
s
e
i
r
e
S
B
s
e
i
r
e
S
A
s
e
i
r
e
S
5
9
4
,
4
8
1
$
)
9
3
9
(
$
)
7
3
0
,
5
2
(
$
3
2
6
,
7
2
$
6
8
7
,
0
5
1
$
1
1
$
7
1
1
$
—
$
—
$
4
3
9
,
1
3
$
6
9
9
,
5
6
3
3
,
2
)
9
2
(
5
9
4
)
9
2
1
(
)
5
6
5
(
0
8
1
,
1
)
5
5
6
,
4
(
)
9
5
3
,
1
(
)
7
1
(
9
0
0
,
1
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
6
3
3
,
2
—
—
)
6
1
2
(
—
—
—
)
5
6
5
(
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
6
9
9
,
5
—
—
)
0
1
7
,
5
(
)
9
5
3
,
1
(
—
—
7
8
1
5
9
4
)
9
2
1
(
0
8
1
,
1
—
2
5
0
,
1
—
)
7
1
(
9
0
0
,
1
7
5
7
,
8
8
1
$
7
9
3
,
1
$
)
8
1
8
,
5
2
(
$
0
5
5
,
6
2
$
3
6
5
,
4
5
1
$
9
7
)
7
9
9
,
1
(
6
4
3
,
9
9
3
4
9
,
7
3
0
0
0
,
0
1
9
0
4
5
1
4
—
)
8
0
2
(
2
8
5
)
6
4
0
,
5
(
1
1
3
,
2
3
3
4
,
1
)
6
3
7
,
6
(
)
5
8
1
,
2
(
—
)
7
9
9
,
1
(
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
)
0
7
2
(
)
6
4
0
,
5
(
3
2
2
,
3
—
—
—
—
—
—
9
7
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
)
7
2
7
(
—
—
—
)
6
3
7
,
6
(
)
5
8
1
,
2
(
—
—
1
6
2
,
9
9
—
—
9
0
4
5
1
1
3
—
)
3
2
2
,
3
(
9
1
5
2
8
5
1
1
3
,
2
3
3
4
,
1
—
—
3
7
9
8
1
3
,
0
3
6
5
6
,
4
0
1
2
8
1
,
1
5
—
3
7
9
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
8
1
3
,
0
3
—
—
8
0
5
,
4
0
1
2
8
1
,
1
5
9
6
8
,
4
2
3
$
)
0
0
6
(
$
)
1
1
9
,
7
2
(
$
1
8
9
,
6
1
$
6
0
3
,
6
5
2
$
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
1
1
—
—
)
5
(
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
6
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
3
—
—
—
$
0
2
1
$
—
—
0
9
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
3
4
9
,
7
3
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
$
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
0
0
0
,
0
1
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
$
4
3
9
,
1
3
$
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
8
4
1
—
7
0
1
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
$
0
1
2
$
3
4
9
,
7
3
$
0
0
0
,
0
1
$
4
3
9
,
1
3
$
k
c
o
t
s
n
o
m
m
o
c
f
o
s
e
r
a
h
s
f
o
t
n
e
m
e
r
i
t
e
r
d
n
a
e
r
u
t
i
e
f
r
o
F
e
s
n
e
p
x
e
n
o
i
t
a
s
n
e
p
m
o
c
n
o
i
t
p
o
k
c
o
t
S
t
e
n
,
e
m
o
c
n
i
e
v
i
s
n
e
h
e
r
p
m
o
c
r
e
h
t
O
d
e
n
r
a
e
s
d
r
a
w
a
k
c
o
t
S
t
n
e
m
y
a
p
e
c
n
a
r
e
v
e
S
e
s
a
h
c
r
u
p
k
n
a
B
s
s
e
n
i
s
u
B
h
c
a
e
B
h
t
i
w
d
e
u
s
s
i
s
t
n
a
r
r
a
W
)
e
r
a
h
s
n
o
m
m
o
c
r
e
p
8
4
.
0
$
(
d
e
r
a
l
c
e
d
s
d
n
e
d
i
v
i
D
k
c
o
t
s
y
r
u
s
a
e
r
t
f
o
s
e
r
a
h
s
5
9
8
,
2
4
f
o
e
s
a
h
c
r
u
P
g
n
i
t
s
e
v
s
d
r
a
w
a
e
r
a
h
s
d
e
t
c
i
r
t
s
e
r
f
o
s
s
o
l
x
a
T
s
d
n
e
d
i
v
i
d
k
c
o
t
s
d
e
r
r
e
f
e
r
P
1
1
0
2
,
1
3
r
e
b
m
e
c
e
D
t
a
e
c
n
a
l
a
B
:
e
m
o
c
n
i
e
v
i
s
n
e
h
e
r
p
m
o
C
e
m
o
c
n
i
t
e
N
t
e
n
,
s
s
o
l
e
v
i
s
n
e
h
e
r
p
m
o
c
r
e
h
t
O
e
m
o
c
n
I
t
e
N
2
1
0
2
,
1
3
r
e
b
m
e
c
e
D
t
a
e
c
n
a
l
a
B
:
)
s
s
o
l
(
e
m
o
c
n
i
e
v
i
s
n
e
h
e
r
p
m
o
C
k
c
o
t
s
n
o
m
m
o
c
f
o
e
c
n
a
u
s
s
I
k
c
o
t
s
d
e
r
r
e
f
e
r
p
f
o
e
c
n
a
u
s
s
I
n
o
i
t
i
s
i
u
q
c
a
s
s
e
n
i
s
u
b
h
g
u
o
r
h
t
d
e
m
u
s
s
a
k
c
o
t
s
d
e
r
r
e
f
e
r
P
n
o
i
t
i
s
i
u
q
c
a
s
s
e
n
i
s
u
b
h
g
u
o
r
h
t
d
e
t
r
e
v
n
o
c
s
n
o
i
t
p
o
k
c
o
t
S
k
c
o
t
s
y
r
u
s
a
e
r
t
f
o
s
e
r
a
h
s
7
1
5
,
7
7
3
f
o
e
s
a
h
c
r
u
P
k
c
o
t
s
y
r
u
s
a
e
r
t
m
o
r
f
s
d
r
a
w
a
k
c
o
t
s
f
o
e
c
n
a
u
s
s
I
k
c
o
t
s
n
o
m
m
o
c
f
o
t
n
e
m
e
r
i
t
e
r
d
n
a
e
r
u
t
i
e
f
r
o
F
s
n
o
i
t
p
o
k
c
o
t
s
f
o
e
s
i
c
r
e
x
E
n
a
l
P
t
n
e
m
t
s
e
v
n
i
e
R
d
n
e
d
i
v
i
D
e
h
t
r
e
d
n
u
d
e
s
a
h
c
r
u
p
s
e
r
a
h
S
s
n
o
i
t
p
o
k
c
o
t
s
o
t
s
t
h
g
i
r
n
o
i
t
a
i
c
e
r
p
p
a
k
c
o
t
s
f
o
n
o
i
s
r
e
v
n
o
C
)
e
r
a
h
s
n
o
m
m
o
c
r
e
p
8
4
.
0
$
(
d
e
r
a
l
c
e
d
s
d
n
e
d
i
v
i
D
e
s
n
e
p
x
e
n
o
i
t
a
s
n
e
p
m
o
c
k
c
o
t
s
d
e
t
c
i
r
t
s
e
R
e
s
n
e
p
x
e
n
o
i
t
a
s
n
e
p
m
o
c
n
o
i
t
p
o
k
c
o
t
S
t
e
n
,
e
m
o
c
n
i
e
v
i
s
n
e
h
e
r
p
m
o
c
r
e
h
t
O
s
t
i
n
u
y
t
i
u
q
e
e
l
b
i
g
n
a
t
f
o
e
c
n
a
u
s
s
I
k
c
o
t
s
n
o
m
m
o
c
f
o
e
c
n
a
u
s
s
I
3
1
0
2
,
1
3
r
e
b
m
e
c
e
D
t
a
e
c
n
a
l
a
B
s
d
n
e
d
i
v
i
d
k
c
o
t
s
d
e
r
r
e
f
e
r
P
:
e
m
o
c
n
i
e
v
i
s
n
e
h
e
r
p
m
o
C
e
m
o
c
n
i
t
e
N
Y
T
I
U
Q
E
’
S
R
E
D
L
O
H
K
C
O
T
S
F
O
S
T
N
E
M
E
T
A
T
S
D
E
T
A
D
I
L
O
S
N
O
C
)
a
t
a
d
e
r
a
h
s
r
e
p
d
n
a
e
r
a
h
s
t
p
e
c
x
e
,
s
d
n
a
s
u
o
h
t
n
i
s
t
n
u
o
m
A
(
.
C
N
I
,
A
I
N
R
O
F
I
L
A
C
F
O
C
N
A
B
)
0
8
2
(
—
3
9
9
0
8
4
8
3
8
,
5
9
8
8
,
1
—
5
8
)
4
2
2
(
)
2
0
6
(
)
3
4
5
(
)
5
0
4
,
2
1
(
)
0
4
6
,
3
(
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
)
0
8
2
(
)
6
2
9
,
1
(
—
—
—
—
9
1
3
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
)
8
4
8
(
—
)
3
4
5
(
)
5
0
4
,
2
1
(
)
0
4
6
,
3
(
—
6
2
9
,
1
3
9
9
0
8
4
8
3
8
,
5
9
8
8
,
1
)
9
1
3
(
5
8
4
2
6
)
2
0
6
(
—
—
—
9
8
5
,
3
0
5
$
3
7
3
$
)
8
9
7
,
9
2
(
$
3
6
8
,
9
2
$
0
1
9
,
2
2
4
$
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
6
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
$
8
5
3
$
3
4
9
,
7
3
$
0
0
0
,
0
1
$
4
3
9
,
1
3
$
k
c
o
t
s
y
r
u
s
a
e
r
t
m
o
r
f
d
e
u
s
s
i
s
d
r
a
w
a
r
o
f
t
n
e
m
t
s
u
j
d
a
n
o
i
t
a
c
i
f
i
s
s
a
l
c
e
R
k
c
o
t
s
y
r
u
s
a
e
r
t
f
o
s
e
r
a
h
s
2
0
5
,
3
2
f
o
e
s
a
h
c
r
u
P
n
a
l
P
t
n
e
m
t
s
e
v
n
i
e
R
d
n
e
d
i
v
i
D
e
h
t
r
e
d
n
u
d
e
s
a
h
c
r
u
p
s
e
r
a
h
S
y
t
i
l
i
b
a
i
l
x
a
t
e
e
y
o
l
p
m
e
o
t
e
u
d
d
e
r
e
d
n
e
r
r
u
s
k
c
o
t
s
d
e
t
c
i
r
t
s
e
R
)
e
r
a
h
s
n
o
m
m
o
c
r
e
p
8
4
.
0
$
(
d
e
r
a
l
c
e
d
s
d
n
e
d
i
v
i
D
s
d
n
e
d
i
v
i
d
t
h
g
i
r
n
o
i
t
a
i
c
e
r
p
p
a
k
c
o
t
S
4
1
0
2
,
1
3
r
e
b
m
e
c
e
D
t
a
e
c
n
a
l
a
B
s
d
n
e
d
i
v
i
d
k
c
o
t
s
d
e
r
r
e
f
e
r
P
k
c
o
t
s
y
r
u
s
a
e
r
t
m
o
r
f
s
d
r
a
w
a
k
c
o
t
s
f
o
e
c
n
a
u
s
s
I
n
a
l
p
n
o
i
t
a
s
n
e
p
m
o
c
k
c
o
t
s
m
o
r
f
t
c
e
f
f
e
x
a
T
e
s
n
e
p
x
e
n
o
i
t
a
s
n
e
p
m
o
c
k
c
o
t
s
d
e
t
c
i
r
t
s
e
R
e
s
n
e
p
x
e
n
o
i
t
a
s
n
e
p
m
o
c
n
o
i
t
p
o
k
c
o
t
S
e
s
n
e
p
x
e
t
h
g
i
r
n
o
i
t
a
i
c
e
r
p
p
a
k
c
o
t
S
s
n
o
i
t
p
o
k
c
o
t
s
f
o
e
s
i
c
r
e
x
E
.
s
t
n
e
m
e
t
a
t
s
l
a
i
c
n
a
n
i
f
d
e
t
a
d
i
l
o
s
n
o
c
o
t
s
e
t
o
n
g
n
i
y
n
a
p
m
o
c
c
a
e
e
S
8
0
1
BANC OF CALIFORNIA, INC.
CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF CASH FLOWS
(Amounts in thousands)
Cash flows from operating activities:
Net income
Adjustments to reconcile net income to net cash used in operating activities
Provision for loan and lease losses
Provision for loan repurchases
Net revenue on mortgage banking activities
Net gain on sale of loans
Net amortization of securities
Depreciation on premises and equipment
Amortization of intangibles
Amortization of debt issuance cost
Stock option compensation expense
Stock award compensation expense
Change in fair value of converted stock options related to business
acquisition
Stock appreciation right expense
Bank owned life insurance income
Operating loss on equity investment
Impairment on intangible assets
Net (gain) loss on sale of securities available for sale
Gain on sale of mortgage servicing rights
Gain on sale of other real estate owned
Gain on sale of branches
Bargain purchase gain
Loss (gain) on sale or disposal of property and equipment
Loss (gain) from change of fair value on mortgage servicing rights
Deferred income tax (benefit) expense
Increase in valuation allowances on other real estate owned
Repurchase of mortgage loans
Originations of loans held for sale from mortgage banking
Originations of other loans held for sale
Proceeds from sales of and principal collected on loans held for sale from
mortgage banking
Proceeds from sales of and principal collected on other loans held for sale
Change in deferred loan (costs) fees
Amortization of premiums and discounts on purchased loans
Change in accrued interest receivable
Change in other assets
Change in accrued interest payable and other liabilities
Net cash used in operating activities
Cash flows from investing activities:
Proceeds from sales of securities available-for-sale
Proceeds from maturities and calls of securities available-for-sale
Proceeds from principal repayments of securities available-for-sale
Purchases of securities available-for-sale
Net cash (used) acquired in acquisitions
Net cash used in branch sale
Loan originations and principal collections, net
Purchase of loans
Redemption of Federal Home Loan Bank stocks
Purchase of Federal Home Loan Bank and other bank stocks
Proceeds from sale of loans held for investment
Net change in time deposits in financial institutions
109
Year Ended December 31,
2013
2012
2014
$
30,318
$
79
$
5,996
10,976
2,808
(95,430)
(19,828)
746
6,834
4,079
686
480
5,838
—
1,889
(224)
689
48
(1,183)
(2,318)
(66)
(456)
—
942
1,564
(17,229)
32
(3,343)
(2,822,406)
(1,439,700)
2,838,771
923,494
(1,296)
(34,776)
(4,247)
(6,605)
(8,603)
(627,516)
111,764
1,231
41,142
(327,069)
(23,409)
—
(376,771)
(38,572)
559
(20,200)
161,638
(54)
7,963
2,383
(67,890)
(8,700)
1,742
4,283
2,651
385
582
2,311
9
1,072
(177)
569
1,061
(331)
—
(464)
(12,104)
—
—
(298)
7,573
97
—
(1,942,622)
(441,969)
1,916,746
107,222
(248)
(20,304)
(5,865)
3,408
5,347
(435,489)
127,298
12,606
98,287
(71,129)
5,644
(448,891)
(385,272)
(857,733)
25
(13,783)
276,516
3,181
5,500
256
(21,310)
(1,106)
1,430
1,714
696
135
495
1,188
—
—
(253)
364
—
83
—
(464)
—
(11,627)
(412)
238
100
703
—
(515,327)
—
495,796
—
662
(2,218)
(322)
4,372
346
(32,965)
11,940
52,287
—
(77,697)
43,671
—
(159,105)
(96,917)
702
—
79,307
—
Proceeds from sale of other real estate owned
Proceeds from sale of mortgage servicing rights
Proceeds from sale of premises and equipment
Additions to premises and equipment
Funding of equity investment
Purchase of interest bearing deposits
Payments of capital lease obligations
Net cash used in investing activities
Cash flows from financing activities:
Net increase in deposits
Net increase in Federal Home Loan Bank advances
Net proceeds from issuance of common stock
Net proceeds from issuance of preferred stock
Net proceeds from issuance of long term debt
Net proceeds from other borrowings
Net proceeds from issuance of tangible equity units
Payment of Amortizing Debt
Purchase of treasury stock
Proceeds from exercise of stock options
Tax expense from restricted stock vesting
Dividends paid on stock appreciation rights
Dividends paid on preferred stock
Dividends paid on common stock
Net cash provided by financing activities
Net change in cash and cash equivalents
Cash and cash equivalents at beginning of year
Cash and cash equivalents at end of year
Supplemental cash flow information
Interest paid on deposits and borrowed funds
Income taxes paid
Income taxes refunds received
Supplemental disclosure of noncash activities
Transfer from loans to other real estate owned, net
Transfer of loans receivable to loans held for sale, net of transfer of $613,
$1,443 and $0 from allowance for loan and lease losses for the years
ended December 31, 2014, 2013 and 2012, respectively
Transfer of loans held for sale to loans receivable
Equipment acquired under capital leases
Conversion of stock appreciation rights to stock options
264
18,808
79
(11,663)
—
—
(901)
(463,154)
676,372
383,000
103,656
—
—
—
64,959
(2,157)
(280)
993
—
(471)
(3,652)
(10,669)
1,211,751
121,081
110,118
231,199
32,592
9,855
263
653
66,334
117,116
1,313
—
$
$
5,123
—
—
(54,965)
—
—
(389)
(1,303,482)
1,514,930
133,167
67,792
37,943
—
—
—
—
(5,005)
540
—
—
(2,185)
(6,736)
1,740,446
1,475
108,643
110,118
23,277
—
—
—
181,360
—
2,675
1,433
$
$
13,789
—
1,324
(6,151)
(624)
(353)
(54)
(137,881)
105,692
55,000
—
(7)
80,283
642
—
—
(565)
—
(17)
—
(1,359)
(4,655)
235,014
64,168
44,475
108,643
7,606
—
—
3,863
—
—
532
—
$
$
See accompanying notes to consolidated financial statements.
110
BANC OF CALIFORNIA, INC.
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
December 31, 2014, 2013 and 2012
NOTE 1 – SUMMARY OF SIGNIFICANT ACCOUNTING POLICIES
Nature of Operations: Banc of California, Inc. (collectively, with its consolidated subsidiaries, the Company, we, us and our),
is a financial holding company under the Bank Holding Company Act of 1956, as amended, headquartered in Orange County,
California and incorporated under the laws of Maryland. Banc of California, Inc.'s assets primarily consist of the outstanding
stock of Banc of California, National Association (the Bank), as well as the outstanding membership interests of The Palisades
Group, LLC (The Palisades Group), and PTB Property Holdings, LLC (PTB).
Banc of California, Inc. is subject to regulation by the Board of Governors of the Federal Reserve System (the Federal Reserve
Board or FRB) and the Bank operates under a national bank charter issued by the Office of the Comptroller of the Currency
(the OCC), its primary regulator. The Bank is a member of the Federal Home Loan Bank (FHLB) system, and maintains
insurance on deposit accounts with the Federal Deposit Insurance Corporation (FDIC). The Bank offers a variety of financial
services to meet the banking and financial needs of the communities we serve, with operations conducted through 37 banking
offices, serving San Diego, Los Angeles, and Orange counties, California and 67 loan production offices in California, Arizona,
Oregon, Virginia, Indiana, Maryland, Colorado, Idaho, and Nevada as of December 31, 2014. The Palisades Group provides
financial advisory and asset management services and PTB Property Holdings, LLC manages and disposes of other real estate
owned properties.
Basis of Presentation: The consolidated financial statements include the accounts of the Company and all other entities in
which it has a controlling financial interest. All significant intercompany accounts and transactions have been eliminated in
consolidation. Unless the context requires otherwise, all references to the Company include its wholly owned subsidiaries. The
accounting and reporting polices of the Company are based upon U.S. generally accepted accounting principles (GAAP) and
conform to predominant practices within the financial services industry. Significant accounting policies followed by the
Company are presented below.
Certain prior period amounts have been reclassified to conform to the current year's presentation. These reclassifications had no
impact on the Company's consolidated financial position, results of operations or net change in cash or cash equivalents.
Use of Estimates in the Preparation of Financial Statements: The preparation of financial statements in conformity with
GAAP requires management to make estimates and assumptions based on available information. These estimates and
assumptions affect the amounts reported in the financial statements and disclosures provided, and actual results could differ.
The allowance for loan and lease losses, reserve for loss on repurchased loans, servicing rights, realization of deferred tax
assets, the valuation of goodwill and other intangible assets, mortgage banking derivatives, purchased credit impaired loan
discount accretion, fair value of assets and liabilities acquired in business combinations, and the fair value measurement of
financial instruments are particularly subject to change and such change could have a material effect on the consolidated
financial statements.
Cash and cash equivalents: Cash and cash equivalents include cash on hand, interest-bearing deposits with other financial
institutions with original maturities under 90 days, and daily federal funds sold. Net cash flows are reported for customer loan
and deposit transactions, interest bearing deposits in other financial institutions, and federal funds purchased, including
overnight borrowings with the Federal Home Loan Bank.
Cash flows from loans, either originated or acquired, are classified at that time according to management's original intent to
either sell or hold the loan for the foreseeable future. When management's intent at origination or purchase is to sell the loan,
the cash flows of that loan are presented as operating cash flows. When management's intent is to hold the loan for the
foreseeable future, the cash flows of that loan are presented as investing cash flows.
Time Deposits in Financial Institutions: Time deposits in financial institutions have original maturities over 90 days and are
carried at cost.
Securities: Investment securities are classified at the time of purchase as available for sale or held-to-maturity. Debt securities
classified as held to maturity are recorded at amortized cost when management has the positive intent and ability to hold them
to maturity. Debt securities are classified as available-for-sale when management intends that they might be sold before
maturity. Equity securities with readily determinable fair values are classified as available-for-sale. Securities available-for-sale
are carried at fair value with unrealized holding gains and losses, net of taxes, reported in other comprehensive income or loss.
111
Accreted discounts and amortized premiums are included in interest income using the level yield method, and realized gains or
losses from sales of securities are calculated using the specific identification method.
Management evaluates securities for other-than-temporary impairment (OTTI) at least on a quarterly basis, and more frequently
when economic conditions warrant such an evaluation. Investment securities classified as available for sale or held-to-maturity
are generally evaluated for OTTI under Statement of Financial Accounting Standards Accounting Standards Codification
(ASC) 320, Accounting for Certain Investments in Debt and Equity Securities. However, certain purchased beneficial interests,
including non-agency mortgage-backed securities, asset-backed securities, and collateralized debt obligations, that had credit
ratings at the time of purchase of below AA are evaluated using the model outlined in ASC 325, Recognition of Interest Income
and Impairment on Purchased Beneficial Interests and Beneficial Interests that Continue to be Held by a Transfer in Securitized
Financial Assets.
In determining OTTI under the ASC 320 model, management considers the extent and duration of the unrealized loss and the
financial condition and near-term prospects of the issuer. Management also considers whether the market decline was affected
by macroeconomic conditions, and assesses whether the Company intends to sell, or it is more likely than not it will be required
to sell a security in an unrealized loss position before recovery of its amortized cost basis. The assessment of whether OTTI
exists involves a high degree of subjectivity and judgment and is based on the information available to management at a point
in time.
The second segment of the portfolio uses the OTTI guidance provided by ASC 325 that is specific to purchased beneficial
interests that, on the purchase date, were rated below AA. Under the ASC 325 model, the Company compares the present value
of the remaining cash flows as estimated at the preceding evaluation date to the current expected remaining cash flows. An
OTTI is deemed to have occurred if there has been an adverse change in the remaining expected future cash flows.
When OTTI occurs in either model, the amount of the impairment recognized in earnings depends on the Company’s intent to
sell the security or if it is more likely than not that it will be required to sell the security before recovery of its amortized cost
basis. If either of the criteria regarding intent or requirement to sell is met, the entire difference between amortized cost and fair
value is recognized as impairment through earnings. For debt securities that do not meet the aforementioned criteria, the
amount of impairment is split into two components as follows: 1) OTTI related to credit loss, which must be recognized in the
income statement and 2) other-than-temporary impairment related to other factors, which is recognized in other comprehensive
income. The credit loss is defined as the difference between the present value of the cash flows expected to be collected and the
amortized cost basis. For equity securities the entire amount of impairment is recognized through earnings.
Federal Home Loan Bank (FHLB) and Federal Reserve Bank (FRB) Stock: The Bank is a member of the FHLB and FRB
system. Members are required to own a certain amount of FHLB and FRB stock based on the level of borrowings and other
factors, and may invest in additional amounts. FHLB and FRB stock is carried at cost, classified as a restricted security, and
periodically evaluated for impairment based on ultimate recovery of par value. Both cash and stock dividends are reported as
income.
Conforming Mortgage Loans Held for Sale: Mortgage loans originated and intended for sale in the secondary market are
carried at the fair value as of each balance sheet date, as determined by outstanding commitments from investors or what
secondary markets are currently offering for portfolios with similar characteristics. The fair value includes the servicing value
of the loans as well as any accrued interest. Mortgage loans held for sale are generally sold with servicing rights retained.
Origination fees and costs are recognized in earnings at the time of origination for newly originated loans held for sale. Gains
and losses on sales of mortgage loans are based on the difference between the selling price and the carrying value of the related
loan sold.
The Company’s conforming mortgage loans held for sale at fair value are Government-sponsored enterprise (GSE) or
Government-eligible at December 31, 2014. These loans are considered to have reliable market price information and the fair
value of these loans at December 31, 2014 was based on quoted market prices of similar assets and included the value of loan
servicing.
In scenarios of market disruptions, the current secondary market prices that are generally relied on to value GSE-eligible
mortgage loans may not be readily available. In these circumstances, the Company may consider other factors, including: 1)
quoted market prices for to-be-announced securities (for agency-eligible loans); 2) recent transaction settlements or traded but
unsettled transactions for similar assets; 3) recent third party market transactions for similar assets; and 4) modeled valuations
using assumptions that the Bank believes would be used by market participants in estimating fair value (assumptions may
include prepayment rates, interest rates, volatilities, mortgage spreads and projected loss rates).
112
Adjustments to reflect unrealized gains and losses resulting from changes in fair value and realized gains and losses upon
ultimate sale of the loans are classified as part of Net Revenue on Mortgage Banking Activities on the Consolidated Statements
of Operations.
Non-Conforming Mortgage Loans Held for Sale: Non-conforming mortgage loans originated and intended for sale in the
secondary market are carried at the lower of cost or fair value on an aggregate basis. A decline in the aggregate fair value of the
loans below their aggregate carrying amount is recognized through a charge to earnings in the period of such a decline.
Unearned income on the loans is taken into earnings when they are sold.
SBA Loans Held for Sale: SBA loans originated and intended for sale in the secondary market are carried at the lower of cost
or estimated market value in the aggregate. Net unrealized losses are recognized through a valuation allowance by charges to
income. Gains or losses realized on the sales of SBA loans are recognized at the time of sale and are determined by the
difference between the net sales proceeds and the carrying value of the loans sold, adjusted for any servicing asset or liability.
Gains and losses on sales of SBA loans are included in noninterest income.
Loans and Leases: Loans and leases (other than purchased credit-impaired loans and leases) that management has the intent
and ability to hold for the foreseeable future, or until maturity or payoff are stated at the principal balance outstanding, net of
charged off amounts and unamortized purchase premiums and discounts and net of deferred loan fees and costs. The deferred
net loan fees and costs, and purchase premiums and discounts are recognized in interest income as an adjustment to yield over
the loan term using the effective interest method. Interest on loans and leases is credited to interest income as earned based on
the interest rate applied to principal amounts outstanding. Interest income is accrued on the unpaid principal balance and is
discontinued on a loan when management believes, after considering economic and business conditions and collection efforts,
that the borrower’s financial condition is such that full collection of principal or interest becomes doubtful, regardless of the
length of past due status. Generally loans are placed on nonaccrual status when they are greater than 90 days past due. When
interest accrual is discontinued, all unpaid accrued interest is reversed against interest income. Interest received on such loans
and leases is accounted for on the cash-basis or cost-recovery method, until qualifying for return to accrual. A charge-off is
recorded at 180 days if the loan balance exceeds the fair value of the collateral less costs to sell. Commercial, commercial real
estate and equipment finance loans are subject to a detailed review when 90 days past due to determine accrual status, or when
payment is uncertain and a specific consideration is made to put a loan or lease on non-accrual status. Consumer loans, other
than those secured by real estate, are typically charged off no later than 180 days past due. Loans and leases are returned to
accrual status when the borrower has demonstrated a satisfactory payment trend subject to management’s assessment of the
borrower’s ability to repay the loan.
Allowance for Loan and Lease Losses: The allowance for loan and lease losses is a reserve established through a provision for
loan and lease loses charged to expense, and represents management’s best estimate of probable losses that may be incurred
within the existing loan and lease portfolio as of the balance sheet date. Subsequent recoveries, if any, are credited to the
allowance. The Company performs an analysis of the adequacy of the allowance at least on a quarterly basis. Management
estimates the allowance balance required using past loan and lease loss experience, the nature and volume of the portfolio,
information about specific borrower situations and estimated collateral values, economic conditions, and other factors.
Allocations of the allowance may be made for specific loans and leases, but the entire allowance is available for any loan or
lease that, in management’s judgment, should be charged off.
The allowance consists of three elements; (i) specific valuation allowances established for probable losses on impaired loans
and leases, (ii) quantitative valuation allowances calculated using loss experience for like loans and leases with similar
characteristics and trends, adjusted, as necessary to reflect the impact of current conditions; and (iii) qualitative allowances
determined based on environmental and other factors that may be internal or external to the Company.
A loan or lease is impaired when, based on current information and events, it is probable that the Company will be unable to
collect all amounts due according to the contractual terms of the loan or lease agreement. The Company evaluates all impaired
loans and leases individually under the guidance of ASC 310, Receivables, primarily through the evaluation of collateral values
and estimated cash flows. Loans and leases for which the terms have been modified and where the borrower is experiencing
financial difficulties are considered troubled debt restructurings (TDR) and classified as impaired.
Factors considered by management in determining impairment include payment status, collateral value, and the probability of
collecting scheduled principal and interest payments when due. Loans and leases that experience insignificant payment delays
and payment shortfalls generally are not classified as impaired. Management determines the significance of payment delays and
payment shortfalls on a case-by-case basis, taking into consideration all of the circumstances surrounding the loan or lease and
the borrower, including the length of the delay, the reasons for the delay, the borrower’s prior payment record, and the amount
of the shortfall in relation to the principal and interest owed. The impairment amount on a collateral dependent loan is charged-
off to the allowance and the impairment amount on a loan that is not collateral dependent is set-up as a specific reserve. TDRs
113
are also measured at the present value of estimated future cash flows using the loan’s or lease’s effective rate at inception or at
the fair value of collateral, less costs to sell, if repayment is expected solely from the collateral. For TDRs that subsequently
default, the Company determines the amount of reserve in accordance with the accounting policy for the allowance for loan and
lease losses.
During the year ended December 31, 2014, the Company enhanced the current methodologies, processes and controls over the
allowance for loan and lease losses (ALLL), due to the Company's organic and acquisitive growth and changing profile.
The following is a synopsis of the enhancements for each component of ALLL:
• Expand the look-back period to 28 rolling quarters to capture a full economic cycle.
• Utilize net historical losses versus gross historical losses.
• Expand the peer group used to determine industry average loss history to include three industry groups; 1) all U.S.
financial and bank holding companies, 2) all California financial and bank holding companies, 3) the peer group
average from the Uniform Bank Performance Report.
• Apply a segment specific loss emergence period to each segment's loss rate.
• Determine qualitative reserves is at each loan segment level based on a baseline risk weighting adjusted for current
risks, trends and business conditions.
• Disaggregate certain qualitative factors to be determined on the portfolio segment level.
These enhancements resulted in an increase of $264 thousand in the ALLL as compared to what it would have been using the
old methodology at December 31, 2014.
At December 31, 2014, the following portfolio segments have been identified: commercial and industrial - secured; commercial
and industrial - unsecured; commercial real estate - retail; commercial real estate - office; commercial real estate - industrial;
commercial real estate - hospitality; commercial real estate - acquisition and development; commercial real estate - condo
conversion; commercial real estate - other; construction; SBA; leases; single family residence -1st trust deed (amortizing,
interest only now amortizing, interest only, negative amortization, and Green Loans); single family residence -2nd trust deeds;
other consumer. The Company categorizes loans and leases into risk categories based on relevant information about the ability
of borrowers and lessees (also referred to as borrowers) to service their obligations such as: current financial information,
historical payment experience, credit documentation, public information, and current economic trends, among other factors.
The Company analyzes loans and leases individually by classifying the loans and leases as to credit risk. This analysis includes
all loans and leases delinquent over 60 days and non-homogeneous loans and leases such as commercial and commercial real
estate loans. Classification of problem SFR mortgage loans is performed on a monthly basis while analysis of non-
homogeneous loans is performed on a quarterly basis.
Loans secured by multi-family and commercial real estate properties generally involve a greater degree of credit risk than SFR
mortgage loans. Because payments on loans secured by multi-family and commercial real estate properties are often dependent
on the successful operation or management of the properties, repayment of these loans may be subject to adverse conditions in
the real estate market or the economy. Commercial business loans are also considered to have a greater degree of credit risk
than SFR mortgage loans due to the fact commercial business loans are typically made on the basis of the borrower’s ability to
make repayment from the cash flow of the borrower’s business. As a result, the availability of funds for the repayment of
commercial business loans may be substantially dependent on the success of the business itself (which, in turn, is often
dependent in part upon general economic conditions). SBA business loans are similar to commercial business loans, but have
additional credit enhancement provided by the U.S. Small Business Administration, for up to 85 percent of the loan amount for
loans up to $150,000 and 75 percent of the loan amount for loans of more than $150,000. Commercial equipment leases are
also similar to commercial business loans in that the leases are typically made on the basis of the borrower’s ability to make
repayment from the cash flow of the borrower’s business. As a result, the availability of funds for the repayment of commercial
equipment leases may be substantially dependent on the success of the business itself (which, in turn, is often dependent in part
upon general economic conditions). Consumer and other real estate loans may entail greater risk than do SFR mortgage loans
given that collection of these loans is dependent on the borrower’s continuing financial stability and, thus, are more likely to be
adversely affected by job loss, divorce, illness, or personal bankruptcy. Green Loans are also considered to carry a higher
degree of credit risk due to their unique cash flows. Credit risk on this asset class is also managed through the completion of
regular re-appraisals of the underlying collateral and monitoring of the borrower’s usage of this account to determine if the
borrower is making monthly payments from external sources or “drawdowns” on their line. In cases where the property values
114
have declined to levels less than the original loan-to-value, or other levels deemed prudent by the Company, the Company may
curtail the line and/or require monthly payments or principal reductions to bring the loan in balance.
Classified Assets: Federal regulations provide for the classification of loans, leases, and other assets, such as debt and equity
securities considered to be of lesser quality, as “substandard,” “doubtful” or “loss.” An asset is considered “substandard” if it is
inadequately protected by the current net worth and paying capacity of the obligor or of the collateral pledged, if any.
“Substandard” assets include those characterized by the “distinct possibility” that the insured institution will sustain “some
loss” if the deficiencies are not corrected. Assets classified as “doubtful” have all of the weaknesses inherent in those classified
“substandard,” with the added characteristic that the weaknesses present make “collection or liquidation in full,” on the basis of
currently existing facts, conditions, and values, “highly questionable and improbable.” Assets classified as “loss” are those
considered “uncollectible” and of such little value that their continuance as assets without the establishment of a specific loss
reserve is not warranted. When an insured institution classifies problem assets as “loss,” it is required to charge off such
amount. The Bank’s determination as to the classification of its assets and the amount of its valuation allowances is subject to
review by its primary regulator, which may order the establishment of additional general or specific loss allowances.
Troubled Debt Restructurings (TDR): A loan is identified as a TDR when a borrower is experiencing financial difficulties and
for economic or legal reasons related to these difficulties, the Company grants a concession to the borrower in the restructuring
that it would not otherwise consider. The Company has granted a concession when, as a result of the restructuring to a troubled
borrower, it does not expect to collect all amounts due, including principal and/or interest accrued at the original terms of the
loan. The concessions may be granted in various forms, including a below-market change in the stated interest rate, a reduction
in the loan balance or accrued interest, an extension of the maturity date, or a note split with principal forgiveness. Loans for
which the borrower has been discharged under Chapter 7 bankruptcy are considered collateral dependent TDRs, impaired at the
date of discharge, and charged down to the fair value of collateral less cost to sell. A restructuring executed at an interest rate
that is at market interest rates based on the current credit characteristics of the borrower is not a TDR.
The Company’s policy is to place consumer loan TDRs, except those that were performing prior to TDR status, on non-accrual
status for a minimum period of 6 months. Commercial TDRs are evaluated on a case-by-case basis for determination of
whether or not to place on non-accrual status. Loans qualify for return to accrual status once they have demonstrated
performance with the restructured terms of the loan agreement for a minimum of 6 months. Initially, all TDRs are reported as
impaired. Generally, TDRs are classified as impaired loans and reported as TDRs for the remaining life of the loan. Impaired
and TDR classification may be removed if the borrower demonstrates compliance with the modified terms for a minimum of 6
months and through one fiscal year-end and the restructuring agreement specifies a market rate of interest equal to that which
would be provided to a borrower with similar credit at the time of restructuring. In the limited circumstance that a loan is
removed from TDR classification it is the Company’s policy to continue to base its measure of loan impairment on the
contractual terms specified by the loan agreement.
Concentration of Credit Risk: Most of the Company’s lending activity is with customers located within San Diego, Los
Angeles, Orange and Riverside Counties, California. Therefore, the Company’s exposure to credit risk is significantly affected
by economic conditions in those areas. Our loans are concentrated geographically in the Southern California market place.
Purchased Credit-Impaired Loans: The Company purchases loans with and without evidence of credit quality deterioration
since origination. Evidence of credit quality deterioration as of the purchase date may include statistics such as prior loan
modification history, updated borrower credit scores and updated loan or lease-to-value (LTV) ratios, some of which may not
be immediately available as of the purchase date. Purchased loans with evidence of credit quality deterioration where the
Company estimates that it will not receive all contractual payments are accounted for as purchased credit impaired loans (PCI
loans). The excess of the cash flows expected to be collected on PCI loans, measured as of the acquisition date, over the
estimated fair value is referred to as the accretable yield and is recognized in interest income over the remaining life of the loan
or lease using a level yield methodology. The difference between contractually required payments as of the acquisition date and
the cash flows expected to be collected is referred to as the non-accretable difference. PCI loans that have similar risk
characteristics, primarily credit risk, collateral type and interest rate risk, are pooled and accounted for as a single unit with a
single composite interest rate and an aggregate expectation of cash flows.
Loans that were acquired during 2012 in connection with the Beach and Gateway acquisitions and during 2013 in connection
with the PBOC acquisition that were considered credit impaired were recorded at fair value at the acquisition date and the
related allowance for loan and lease losses was not carried over to the Company’s allowance. Any losses on such loans are
charged against the non-accretable difference established in purchase accounting and are not reported as charge-offs until such
non-accretable difference is fully utilized. These loans were evaluated individually and were not part of the aforementioned
pools.
115
The Company estimates cash flows expected to be collected over the life of the loan using management’s best estimate which is
derived using current key assumptions such as default rates, loss severity and payment speeds. If, upon subsequent evaluation,
the Company determines it is probable that the present value of the expected cash flows have decreased due to a deterioration
of credit, the PCI loan is considered further impaired which will result in a charge to the provision for loan and lease losses and
a corresponding increase to the allowance for loan and lease losses. If, upon subsequent evaluation, it is probable that there is
an increase in the present value of the expected cash flows, the Company will reduce any remaining allowance. If there is no
remaining allowance, the Company will recalculate the amount of accretable yield as the excess of the revised expected cash
flows over the current carrying value resulting in a reclassification from non-accretable difference to accretable yield. The
present value of the expected cash flows for PCI purchased loan pools is determined using the PCI loans’ effective interest rate,
adjusted for changes in the PCI loans’ interest rate indexes. Adjustments in interest rate assumptions and prepayment behavior
do not impact the Company’s assessment of credit impairment. The present value of the expected cash flows for PCI loans and
leases acquired through mergers with other banks includes, in addition to the above, an evaluation of the credit worthiness of
the borrower. Loan dispositions may include sales of loans, receipt of payments in full from the borrower or foreclosure. Write-
downs are not recorded on the PCI loan pool until actual losses exceed the remaining non-accretable difference. To date, no
write-downs have been recorded for the PCI loans held by the Company.
Other Real Estate Owned: Other real estate owned (OREO), which represents real estate acquired through foreclosure in
satisfaction of commercial and real estate loans, is initially recorded at fair value less estimated selling costs of the real estate,
based on current independent appraisals obtained at the time of acquisition, less costs to sell when acquired, establishing a new
cost basis. Loan balances in excess of fair value of the real estate acquired at the date of acquisition are charged to the
allowance for loan losses. Gains and losses on the sale of OREO are included in Net Gain on Sales of Other Real Estate
Owned, reductions in fair value subsequent to foreclosure are included in Valuation Allowance for Other Real Estate Owned
and any subsequent operating expenses or income of such properties are included in All Other Expense on the Consolidated
Statements of Operations.
Premises and Equipment: Land is carried at cost. Premises and equipment are stated at cost less accumulated depreciation and
amortization. Depreciation and amortization are computed using the straight-line method with the following estimated useful
lives: building 40 years and leasehold improvements-life of lease, and furniture, fixtures, and equipment 3 to 7 years.
Maintenance and repairs are charged to expense as incurred, and improvements that extend the useful lives of assets are
capitalized.
Bank Owned Life Insurance: The Bank has purchased life insurance policies on certain key current and former executives.
Bank owned life insurance is recorded at the amount that can be realized under the insurance contract at the balance sheet date,
which is the cash surrender value adjusted for other charges or other amounts due that are probable at settlement.
Servicing Rights-Mortgage (Fair Value Method): A servicing asset or liability is recognized when undertaking an obligation to
service a financial asset under mortgage servicing contract, including a transfer of the servicer’s financial assets that meet the
requirements for sale accounting. Such servicing asset or liability is initially measured at fair value based on either market
prices for comparable servicing contracts or alternatively is based on a valuation model that is based on the present value of the
contractually specified servicing fee, net of servicing costs, over the estimated life of the loan, using a discount rate based on
the related note rate and is recorded on the Consolidated Statements of Operations.
Fair value is based on market prices for comparable mortgage servicing contracts, when available, or alternatively, is based on a
valuation model that calculates the present value of estimated future net servicing income.
Under the fair value measurement method, the Company measures servicing rights at fair value at each reporting date and
reports changes in fair value of servicing assets in earnings in the period in which the changes occur, and are included with Net
Revenue on Mortgage Banking Activities on the Consolidated Statements of Operations. The fair values of servicing rights are
subject to significant fluctuations as a result of changes in estimates and actual prepayment speeds and default rates and losses.
Currently the Company does not hedge the income statement effects of changes in fair value of the servicing assets.
Servicing fee income, which is reported in Loan Servicing Income on the Consolidated Statements of Operations, is recorded
for fees earned for servicing loans. The fees are based on a contractual percentage of the outstanding principal; or a fixed
amount per loan and are recorded as income when earned. Late fees and ancillary fees related to loan servicing are not material.
Servicing Rights-Small Business Administration Loans (Amortized Cost Method): As a general course of business, the Bank
originates and sells the guaranteed portion of its SBA loans. To calculate the gain (loss) on sales of SBA loans, the Bank’s
investment in the loan is allocated among the retained portion of the loan, the servicing retained, the interest-only strip and the
sold portion of the loan, based on the relative fair market value of each portion. The gain (loss) on the sold portion of the loan is
recognized at the time of sale based on the difference between sale proceeds and the amount of the allocated investment to the
sold portion of the loan.
116
The portion of the servicing fees that represent contractually specified servicing fees (contractual servicing) is reflected as a
servicing asset and is amortized over the estimated life of the servicing; in the event future prepayments exceed management’s
estimates and future expected cash flows are inadequate to cover the servicing asset, impairment is recognized. The portion of
servicing fees in excess of contractual servicing fees are reflected as interest-only (I/O) strips receivable, which is included in
Other Assets on the Consolidated Statements of Financial Condition. The I/O strips receivable are carried at fair value, with
unrealized gains and losses recorded in the Consolidated Statements of Operations. The Company did not have any I/O strip
receivable at December 31, 2014 and 2013.
Goodwill and Other Intangible Assets: Goodwill represents the excess purchase price of businesses acquired over the fair
value of the identifiable net assets acquired and is assigned to specific reporting units. Goodwill is not subject to amortization
and is evaluated for impairment annually, during the third fiscal quarter, or more frequently in the interim if events occur or
circumstances change indicating it would more likely than not result in a reduction of the fair value of a reporting unit below its
carrying value. Goodwill is evaluated for impairment by either performing a qualitative evaluation or a two-step quantitative
test. The qualitative evaluation is an assessment of factors to determine whether it is more likely than not that the fair value of a
reporting unit is less than its carrying amount, including goodwill. Discounted cash flow estimates, which include significant
management assumptions relating to revenue growth rates, net interest margins, weighted average cost of capital, and future
economic and market conditions, are used to determine fair value under the two-step quantitative test. In Step 1, the fair value
of a reporting unit is compared to its carrying amount, including goodwill. If the fair value of the reporting unit exceeds its
carrying amount, goodwill of the reporting unit is not considered impaired, and it is not necessary to continue to Step 2 of the
impairment process. Otherwise, Step 2 is performed where the implied fair value of goodwill is compared to the carrying value
of goodwill in the reporting unit. If a reporting unit's carrying value exceeds fair value, the difference is charged to noninterest
expense.
Other intangible assets represent purchased assets that lack physical substance but can be distinguished from goodwill because
of contractual or other legal rights, or because the asset is capable of being sold or exchanged either separately or in
combination with a related contract, asset or liability. Other intangible assets with finite useful lives are amortized to
noninterest expense over their estimated useful lives and are evaluated for impairment whenever events occur or circumstances
change indicating the carrying amount of the asset may not be recoverable.
Affordable Housing Fund Investment: The Company has invested in two limited partnerships that were formed to develop
and operate several apartment complexes designed as high-quality affordable housing for lower income tenants throughout the
State of California and other states. The Company accounts for these investments under the equity method. The Company’s
ownership in each limited partnership varies from 8 percent to 19 percent. At December 31, 2014 and 2013, the gross
investments in these limited partnerships amounted to $9.0 million and $5.6 million, respectively, with original investment
amount to be $9.5 million. The unfunded portion was $487 thousand at December 31, 2014. Each of the partnerships must meet
the regulatory minimum requirements for affordable housing for a minimum 15-year compliance period to fully utilize the tax
credits. If the partnerships cease to qualify during the compliance period, the credit may be denied for any period in which the
project is not in compliance and a portion of the credit previously taken is subject to recapture with interest.
The approximate future federal and state tax credits to be generated over a multiple-year period are $4.9 million and $5.6
million at December 31, 2014 and 2013, respectively. The Company had an unused tax credit carryforward of $0. Investment
amortization amounted to $689 thousand and $569 thousand for the years ended December 31, 2014 and 2013 respectively.
Reserve for Unfunded Commitments: The reserve for unfunded commitments provides for probable losses inherent with
funding the unused portion of legal commitments to available to lend. The unfunded reserve calculation includes factors that
are consistent with ALLL methodology for funded loans using the loss given default, probability of default and a draw down
factor applied to the underlying borrower risk and facility grades. Changes in the reserve for unfunded credit commitments,
within Accrued Expenses and Other Liabilities, is reported as a component of All Other Expense on the Consolidated
Statements of Operations.
Reserve for Loss on Repurchased Loans: In the ordinary course of business, as loans held for sale are sold, the Bank makes
standard industry representations and warranties about the loans. The Bank may have to subsequently repurchase certain loans
or reimburse certain investor losses due to defects that may have occurred in the origination of the loans. Such defects include
documentation or underwriting errors. In addition, certain investor contracts require the Bank to repurchase loans from
previous whole loan sales transactions that experience early payment defaults. If there are no such defects or early payment
defaults, the Bank has no commitment to repurchase loans that it has sold. The level of reserve for loss on repurchased loans is
an estimate that requires considerable management judgment. The Bank’s reserve is based upon the expected future repurchase
trends for loans already sold in whole loan sale transactions and the expected valuation of such loans when repurchased, which
include first and second trust deed loans. At the point when loss reimbursements are made directly to the investor, the reserve
for loss reimbursements on sold loans is charged for the losses incurred.
117
Business Combinations: Business combinations are accounted for under the acquisition method of accounting in accordance
with ASC 805, Business Combinations. Under the acquisition method the acquiring entity in a business combination recognizes
100 percent of the acquired assets and assumed liabilities, regardless of the percentage owned, at their estimated fair values as
of the date of acquisition. Any excess of the purchase price over the fair value of net assets and other identifiable intangible
assets acquired is recorded as goodwill. To the extent the fair value of net assets acquired, including other identifiable assets,
exceed the purchase price, a bargain purchase gain is recognized. Assets acquired and liabilities assumed from contingencies
must also be recognized at fair value, if the fair value can be determined during the measurement period. Results of operations
of an acquired business are included in the statement of operations from the date of acquisition. Acquisition-related costs,
including conversion and restructuring charges, are expensed as incurred. The Company applied this guidance to the
RenovationReady and BPNA Branch acquisitions that were consummated in 2014, the PBOC, The Palisades Group, and CS
Financial acquisitions that were consummated in 2013, and the Gateway Bancorp and Beach Business Bank acquisitions that
were consummated in 2012.
Long-term Assets: Premises and equipment and other long-term assets are reviewed for impairment when events indicate their
carrying amount may not be recoverable from future undiscounted cash flows. If impaired, the assets are recorded at fair value.
Deferred Financing Costs: Deferred financing costs associated with the Company’s senior notes and junior subordinated
amortizing notes are included in Notes Payable on the Consolidated Statements of Financial Condition. The deferred financing
costs are being amortized on a basis that approximates a level yield method over the eight-year term of the senior notes and the
five-year term of the junior subordinated amortizing notes.
Loan Commitments and Related Financial Statements: Financial instruments include off-balance sheet credit instruments,
such as commitments to make loans and commercial letters of credit, issued to meet customer financing needs. The face
amount for these items represents the exposure to loss, before considering customer collateral or ability to repay. Such financial
instruments are recorded when they are funded.
Stock-Based Compensation: Compensation cost is recognized for stock appreciation rights, stock options and restricted stock
awards issued to employees and directors, based on the fair value of these awards at the date of grant. A Black-Scholes model is
utilized to estimate the fair value of stock options, while the market price of the Company’s common stock at the date of grant
is used for restricted stock awards. Compensation cost is recognized over the required service period, generally defined as the
vesting period. For awards with graded vesting, compensation cost is recognized on a straight-line basis over the requisite
service period for the entire award.
Income Taxes: Income tax expense is the total of the current year income tax due or refundable and the change in deferred tax
assets and liabilities. Deferred tax assets and liabilities are the expected future tax amounts for the temporary differences
between carrying amounts and tax bases of assets and liabilities, computed using enacted tax rates. A valuation allowance is
established when necessary to reduce deferred tax assets when it is more-likely-than-not that a portion or all of the net deferred
tax assets will not be realized. As of December 31, 2014, the Company had a net deferred tax asset of $16.4 million, net of a $0
valuation allowance and the Company had a net deferred tax asset of $0, net of a $17.3 million valuation allowance as of
December 31, 2013. The decrease in the valuation allowance against its federal and state deferred tax assets was due primarily
to current year taxable income, including strong core earnings and management’s projection of taxable income for future tax
years. See further discussion in Note 13.
The Company and its subsidiaries are subject to U.S. Federal income tax as well as income tax in multiple state jurisdictions.
The Company is no longer subject to examination by U.S. Federal taxing authorities for years before 2010, with the exception
of Gateway Bancorp, a predecessor entity, which is currently under exam by the Internal Revenue Service for the 2008 and
2009 tax years. The statute of limitations for the assessment of California Franchise taxes has expired for tax years before 2010;
other state income and franchise tax statutes of limitations vary by state.
Tax positions that are uncertain but meet a more likely than not recognition threshold are initially and subsequently measured
as the largest amount of tax benefit that has a greater than 50% likelihood of being realized upon settlement with a taxing
authority that has full knowledge of all relevant information. The determination of whether or not a tax position meets the more
likely than not recognition threshold considers the facts, circumstances and information available at the reporting date and is
subject to management's judgment. The Company recognizes interest and/or penalties related to income tax matters in income
tax expense. The Company had $23 thousand and $0 accrued for interest and penalties at December 31, 2014 and 2013,
respectively.
Earnings Per Common Share: Earnings per common share is computed under the two-class method. Basic earnings per
common share (EPS) is computed by dividing net income allocated to common stockholders by the weighted average number
of shares outstanding, including the minimum number of shares issuable under purchase contracts relating to the tangible
equity units (see the discussion of the tangible equity units in Note 18). Diluted EPS is computed by dividing net income
118
allocated to common stockholders by the weighted average number of shares outstanding, adjusted for the dilutive effect of the
restricted stock units, the potentially issuable shares in excess of the minimum under purchase contracts relating to the tangible
equity units, outstanding stock options, and warrants to purchase common stock. Net income allocated to common stockholders
is computed by subtracting income allocated to participating securities, participating securities dividends and preferred stock
dividend from net income. Participating securities are instruments granted in share-based payment transactions that contain
rights to receive nonforfeitable dividends or dividend equivalents, which includes the Stock Appreciation Rights to the extent
they confer dividend equivalent rights, as described under “Stock Appreciation Rights” in Note 16.
Comprehensive Income (Loss): Comprehensive income (loss) consists of net income (loss) and other comprehensive income
or loss. Other comprehensive income or loss includes unrealized gains and losses on securities available for sale and interest
rate swap, net of tax, which are recognized as a separate component of stockholders’ equity.
Accounting for Derivative Instruments and Hedging Activities: The Company records its derivative instruments at fair value
as either assets or liabilities on the Consolidated Statements of Financial Condition in other assets and accrued expenses and
other liabilities, respectively. The change in derivative instruments fair value is recorded in current earnings in Net Revenue on
Mortgage Banking Activities on the Consolidated Statements of Operations.
The Company enters into commitments to originate mortgage loans whereby the interest rate on the loan is set prior to funding
(interest rate lock commitments, or IRLCs). Interest rate lock commitments on mortgage loans that are intended to be sold are
considered derivatives and are recorded at fair value in Other Assets or Accrued Expenses and Other Liabilities on the
Consolidated Statements of Financial Condition with the change in fair value recorded in the Consolidated Statements of
Operations. The estimated fair value is based on current market prices for similar instruments.
The Company hedges the risk of the overall change in the fair value of loan commitments to borrowers by selling forward
contracts on securities of GSEs. Forward contracts on securities are considered derivative instruments. The Company has not
formally designated these derivatives as a qualifying hedge relationship and accordingly, accounts for such forward contracts as
freestanding derivatives with changes in fair value recorded to earnings each period.
Loss Contingencies: Loss contingencies, including claims and legal actions arising in the ordinary course of business, are
recorded as liabilities when the likelihood of loss is probable and an amount or range of loss can be reasonably estimated.
Management does not believe there now are such matters that will have a material effect on the consolidated financial
statements.
Dividend Restriction: Banking regulations require maintaining certain capital levels and may limit the dividends paid by the
Bank to the Company or by the Company to stockholders.
Fair Values of Financial Instruments: The Company measures certain assets and liabilities on a fair value basis, in accordance
with ASC Topic 820, "Fair Value Measurement". Fair value is used on a recurring basis for certain assets and liabilities in
which fair value is the primary basis of accounting. Examples of these include derivative instruments and available for sale
securities. Additionally, fair value is used on a non-recurring basis to evaluate assets or liabilities for impairment in accordance
with ASC Topic 825, "Financial Instruments". Examples of these include impaired loans, long-lived assets, OREO, goodwill,
and core deposit intangible assets as well as loans held for sale accounted for at the lower of cost or fair value.
Fair value is the exchange price that would be received for an asset or paid to transfer a liability in an orderly transaction
between market participants. When observable market prices are not available, fair value is estimated using modeling
techniques such as discounted cash flow analysis. These modeling techniques utilize assumptions that market participants
would use in pricing the asset or the liability, including assumptions about the risk inherent in a particular valuation technique,
the effect of a restriction on the sale or use of an asset, and the risk of nonperformance. Depending on the nature of the asset or
liability, the Company uses various valuation techniques and assumptions when estimating the instrument’s fair value.
Considerable judgment may be involved in determining the amount that is most representative of fair value.
To increase consistency and comparability of fair value measures, ASC Topic 820, "Fair Value Measurement" established a
three-level hierarchy to prioritize the inputs used in valuation techniques between observable inputs among (i) observable
inputs that reflect quoted prices in active markets, (ii) inputs other than quoted prices with observable market data, and (iii)
unobservable data such as the Company’s own data or single dealer non-binding pricing quotes. The Company assesses the
valuation hierarchy for each asset or liability measured at the end of each quarter, as a result assets or liabilities may be
transferred within hierarchy levels due to changes in availability of observable market inputs to measure fair value at the
measurement date. Further information regarding the Company's policies and methodology used to measure fair value is
presented in Note 3.
119
Transfer of Financial Assets: Transfers of financial assets are accounted for as sales when control over the assets has been
surrendered. Control over transferred assets is generally considered to have been surrendered when (i) the transferred assets are
legally isolated from the Company or its consolidated affiliates, even in bankruptcy or other receivership, (ii) the transferee has
the right to pledge or exchange the assets with no conditions that constrain the transferee and provide more than a trivial benefit
to the Company, and (iii) the Company does not maintain the obligation or unilateral ability to reclaim or repurchase the assets.
The Company sells financial assets in the normal course of business, the majority of which are residential mortgage loan sales
primarily to government-sponsored enterprises through established programs and other individual or portfolio loan and
securities sales. In accordance with accounting guidance for asset transfers, the Company considers any ongoing involvement
with transferred assets in determining whether the assets can be derecognized from the balance sheet. With the exception of
servicing and certain performance-based guarantees, the Company’s continuing involvement with financial assets sold is
minimal and generally limited to market customary representation and warranty clauses.
When the Company sells financial assets, it may retain servicing rights and/or other interests in the financial assets. The gain or
loss on sale depends on the previous carrying amount of the transferred financial assets and the consideration received and any
liabilities incurred in exchange for the transferred assets. Upon transfer, any servicing assets and other interests held by the
Company are carried at the lower of cost or fair value.
Fee Revenue: Generally, fee revenue from deposit service charges and loans is recognized when earned, except where ultimate
collection is uncertain, in which case revenue is recognized when received.
Marketing Costs: Marketing costs are expensed as incurred.
Investment Advisory Performance Fees: The Company’s SEC-registered investment advisor, The Palisades Group, receives
investment advisory performance fees from actively managed investment funds. Certain performance fees are not finalized
until the end of a period of time specified in the contracts. Such fees are recognized only to the extent that the amounts will not
be reversed due to clawback provisions.
Correction of Prior Period Errors: During the year ended December 31, 2014, the Company made cumulative prior period
(years ended December 31, 2013 and 2012) adjustments related to the provision for loan repurchases, the allowance for loan
and lease losses, restricted stock compensation expense, and other expenses, which increased the provision for loan repurchases
by $571 thousand, provision for loan and lease losses by $1.2 million, and other expense by $353 thousand, and decreased
stock compensation expense by $234 thousand. The Company reviewed the impact of these corrections in accordance with
Securities Exchange Commission Staff Accounting Bulletin No. 99 “Materiality”, and determined that the corrections were not
material to prior or current periods.
Adoption of New Accounting Standards
In January 2014, the FASB issued guidance within ASU 2014-1, “Accounting for Investments in Qualified Affordable Housing
Projects.” The amendments in ASU 2014-1to Topic 323, “Equity Investments and Joint Ventures,” provide guidance on
accounting for investments by a reporting entity in flow-through limited liability entities that manage or invest in affordable
housing projects that qualify for the low-income housing tax credit. The amendments permit reporting entities to make an
accounting policy election to account for their investments in qualified affordable housing projects using the proportional
amortization method if certain conditions are met. Under the proportional amortization method, an entity amortizes the initial
cost of the investment in proportion to the tax credits and other tax benefits received, and recognizes the net investment
performance in the income statement as a component of income tax expense (benefit). The amendments are effective for fiscal
years, and interim periods within those years, beginning after December 31, 2014 and should be applied retrospectively to all
periods presented. Early adoption is permitted. All of the Company’s affordable housing fund investments are within the scope
of this guidance. The Company does not expect the application of this guidance to have a material impact on the Company's
financial statements.
In January 2014, the FASB issued ASU No. 2014-4, “Reclassification of Residential Real Estate Collateralized Consumer
Mortgage Loans upon Foreclosure.” ASU 2014-4 clarifies that an in substance repossession or foreclosure has occurred, and a
creditor is considered to have received physical possession of residential real estate property collateralizing a consumer
mortgage loan, upon either the creditor obtaining legal title to the residential real estate property upon completion of a
foreclosure or the borrower conveying all interest in the residential real estate property to the creditor to satisfy that loan
through completion of a deed in lieu of foreclosure. Interim and annual disclosure is required of both the amount of foreclosed
residential real estate property held by the creditor and the recorded investment in consumer mortgage loans collateralized by
residential real estate property that are in the process of foreclosure. ASU 2014-4 is effective using either the modified
retrospective transition method or a prospective transition method for fiscal years and interim periods within those years,
120
beginning after December 15, 2014, and early adoption is permitted. The Company does not expect the application of this
guidance to have a material impact on the Company's financial statements.
In May 2014, the FASB issued ASU No. 2014-9, “Revenue From Contracts With Customers”, that outlines a single
comprehensive model for entities to use in accounting for revenue arising from contracts with customers and supersedes most
current revenue recognition guidance, including industry-specific guidance. The ASU is based on the principle that an entity
should recognize revenue to depict the transfer of goods or services to customers in an amount that reflects the consideration to
which the entity expects to be entitled in exchange for those goods or services. The ASU also requires additional disclosure
about the nature, amount, timing and uncertainty of revenue and cash flows arising from customer contracts, including
significant judgments and changes in judgments and assets recognized from costs incurred to fulfill a contract. Entities have the
option of using either a full retrospective or a modified retrospective approach for the adoption of the new standard. The ASU
becomes effective for Company at the beginning of its 2017 fiscal year; early adoption is not permitted. The Company is in the
process of evaluating the impact that adoption of this guidance may have on its consolidated financial statements.
In June 2014, the FASB issued ASU No. 2014-11, “Transfers and Servicing: Repurchase-to-Maturity Transactions, Repurchase
Financings, and Disclosures”. The ASU changes the accounting for repurchase-to-maturity transactions to secured borrowing
accounting. In addition, for repurchase financing arrangements, the amendments require separate accounting for a transfer of a
financial asset executed contemporaneously with a repurchase agreement with the same counterparty, which will result in
secured borrowing accounting for the repurchase agreement. The ASU also requires disclosures for certain transactions
comprising (1) a transfer of a financial asset accounted for as a sale and (2) an agreement with the same transferee entered into
in contemplation of the initial transfer that results in the transferor retaining substantially all of the exposure to the economic
return on the transferred financial asset throughout the term of the transaction. There are also additional disclosure requirements
for repurchase agreements, securities lending transactions, and repurchase-to-maturity transactions that are accounted for as
secured borrowings. ASU 2014-11 is effective using either the modified retrospective transition method or a prospective
transition method for fiscal years and interim periods within those years, beginning after December 15, 2014. The Company
does not expect the application of this guidance to have a material impact on the Company's financial statements.
In June 2014, the FASB issued ASU No. 2014-12, “Compensation—Stock Compensation (Topic 718): Accounting for Share-
Based Payments When the Terms of an Award Provide That a Performance Target Could Be Achieved after the Requisite
Service Period”. The ASU requires that a performance target that affects vesting and that could be achieved after the requisite
service period be treated as a performance condition. A reporting entity should apply existing guidance in Topic 718 as it relates
to awards with performance conditions that affect vesting to account for such awards. As such, the performance target should
not be reflected in estimating the grant-date fair value of the award. ASU 2014-12 is effective for annual periods and interim
periods within those annual periods beginning after December 15, 2015. The Company is in the process of evaluating the
impact that adoption of this guidance may have on its consolidated financial statements.
In August 2014, the FASB issued ASU 2014-14, “Receivables-Troubled Debt Restructurings by Creditors (Subtopic 310-40),
Classification of Certain Government-Guaranteed Mortgage Loans upon Foreclosure.” Under ASU 2014-14, a mortgage loan
should be derecognized and a separate receivable based on the principal and interest expected to be recovered from the
governmental guarantor should be recognized upon foreclosure when all of the following conditions exist: a government
guarantee exists that is not separable from the loan prior to the foreclosure; as of the date of the foreclosure the creditor has the
intent to convey the real estate to the governmental agency that issued the guarantee, to make a claim on the guarantee and the
creditor has the ability to recover amounts due from the governmental entity as a result of the claim; and, as of the time of the
foreclosure, the claim amount that is based on the fair value of the real estate is fixed. ASU 2014-14 is effective using either the
modified retrospective transition method or a prospective transition method for fiscal years and interim periods within those
years, beginning after December 15, 2014. The Company does not expect the application of this guidance to have a material
impact on the Company's financial statements.
121
NOTE 2 – BUSINESS COMBINATIONS AND BRANCH SALES
The Company completed the following acquisitions between January 1, 2012 and December 31, 2014 and used the acquisition
method of accounting. Accordingly, the operating results of the acquired entities have been included in the consolidated
financial statements from their respective dates of acquisition.
The following table presents a summary of acquired assets and assumed liabilities along with a summary of the acquisition
consideration as of the dates of acquisition:
Banco
Popular
Branches
Renovation
Ready
CS Financial
Acquisition and Date Acquired
The
Palisades
Group
Private Bank
of California
November 8,
2014
January 31,
2014
October 31,
2013
September 10,
2013
July 1,
2013
Gateway
Bancorp
August 18,
2012
Beach
Business
Bank
July 1,
2012
(In thousands)
$
5,532
$
— $
482
$
900
$
33,752
$
1,783
$
Assets acquired
Cash and due from banks
Interest-bearing deposits
Federal funds sold
Securities available for sale
Loans held for sale
—
—
—
—
Loans and leases receivable
1,072,449
Federal Home Loan Bank and
other bank stock, at cost
Servicing rights
Premises, equipment, and
capital leases
Income tax receivable
Goodwill
Other intangible assets
Other assets
—
—
9,002
—
—
15,777
2,301
$
$
$
$
Total assets acquired
$ 1,105,061
Liabilities assumed
Deposits
Advances from Federal Home
Loan Bank
Other liabilities
$ 1,076,614
—
506
Total liabilities assumed
1,077,120
SBLF preferred stock assumed
Total consideration paid
Summary of consideration
Cash paid
Common stock issued
Replacement awards
Stock warrants issued
Noninterest-bearing note
Performance based equity
Earn-out liabilities
—
27,941
27,941
$
$
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
2,239
761
—
—
—
—
4,982
—
—
—
704
—
7,178
690
608
5
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
364
—
—
219,298
—
—
35,090
76
—
5,867
4,674
55,478
5,661
—
385,256
131,322
229,722
—
—
1,501
682
15,126
10,400
6,578
940
1,636
741
—
—
1,675
4,702
1,554
—
709
—
7,048
4,495
3,831
$
$
177,965
142,995
$
$
319,039
271,320
3,000
$
14,644
$
1,269
$
672,593
— $
— $
— $
561,890
$
$
—
1,000
1,000
—
2,000
1,000
1,000
—
—
—
—
1,000
$
$
—
6,722
6,722
—
7,922
1,500
1,964
—
—
3,150
1,308
—
—
1,219
1,219
41,833
2,481
—
7,940
—
7,565
606,204
150,935
278,885
—
50
50
—
—
—
—
—
—
$
$
10,000
56,389
28,077
28,282
$
$
30
—
—
—
—
—
15,403
15,403
$
$
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
40,154
39,145
—
—
1,009
—
—
—
122
Banco Popular’s California Branch Network Acquisition
Effective November 8, 2014, the Bank acquired 20 full-service branches from Banco Popular North America (BPNA) in the
Southern California banking market, as contemplated by the Purchase and Assumption Agreement between the Bank and
BPNA dated as of April 22, 2014 (the Purchase Agreement). The purchase price, net of deposit premiums received of $3.9
million, was $24.0 million. The transaction added $1.07 billion in loans and $1.08 billion in deposits to the Bank.
The following table summarizes the total consideration transferred as a part of the BPNA Branch Acquisition as well as the fair
value adjustments to the BPNA balance sheet as of the respective acquisition date:
Total Consideration
Net assets pre-acquisition
Fair value adjustments
Loans receivable
Core Deposit Intangibles
Certificates of deposit purchase premium
Premises and equipment
Total fair value adjustments
Fair value of net assets acquired
Net fair value in excess of consideration
November 8, 2014
(In thousands)
$
(12,165)
15,777
(916)
1,218
$
$
27,941
24,027
3,914
27,941
—
The fair value of loans acquired from BPNA was estimated by utilizing a methodology wherein similar loans were aggregated
into pools. Cash flows for each pool were determined by estimating future credit losses and the rate of prepayments. Projected
monthly cash flows were then discounted to present value based on a market rate for similar loans. There was no carryover of
BPNA's allowance for loan losses associated with the acquired loans as the loans were initially recorded at fair value.
Core deposit intangible asset of $15.8 million recognized as part of the BPNA Branch Acquisition was valued using a net cost
savings method and was calculated as the present value of the estimated net cost savings attributable to the core deposit base
over the expected remaining life of the deposits. The cost savings derived from the core deposit balance was calculated as the
difference between the prevailing alternative cost of funds and the estimated actual cost of the core deposits. The core deposit
intangible is being amortized over its estimated useful life of ten years using the sum of years-digits amortization methodology.
The fair value of savings and transaction deposit accounts acquired from BPNA was assumed to approximate the carrying value
as these accounts have no stated maturity and are payable on demand. Certificates of deposit were valued by projecting out the
expected cash flows based on the remaining contractual terms of the certificates of deposit. These cash flows were discounted
based on market rates for certificates of deposit with corresponding remaining maturities.
Direct costs related to the BPNA Branch Acquisition were expensed as incurred and amounted to $4.3 million for the year
ended December 31, 2014. These acquisition integration expenses included technology costs related to system conversion and
professional fees.
Certain valuations related to acquired loans receivable, premises and equipment, and other intangible assets and assumed
deposits are still under review by management and considered preliminary and could differ significantly when management's
review is finalized.
RenovationReady® Acquisition
Effective January 31, 2014, the Company acquired certain assets, including service contracts and intellectual property, of
RenovationReady, a provider of specialized loan services to financial institutions and mortgage bankers that originate agency
eligible residential renovation and construction loan products.
The purchased identifiable intangible assets and assumed liabilities were recorded at their estimated fair values as of
January 31, 2014. The Company recorded $2.2 million of goodwill and $761 thousand of other intangible assets. The other
intangible assets are related to a customer relationship intangible.
123
CS Financial Acquisition
Effective October 31, 2013, the Company acquired CS Financial, Inc. (CS Financial), a California corporation and Southern
California-based mortgage banking firm controlled by former Company director and current Bank executive Jeffrey T. Seabold.
As a result of the acquisition, CS Financial became a wholly owned subsidiary of the Bank. For additional information
regarding this transaction, see Note 25.
The purchased assets, including identifiable intangible assets, and assumed liabilities were recorded at their estimated fair
values as of October 31, 2013. The Company recorded $7.2 million of goodwill and $690 thousand of other intangible assets.
The other intangible assets are related to a trade name intangible.
The Palisades Group, LLC Acquisition
Effective September 10, 2013, the Company acquired The Palisades Group, a Delaware limited liability company and a
registered investment adviser under the Investment Advisers Act of 1940, pursuant to the terms of the Amended and Restated
Units Purchase Agreement dated as of November 30, 2012, amended and restated as of August 12, 2013, for $50 thousand. The
Palisades Group provides financial advisory and asset management services to third parties, including the Bank, with respect to
the purchase, sale and management of portfolios of residential mortgage loans.
The Palisades Group acquisition was accounted for under GAAP guidance for business combinations. The assets and liabilities
were recorded at their estimated fair values as of the September 10, 2013 acquisition date. No goodwill was recognized.
The Private Bank of California Acquisition
Effective July 1, 2013, the Company completed its acquisition of The Private Bank of California, (PBOC) pursuant to the terms
of the Agreement and Plan of Merger, dated as of August 21, 2012, as amended (the PBOC Merger Agreement), by and
between the Company, Beach Business Bank (Beach) (then a separate subsidiary bank of the Company) and PBOC. PBOC
merged with and into Beach, with Beach continuing as the surviving entity in the merger and a wholly owned subsidiary of the
Company, and changing its name to “The Private Bank of California.” On October 11, 2013, The Private Bank of California
was merged with the Company’s other wholly owned banking subsidiary, Banc of California, National Association (formerly
Pacific Trust Bank), to form the Bank.
Pursuant to the terms of the PBOC Merger Agreement, the Company paid aggregate merger consideration of (1) 2,082,654
shares of Company common stock (valued at $28.3 million based on the $13.58 per share closing price of Company common
stock on July 1, 2013), and (2) $25.4 million in cash. Additionally, the Company paid $2.7 million for the cancellation of
certain outstanding options to acquire PBOC common stock in accordance with the PBOC Merger Agreement and converted
the remaining outstanding PBOC stock options to Company stock options with an assumed fair value of approximately $30
thousand. On the basis of the number of shares of PBOC common stock issued and outstanding immediately prior to the
completion of the merger, each outstanding share of PBOC common stock was converted into the right to receive $6.52 in cash
and 0.5379 shares of Company common stock.
In addition, upon completion of the acquisition, each share of preferred stock issued by PBOC as part of the Small Business
Lending Fund (SBLF) program of the United States Department of Treasury (10,000 shares in the aggregate with a liquidation
preference amount of $1,000 per share) was converted automatically into one substantially identical share of preferred stock of
the Company. The terms of the preferred stock issued by the Company in exchange for the PBOC preferred stock are
substantially identical to the preferred stock previously issued by the Company as part of its own participation in the SBLF
program (32,000 shares in aggregate with a liquidation preference amount of $1,000 per share).
PBOC provided a range of financial services, including credit and deposit products as well as cash management services, from
its headquarters located in the Century City area of Los Angeles, California as well as full-service branches in Hollywood and
Irvine, and a loan production office in downtown Los Angeles. PBOC’s target clients included high-net worth and high income
individuals, business professionals and their professional service firms, business owners, entertainment service businesses and
non-profit organizations.
In accordance with GAAP guidance for business combinations, the Company expensed approximately $2.6 million of direct
acquisition costs, all of which were recognized in 2013, and recorded $15.1 million of goodwill and $10.4 million of other
intangible assets. The other intangible assets are primarily related to core deposits and are being amortized on an accelerated
basis over 2-7 years. Loans acquired from PBOC that were considered credit impaired were written down to fair value at the
acquisition date in accordance with purchase accounting. In addition, the allowance for loan losses for all PBOC loans was not
carried over to the Company’s allowance for loan and lease losses. A full valuation allowance for the deferred tax asset was
124
recorded based on management’s evaluation of the expectation of recovery of deferred tax assets for the Company. For tax
purposes, purchase accounting adjustments, including goodwill are all nontaxable and/or non-deductible.
Gateway Bancorp Acquisition
Effective August 18, 2012, the Company acquired Gateway Bancorp, the holding company of Gateway Business Bank
(Gateway) pursuant to the terms of the Stock Purchase Agreement (the Purchase Agreement) dated June 3, 2011, as amended
on November 28, 2011, February 24, 2012, June 30, 2012, and July 31, 2012. The acquisition was accomplished by the
Company’s purchase of all of the outstanding stock of Gateway Bancorp, followed by the merger of Gateway into the Bank.
Under the terms of the Purchase Agreement, the Company purchased all of the issued and outstanding shares of Gateway
Bancorp for $15.4 million in cash.
Gateway operated branches in Lakewood and Laguna Hills, California. As part of the acquisition, Mission Hills Mortgage
Bankers, a division of Gateway, including its 22 loan production offices in California, Arizona, Oregon and Washington,
became a part of the Bank’s mortgage banking operations. Gateway’s consolidated assets and equity as of August 17, 2012
totaled $178.0 million and $27.0 million, respectively. The acquired assets and liabilities were recorded at fair value at the date
of acquisition.
In accordance with GAAP guidance for business combinations, the Company recorded $11.6 million of bargain purchase gain
and $1.7 million of other intangible assets during the year ended December 31, 2012. The other intangible assets are related to
$720 thousand of core deposits, which are being amortized on an accelerated basis over 4 - 6 years, and $955 thousand of trade
name intangible which is being amortized over 20 years. For tax purposes the purchase accounting adjustments and bargain
purchase gain are non-taxable and/or non-deductible. Due to circumstances that Gateway faced at the time the acquisition was
negotiated, which include regulatory orders and operating losses, the terms negotiated included a purchase price that was $5
million lower than Gateway Bancorp’s equity book value. The discount was further increased to $6.5 million in exchange for
the elimination of any contingent liability to the stockholder of Gateway Bancorp related to mortgage repurchase risk. Due to
delays in obtaining regulatory approval, the transaction closed nine months later than originally planned. This passage of time
allowed Gateway to eliminate all regulatory orders, return to profitability, improve asset quality, and increase the book value of
equity by reducing the expected discount on assets. As a result, a bargain purchase gain of $11.6 million resulted at the time of
purchase.
Beach Business Bank Acquisition
Effective July 1, 2012, the Company acquired Beach Business Bank pursuant to the terms of the Agreement and Plan of Merger
(the Merger Agreement) dated August 30, 2011, as amended October 31, 2011. At the effective time of the transaction, a newly
formed and wholly owned subsidiary of the Company (Merger Sub) merged with and into Beach (the Merger), with Beach
continuing as the surviving entity in the Merger and a wholly owned subsidiary of the Company. Pursuant and subject to the
terms of the Merger Agreement, each outstanding share of Beach common stock (other than specified shares owned by the
Company, Merger Sub or Beach, and other than in the case of shares in respect of, or underlying, certain Beach options and
other equity awards, which were treated as set forth in the Merger Agreement) was converted into the right to receive $9.21415
in cash and one warrant. Each warrant entitled the holder to purchase 0.33 of a share of Company common stock at an exercise
price of $14.00 per share for a period of one year. The aggregate cash consideration paid to Beach stockholders in the Merger
was approximately $39.1 million. In addition, Beach stockholders received in aggregate warrants to purchase the equivalent of
1,401,959 shares of the Company’s common stock with an estimated fair value of $1.0 million. All of the warrants expired on
June 30, 2013 without being exercised.
Beach (re-named The Private Bank of California effective July 1, 2013 and merged with Pacific Trust Bank on October 11,
2013 to form the Bank) operated branches in Manhattan Beach, Long Beach, and Costa Mesa, California. Beach also had a
division named The Doctors Bank®, which serves physicians and dentists nationwide. Additionally, Beach provided loans to
small businesses based on Small Business Administration (SBA) lending programs. Beach’s consolidated assets and equity
(unaudited) as of June 30, 2012 totaled $311.9 million and $33.3 million, respectively. The acquired assets and liabilities were
recorded at fair value at the date of acquisition.
In accordance with GAAP guidance for business combinations, the Company recorded $7.0 million of goodwill and $4.5
million of other intangible assets during the year ended December 31, 2012. The other intangible assets are primarily related to
core deposits and are being amortized on an accelerated basis over 2 - 7 years. For tax purposes purchase accounting
adjustments, including goodwill are all non-taxable and/or non-deductible.
125
Unaudited Pro Forma Information
While the BPNA Branch Acquisition is considered a purchase of a business for accounting purposes, pro forma income
statement information is not presented because the BPNA Branch Acquisition does not represent the acquisition of a business
which has continuity both before and after the acquisition. Pro formation income statement information for RenovationReady is
not presented because it is immaterial.
The following table presents unaudited pro forma information as if the acquisitions of PBOC, The Palisades Group, and CS
Financial had occurred on January 1, 2013 and 2012 after giving effect to certain adjustments. The unaudited pro forma
information for the years ended December 31, 2013 and 2012 includes adjustments for interest income on loans and securities
acquired, amortization of intangibles arising from the transaction, interest expense on deposits and borrowings acquired, and
the related income tax effects.
Net interest income
Provision for loan and lease losses
Noninterest income
Noninterest expense
Income before income taxes
Income tax expense
Net income
Preferred stock dividends
Net income (loss) available to common stockholders
Basic earnings (loss) per total common share
Diluted earnings (loss) per total common share
Year Ended December 31,
2013
2012
(In thousands, except per share data)
$
107,607
$
8,822
118,459
208,082
9,162
8,252
910
2,185
$
$
$
(1,275) $
(0.08) $
(0.08) $
67,249
7,013
64,701
113,091
11,846
2,522
9,324
1,359
7,965
0.56
0.56
The above unaudited pro forma financial information for 2013 and 2012 includes the pre-acquisition periods for PBOC, The
Palisades Group, and CS Financial. The above unaudited pro forma financial information includes pre-acquisition provisions
for loan and lease losses recognized by PBOC and CS Financial of $859 thousand and $1.5 million for the years ended
December 31, 2013 and 2012, respectively. The above pro forma financial information does not include cost saves or
integration costs and may not be reflective of what the actual results would have been for the applicable period had the
transaction occurred at the beginning of the period.
The following table presents unaudited pro forma information as if the acquisitions of Gateway and Beach had occurred on
January 1, 2012 and 2011 after giving effect to certain adjustments. The unaudited pro forma information for the years ended
December 31, 2012 and 2011 includes adjustments for interest income on loans and securities acquired, amortization of
intangibles arising from the transaction, interest expense on deposits and borrowings acquired, and the related income tax
effects.
Net interest income
Provision for loan and lease losses
Noninterest income
Noninterest expense
Income before income taxes
Income tax expense
Net income
Preferred stock dividends
Net income (loss) available to common stockholders
Basic earnings (loss) per total common share
Diluted earnings (loss) per total common share
126
Year Ended December 31,
2012
2011
(In thousands, except per share data)
$
57,921
$
6,350
54,918
106,260
229
2,529
(2,300)
1,359
$
$
$
(3,659) $
(0.33) $
(0.33) $
49,534
6,062
34,465
83,043
(5,106)
(1,172)
(3,934)
534
(4,468)
(0.45)
(0.45)
The above unaudited pro forma financial information for 2013 and 2012 includes the pre-acquisition periods for Gateway and
Beach. The above unaudited pro forma financial information includes pre-acquisition provisions for loan and lease losses
recognized by Gateway and Beach of $850 thousand and $674 thousand for the years ended December 31, 2012 and 2011,
respectively. Excluded from the above pro forma financials for the year ended December 31, 2012 is the bargain purchase gain
of $11.6 million related to the Gateway acquisition. The above pro forma financial information does not include cost saves or
integration costs and may not be reflective of what the actual results would have been for the applicable period had the
transaction occurred at the beginning of the period.
Branch Sales
On October 4, 2013, the Bank sold eight branches and related assets and deposit liabilities to a Washington state chartered bank
(AWB). The transaction was completed with a transfer of $464.3 million deposits to AWB in exchange for a deposit premium
of 2.3 percent. Certain other assets related to the branches include the real estate for three of the branch locations and certain
overdraft and other credit facilities related to the deposit accounts. The Company recognized a gain of $12.6 million from this
transaction, of which $12.1 million was recognized in 2013.
127
NOTE 3 – FAIR VALUES OF FINANCIAL INSTRUMENTS
Fair Value Hierarchy
ASC 820-10 establishes a fair value hierarchy which requires an entity to maximize the use of observable inputs and minimize
the use of unobservable inputs when measuring fair value. The topic describes three levels of inputs that may be used to
measure fair value:
• Level 1: Quoted prices (unadjusted) for identical assets or liabilities in active markets that the entity has the ability to
access as of the measurement date.
• Level 2: Significant observable inputs other than Level 1 prices such as quoted prices for similar assets or liabilities;
quoted prices in markets that are not active; or other inputs that are observable or can be corroborated by observable
market data.
• Level 3: Significant unobservable inputs that reflect a reporting entity’s own assumptions about the assumptions that
market participants would use in pricing an asset or liability.
Categorization within the valuation hierarchy is based upon the lowest level of input that is significant to the fair value
measurement.
Assets and Liabilities Measured on a Recurring Basis
Securities Available for Sale: The fair values of securities available for sale are generally determined by quoted market prices in
active market, if available (Level 1). If quoted market prices are not available, the Company employs an independent pricing
service that utilizes matrix pricing to calculate fair value. Such fair value measurements consider observable data such as dealer
quotes, market spreads, cash flows, yield curves, live trading levels, trade execution data, market consensus prepayments
speeds, credit information, and respective terms and conditions for debt instruments. The Company employs procedures to
monitor the pricing service's assumptions and establishes processes to challenge the pricing service's valuations that appear
unusual or unexpected. Level 2 securities include SBA loan pool securities, U.S. GSE and agency securities, Private label
residential MBS, and Agency MBS. When a market is illiquid or there is a lack of transparency around the inputs to valuation,
the securities are classified as Level 3 and reliance is placed upon internally developed models, and management judgment and
evaluation for valuation. The Company had no securities available for sale classified as Level 3 at December 31, 2014 and
2013.
Loans Held for Sale, carried at fair value: The fair value of loans held for sale is based on commitments outstanding from
investors as well as what secondary markets are currently offering for portfolios with similar characteristics. Therefore, loans
held for sale subjected to recurring fair value adjustments are classified as Level 2. The fair value includes the servicing value
of the loans as well as any accrued interest.
Derivative Assets and Liabilities: The Company’s derivative assets and liabilities are carried at fair value as required by GAAP
and are accounted for as freestanding derivatives. The Company has entered into pay-fixed, receive-variable interest rate swap
contracts with institutional counterparties to hedge against variability in cash flow attributable to interest rate risk caused by
changes in the LIBOR benchmark interest rate on the Company’s ongoing LIBOR-based variable rate deposits. The Company
is accounting for the swaps as cash flow hedges under ASC 815. The other derivative assets are interest rate lock commitments
(IRLCs) with prospective residential mortgage borrowers. These commitments are carried at fair value based on the fair value
of the underling mortgage loans which are based on observable market data. The Company adjusts the outstanding IRLCs with
prospective borrowers based on an expectation that it will be exercised and the loan will be funded. Changes in fair value are
recorded in earnings as a component of net revenue on mortgage banking activities. These commitments are classified as Level
2 in the fair value disclosures, as the valuations are based on market observable inputs. Additional derivative assets and
liabilities, typically mortgage-backed to-be-announced (TBA) securities, are used to hedge fair value changes, driven by
changes in interest rates, on the Company’s mortgage assets. The Company hedges the period from the interest rate lock
(assuming a fall-out factor) to the date of the loan sale. The estimated fair value is based on current market prices for similar
instruments. Given the meaningful level of secondary market activity for derivative contracts, active pricing is available for
similar assets and accordingly, the Company classifies its derivative assets and liabilities as Level 2.
Mortgage Servicing Rights: The Company retains servicing on some of its mortgage loans sold and elected the fair value option
for valuation of these mortgage servicing rights (MSRs). The value is based on a third party provider that calculates the present
value of the expected net servicing income from the portfolio based on key factors that include interest rates, prepayment
assumptions, discount rate and estimated cash flows. Because of the significance of unobservable inputs, these servicing rights
are classified as Level 3. At December 31, 2014, $5.9 million of the mortgage servicing rights is valued based on a market bid
that settled subsequent to year end, which is included as Level 3.
128
The following table presents the Company’s financial assets and liabilities measured at fair value on a recurring basis as of the
dates indicated:
Fair Value Measurement Level
Quoted Prices
in Active
Markets
for Identical
Assets
(Level 1)
Significant
Other
Observable
Inputs
(Level 2)
Significant
Unobservable
Inputs
(Level 3)
(In thousands)
Carrying
Value
December 31, 2014
Assets
Available-for-sale securities:
SBA loan pools securities
U.S. government-sponsored entities and agency
securities
Private label residential mortgage-backed securities
Agency mortgage-backed securities
Loans held for sale, carried at fair value
Derivative assets (1)
Mortgage servicing rights (2)
Liabilities
Derivative liabilities (3)
December 31, 2013
Assets
Available-for-sale securities:
SBA loan pools securities
$
1,715
$
— $
1,715
$
1,982
3,168
338,830
278,749
6,379
19,082
3,235
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
1,982
3,168
338,830
278,749
6,379
—
3,235
$
1,736
$
— $
1,736
$
U.S. government-sponsored entities and agency
securities
Private label residential mortgage-backed securities
Agency mortgage-backed securities
Loans held for sale, carried at fair value
Derivative assets (1)
Mortgage servicing rights (2)
Liabilities
Derivative liabilities (3)
1,920
14,752
151,614
192,613
5,493
13,535
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
1,920
14,752
151,614
192,613
5,493
—
—
(1) Included in Other Assets on the Consolidated Statements of Financial Condition
(2) Included in Servicing Rights, Net and Servicing Rights Held For Sale on the Consolidated Statements of Financial Condition
(3) Included in Accrued Expenses and Other Liabilities on the Consolidated Statements of Financial Condition
—
—
—
—
—
—
19,082
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
13,535
—
129
The following table presents a reconciliation of assets measured at fair value on a recurring basis using significant
unobservable inputs (Level 3) for the periods indicated:
Balance at December 31, 2011
Transfers out of Level 3 (1)
Total gains or losses (realized/unrealized):
Included in earnings-realized
Included in earnings-fair value adjustment
Included in other comprehensive income
Amortization of premium (discount)
Additions
Sales and settlements
Balance at December 31, 2012
Transfers out of Level 3 (1)
Total gains or losses (realized/unrealized):
Included in earnings-realized
Included in earnings-fair value adjustment
Included in other comprehensive income
Amortization of premium (discount)
Additions
Sales and settlements
Balance at December 31, 2013
Transfers out of Level 3 (1)
Total gains or losses (realized/unrealized):
Included in earnings-realized
Included in earnings-fair value adjustment
Included in other comprehensive income
Amortization of premium (discount)
Additions
Sales and settlements
Balance at December 31, 2014
Private
Label
Residential
Mortgage
Backed
Securities
$
76,203
$
(56,767)
(83)
—
(2,173)
(196)
—
(14,770)
2,214
$
— $
—
—
—
—
—
(2,214)
— $
— $
—
—
—
—
—
—
$
$
$
$
Mortgage
Servicing
Rights
(In thousands)
Total
— $
—
—
(42)
—
—
1,975
(194)
1,739
$
— $
—
1,360
—
—
11,463
(1,027)
13,535
$
— $
—
(233)
—
—
26,399
(20,619)
76,203
(56,767)
(83)
(42)
(2,173)
(196)
1,975
(14,964)
3,953
—
—
1,360
—
—
11,463
(3,241)
13,535
—
—
(233)
—
—
26,399
(20,619)
19,082
$
— $
19,082
$
(1) The Company’s policy is to recognize transfers in and transfers out as of the actual date of the event or change in circumstances that
cause the transfer.
130
The following table presents quantitative information about Level 3 fair value measurements on a recurring basis as of the dates
indicated:
Fair Value
(In thousands)
Valuation Technique(s)
Unobservable Input(s)
Range (Weighted Average)
December 31, 2014
Mortgage servicing rights
December 31, 2013
Mortgage servicing rights
December 31, 2012
Mortgage servicing rights
Private label residential
mortgage-backed securities
$
$
$
$
13,135 Discounted cash flow
Discount rate
9.00% to 19.50% (10.09%)
Prepayment rate
4.59% to 31.02% (13.22%)
13,535 Discounted cash flow
Discount rate
10.00% to 17.94% (10.26%)
Prepayment rate
4.19% to 34.54% (9.85%)
1,739 Discounted cash flow
Discount rate
10.5% to 11.5% (10.5%)
2,214 Discounted cash flow
Voluntary prepayment rate
3.15% to 8.00% (5.80%)
Prepayment rate
4.3% to 35.3% (13.8%)
Collateral default rate
8.46% to 8.56% (8.5%)
Loss severity at default
55%
The significant unobservable inputs used in the fair value measurement of the Company’s servicing rights include the discount
rate and estimated cash flow. There may be inherent weaknesses in any calculation technique, and changes in the underlying
assumptions used, including discount rates and estimates of future cash flows, could significantly affect the results.
Assets and Liabilities Measured on a Non-Recurring Basis
Impaired Loans and Leases: The fair value of impaired loans and leases with specific allocations of the allowance for loan and
lease losses based on collateral values is generally based on recent real estate appraisals. These appraisals may utilize a single
valuation approach or a combination of approaches including comparable sales and the income approach. Adjustments are
routinely made in the appraisal process by the appraisers to adjust for differences between the comparable sales and income
data available. Such adjustments are typically significant and result in a Level 3 classification of the inputs for determining fair
value.
Loans Held for Sale, carried at lower of cost or fair value: The Company records non-conforming jumbo mortgage loans held
for sale at the lower of cost or fair value. The Company obtains fair values from a third party independent valuation service
provider. Loans held for sale are accounted for at the lower of cost or market and are considered to be recognized at fair value
when they are recorded at below cost and are classified as Level 2.
SBA Servicing Assets: SBA servicing assets represents the value associated with servicing SBA loans that have been sold. The
fair value for SBA servicing assets is determined through discounted cash flow analysis and utilizes discount rates and
prepayment speed assumptions as inputs. All of these assumptions require a significant degree of management estimation and
judgment. The fair market valuation is performed on a quarterly basis for SBA servicing assets. SBA servicing assets are
account for at the lower of cost or market and considered to be recognized at fair value when they are recorded at below cost
and are classified as Level 3.
Other Real Estate Owned Assets: Other real estate owned assets (OREO) are recorded at the fair value less estimated costs to
sell at the time of foreclosure. The fair value of other real estate owned assets is generally based on recent real estate appraisals
adjusted for estimated selling costs. These appraisals may utilize a single valuation approach or a combination of approaches
including comparable sales and the income approach. Adjustments are routinely made in the appraisal process by the appraisers
to adjust for differences between the comparable sales and income data available. Such adjustments may be significant and
result in a Level 3 classification of the inputs for determining fair value. Only OREO with a valuation allowance are considered
to be carried at fair value. For the years ended December 31, 2014, 2013 and 2012, the Company experienced $32 thousand,
$97 thousand and $703 thousand in valuation allowance expense for those assets, respectively.
Alternative Investments (Affordable Housing Fund Investment & SBIC): The Company generally accounts for its percentage
ownership of alternative investment funds at cost, subject to impairment testing. These are non-public investments that cannot
be redeemed since the Company’s investment is distributed as the underlying investments are liquidated, which generally takes
10 years. There are currently no plans to sell any of these investments prior to their liquidation. The alternative investments
carried at cost are considered to be measured at fair value on a non-recurring basis when there is impairment. The Company has
131
unfunded commitments of $487 thousand and $4.7 million for Affordable House Fund Investment and SBIC as of December
31, 2014, respectively.
The following table presents the Company’s financial assets and liabilities measured at fair value on a non-recurring basis as of
the dates indicated:
Fair Value Measurement Level
Quoted Prices
in Active
Markets
for Identical
Assets
(Level 1)
Significant
Other
Observable
Inputs
(Level 2)
Significant
Unobservable
Inputs
(Level 3)
(In thousands)
Carrying
Value
December 31, 2014
Assets
Impaired loans:
Single family residential mortgage
Commercial and industrial
SBA servicing assets
Other real estate owned:
Single family residential
December 31, 2013
Assets
Impaired loans:
$
6,206
$
— $
— $
4,313
484
423
—
—
—
—
—
—
Single family residential mortgage
$
12,814
$
— $
8,769
$
Commercial real estate
Multi-family
Other consumer
Commercial and industrial
SBA
3,868
1,972
249
33
10
—
—
—
—
—
105
—
216
—
—
6,206
4,313
484
423
4,045
3,763
1,972
33
33
10
The Company did not have any other real estate owned and SBA servicing assets were recorded at cost at December 31, 2013.
The following table presents the gains and (losses) recognized on assets measured at fair value on a non-recurring basis for the
periods indicated:
Impaired loans:
Single family residential mortgage
Commercial real estate
Multi-family
SBA
Other consumer
SBA servicing assets
Other real estate owned
Year Ended December 31,
2014
2013
2012
(In thousands)
$
(375) $
(1,143) $
88
—
—
(2)
(42)
34
—
(465)
—
(2)
—
367
(1,890)
(987)
—
—
—
—
(239)
132
The following table presents the carrying amounts and estimated fair values of financial assets and liabilities as of the dates
indicated:
Carrying
Amount
Fair Value Measurement Level
Level 1
Level 2
Level 3
Total
(In thousands)
December 31, 2014
Financial assets
Cash and cash equivalents
$
231,199
$
231,199
$
Time deposits in financial institutions
Securities available for sale
FHLB and other bank stock
Loans held for sale
Loans and leases receivable, net of allowance
Accrued interest receivable
Derivative assets
Financial liabilities
Deposits
Advances from Federal Home Loan Bank
Notes payable
Derivative liabilities
Accrued interest payable
December 31, 2013
Financial assets
1,900
345,695
42,241
1,187,090
3,919,642
15,113
6,379
4,671,831
633,000
93,569
3,235
2,044
1,900
—
—
—
—
15,113
—
—
—
87,428
—
2,044
Cash and cash equivalents
$
110,118
$
110,118
$
Time deposits in financial institutions
Securities available for sale
FHLB and other bank stock
Loans held for sale
Loans and leases receivable, net of allowance
Accrued interest receivable
Derivative assets
Financial liabilities
Deposits
Advances from Federal Home Loan Bank
Notes payable
Derivative liabilities
Accrued interest payable
1,846
170,022
22,600
716,733
2,427,306
10,866
5,493
2,918,644
250,000
82,320
—
1,646
1,846
—
—
—
—
10,866
—
—
—
85,564
—
1,646
The methods and assumptions used to estimate fair value are described as follows:
— $
—
345,695
42,241
1,195,834
—
—
6,379
— $
231,199
—
—
—
—
4,045,465
—
—
1,900
345,695
42,241
1,195,834
4,045,465
15,113
6,379
—
4,575,264
4,575,264
633,083
13,360
3,235
—
— $
—
170,022
22,600
719,496
—
—
5,493
2,877,650
250,090
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
633,083
100,788
3,235
2,044
— $
110,118
—
—
—
—
1,846
170,022
22,600
719,496
2,460,953
2,460,953
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
10,866
5,493
2,877,650
250,090
85,564
—
1,646
Cash and cash equivalents and time deposits in financial institutions: The carrying amounts of cash and cash equivalents and
time deposits in financial institutions approximate fair value due to the short-term nature of these instruments (Level 1).
FHLB and other bank stock: FHLB and other bank stock is recorded at cost. Ownership of FHLB stock is restricted to member
banks, and purchases and sales of these securities are at par value with the issuer.
Loans and leases receivable, net of allowance for loan and lease losses: The fair value for loans receivable is estimated based
on the discounted cash flow approach. The discount rate was derived from the associated yield curve plus spreads and reflects
the offering rates offered by the Bank for loans with similar financial characteristics. Yield curves are constructed by product
and payment types. These rates could be different from what other financial institutions could offer for these loans. No
adjustments have been made for changes in credit within the loan portfolio. Additionally, the fair value of our loans may differ
significantly from the values that would have been used had a ready market existed for such loans and may differ materially
from the values that we may ultimately realize (Level 3).
133
Accrued interest receivable: The carrying amount of accrued interest receivable approximates its fair value (Level 1).
Deposits: The fair value of deposits is estimated based on discounted cash flows. The cash flows for non-maturity deposits,
including savings accounts and money market checking, are estimated based on their historical decaying experiences. The
discount rate used for fair valuation is based on interest rates currently being offered by the Bank on comparable deposits as to
amount and term (Level 3).
Advances from Federal Home Loan Bank: The fair value of advances from FHLB is estimated based on the discounted cash
flows approach. The discount rate was derived from the current market rates for borrowings with similar remaining maturities
(Level 2).
Accrued interest payable: The carrying amount of accrued interest payable approximates its fair value (Level 1).
134
NOTE 4 – SECURITIES AVAILABLE FOR SALE
The following table presents the amortized cost and fair value of the available-for-sale investment securities portfolio and the
corresponding amounts of gross unrealized gains and losses recognized in accumulated other comprehensive income (loss) as
of the dates indicated:
Amortized
Cost
Gross
Unrealized
Gains
Gross
Unrealized
Losses
(In thousands)
Fair Value
December 31, 2014
Available for sale
SBA loan pool securities
U.S. government-sponsored entities and agency securities
Private label residential mortgage-backed securities
Agency mortgage-backed securities
Total securities available for sale
December 31, 2013
Available for sale
SBA loan pool securities
U.S. government-sponsored entities and agency securities
Private label residential mortgage-backed securities
Agency mortgage-backed securities
Total securities available for sale
$
$
$
$
1,697
$
1,940
3,169
338,072
344,878
$
18
42
12
1,363
1,435
$
$
— $
—
(13)
(605)
(618) $
1,794
$
— $
(58) $
1,928
14,653
153,134
171,509
$
—
135
299
434
(8)
(36)
(1,819)
$
(1,921) $
1,715
1,982
3,168
338,830
345,695
1,736
1,920
14,752
151,614
170,022
The following table presents amortized cost and fair value of the available-for-sale investment securities portfolio by expected
maturity. In the case of residential mortgage-backed securities and SBA loan pool securities, expected maturities may differ
from contractual maturities because borrowers generally have the right to call or prepay obligations with or without call or
prepayment penalties. For that reason, mortgage-backed securities and SBA loan pool securities are not included in the maturity
categories.
December 31, 2014
Amortized
Cost
Fair Value
(In thousands)
Maturity:
Available for sale
Within one year
One to five years
Five to ten years
Greater than ten years
SBA loan pool, private label residential mortgage backed and agency mortgage-backed
securities
$
— $
1,940
—
—
342,938
Total
$
344,878
$
—
1,982
—
—
343,713
345,695
At December 31, 2014 and 2013, there were no holdings of any one issuer, other than the U.S. Government and its agencies, in
an amount greater than 10 percent of stockholders’ equity.
135
The following table presents proceeds from sales and calls of securities and the associated gross gains and losses realized
through earnings upon the sale of available for sale securities for the periods indicated:
Gross realized gains on sales of securities available for sale
Gross realized losses on sales of securities available for sale
Net realized gains (losses) on sales of securities available for sale
Proceeds from sales of securities available for sale
Tax expense on sales of securities available for sale
Year Ended December 31,
2014
2013
2012
(In thousands)
$
$
$
$
1,221
(38)
1,183
111,764
498
$
$
$
$
438
(107)
331
127,298
$
$
$
— $
19
(102)
(83)
11,940
—
Securities available for sale with carrying values of $27.1 million and $63.0 million as of December 31, 2014 and 2013,
respectively, were pledged to secure FHLB advances, public deposits and for other purposes as required or permitted by law.
The following table summarizes the investment securities with unrealized losses by security type and length of time in a
continuous unrealized loss position as of the dates indicated:
Less Than 12 Months
12 Months or Longer
Total
Fair Value
Gross
Unrealized
Losses
Fair
Value
Gross
Unrealized
Losses
Fair
Value
Gross
Unrealized
Losses
(In thousands)
December 31, 2014
Available for sale
SBA loan pool securities
$
— $
— $
— $
— $
— $
U.S. government-sponsored entities
and agency securities
Private label residential mortgage-
backed securities
Agency mortgage-backed securities
—
372
68,200
—
(9)
(332)
—
1,355
22,212
—
(4)
(273)
—
1,727
90,412
Total securities available for sale
$
68,572
$
(341) $
23,567
$
(277) $
92,139
$
December 31, 2013
Available for sale
SBA loan pool securities
$
1,736
$
(58) $
— $
— $
1,736
$
U.S. government-sponsored entities
and agency securities
Private label residential mortgage-
backed securities
Agency mortgage-backed securities
1,920
(8)
2,064
114,104
(11)
(1,790)
—
3,913
1,821
—
(25)
(29)
1,920
5,977
115,925
Total securities available for sale
$
119,824
$
(1,867) $
5,734
$
(54) $
125,558
$
—
—
(13)
(605)
(618)
(58)
(8)
(36)
(1,819)
(1,921)
The Company did not record other-than-temporary impairment (OTTI) for securities available for sale for the years ended
December 31, 2014, 2013 and 2012.
At December 31, 2014, the Company’s securities available for sale portfolio consisted of 92 securities, 49 of which were in an
unrealized loss position. The unrealized losses are related to an overall increase in interest rates and a decrease in prepayment
speeds of the agency mortgage-backed securities.
The Company monitors to ensure it has adequate credit support and as of December 31, 2014, the Company did not have the
intent to sell these securities and it is not likely that it will be required to sell the securities before their anticipated recoveries.
Of the Company’s $345.7 million securities portfolio, $344.4 million were rated AAA, AA or A, $1.1 million were rated BBB,
and a private label residential mortgage-backed security of $181 thousand was rated BB based on the most recent credit rating
from the rating agencies as of December 31, 2014. The BB rated private label residential mortgage-backed security was
subsequently sold during January 2015. The Company considers the lowest credit rating for identification of potential OTTI.
136
NOTE 5 – LOANS AND LEASES AND ALLOWANCE FOR LOAN AND LEASE LOSSES
The following table presents the balances in the Company’s loans and leases portfolio as of the dates indicated:
Non-
Traditional
Mortgages
(NTM)
Traditional
Loans
Total NTM
and
Traditional
Loans
($ in thousands)
Purchased
Credit
Impaired
Total Loans
and Leases
Receivable
December 31, 2014
Commercial:
Commercial and industrial
Commercial real estate
Multi-family
SBA
Construction
Lease financing
Consumer:
Single family residential mortgage
Green Loans (HELOC) - first liens
Green Loans (HELOC) - second liens
Other consumer
Total loans and leases
Percentage to total loans and leases
Allowance for loan and lease losses
Loans and leases receivable, net
December 31, 2013
Commercial:
Commercial and industrial
Commercial real estate
Multi-family
SBA
Construction
Lease financing
Consumer:
Single family residential mortgage
Green Loans (HELOC) - first liens
Green Loans (HELOC) - second liens
Other consumer
Total loans and leases
Percentage to total loans and leases
Allowance for loan and lease losses
Loans and leases receivable, net
$
— $
489,766
$
489,766
$
1,134
$
—
—
—
—
—
222,306
123,177
4,979
113
988,330
955,683
32,998
42,198
85,749
595,100
—
—
161,826
988,330
955,683
32,998
42,198
85,749
817,406
123,177
4,979
161,939
11,527
—
3,157
—
—
490,900
999,857
955,683
36,155
42,198
85,749
231,079
1,048,485
—
—
—
123,177
4,979
161,939
$
350,575
$
3,351,650
$
3,702,225
$
246,897
$
3,949,122
8.9%
84.8%
93.7%
6.3%
100.0%
(29,480)
$
3,919,642
$
— $
283,743
$
283,743
$
4,028
$
—
—
—
—
—
156,490
147,705
5,289
113
514,869
141,580
23,740
24,933
31,949
667,526
—
—
108,888
514,869
141,580
23,740
24,933
31,949
824,016
147,705
5,289
109,001
15,014
—
3,688
—
—
287,771
529,883
141,580
27,428
24,933
31,949
314,820
1,138,836
—
—
1,736
147,705
5,289
110,737
$
309,597
$
1,797,228
$
2,106,825
$
339,286
$
2,446,111
12.7%
73.4%
86.1%
13.9%
100.0%
(18,805)
$
2,427,306
137
Non Traditional Mortgage Loans
The Company’s non-traditional mortgage (NTM) portfolio is comprised of three interest only products: Green Account Loans
(Green Loans), fixed or adjustable hybrid interest only rate mortgage (Interest Only) loans and a small number of additional
loans with the potential for negative amortization. As of December 31, 2014 and 2013, the non-traditional mortgage loans
totaled $350.6 million, or 8.9 percent of the total loans and leases, and $309.6 million, or 12.7 percent of the total loans and
leases, respectively. The total NTM portfolio increased by $41.0 million, or 13.2 percent, during the year ended December 31,
2014.
The following table presents the composition of the NTM portfolio as of the dates indicated:
December 31,
2014
2013
Count
Amount
Percent
Count
Amount
Percent
($ in thousands)
148
207
32
387
19
1
20
407
$
123,177
209,207
13,099
345,483
4,979
113
5,092
35.1 %
59.7 %
3.7 %
98.5 %
1.4 %
0.1 %
1.5 %
350,575
100.0%
$
3,949,122
8.9%
173
244
37
454
23
1
24
478
$
147,705
139,867
16,623
304,195
5,289
113
5,402
47.7 %
45.2 %
5.4 %
98.3 %
1.7 %
— %
1.7 %
309,597
100.0%
$
2,446,111
12.7%
Green Loans (HELOC) - first liens
Interest only - first liens
Negative amortization
Total NTM - first liens
Green Loans (HELOC) - second liens
Interest only - second liens
Total NTM - second liens
Total NTM loans
Total loans and leases
% of NTM to total loans and leases
Green Loans
Green Loans are single family residential first and second mortgage lines of credit with a linked checking account that allows
all types of deposits and withdrawals to be performed. The loans are generally interest only with a 15 year balloon payment due
at maturity. At December 31, 2014 and 2013, Green Loans totaled $128.2 million and $153.0 million, respectively. As of
December 31, 2014 and 2013, $12.5 million and $5.7 million, respectively, of the Company’s Green Loans were non-
performing. As a result of their unique payment feature, Green Loans possess higher credit risk due to the potential of negative
amortization; however, management believes the risk is mitigated through the Company’s loan terms and underwriting
standards, including its policies on loan-to-value ratios and the Company’s contractual ability to curtail loans when the value of
the underlying collateral declines. The Company discontinued origination of the Green Loan products in 2011.
Interest Only Loans
Interest only loans are primarily single family residential first mortgage loans with payment features that allow interest only
payments in initial periods before converting to a fully amortizing loan. As of December 31, 2014 and 2013, interest only loans
totaled $209.3 million and $140.0 million, respectively. As of December 31, 2014 and 2013, $2.0 million and $752 thousand of
the interest only loans were non-performing, respectively.
Loans with the Potential for Negative Amortization
Negative amortization loans totaled $13.1 million and $16.6 million at December 31, 2014 and 2013, respectively. The
Company discontinued origination of negative amortization loans in 2007. As of December 31, 2014 and 2013, $0 and $1.2
million of the loans that had the potential for negative amortization were non-performing, respectively. These loans pose a
potentially higher credit risk because of the lack of principal amortization and potential for negative amortization; however,
management believes the risk is mitigated through the loan terms and underwriting standards, including the Company’s policies
on loan-to-value ratios.
138
Risk Management of Non-Traditional Mortgages
The Company has determined that the most significant performance indicators for non-traditional mortgages are loan-to-value
(LTV) and FICO scores. Accordingly, the Company manages credit risk in the NTM portfolio through semi-annual review of
the loan portfolio that includes refreshing FICO scores on the Green Loans and home equity lines of credit, as needed in
conjunction with portfolio management, and ordering third party automated valuation models. The loan review is designed to
provide a method of identifying borrowers who may be experiencing financial difficulty before they actually fail to make a loan
payment. Upon receipt of the updated FICO scores, an exception report is run to identify loans with a decrease in FICO of 10
percent or more and/or a resulting FICO of 620 or less. The loans are then further analyzed to determine if the risk rating
should be downgraded which will increase the reserves the Company will establish for potential losses. A report of the semi-
annual loan review is published and regularly monitored.
As these loans are revolving lines of credit, the Company, based on the loan agreement and loan covenants of the particular
loan, as well as applicable rules and regulations, could suspend the borrowing privileges or reduce the credit limit at any time
the Company reasonably believes that the borrower will be unable to fulfill their repayment obligations under the agreement or
certain other conditions are met. In many cases, the decrease in FICO is the first indication that the borrower may have
difficulty in making their future payment obligations.
As a result, the Company proactively manages the portfolio by performing detailed analysis on its portfolio with emphasis on
the NTM portfolio. The Company’s Internal Asset Review Committee (IARC) conducts meetings on at least a quarterly basis to
review the loans classified as special mention, substandard, or doubtful and determines whether a suspension or reduction in
credit limit is warranted. If the line has been suspended and the borrower would like to have their credit privileges reinstated,
they would need to provide updated financials showing their ability to meet their payment obligations.
On the interest only loans, the Company projects future payment changes to determine if there will be a material increase in the
required payment and then monitors the loans for possible delinquency. The individual loans are monitored for possible
downgrading of risk rating, and trends within the portfolio are identified that could affect other interest only loans scheduled for
payment changes in the near future.
Non-Traditional Mortgage Performance Indicators
The following table presents the Company’s non-traditional single family residential mortgage Green Loans first lien portfolio
at December 31, 2014 by FICO scores that were obtained during the quarter ended December 31, 2014, comparing to the FICO
scores for those same loans that were obtained during the quarter ended December 31, 2013:
By FICO Scores Obtained
During the Quarter Ended
December 31, 2014
December 31, 2014
By FICO Scores Obtained
During the Quarter Ended
December 31, 2013
Change
Count
Amount
Percent
Count
Amount
Percent
Count
Amount
Percent
($ in thousands)
FICO Score
800+
700-799
600-699
<600
No FICO
Totals
$
28
72
29
8
11
20,248
52,532
31,053
11,893
7,451
16.4 %
42.7 %
25.2 %
9.7 %
6.0 %
$
13
87
30
8
10
8,263
66,493
26,438
7,001
14,982
6.7 %
53.9 %
21.5 %
5.7 %
12.2 %
(15)
(1)
—
1
15
$
11,985
9.7 %
(13,961)
(11.2)%
4,615
4,892
(7,531)
3.7 %
4.0 %
(6.2)%
— %
148
$
123,177
100.0%
148
$
123,177
100.0%
— $
—
The Company updates FICO scores on a semi-annual basis, typically in the second and fourth quarters or as needed in
conjunction with proactive portfolio management.
139
Loan to Value
LTV represents estimated current loan to value ratio, determined by dividing current unpaid principal balance by latest
estimated property value received per the Company policy. The table below represents the Company’s single family residential
NTM first lien portfolio by loan-to-value (LTV) as of the dates indicated:
Green
Interest Only
Negative Amortization
Total
Count
Amount
Percent
Count
Amount
Percent
Count
Amount
Percent
Count
Amount
Percent
($ in thousands)
December 31, 2014
< 61
61-80
81-100
> 100
Total
December 31, 2013
< 61
61-80
81-100
> 100
Total
77
45
18
8
$
58,856
46,177
11,846
6,298
47.8 %
37.5 %
9.6 %
5.1 %
60
54
33
60
$
93,254
81,472
14,927
19,554
44.7 %
38.9 %
7.1 %
9.3 %
148
$
123,177
100.0%
207
$
209,207
100.0%
90
38
26
19
$
78,807
33,604
14,917
20,377
53.3 %
22.8 %
10.1 %
13.8 %
80
51
43
70
$
65,181
28,999
21,474
24,213
46.6 %
20.7 %
15.4 %
17.3 %
$
$
$
15
12
4
1
32
13
13
8
3
6,023
5,901
781
394
46.0 %
45.0 %
6.0 %
3.0 %
152
111
55
69
$
158,133
133,550
27,554
26,246
45.8 %
38.6 %
8.0 %
7.6 %
13,099
100.0%
387
$
345,483
100.0%
4,930
7,643
3,277
773
29.7 %
45.9 %
19.7 %
4.7 %
183
102
77
92
$
148,918
70,246
39,668
45,363
49.0 %
23.1 %
13.0 %
14.9 %
173
$
147,705
100.0%
244
$
139,867
100.0%
37
$
16,623
100.0%
454
$
304,195
100.0%
The decrease in Green Loans was due to reductions in principal balance and payoffs and the increase in interest only was due to
increased originations. During 2014, overall improvement on LTV of the Company’s single family residential NTM first lien
portfolio was due to the improvement in the real estate market and the economy in Southern California. The Company updates
LTV on a semi-annual basis, typically in the second and fourth quarters or as needed in conjunction with proactive portfolio
management.
140
Allowance for Loan and Lease Losses
The Company has an established credit risk management process that includes regular management review of the loan and
lease portfolio to identify problem loans and leases. During the ordinary course of business, management becomes aware of
borrowers and lessees that may not be able to meet the contractual requirements of the loan and lease agreements. Such loans
and leases are subject to increased monitoring. Consideration is given to placing the loan or lease on non-accrual status,
assessing the need for additional allowance for loan and lease losses, and partial or full charge-off. The Company maintains the
allowance for loan and lease losses at a level that is considered adequate to cover the estimated and known inherent risks in the
loan and lease portfolio.
The Company also maintains a reserve for unfunded loan commitments at a level that is considered adequate to cover the
estimated and known inherent risks. The probability of usage of the unfunded loan commitments and credit risk factors
determined based on outstanding loan balance of the same customer or outstanding loans that shares similar credit risk
exposure are used to determine the adequacy of the reserve. As of December 31, 2014 and 2013, the reserve for unfunded loan
commitments was $1.9 million and $1.4 million, respectively.
The credit risk monitoring system is designed to identify impaired and potential problem loans, and to permit periodic
evaluation of impairment and the adequacy of the allowance for credit losses in a timely manner. In addition, the Board of
Directors of the Bank has adopted a credit policy that includes a credit review and control system which it believes should be
effective in ensuring that the Company maintains an adequate allowance for credit losses. The Board of Directors provides
oversight and guidance for management’s allowance evaluation process, including quarterly valuations, and consideration of
management’s determination of whether the allowance is adequate to absorb losses in the loan and lease portfolio. During year
ended December 31, 2014, the Company enhanced the current methodologies, processes and controls over the allowance for
loan and lease losses (ALLL), due to the Company's rapid organic and acquisitive growth and rapidly changing profile. See
Note 1 for a summary of the enhancements made to the ALLL methodology. The determination of the amount of the allowance
for loan and lease losses and the provision for loan and lease losses is based on management’s current judgment about the credit
quality of the loan and lease portfolio and takes into consideration known relevant internal and external factors that affect
collectability when determining the appropriate level for the allowance for loan and lease losses. Additions to the allowance for
loan and lease losses are made by charges to the provision for loan and lease losses. Identified credit exposures that are
determined to be uncollectible are charged against the allowance for loan and lease losses. Recoveries of previously charged off
amounts, if any, are credited to the allowance for loan and lease losses.
The following table presents a summary of activity in the allowance for loan and lease losses for the periods indicated:
Balance at beginning of year
Loans and leases charged off
Recoveries of loans and leases previously charged off
Transfer of loans to held-for-sale
Provision for loan and lease losses
Balance at end of year
Year Ended December 31,
2014
2013
2012
(In thousands)
18,805
$
14,448
$
(923)
1,235
(613)
10,976
(3,013)
850
(1,443)
7,963
29,480
$
18,805
$
$
$
12,780
(4,071)
239
—
5,500
14,448
141
The following table presents the activity and balance in the allowance for loan and lease losses and the recorded investment,
excluding accrued interest, in loans and leases by portfolio segment and is based on the impairment method as of or for the year
ended December 31, 2014:
Commercial
and
Industrial
Commercial
Real Estate
Multi-
family
SBA
Construction
Lease
Financing
Single
Family
Residential
Mortgage
Other
Consumer
Unallocated
Total
(In thousands)
Allowance for loan and
lease losses:
Balance at December 31,
2013
Charge-offs
Recoveries
Transfer of loans to held-
for-sale
Provision
Balance at December 31,
2014
Individually evaluated for
impairment
Collectively evaluated for
impairment
Acquired with deteriorated
credit quality
Total ending allowance
balance
Loans:
Individually evaluated for
impairment
Collectively evaluated for
impairment
Acquired with deteriorated
credit quality
Total ending loan
balances
$
1,822
$
5,484
$
2,566
$
235
$
244
$
428
$
7,044
$
532
$
450
$
18,805
—
56
—
(65)
842
—
(3)
—
—
5,032
(2,421)
4,616
(17)
314
—
(197)
—
—
—
602
(244)
20
—
669
(374)
—
(613)
1,135
6,910
788
$
$
3,840
$
7,179
$
335
$
846
$
873
$
7,192
— $
— $
— $
— $
— $
500
(220)
3
—
—
—
—
(923)
1,235
(613)
1,990
(450)
10,976
2,305
$
— $
29,480
— $
— $
1,288
$
$
6,122
3,834
7,179
—
6
—
335
—
846
—
873
—
6,675
2,305
17
—
—
—
28,169
23
6,910
$
3,840
$
7,179
$
335
$
846
$
873
$
7,192
$
2,305
$
— $
29,480
9,021
$
1,017
$
1,594
$
6
$
— $
— $
21,337
$
503
$
— $
33,478
480,745
987,313
954,089
32,992
42,198
85,749
919,246
166,415
1,134
11,527
—
3,157
—
—
231,079
—
—
—
3,668,747
246,897
$
$
$
$
$ 490,900
$ 999,857
$ 955,683
$
36,155
$
42,198
$
85,749
$ 1,171,662
$ 166,918
$
— $ 3,949,122
142
The following table presents the activity and balance in the allowance for loan and lease losses and the recorded investment,
excluding accrued interest, in loans and leases by portfolio segment and is based on the impairment method as of or for the year
ended December 31, 2013:
Commercial
and
Industrial
Commercial
Real Estate
Multi-
family
SBA
Construction
Lease
Financing
Single
Family
Residential
Mortgage
Other
Consumer
Unallocated
Total
(In thousands)
Allowance for loan and
lease losses:
Balance at December 31,
2012
Charge-offs
Recoveries
Transfer of loans to held-
for-sale
Provision
Balance at December 31,
2013
Individually evaluated for
impairment
Collectively evaluated for
impairment
Acquired with deteriorated
credit quality
Total ending allowance
balance
Loans:
Individually evaluated for
impairment
Collectively evaluated for
impairment
Acquired with deteriorated
credit quality
Total ending loan
balances
$
$
$
$
$
261
$
8,855
$
274
$
— $
14,448
$
263
$
3,178
$
1,478
$
118
$
—
98
—
1,461
(472)
268
—
2,510
(553)
88
—
1,553
(648)
285
—
480
21
—
—
—
223
(23)
11
—
179
(1,302)
92
(1,443)
842
1,822
$
5,484
$
2,566
— $
— $
60
$
$
235
$
244
$
428
$
7,044
— $
— $
— $
34
$
$
1,822
5,484
2,506
—
—
—
235
—
244
—
428
—
6,814
196
(15)
8
—
265
532
2
530
—
$
$
—
—
—
450
(3,013)
850
(1,443)
7,963
450
$
18,805
— $
96
450
—
18,513
196
1,822
$
5,484
$
2,566
$
235
$
244
$
428
$
7,044
$
532
$
450
$
18,805
33
$
3,868
$
1,972
$
10
$
— $
— $
12,814
$
249
$
— $
18,946
283,710
511,001
139,608
23,730
24,933
31,949
958,907
114,041
4,028
15,014
—
3,688
—
—
314,820
1,736
—
—
2,087,879
339,286
$ 287,771
$ 529,883
$ 141,580
$
27,428
$
24,933
$
31,949
$ 1,286,541
$ 116,026
$
— $ 2,446,111
143
The following table presents loans and leases individually evaluated for impairment by class of loans and leases as of the dates
indicated. The recorded investment, excluding accrued interest, presents customer balances net of any partial charge-offs
recognized on the loans and leases and net of any deferred fees and costs.
December 31,
2014
2013
Unpaid
Principal
Balance
Recorded
Investment
Allowance
for Loan and
Lease Losses
Unpaid
Principal
Balance
Recorded
Investment
Allowance
for Loan and
Lease Losses
(In thousands)
$
4,803
$
4,708
$
— $
50
$
33
$
1,910
1,747
24
15,729
507
4,310
—
6,422
—
1,017
1,594
6
15,131
503
4,313
—
6,206
—
—
—
—
—
—
788
—
500
—
4,951
487
26
10,765
248
—
1,797
3,378
2
3,868
270
10
9,487
247
—
1,702
3,327
2
$
35,452
$
33,478
$
1,288
$
21,704
$
18,946
$
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
60
34
2
96
With no related allowance recorded:
Commercial:
Commercial and industrial
Commercial real estate
Multi-family
SBA
Consumer:
Single family residential mortgage
Other consumer
With an allowance recorded:
Commercial:
Commercial and industrial
Multi-family
Consumer:
Single family residential mortgage
Other consumer
Total
The following table presents information on impaired loans and leases, disaggregated by class, for the periods indicated:
2014
Year Ended December 31,
2013
2012
Average
Recorded
Investment
Interest
Income
Recognized
Cash Basis
Interest
Recognized
Average
Recorded
Investment
Interest
Income
Recognized
Cash Basis
Interest
Recognized
Average
Recorded
Investment
Interest
Income
Recognized
Cash Basis
Interest
Recognized
(In thousands)
Commercial:
Commercial and industrial
$
4,166
$
92
$
Commercial real estate
Multi-family
SBA
Consumer:
Single family residential
mortgage
Other consumer
Total
2,865
1,653
3
16,285
580
110
43
—
390
25
133
125
43
—
405
24
$
67
$
10
$
10
$
1,879
$
21
$
3,554
1,345
12
12,562
693
163
35
1
304
2
171
37
1
308
2
4,743
5,468
438
21,912
3
170
256
10
299
—
60
217
266
16
599
—
$
25,552
$
660
$
730
$
18,233
$
515
$
529
$
34,443
$
756
$
1,158
144
Non-accrual Loans and Leases
The following table presents nonaccrual loans and leases, and loans past due 90 days or more and still accruing as of the dates
indicated:
2014
Traditional
Loans
NTM Loans
December 31,
Total
NTM Loans
(In thousands)
2013
Traditional
Loans
Total
$
— $
— $
— $
— $
— $
—
14,592
23,789
38,381
7,698
23,950
31,648
Loans past due 90 days or more and still
accruing
Nonaccrual loans:
The Company maintains specific
allowances for these loans of $478
in 2014 and $95 in 2013
The following table presents the composition of nonaccrual loans and leases as of the dates indicated:
2014
Traditional
Loans
NTM Loans
December 31,
Total
NTM Loans
(In thousands)
2013
Traditional
Loans
Total
Commercial:
Commercial and industrial
Commercial real estate
Multi-family
SBA
Construction
Lease financing
Consumer:
Single family residential mortgage
Green Loans (HELOC) - first liens
Green Loans (HELOC) - second liens
Other consumer
$
— $
7,143
$
7,143
$
— $
33
$
—
—
—
—
—
2,049
12,334
209
—
1,017
1,834
285
—
100
13,370
—
—
40
1,017
1,834
285
—
100
15,419
12,334
209
40
—
—
—
—
—
2,000
5,482
216
—
3,868
1,972
10
—
—
18,032
—
—
35
33
3,868
1,972
10
—
—
20,032
5,482
216
35
Total nonaccrual loans and leases $
14,592
$
23,789
$
38,381
$
7,698
$
23,950
$
31,648
145
Past Due Loans and Leases
The following table presents the aging of the recorded investment in past due loans and leases as of December 31, 2014,
excluding accrued interest receivable (which is not considered to be material), by class of loans and leases:
December 31, 2014
30 - 59 Days
Past Due
60 - 89 Days
Past Due
Greater
than
89 Days
Past due
Total
Past Due
Current
Total
(In thousands)
NTM loans:
Single family residential mortgage
$
1,415
$
165
$
2,049
$
3,629
$
218,677
$
222,306
Green Loans (HELOC) - first liens
Green Loans (HELOC) - second liens
Other consumer
Total NTM loans
Traditional loans:
Commercial:
Commercial and industrial
Commercial real estate
Multi-family
SBA
Construction
Lease financing
Consumer:
Single family residential mortgage
Other consumer
Total traditional loans
Purchased Credit Impaired (PCI)
loans:
Commercial:
Commercial and industrial
Commercial real estate
SBA
Consumer:
Single family residential mortgage
Other consumer
Total PCI loans
Total
8,853
294
—
10,562
79
2,237
1,072
82
—
1,055
17,185
9
21,719
—
—
878
13,262
—
14,140
—
—
—
165
37
—
208
—
—
36
7,878
89
8,248
—
—
—
3,501
—
3,501
437
209
—
9,290
503
—
113,887
123,177
4,476
113
4,979
113
2,695
13,422
337,153
350,575
3,370
—
—
254
—
100
10,411
5
14,140
—
951
300
4,510
—
5,761
3,486
2,237
1,280
336
—
1,191
35,474
103
486,280
986,093
954,403
32,662
42,198
84,558
559,626
161,723
489,766
988,330
955,683
32,998
42,198
85,749
595,100
161,826
44,107
3,307,543
3,351,650
—
951
1,178
21,273
—
23,402
1,134
10,576
1,979
1,134
11,527
3,157
209,806
231,079
—
—
223,495
246,897
$
46,421
$
11,914
$
22,596
$
80,931
$ 3,868,191
$ 3,949,122
146
The following table presents the aging of the recorded investment in past due loans and leases as of December 31, 2013,
excluding accrued interest receivable (which is not considered to be material), by class of loans and leases:
December 31, 2013
30 - 59 Days
Past Due
60 - 89 Days
Past Due
Greater
than
89 Days
Past due
Total
Past Due
Current
Total
(In thousands)
NTM loans:
Single family residential mortgage
$
1,003
$
1,854
$
Green Loans (HELOC) - first liens
Green Loans (HELOC) - second liens
Other consumer
Total NTM loans
Traditional loans:
Commercial:
Commercial and industrial
Commercial real estate
Multi-family
SBA
Construction
Lease financing
Consumer:
Single family residential mortgage
Other consumer
Total traditional loans
PCI Loans:
Commercial:
Commercial and industrial
Commercial real estate
SBA
Consumer:
Single family residential mortgage
Other consumer
Total PCI loans
Total
653
—
—
—
—
—
769
437
—
—
$
3,626
$
152,864
$
156,490
1,090
146,615
147,705
—
—
5,289
113
5,289
113
1,656
1,854
1,206
4,716
304,881
309,597
52
5,554
602
14
—
271
20,684
209
27,386
—
—
45
21,888
—
21,933
235
194
—
48
—
92
6,124
110
6,803
—
—
1
8,580
—
8,581
—
—
—
—
—
19
12,181
35
12,235
—
—
106
12,099
—
12,205
287
5,748
602
62
—
382
38,989
354
283,456
509,121
140,978
23,678
24,933
31,567
628,537
108,534
283,743
514,869
141,580
23,740
24,933
31,949
667,526
108,888
46,424
1,750,804
1,797,228
—
—
152
42,567
—
42,719
4,028
15,014
3,536
272,253
1,736
296,567
4,028
15,014
3,688
314,820
1,736
339,286
$
50,975
$
17,238
$
25,646
$
93,859
$ 2,352,252
$ 2,446,111
147
Troubled Debt Restructurings
Troubled Debt Restructurings (TDRs) of loans are defined by ASC 310-40, “Troubled Debt Restructurings by Creditors” and
ASC 470-60, “Troubled Debt Restructurings by Debtors” and evaluated for impairment in accordance with ASC 310-10-35.
The concessions may be granted in various forms, including reduction in the stated interest rate, reduction in the amount of
principal amortization, forgiveness of a portion of a loan balance or accrued interest, or extension of the maturity date. In order
to determine whether a borrower is experiencing financial difficulty, an evaluation is performed of the probability that the
borrower will be in payment default on any of its debt in the foreseeable future without the modification. This evaluation is
performed under the Company’s internal underwriting policy.
For the year ended December 31, 2014, there were six modifications through bankruptcy discharges. There were two
modifications through extensions of maturities for the year ended December 31, 2013. There were four modifications through
extensions of maturities for the year ended December 31, 2012. The following table summarizes the pre-modification and post-
modification balances of the new TDRs for the periods indicated:
Year Ended December 31,
2014
Pre-
Modification
Outstanding
Recorded
Investment
Post-
Modification
Outstanding
Recorded
Investment
Number of
Loans
Number of
Loans
2013
Pre-
Modification
Outstanding
Recorded
Investment
($ in thousands)
Post-
Modification
Outstanding
Recorded
Investment
Number of
Loans
2012
Pre-
Modification
Outstanding
Recorded
Investment
Post-
Modification
Outstanding
Recorded
Investment
Commercial:
Commercial real estate
— $
— $
SBA
Consumer:
Single family residential
mortgage
Other consumer
Total
—
5
1
6
—
1,245
294
$
1,539
$
—
—
1,229
294
1,523
— $
— $
—
—
2
2
$
—
—
435
435
$
—
—
—
435
435
$
1
3
$
288
420
—
—
4
—
—
$
708
$
288
420
—
—
708
The following table presents loans and leases that were modified as TDRs during the past 12 months that had payment defaults
during the periods indicated:
2014
Year Ended December 31,
2013
2012
Number of
Loans
Recorded
Investment
Number of
Loans
Recorded
Investment
Number of
Loans
Recorded
Investment
($ in thousands)
Consumer:
Single family residential mortgage
Total
— $
— $
—
—
— $
— $
—
—
1
1
$
$
4
4
Troubled debt restructured loans and leases consist of the following as of the dates indicated:
NTM Loans
2014
Traditional
Loans
December 31,
Total
NTM Loans
(In thousands)
2013
Traditional
Loans
Total
Commercial:
Commercial real estate
SBA
Consumer:
Single family residential mortgage
Green Loans (HELOC) - first liens
Green Loans (HELOC) - second liens
Total
$
$
— $
—
— $
6
— $
6
— $
—
$
194
10
—
3,442
294
3,736
$
4,269
—
—
4,275
$
4,269
3,442
294
8,011
$
—
3,468
—
3,468
$
3,605
—
—
3,809
$
194
10
3,605
3,468
—
7,277
The Company did not have any commitments to lend to customers with outstanding loans or leases that were classified as
troubled debt restructurings as of December 31, 2014 and 2013.
148
Credit Quality Indicators
The Company categorizes loans and leases into risk categories based on relevant information about the ability of borrowers to
service their debt such as: current financial information, historical payment experience, credit documentation, public
information, and current economic trends, among other factors. The Company performs historical loss analysis that is
combined with a comprehensive loan or lease to value analysis to analyze the associated risks in the current loan and lease
portfolio. The Company analyzes loans and leases individually by classifying the loans and leases as to credit risk. This
analysis includes all loans and leases delinquent over 60 days and non-homogeneous loans and leases such as commercial and
commercial real estate loans and leases. Classification of problem single family residential loans is performed on a monthly
basis while analysis of non-homogeneous loans and leases is performed on a quarterly basis. The Company uses the following
definitions for risk ratings:
Pass: Loans and leases classified as pass are in compliance in all respects with the Bank’s credit policy and regulatory
requirements, and do not exhibit any potential or defined weakness as defined under “Special Mention”, “Substandard” or
“Doubtful/Loss”.
Special Mention: Loans and leases classified as special mention have a potential weakness that deserves management’s close
attention. If left uncorrected, these potential weaknesses may result in deterioration of the repayment prospects for the loan or
lease or of the Company’s credit position at some future date.
Substandard: Loans and leases classified as substandard are inadequately protected by the current net worth and paying
capacity of the obligor or of the collateral pledged, if any. Loans and leases so classified have a well-defined weakness or
weaknesses that jeopardize the liquidation of the debt. They are characterized by the distinct possibility that the institution will
sustain some loss if the deficiencies are not corrected.
Doubtful/Loss: Loans and leases classified as doubtful have all the weaknesses inherent in those classified as substandard, with
the added characteristic that the weaknesses make collection or liquidation in full, on the basis of currently existing facts,
conditions, and values, highly questionable and improbable.
Not-Rated: When accrual of income on a pool of purchased credit impaired (PCI) loans with common risk characteristics is
appropriate in accordance with ASC 310-30, individual loans in those pools are not risk-rated. The credit criteria evaluated are
FICO scores, loan-to-value, delinquency, and actual cash flows versus expected cash flows of the loan pools.
Loans and leases not meeting the criteria above that are analyzed individually as part of the above described process are
considered to be pass rated loans and leases.
149
The following table presents the risk categories for loans and leases as of December 31, 2014:
Pass
Special
Mention
Substandard
Doubtful
Not-Rated
Total
December 31, 2014
(In thousands)
NTM loans:
Single family residential mortgage
$
219,747
$
Green Loans (HELOC) - first liens
Green Loans (HELOC) - second liens
Other consumer
Total NTM loans
Traditional loans:
Commercial:
Commercial and industrial
Commercial real estate
Multi-family
SBA
Construction
Lease financing
Consumer:
104,640
4,770
113
329,270
477,319
943,645
932,438
32,171
42,198
85,613
Single family residential mortgage
Other consumer
Total traditional loans
569,871
161,701
3,244,956
PCI loans:
Commercial:
Commercial and industrial
Commercial real estate
SBA
Consumer:
Single family residential mortgage
Other consumer
Total PCI loans
Total
104
6,676
677
—
—
279
399
—
—
678
117
14,281
6,684
—
—
36
10,395
85
31,598
—
985
351
—
—
$
2,280
$
— $
— $
222,306
18,138
209
—
20,627
12,330
30,404
16,561
827
—
100
14,834
40
75,096
1,030
3,866
2,129
268
—
7,293
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
123,177
4,979
113
350,575
489,766
988,330
955,683
32,998
42,198
85,749
595,100
161,826
3,351,650
1,134
11,527
3,157
230,811
231,079
—
—
230,811
246,897
7,457
1,336
$ 3,581,683
$
33,612
$
103,016
$
— $
230,811
$ 3,949,122
150
The following table presents the risk categories for loans and leases as of December 31, 2013:
Pass
Special
Mention
Substandard
Doubtful
Not-Rated
Total
December 31, 2013
(In thousands)
NTM loans:
Single family residential mortgage
$
151,728
$
2,321
$
2,441
$
— $
— $
156,490
Green Loans (HELOC) - first liens
129,679
11,470
Green Loans (HELOC) - second liens
Other consumer
Total NTM loans
Traditional loans:
Commercial:
Commercial and industrial
Commercial real estate
Multi-family
SBA
Construction
Lease financing
Consumer:
Single family residential mortgage
Other consumer
Total traditional loans
PCI loans:
Commercial:
Commercial and industrial
Commercial real estate
SBA
Consumer:
Single family residential mortgage
Other consumer
Total PCI loans
Total
5,073
113
—
—
286,593
13,791
280,527
510,117
139,608
23,714
24,933
31,949
640,701
108,745
1,760,294
—
10,148
844
—
—
1
—
—
—
—
—
6,350
108
6,459
969
—
605
—
—
10,992
1,574
6,556
216
—
9,213
3,215
4,752
1,972
26
—
—
20,475
33
30,473
3,059
4,866
2,239
287
1,736
12,187
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
2
2
—
—
—
—
—
—
2
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
314,533
—
314,533
147,705
5,289
113
309,597
283,743
514,869
141,580
23,740
24,933
31,949
667,526
108,888
1,797,228
4,028
15,014
3,688
314,820
1,736
339,286
$
314,533
$ 2,446,111
$ 2,057,879
$
21,824
$
51,873
$
The increase in special mention and substandard loans from December 31, 2013 to December 31, 2014 was mainly due to those
loans acquired in the BPNA Branch Acquisition.
151
Purchased Credit Impaired Loans and Leases
During the years ended December 31, 2014, 2013 and 2012, the Company acquired loans and leases through business
acquisitions and purchases of loan pools for which there was, at acquisition, evidence of deterioration of credit quality
subsequent to origination and it was probable, at acquisition, that all contractually required payments would not be collected.
The following table presents the outstanding balance and carrying amount of those loans and leases, which are sometimes
collectively referred to as “PCI loans” as of the dates indicated:
Commercial:
Commercial and industrial
Commercial real estate
SBA
Consumer:
Single family residential mortgage
Other consumer
Total
December 31,
2014
2013
Outstanding
Balance
Carrying
Amount
Outstanding
Balance
Carrying
Amount
(In thousands)
$
1,767
$
1,134
$
5,838
$
13,708
4,220
283,067
—
11,527
3,157
231,079
—
17,682
4,940
414,341
2,134
4,028
15,014
3,688
314,820
1,736
$
302,762
$
246,897
$
444,935
$
339,286
The following table presents a summary of accretable yield, or income expected to be collected for the periods indicated:
Balance at beginning of year
New loans or leases purchased
Accretion of income
Increase (decrease) in expected cash flows
Disposals
Balance at end of year
Year Ended December 31,
2014
2013
2012
(In thousands)
$
126,336
$
32,206
$
—
(25,335)
29,267
(37,967)
155,416
(19,177)
(17,358)
(24,751)
—
36,000
(3,633)
—
(161)
$
92,301
$
126,336
$
32,206
The following table presents loans and leases purchased and acquired through business acquisitions at acquisition dates for
which it was probable at acquisition that all contractually required payments would not be collected for the periods indicated:
Commercial:
Commercial and industrial
Commercial real estate
Multi-family
SBA
Construction
Consumer:
Single family residential mortgage
Other consumer
Outstanding balance
Cash flows expected to be collected at acquisitions
Fair value of acquired loans at acquisition
Year Ended December 31,
2014
2013
2012
(In thousands)
$
— $
—
—
—
—
—
—
— $
— $
—
$
$
152
2,721
$
3,226
—
—
4,333
473,942
844
485,066
504,197
348,569
$
$
12,542
24,164
1,222
8,684
—
115,207
—
161,819
141,302
105,302
The Company did not purchase any PCI loans during the year ended December 31, 2014. The Company sold a portion of PCI
loans with unpaid principal balances and carrying values as of the respective sale dates of $91.9 million and $56.7 million,
respectively, during the year ended December 31, 2014. The Company recognized net gain on sale loans of $11.8 million from
these transactions for the year ended December 31, 2014, and the gain was included in Net Gain on Sale of Loans on the
Consolidated Statements of Operations.
The Company completed five bulk loan acquisitions with unpaid principal balances and fair values of $1.02 billion and $849.9
million, respectively, at the respective acquisition dates during the year ended December 31, 2013. The Company determined
that unpaid principal balance and fair value of $485.1 million and $348.6 million of these loans displayed evidence of credit
quality deterioration since origination and it was probable, at acquisition that all contractually required payments would not be
collected. The Company sold a portion of PCI loans with unpaid principal balances and carrying values of $141.7 million and
$80.5 million, respectively, during the year ended December 31, 2013. The Company recognized net gain on sale of $2.4
million from these transactions for the year ended December 31, 2013, and the gain was included in Net Gain on Sale of Loans
on the Consolidated Statements of Operations.
The Company completed three bulk PCI loan acquisitions with unpaid principal balances and fair values of $114.8 million and
$66.7 million, respectively, at the respective acquisition dates, and did not sell any PCI loans during the year ended December
31, 2012.
Purchases and Sales
The following table presents loans and leases purchased and/or sold by portfolio segment, excluding loans held for sale, loans
and leases acquired in business combinations and purchased credit-impaired loans and leases for the periods indicated:
Year Ended December 31,
2014
2013
2012
Purchases
Sales
Purchases
Sales
Purchases
Sales
(In thousands)
Commercial:
Commercial and industrial
$
— $
— $
— $
— $
— $
—
—
7,838
—
—
—
—
—
—
7,850
—
—
2,507
—
—
1,400
17,274
—
—
11,772
—
—
—
7,116
—
—
Commercial real estate
Multi-family
SBA
Construction
Lease financing
Consumer:
Single family residential mortgage
Other consumer
Total
—
—
—
—
38,572
—
—
82,552
507,736
186,140
—
—
—
—
—
70,438
—
$
38,572
$
90,390
$
515,586
$
188,647
$
30,446
$
77,554
The Company purchased the above loans and leases at a net discount of $0, $43.4 million, and $231 thousand for the years
ended December 31, 2014, 2013, and 2012, respectively. For the purchased loans and leases disclosed above, the Company did
not incur any specific allowances for loan and lease losses during the year ended December 31, 2014, 2013, and 2012. The
Company determined that it was probable at acquisition that all contractually required payments would be collected.
The Company also strategically transferred certain SFR mortgage loans of $62.0 million and $181.4 million, net of transfer of
$989 thousand and $1.4 million from allowance for loan and lease losses, from loans and leases held for investment to loans
held for sale at lower of cost or fair value, and sold them in pools, unlike the loans individually originated to be sold into the
secondary market on a whole loan basis for the years ended December 31, 2014 and 2013.
153
NOTE 6 – PREMISES, EQUIPMENT, AND CAPITAL LEASES, NET
The following table presents the summary of premises and equipment, including capital leases that are included in equipment,
as of the dates indicated:
Land
Building and improvement
Furniture, fixtures, and equipment
Leasehold improvements
Construction in process
Total
Less accumulated depreciation
Premises and equipment, net
December 31,
2014
2013
Total Premises
and Equipment
Capital Leases
Total Premises
and Equipment
Capital Leases
$
22,330
$
— $
18,000
$
(In thousands)
31,403
30,469
8,764
3,176
96,142
(17,457)
—
4,520
—
—
4,520
(1,361)
26,995
22,583
7,001
2,341
76,920
(10,660)
$
78,685
$
3,159
$
66,260
$
—
—
3,207
—
—
3,207
(498)
2,709
During the year ended December 31, 2014, the Company acquired premises and equipment of $9.0 million in the BPNA
Branch Acquisition.
During the year ended December 31, 2013, the Company purchased a certain improved real property office complex located at
1588 South Coast Drive, Costa Mesa, California (the Property) at a purchase price of approximately $40.0 million.
On October 4, 2013, the Company completed the sale of eight branch locations to AmericanWest Bank, a Washington state
chartered bank. The transaction included net book values of $1.2 million of land and improvement, $1.2 million of buildings,
$402 thousand of furniture, fixtures and equipment, and $348 thousand of leasehold improvement as of the transaction date.
The Company recognized depreciation expense of $6.8 million, $4.3 million and $1.7 million for years ended December 31,
2014, 2013, and 2012, respectively.
The Company leases certain equipment under capital leases. The lease arrangements require monthly payments through 2020.
The Company leases certain properties under operating leases. Total rent expense for the years ended December 31, 2014,
2013, and 2012 amounted to $13.0 million, $7.6 million and $3.2 million, respectively. Pursuant to the terms of non-cancelable
lease agreements in effect at December 31, 2014 pertaining to banking premises and equipment, future minimum rent
commitments under various operating leases are as follows, before considering renewal options that generally are present.
The following table presents the future commitments under operating leases and capital leases as of December 31, 2014:
2015
2016
2017
2018
(In thousands)
2019 and
After
Total
Commitments under operating leases
Commitments under capital lease
Total
$
$
12,785
959
13,744
$
$
9,885
959
10,844
$
$
7,341
895
8,236
$
$
4,900
332
5,232
$
$
10,278
42
10,320
$
$
45,189
3,187
48,376
154
NOTE 7 – SERVICING RIGHTS
The Company retains mortgage servicing rights (MSRs) from certain of its sales of residential mortgage loans. MSRs on
residential mortgage loans are reported at fair value. Income earned by the Company on its MSRs is derived primarily from
contractually specified mortgage servicing fees and late fees, net of curtailment costs and third party subservicing costs. The
Company retains servicing rights in connection with its SBA loan operations, which are measured using the amortization
method.
Income earned from servicing rights was $4.2 million, $2.0 million and $92 thousand for the years ended December 31, 2014,
2013, and 2012, respectively. These amounts are reported in Loan Servicing Income on the Consolidated Statements of
Operations. The following table presents a composition of servicing rights as of the dates indicated:
Mortgage servicing rights, at fair value
SBA servicing rights, at cost
Total
December 31,
2014
2013
(In thousands)
$
$
19,082
484
19,566
$
$
13,535
348
13,883
Mortgage loans sold with servicing retained are not reported as assets and are subserviced by a third party vendor. The unpaid
principal balance of these loans at December 31, 2014 and 2013 was $1.92 billion and $1.37 billion, respectively. Custodial
escrow balances maintained in connection with serviced loans were $8.3 million and $5.9 million at December 31, 2014 and
2013, respectively.
Mortgage Servicing Rights
At December 31, 2014, $5.9 million of the mortgage servicing rights was valued based on a market bid that settled subsequent
to year end, which was included as Level 3 fair value of MSRs. The following table presents the key characteristics, inputs and
economic assumptions used to estimate the Level 3 fair value of the MSRs as of the dates indicated:
Fair value of retained MSRs
Discount rate
Constant prepayment rate
Weighted-average life (in years)
The following table presents activity in the MSRs for the periods indicated:
December 31,
2014
2013
($ in thousands)
$
13,135
$
13,535
10.09%
13.22%
5.80
10.39%
10.28%
7.37
Balance at beginning of year
Acquired in business combinations
Additions
Prepayments
Changes in fair value resulting from valuation inputs or assumptions
Sales of servicing rights
Other—loans paid off
Balance at end of year
Year Ended December 31,
2014
2013
2012
(In thousands)
$
13,535
$
1,739
$
—
26,399
(1,155)
(233)
(17,773)
(1,691)
—
11,463
(480)
1,360
—
(547)
$
19,082
$
13,535
$
—
1,534
441
(69)
(42)
—
(125)
1,739
155
SBA Servicing Rights
The Company used a discount rate of 7.25 percent to calculate the present value of cash flows and an estimated prepayment
speed based on prepayment data available. Discount rates and prepayment speeds are reviewed quarterly and adjusted as
appropriate. The following table presents activity in the SBA servicing rights for the periods indicated:
Balance at beginning of year
Acquired in business combinations
Additions
Amortization, including prepayments
Impairment
Balance at end of year
Year Ended December 31,
2014
2013
2012
(In thousands)
348
$
539
$
—
261
(83)
(42)
—
32
(223)
—
484
$
348
$
—
557
171
(189)
—
539
$
$
The Company did not have any interest-only strip outstanding as of December 31, 2014 or 2013. The following table presents
activity in the interest-only strip for the periods indicated:
Balance at beginning of year
Acquired in business combinations
Additions
Disposals
Amortization, including prepayments
Balance at end of year
Year Ended December 31,
2014
2013
2012
(In thousands)
— $
— $
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
— $
— $
—
30
—
(29)
(1)
—
$
$
156
NOTE 8 – OTHER REAL ESTATE OWNED
The following table presents the activity in other real estate owned for the periods indicated:
Balance at beginning of year
Additions
Sales and net direct write-downs
Net change in valuation allowance
Balance at end of year
Year Ended December 31,
2014
2013
2012
$
$
(In thousands)
— $
4,527
$
653
(198)
(32)
229
(6,825)
2,069
423
$
— $
14,692
3,863
(16,040)
2,012
4,527
The following table presents the activity in the other real estate owned valuation allowance for the periods indicated:
Balance at beginning of year
Additions
Net direct write-downs and removals from sale
Balance at end of year
Year Ended December 31,
2014
2013
2012
$
$
(In thousands)
— $
2,069
$
32
—
32
97
(2,166)
$
— $
4,081
703
(2,715)
2,069
The following table presents expenses related to foreclosed assets included in Loan Servicing and Foreclosure Expenses on the
Consolidated Statements of Operations for the periods indicated:
Net gain (loss) on sales
Operating expenses, net of rental income
Total
Year Ended December 31,
2014
2013
2012
$
$
(In thousands)
66
—
66
$
$
464
(362)
102
$
$
464
(676)
(212)
The following table presents loans provided for sales of other real estate owned, included in Other Assets on the Consolidated
Statements of Financial Condition, and deferred gain on real estate sold on contract, included in Accrued Expenses and Other
Liabilities on the Consolidated Statements of Financial Condition for the periods indicated:
Loans provided for sales of other real estate owned sold on contract
$
Deferred gain on other real estate sold on contract
Year Ended December 31,
2014
2013
2012
(In thousands)
— $
—
— $
—
914
10
157
NOTE 9 – GOODWILL AND OTHER INTANGIBLE ASSETS, NET
At December 31, 2014, the Company had goodwill of $31.6 million related to the RenovationReady, CS Financial, PBOC, and
Beach acquisitions. The following table presents changes in the carrying amount of goodwill for the periods indicated:
Goodwill balance at beginning of the year
Goodwill acquired during the year
Goodwill adjustments for purchase accounting
Impairment losses
Goodwill balance at end of year
Accumulated impairment losses at end of year
Year Ended December 31,
2014
2013
2012
(In thousands)
30,143
$
7,048
$
2,239
(791)
—
23,095
—
—
31,591
$
30,143
$
— $
— $
$
$
$
—
7,048
—
—
7,048
—
The goodwill adjustments made during the year ended December 31, 2014 related to the finalization of accounting adjustments
for the CS Financial and PBOC acquisitions.
The Company tests its goodwill for impairment annually as of August 31 (the Measurement Date). At the Measurement Date,
the Company, in accordance with ASC 350-20-35-3, evaluated, based on the weight of evidence, the significance of all
qualitative factors to determine whether it is more likely than not that the fair value of the reporting unit is less than its carrying
amount. The assessment of qualitative factors at the Measurement Date indicated that it is not more likely than not that
impairment exists; as a result no futher testing was performed.
Core deposit intangibles are amortized over their useful lives ranging from 4 to 10 years. As of December 31, 2014, the
weighted average remaining amortization period for core deposit intangibles was approximately 8.2 years. Customer
relationship intangible, related to the RenovationReady acquisition, is amortized over its useful life of 5 years. As of December
31, 2014, the remaining amortization period for customer relationship intangible was approximately 4.1 years. Trade name
intangibles, related to the RenovationReady and CS Financial acquisitions, have indefinite useful lives. The following table
presents a summary of other intangible assets as of the dates indicated:
December 31, 2014
Core deposit intangibles
Customer relationship intangible
Trade name intangibles
December 31, 2013
Core deposit intangibles
Gross
Carrying
Value
Accumulated
Amortization
(In thousands)
Net
Carrying
Value
$
$
31,162
$
7,237
$
23,925
670
780
123
—
547
780
15,433
$
3,281
$
12,152
During the year ended December 31, 2014, the Company wrote off a portion of core deposit intangibles related to the Beach
acquisition of $48 thousand due to lower remaining deposit balances than forecasted. During the year ended December 31,
2013, the Company wrote off all remaining trade name intangible assets of Beach, Gateway and PBOC of $976 thousand due to
the merger of the Company’s two banking subsidiaries into a single bank and a portion of core deposit intangibles related to the
Gateway acquisition of $85 thousand due to lower remaining deposit balances than forecasted.
Aggregate amortization of intangible assets was $4.1 million, $2.7 million and $696 thousand for the years ended
December 31, 2014, 2013 and 2012, respectively. The following table presents estimated future amortization expenses as of
December 31, 2014:
Estimated future amortization expense
$
5,836
$
4,946
$
4,066
$
3,205
$
6,419
$
24,472
2015
2016
2017
2018
(In thousands)
2019 and
After
Total
The Company realigned its management reporting structure at December 31, 2014 and, accordingly, its segment reporting
structures and goodwill reporting units. In connection with the realignment, management reallocated goodwill to the new
158
reporting units using a relative fair value approach. The carrying value of goodwill allocated to the reportable segments were
$29.5 million and $2.1 million to the Banking segment and Mortgage Banking segment, respectively, at December 31, 2014.
See Note 22 for additional information.
NOTE 10 – DEPOSITS
The following table presents the components of interest-bearing deposits as of the dates indicated:
Interest-bearing demand deposits
Money market accounts
Savings accounts
Certificates of deposit under $100,000
Certificates of deposit of $100,000 or more
Total interest-bearing deposits
December 31,
2014
2013
(In thousands)
$
1,054,828
$
1,074,432
985,646
449,580
445,050
539,098
518,696
963,536
27,921
440,235
$
4,009,536
$
2,489,486
Total interest-bearing deposits increased $1.52 billion during the year ended December 31, 2014. The increase is mainly due to
$924.5 million in interest-bearing deposits assumed in the BPNA Branch Acquisition and a $277.4 million increase in deposits
generated through strategic plans aiming to increase core deposits by launching interest-bearing core deposit products with
enhanced features to attract high net worth depositors in the Company’s target markets while reducing the reliance on
certificates of deposit.
As of December 31, 2014, the Bank had brokered deposits of $763.0 million, which represented 12.8 percent of total assets.
The Company primarily relies on competitive pricing policies, marketing and customer service to attract and retain deposits.
The Bank has an asset liability management policy that limits brokered deposit balances to no more than 45 percent of total
assets, with an operating target of less than 25 percent of total assets.
The following table presents scheduled maturities of certificates of deposit as of December 31, 2014:
Certificates of deposit under $100,000
Certificates of deposit of $100,000 or
more
Total certificates of deposit
$
$
2015
2016
2017
2018
(In thousands)
2019 and
After
Total
393,703
$
23,389
$
9,916
$
18,778
$
3,794
$
449,580
248,691
95,531
70,069
24,261
6,498
445,050
642,394
$
118,920
$
79,985
$
43,039
$
10,292
$
894,630
159
NOTE 11 – FEDERAL HOME LOAN BANK ADVANCES AND OTHER BORROWINGS
At December 31, 2014, the Bank had fixed-rate advances of $400.0 million at a weighted average interest rate of 0.31 percent
and variable-rate advances of $233.0 million at a weighted average interest rate of 0.27 percent from the FHLB. At December
31, 2013, $25.0 million of the Bank’s advances from the FHLB were fixed-rate and had interest rates ranging from 0.59 percent
to 0.82 percent with a weighted average interest rate of 0.73 percent, and $225.0 million of the Bank’s advances from the
FHLB were variable-rate and had a weighted average interest rate of 0.06 percent. The following table presents contractual
maturities by year of the Bank's advances as of December 31, 2014:
Fixed rate
Variable rate
Total
2015
2016
2017
2018
(In thousands)
2019 and
After
Total
$
$
400,000
233,000
633,000
$
$
— $
—
— $
— $
—
— $
— $
—
— $
— $
400,000
—
233,000
— $
633,000
Each advance is payable at its maturity date. Advances paid early are subject to a prepayment penalty. At December 31, 2014
and 2013, the Bank’s advances from the FHLB were collateralized by certain real estate loans with an aggregate unpaid
principal balance of $1.84 billion and $740.1 million, respectively. The Bank’s investment in capital stock of the FHLB of San
Francisco totaled $29.8 million and $14.4 million, respectively, at December 31, 2014 and 2013. Based on this collateral and
the Bank’s holdings of FHLB stock, the Bank was eligible to borrow an additional $501.3 million at December 31, 2014. In
addition, the Bank had available lines of credit with the Federal Reserve Bank totaling $102.3 million at December 31, 2014.
The following table presents financial data of FHLB advances as of the dates or for the periods indicated:
Weighted-average interest rate at end of year
Average interest rate during the year
Average balance
Maximum amount outstanding at any month-end
Balance at end of year
As of or For the Year Ended December 31,
2014
2013
2012
($ in thousands)
0.29%
0.20%
267,816
633,000
633,000
$
$
$
0.13%
0.36%
74,712
250,000
250,000
$
$
$
$
$
$
0.44%
0.64%
54,030
100,000
75,000
160
NOTE 12 – LONG TERM DEBT
Senior Notes
On April 23, 2012, the Company completed the public offering of $33.0 million aggregate principal amount of its 7.50 percent
Senior Notes due April 15, 2020 (the Senior Notes) at a price to the public of $25.00 per Senior Note. Net proceeds after
discounts were approximately $31.7 million. The Senior Notes were issued under the Senior Debt Securities Indenture, dated as
of April 23, 2012 (the Base Indenture), as supplemented by the First Supplemental Indenture, dated as of April 23, 2012 (the
Supplemental Indenture, and together with the Base Indenture, the Indenture), between the Company and U.S. Bank National
Association, as trustee.
On December 6, 2012, the Company completed the issuance and sale of an additional $45.0 million aggregate principal amount
of the Senior Notes at a price to the public of $25.00 per Senior Note, plus accrued interest from October 15, 2012. Net
proceeds after discounts, including a full exercise of the $6.8 million underwriters’ overallotment option on December 7, 2012,
were approximately $50.1 million.
The Senior Notes are the Company’s senior unsecured debt obligations and rank equally with all of the Company’s other
present and future unsecured unsubordinated obligations. The Senior Notes bear interest at a per-annum rate of 7.50 percent.
The Company makes interest payments on the Notes quarterly in arrears.
The Senior Notes will mature on April 15, 2020. However, the Company may, at the Company’s option, on April 15, 2015, or
on any scheduled interest payment date thereafter, redeem the Senior Notes in whole or in part on not less than 30 nor more
than 60 days’ prior notice. The Senior Notes will be redeemable at a redemption price equal to 100 percent of the principal
amount of the Senior Notes to be redeemed plus accrued and unpaid interest to the date of redemption.
The Indenture contains several covenants which, among other things, restrict the Company’s ability and the ability of the
Company’s subsidiaries to dispose of or incur liens on the voting stock of certain subsidiaries and also contains customary
events of default.
Tangible Equity Units – Amortizing Notes
On May 21, 2014, the Company issued $69,000,000 of 8.00% tangible equity units (TEUs) in an underwritten public offering.
A total of 1,380,000 TEUs were issued, including 180,000 TEUs issued to the underwriter upon exercise of its overallotment
option, with each TEU having a stated amount of $50.00. Each TEU is comprised of (i) a prepaid stock purchase contract (each
a Purchase Contract) that will be settled by delivery of a specified number of shares of Company Common Stock and (ii) a
junior subordinated amortizing note due May 15, 2017 (each an Amortizing Note) that has an initial principal amount of
$10.604556 per Amortizing Note, bears interest at a rate of 7.50% per annum and has a scheduled final installment payment
date of May 15, 2017. The Company has the right to defer installment payments on the Amortizing Notes at any time and from
time to time, subject to certain restrictions, so long as such deferral period does not extend beyond May 15, 2019.
The Purchase Contracts and Amortizing Notes are accounted for separately. The Purchase Contract component of the TEUs is
recorded in Additional Paid in Capital on the Consolidated Statements of Financial Condition. The Amortizing Note is recorded
in Notes Payable on the Consolidated Statements of Financial Condition. The relative fair values of the Amortizing Notes and
Purchase Contracts were estimated to be approximately $14,634,000 and $54,366,000, respectively. Total issuance costs
associated with the TEUs were $4,041,000 (including the underwriter discount of $3,278,000), of which $857,000 was
allocated to the liability component and $3,184,000 was allocated to the equity component of the TEUs. The portion of the
issuance costs allocated to the debt component of the TEUs is being amortized over the term of the amortizing note. Net
proceeds of $64,959,000 from the issuance of the TEUs were designated to partially finance the Company’s previously
announced acquisition of 20 California branches from BPNA and for general corporate purposes. See Note 18 for additional
information.
161
NOTE 13 – INCOME TAXES
The following table presents the components of income tax (benefit) expense for the periods indicated:
Current income taxes:
Federal
State
Total current income tax expense (benefit)
Deferred income taxes:
Federal
State
Total deferred income tax (benefit) expense
Change in valuation allowance
Income tax (benefit) expense
Year Ended December 31,
2014
2013
2012
(In thousands)
$
10,340
$
(332) $
2,348
12,688
(307)
762
455
(17,684)
19
(313)
2,646
858
3,504
4,069
$
(4,541) $
7,260
$
34
—
34
(1,252)
(356)
(1,608)
1,689
115
The following table presents a reconciliation of the recorded income tax (benefit) expense to the amount of taxes computed by
applying the applicable statutory Federal income tax rate of 35 percent to earnings or loss before income taxes for the year
ended December 31, 2014 and the applicable statutory Federal income tax rate of 34 percent to earnings or loss before income
taxes for the years ended December 31, 2013 and 2012:
Year Ended December 31,
2014
2013
2012
Computed expected income tax expense (benefit) at Federal statutory rate
35.0 %
34.0 %
34.0 %
Increase (decrease) resulting from:
Book bargain purchase gain
Other permanent book-tax differences
State tax expense, net of federal benefit
Change in valuation allowance
Federal effect of state tax deferred due to the change in valuation allowance
Other, net
Effective tax rates
— %
0.3 %
8.3 %
(68.6 )%
7.4 %
— %
(17.6)%
— %
3.6 %
7.8 %
55.4 %
— %
(1.9)%
98.9 %
(68.4)%
9.1 %
(3.8)%
30.4 %
— %
0.8 %
2.1 %
The Company had net income taxes payable of $56 thousand at December 31, 2014 and net income tax receivable of $3.0
million at December 31, 2013 on its Consolidated Statements of Financial Condition. The Company had available at December
31, 2014, $4.3 million of unused Federal net operating loss carryforwards that may be applied against future taxable income
through 2031. The Company had available at December 31, 2014, $13.8 million of unused state net operating loss
carryforwards that may be applied against future taxable income through 2031. Utilization of the net operating loss and other
carryforwards are subject to annual limitations set forth in Section 382 of the Internal Revenue Code. The tax attributes
acquired in the Beach Business Bank and Gateway Bancorp acquisitions are subject to an annual Section 382 limitation of $1.3
million and $474 thousand, respectively.
162
The following table presents the tax effects of temporary differences that give rise to significant portions of deferred tax assets
and deferred tax liabilities as of the dates indicated:
December 31,
2014
2013
2012
(In thousands)
Deferred tax assets:
Allowance for loan and lease losses
$
17,923
$
15,138
$
Investment in partnership
Stock options and awards
Accrued expenses
Valuation allowance on other real estate owned
Reserve for loss on repurchased loans
Federal net operating losses
State net operating losses
Federal credits
Unrealized loss on securities available for sale
Other deferred tax assets
Total deferred tax assets
Deferred tax liabilities:
Unrealized gain on securities available for sale
Derivative instruments adjustment
Investment in partnership
Mortgage servicing rights
FHLB stock dividends
Intangible amortization
Other deferred tax liabilities
Total deferred tax liabilities
Valuation allowance
Net deferred tax assets
72
3,991
2,898
13
3,491
1,494
973
10
—
2,374
33,239
(307)
(1,421)
—
(8,023)
(571)
(3,595)
(2,877)
(16,794)
—
316
2,212
2,112
—
2,433
3,988
4,235
1,764
662
1,509
34,369
—
(2,362)
—
(6,070)
(609)
(5,460)
(2,525)
(17,026)
(17,343)
$
16,445
$
— $
9,537
—
1,336
1,515
852
1,421
2,357
2,314
1,749
—
1,453
22,534
(1,219)
(736)
(6)
(716)
(618)
(2,451)
(800)
(6,546)
(8,416)
7,572
Deferred tax assets are reduced by a valuation allowance when, in the opinion of management, it is more likely than not that
some portion, or all, of the deferred tax asset will not be realized. In assessing the realization of deferred tax assets,
management will continue to evaluate both positive and negative evidence on a quarterly basis, including the existence of any
cumulative losses in the current year and the prior two years, the amount of taxes paid in available carry-back years, and tax
planning strategies. Based on this analysis, the management determined that it was more likely than not that all of the deferred
tax assets would be realized therefore no valuation allowance against net deferred tax assets of $16.4 million was required at
December 31, 2014. The Company had recorded a full valuation allowance of $17.3 million against its net deferred tax assets at
December 31, 2013.
The positive evidence supporting the reversal of the Company’s deferred tax asset valuation allowance as of December 31,
2014 included: (i) pretax book income of $25.8 million and estimated taxable income before net operating losses (NOL) of
$42.8 million for the year ended December 31, 2014, (ii) four consecutive quarters of positive and accelerating pretax book
income from core earnings, (iii) cumulative pretax book income of approximately $27.5 million over the previous 36 month
period (without regard to the bargain purchase gain in 2012 related to the Gateway acquisition), (iv) projections of pretax book
income for the 2015, 2016 and 2017 years, (v) projection of significant taxable income for the 2015, 2016, and 2017 years, (vi)
utilization of $7.9 million and $23.0 million of Federal and State net operating losses (representing approximately 64 percent of
the total NOL’s included in the Company’s deferred tax assets) during the year ended December 31, 2014, and (vii) acquisitions
which strengthened the Company’s position in primary existing and new markets. Generally, to the extent the Company has
book income it will also have taxable income (with the exception of book/tax differences related to the timing of loan charge-
offs versus loan loss provisions and the timing of certain mortgage banking gains and losses). Continued profitability from core
banking operations through 2014, without significant loan losses, suggests that pretax book income should be sustainable for
future years absent a significant increase in loan losses.
163
The negative evidence that management considered included: (i) uncertainty in accurately and consistently projecting earnings
from operations for tax years ending after December 31, 2014, and (ii) taxable losses generated for the 2012 and 2013 years.
During 2014, estimated taxable income of $42.8 million allowed the Company to utilize $7.9 million and $23.0 million of
Federal and State net operating losses (representing approximately 64 percent of the total NOL’s included in the Company’s
deferred tax assets), and all of its $1.7 million of Federal low income housing tax credits. The remaining net operating losses
are limited under IRC section 382 and will expire if not used by 2031. In order to utilize all of its existing net operating loss
carryover, the Company would only need taxable income of approximately $1.4 million in 2018 and approximately $500
thousand in each year from 2019 to 2031. The Company believes that the utilization of a significant portion of the net operating
losses and tax credits in 2014, along with the Company’s projection of future taxable income should be considered significant
positive evidence that the net operating loss deferred tax assets will be realized in future periods. Taking all of the foregoing
information into account, management believes that it is “more likely than not” that all of the Company’s federal and state net
deferred assets will be realized in future years and that, as of December 31, 2014, no valuation allowance against its federal and
state deferred tax assets is required.
The Company adopted the provisions of ASC 740-10-25, which relates to the accounting for uncertainty in income taxes
recognized in an enterprise’s financial statements on January 1, 2007. ASC 740-10-25 prescribes a threshold and a
measurement process for recognizing in the financial statements a tax position taken or expected to be taken in a tax return and
also provides guidance on derecognition, classification, interest and penalties, accounting in interim periods, disclosure and
transition.
At December 31, 2014 and 2013, the Company had $23 thousand and $0 accrued interest or penalties, respectively. The table
below summaries the activity related to our unrecognized tax benefits:
Beginning balance
Increase related to prior year tax positions
Increase in current year tax positions
Ending balance
Year Ended December 31,
2014
2013
2012
$
$
(In thousands)
2,203
$
— $
369
2,849
345
1,858
5,421
$
2,203
$
—
—
—
—
The unrecognized tax benefits, if recognized, would not result in a reduction of income tax expense.
164
NOTE 14 – MORTGAGE BANKING ACTIVITIES
The Bank originates conforming single family residential mortgage loans and sells these loans in the secondary market. The
amount of net revenue on mortgage banking activities is a function of mortgage loans originated for sale and the fair values of
these loans and related derivatives. Net revenue on mortgage banking activities includes mark to market pricing adjustments on
loan commitments and forward sales contracts, and initial capitalized value of mortgage servicing rights (MSRs).
During the year ended December 31, 2014, the Bank originated $2.82 billion and sold $2.75 billion of conforming single
family residential mortgage loans in the secondary market. The net gain and margin were $84.1 million and 3.0 percent,
respectively, and loan origination fees were $11.3 million for the year ended December 31, 2014. Included in the net gain is the
initial capitalized value of our MSRs, which totaled $25.2 million on loans sold to Fannie Mae, Freddie Mac and Ginnie Mae
for the year ended December 31, 2014.
During the year ended December 31, 2013, the Bank originated $1.94 billion and sold $1.86 billion of conforming single
family residential mortgage loans in the secondary market. The net gain and margin were $58.0 million and 3.0 percent,
respectively, and loan origination fees were $9.9 million for the year ended December 31, 2013. Included in the net gain is the
initial capitalized value of our MSRs, which totaled $10.9 million on loans sold to Fannie Mae and Freddie Mac for the year
ended December 31, 2013.
During the year ended December 31, 2012, the Bank originated $518 million and sold $477 million of conforming single
family residential mortgage loans in the secondary market. The net gain and margin were $18.9 million and 3.7 percent,
respectively, and loan origination fees were $2.8 million for the year ended December 31, 2012. Included in the net gain is the
initial capitalized value of our MSRs, which totaled $441 thousand on loans sold to Fannie Mae and Freddie Mac for the year
ended December 31, 2012.
Mortgage Loan Repurchase Obligations
In addition to net revenue on mortgage banking activities, the Company records provisions to the representation and warranty
reserve representing our initial estimate of losses on probable mortgage repurchases or loss reimbursements. Total provision for
loan repurchases totaled $4.2 million, $2.4 million and $256 thousand for the years ended December 31, 2014, 2013 and 2012,
respectively. Of these total provision for loan repurchases, the Company provided initial provision for loan repurchases of $1.4
million against net revenue on mortgage banking activities during the year ended December 31, 2014.
The following table presents a summary of activity in the reserve for loss on repurchased loans for the periods indicated:
Balance at beginning of year
Acquired in business combinations
Provision for loan repurchases
Payments made for loss reimbursement on sold loans
Balance at end of year
Year Ended December 31,
2014
2013
2012
(In thousands)
5,427
$
3,485
$
—
4,243
(1,367)
314
2,383
(755)
8,303
$
5,427
$
$
$
—
3,254
256
(25)
3,485
165
NOTE 15 – RISK MANAGEMENT AND DERIVATIVE INSTRUMENTS
The Company uses derivative instruments and other risk management techniques to reduce its exposure to adverse fluctuations
in interest rates in accordance with its risk management policies. The Company utilizes forward contracts and investor
commitments to economically hedge mortgage banking products and may from time to time use interest rate swaps as hedges
against certain liabilities.
On September 30, 2013, the Company entered into pay-fixed, receive-variable interest-rate swap contracts with institutional
counterparties to hedge against variability in cash flows attributable to interest rate risk caused by changes in the LIBOR
benchmark interest rate on the Company’s ongoing LIBOR based variable rate deposits. The Company is accounting for the
swaps as cash flow hedges under ASC 815. The notional amount of the interest rate swaps is $50.0 million with a maturity date
of September 27, 2018. The fair values of the interest rate swaps were loss of $235 thousand and gain of $226 thousand at
December 31, 2014 and 2013, respectively.
The Company originates residential real estate mortgage loans and generates revenues from the origination and sale of these
loans. Although management closely monitors market conditions, such activities are sensitive to fluctuations in prevailing
interest rates and real estate markets. As of December 31, 2014, approximately 79.8 percent of all properties securing loans
held for sale were located in California. A change in the underlying economic conditions of the California residential real estate
market could have an adverse impact on the Company’s results of operations.
In connection with mortgage banking activities, if interest rates increase, the value of the Company’s loan commitments to
borrowers and fixed rate mortgage loans held-for-sale are adversely impacted. The Company attempts to economically hedge
the risk of the overall change in the fair value of loan commitments to borrowers and mortgage loans held for sale by selling
forward contracts on securities with government-sponsored enterprises (GSEs) and investors in loans. Forward contracts on
securities of GSEs and loan commitments to borrowers are non-designated derivative instruments and the gains and losses
resulting from these derivative instruments are included in Net Revenue on Mortgage Banking Activities on the Consolidated
Statements of Operations. At December 31, 2014, the resulting derivative assets of $6.4 million and liabilities of $3.0 million,
are included in Other Assets and Accrued Expenses and Other Liabilities, respectively, on the Consolidated Statements of
Financial Condition. At December 31, 2014, the Company had outstanding forward sales commitments totaling $390.6 million.
At December 31, 2014, the Company was committed to fund loans for borrowers of approximately $190.0 million.
The net losses relating to free-standing derivative instruments used for risk management were $17.3 million, $270 thousand and
$0 for the years ended December 31, 2014, 2013 and 2012, respectively, and are included in Net Revenue on Mortgage
Banking Activities on the Consolidated Statements of Operations.
The following table presents the amount and market value of derivative instruments included in the Consolidated Statements of
Financial Condition as of the dates indicated. Note 3 contains further disclosures pertaining to the fair value of mortgage
banking derivatives.
Included in assets:
Interest rate lock commitments
Mandatory forward commitments
Interest rate swap
Total included in assets
Included in liabilities:
Interest rate lock commitments
Mandatory forward commitments
Interest rate swap
Total included in liabilities
December 31,
2014
2013
Notional
Amount
Fair Value
Notional
Amount
Fair Value
(In thousands)
$
$
$
$
179,923
$
5,750
$
129,010
$
25,735
—
205,658
10,075
364,829
50,000
$
$
629
—
6,379
197
2,803
235
$
$
242,337
50,000
421,347
$
— $
—
—
424,904
$
3,235
$
— $
3,962
1,305
226
5,493
—
—
—
—
166
NOTE 16 – EMPLOYEE STOCK COMPENSATION
Share-based Compensation Expense
For the years ended December 31, 2014, 2013 and 2012, share-based compensation expense on stock option awards, restricted
stock awards and restricted stock units was $6.3 million, $2.9 million, and $1.7 million respectively, and the related tax benefits
(expense) were $2.7 million, $0 and $(17) thousand, respectively.
On July 16, 2013, the Company’s stockholders approved the Company’s 2013 Omnibus Stock Incentive Plan (the 2013
Omnibus Plan). Upon the approval of the 2013 Omnibus Plan, the Company ceased being able to grant new awards under the
Company’s 2011 Omnibus Incentive Plan or any prior equity incentive plans. The 2013 Omnibus Plan provides that the
aggregate number of shares of Company common stock that may be subject to awards under the 2013 Omnibus Plan will be 20
percent of the then outstanding shares of Company common stock (the Share Limit), provided that in no event will the Share
Limit be less than the greater of 2,384,711 shares of Company common stock and the aggregate number of shares of Company
common stock with respect to which awards have been properly granted under the 2013 Omnibus Plan up to that point in time.
As of December 31, 2014, based on the number of shares then-registered for issuance under the 2013 Omnibus Plan, 540,606
shares were available for future awards under the 2013 Omnibus Plan.
Unrecognized Share-based Compensation Expense
The following table presents unrecognized share-based compensation expense as of December 31, 2014:
Stock option awards
Restricted stock awards and restricted stock units
Total
Stock Options
Unrecognized
Expense
Average
Expected
Recognition
Period
($ in thousands)
$
$
1,096
10,380
11,476
3.1 years
3.6 years
3.5 years
The Company has issued stock options to certain employees, officers and directors. Stock options are issued at the closing
market price immediately before the grant date, and generally have a three-to five-year vesting period and contractual terms of
seven to ten years.
The weighted-average estimated fair value per share options granted was estimated on the date of grant using the Black-
Scholes option-pricing model with the following weighted-average assumptions.
Granted date fair value of options granted
Fair value of options vested
Total intrinsic value of options exercised
Cash received from options exercised
Weighted-average estimated fair value per share of options granted
Year Ended December 31,
2014
2013
2012
($ in thousands, except per share data)
$
$
$
$
$
781
346
110
993
3.38
$
$
$
$
$
1,399
1,090
104
$
$
$
— $
3.52
$
634
—
—
—
3.84
Expected volatility was determined based on the historical monthly volatility of our stock price over a period equal to the
expected term of the options granted. The expected term of the options represents the period that options granted are expected
to be outstanding based primarily on the historical exercise behavior associated with previous options grants. The risk-free
interest rate was based on the U.S. Treasury yield curve at the time of grant for a period equal to the expected term of the
options granted.
167
The following table presents a summary of weighted-average assumptions used for calculating fair value options for the periods
indicated:
Weighted-average assumptions
Dividend yield
Expected volatility
Expected term
Risk-free interest rate
Year Ended December 31,
2014
2013
2012
3.69%
40.26%
6.0 years
1.99%
3.87%
41.06%
5.0 years
1.21%
4.07%
47.18%
10.0 years
1.67%
The following table represents stock option activity and weighted-average exercise price per share for the periods indicated:
Year Ended December 31,
2014
2013
2012
Weighted-
Average
Exercise
Price per
Share
Number of
Shares
734,721
231,016
$
$
— $
(86,667) $
— $
879,070
166,016
$
$
12.73
12.05
—
11.46
—
12.67
11.28
Weighted-
Average
Exercise
Price per
Share
12.16
13.72
12.65
12.00
13.41
12.73
12.00
Number of
Shares
525,799
389,569
22,581
$
$
$
(44,988) $
(158,240) $
734,721
526,667
$
$
Weighted-
Average
Exercise
Price per
Share
12.01
11.54
—
—
11.80
12.16
12.46
Number of
Shares
918,569
165,000
$
$
— $
— $
(557,770) $
525,799
259,131
$
$
Outstanding at beginning of year
Granted
Replacement awards issued
Exercised
Forfeited
Outstanding at end of year
Exercisable at end of year
The following table represents changes in unvested stock options and related information as of and for the periods indicated:
Year Ended December 31,
2014
2013
2012
Weighted-
Average
Exercise
Price per
Share
13.16
12.05
12.94
—
12.74
Number
of Shares
419,569
231,016
$
$
(97,913) $
— $
552,672
$
Weighted-
Average
Exercise
Price per
Share
11.70
13.72
11.68
12.95
13.16
Number
of Shares
266,668
389,569
$
$
(93,334) $
(143,334) $
419,569
$
Weighted-
Average
Exercise
Price per
Share
12.17
11.80
13.26
11.90
11.70
Number
of Shares
723,904
165,000
$
$
(170,236) $
(452,000) $
266,668
$
Outstanding at beginning of year
Granted
Vested
Forfeited
Outstanding at end of year
168
The following table presents a summary of stock options outstanding as of December 31, 2014:
Options Outstanding
Options Exercisable
Number
of Shares
Intrinsic
Value
Weighted-
Average
Exercise
Price per
Share
Weighted-
Average
Remaining
Contractual
Life
Number
of Shares
Intrinsic
Value
Weighted-
Average
Exercise
Price per
Share
Weighted-
Average
Remaining
Contractual
Life
$10.89 to $11.47
166,016
$
31,529
$
$12.50 to $13.50
$13.50 to $14.50
$13.50 to $14.50
$14.50 to $15.81
380,000
125,000
167,162
40,892
— $
— $
— $
— $
Total
879,070
$
31,529
$
11.28
12.10
13.13
14.25
15.81
12.67
7.5 years
8.1 years
8.5 years
4.5 years
6.5 years
166,016
$
31,529
$
11.28
7.5 years
—
—
—
—
— $
— $
— $
— $
—
—
—
—
0.0 years
0.0 years
0.0 years
0.0 years
7.3 years
166,016
$
31,529
$
11.28
7.5 years
Restricted Stock Awards and Restricted Stock Units
The Company also has granted restricted stock awards and restricted stock units to certain employees, officers and directors.
The restricted stock awards and units are valued at the closing price of the Company’s stock on the date of award. The
restricted stock awards and units fully vest after a specified number of years (ranging from one to five years) of continued
service from the date of grant. The Company recognizes an income tax deduction in an amount equal to the taxable income
reported by the holders of the restricted stock, generally when vested or, in the case of restricted stock units, when settled.
The following table represents restricted stock awards and restricted stock units activity for the periods indicated:
Year Ended December 31,
2014
2013
2012
Number of
Shares
893,886
915,077
$
$
(261,952) $
(259,709) $
1,287,302
$
Weighted-
Average
Price per
Share
Number of
Shares
Weighted-
Average
Price per
Share
Number of
Shares
Weighted-
Average
Price per
Share
13.78
11.77
13.51
13.21
12.53
163,682
936,542
$
$
(88,169) $
(118,169) $
893,886
$
11.43
13.82
11.98
12.70
13.78
58,716
224,943
$
$
(104,414) $
(15,563) $
163,682
$
13.28
11.72
12.45
15.81
11.43
Outstanding at beginning of year
Granted
Vested
Forfeited
Outstanding at end of year
Stock Appreciation Rights
On August 21, 2012, the Company granted to its chief executive officer a ten-year stock appreciation right (SAR) with respect
to 500,000 shares (Initial SAR) of the Company’s common stock with a base price of $12.12 per share. One third of the Initial
SAR vested on the grant date, one third vested on the first anniversary of the grant date and one-third vested on the second
anniversary of the grant date such that the SAR was fully vested on the second anniversary of the grant date. Upon cessation of
the chief executive officer’s service with the Company for “Cause” or without “Good Reason” (including a cessation of service
following the expiration of the term of the chief executive officer’s employment agreement), the vested portion of all SARs will
expire 90 days following the cessation of service. Except as otherwise described below for the Additional SAR VI, additional
SARs (Additional SARs) have been issued to the Company’s chief executive officer with the same terms and conditions
(including vesting and dividend equivalent rights) as the Initial SAR pursuant to the anti-dilution provisions under the SAR
agreement with the Company due to the Company’s subsequent issuances of shares of common stock.
On May 21, 2014, the Company issued additional SARs (Additional SAR VI) to the Company’s chief executive officer relating
to a public offering of the Company’s tangible equity units (TEUs). Each TEU is comprised of a prepaid stock purchase
contract (each, a Purchase Contract) and a junior subordinated amortizing note due May 15, 2017 issued by the Company
(each, an Amortizing Note). Unless settled early at the holder’s option, each Purchase Contract will automatically settle and the
Company will deliver a number of shares of its voting common stock based on the then applicable market value of the voting
common stock, ranging from an initial minimum settlement rate of 4.4456 shares per Purchase Contract (subject to adjustment)
if the applicable market value is equal to or greater than $11.247 per share to an initial maximum settlement rate of 5.1124
shares per Purchase Contract (subject to adjustment) if the applicable market value is less than or equal to $9.78 per share. The
number of settlement shares underlying the Additional SAR VI was calculated using the initial maximum settlement rate and,
169
therefore, the number of shares underlying the Additional SAR VI is subject to adjustment and forfeiture if the aggregate
number of shares of stock issued in settlement of any single Purchase Contract is less than the initial maximum settlement rate.
Until each Purchase Contract settles and the voting common stock related thereto is issued, each corresponding Additional SAR
VI has a vesting date of May 21, 2017 and has no dividend equivalent rights prior to vesting. The Additional SAR VI vests
earlier as follows: (i) for any Purchase Contract settled before August 21, 2014, the Additional SAR VI corresponding to such
Purchase Contract became 2/3 vested and exercisable on the date on which any such Purchase Contract was settled and the
remaining 1/3 became vested and exercisable on August 21, 2014 and, until it became vested on August 21, 2014, the 1/3
unvested Additional SAR VI corresponding to such Purchase Contract was eligible for the same dividend equivalent rights as
the Initial SAR; (ii) for any Purchase Contract settled in shares of voting common stock on or after August 21, 2014, then the
Additional SAR VI corresponding to such Purchase Contract shall become 100% vested and exercisable on the date on which
any such Purchase Contract is settled; and (iii) if the aggregate number of shares of voting common stock issued in settlement
of any single Purchase Contract on the settlement date (the Actually Issued Common Shares) is less than the initial maximum
settlement rate, then the Additional SAR VI related to that single Purchase Contract shall be recalculated and adjusted pursuant
to the terms of the Initial SAR based on the Actually Issued Common Shares instead of the initial maximum settlement rate and
the chief executive officer shall forfeit on such settlement date any Additional SAR VI granted in excess of those that would
have been granted on the respective settlement date.
The following table represents a summary of all outstanding SARs (Initial SAR and Additional SARs, together the SARs):
Grant Date
Initial SAR
8/21/2012
Additional
SAR I (1)
6/21/2013
Additional
SAR II (2)
7/1/2013
Additional
SAR III (3)
7/2/2013
Additional
SAR IV (4)
12/10/2013
Additional
SAR V (5)
5/21/2014
Additional
SAR VI (6)
5/21/2014
Additional
SAR VII (7)
11/7/2014
Number of shares
500,000
150,933
Base price per share
Fair value per share
$
$
12.12
2.77
$
$
13.06
2.38
$
$
88,366
13.60
2.17
15,275
13.55
2.19
$
$
70,877
252,023
281,586
216,334
$
$
12.83
2.47
$
$
10.09
1.65
$
$
10.09
2.22
Risk-free interest
rate
Expected term
Expected stock price
volatility
Dividend yield
0.36%
2.55
0.36%
2.55
0.36%
2.55
0.36%
2.55
0.36%
2.55
0.42%
2.11
0.79%
3.00
30.54%
30.54%
30.54%
30.54%
30.54%
27.82%
30.85%
—%
—%
—%
—%
—%
—%
—%
11.62
1.84
0.91%
2.92
21.68%
—%
(1) Issued due to the Company’s common stock issuance for an underwritten public offering completed on June 21, 2013.
(2) Issued due to the Company’s common stock issuance in connection with the PBOC acquisition completed on July 1, 2013.
(3) Issued due to the Company’s common stock issuance for the exercise of over-allotment option granted to the underwriters of the
Company’s public common stock offering initially completed on June 21, 2013.
(4) Issued due to the Company’s common stock issuance in a private placement completed on December 10, 2013.
(5) Issued due to the Company’s common stock issuance for an underwritten public offering completed on May 21, 2014.
(6) The Additional SAR VI originally related to 300,219 shares of common stock with a scheduled vesting of May 21, 2017, as described
above. As a result of the settlements of portions of the Purchase Contacts, the Additional SAR VI accelerated in vesting with respect to
133,997 shares and 18,633 shares were forfeited as of December 31, 2014. The portion of Additional SAR VI that has accelerated in
vesting has the same terms and conditions as the Initial SAR.
(7) Issued due to the Company's common stock issuance for a private placement completed on November 7, 2014.
The SARs originally were to be settled in cash and the compensation expense for the SARs was recognized over the vesting
period based on the fair value as calculated using Black Scholes as of the grant date and adjusted each quarter. On
December 13, 2013, the Company amended the Initial SAR agreement to provide that the SARs be settled in shares of voting
common stock rather than cash, with all other terms remaining substantially the same. Currently, compensation expense is
recognized over the vesting period based on the fair value as calculated using Black Scholes as of the conversion date for the
SARs issued before the conversion date and grant dates for the SARs issued after the conversion date.
170
NOTE 17 – EMPLOYEE BENEFIT PLANS
The Company has a 401(k) plan whereby all employees can participate in the plan. Employees may contribute up to 100
percent of their compensation subject to certain limits based on federal tax laws. The Company makes an enhanced safe-harbor
matching contribution that equals to 100 percent of the first 4 percent of the employee’s deferral rate not to exceed 4 percent of
the employee’s compensation. The safe-harbor matching contribution is fully vested by the participant when made.
For the years ended December 31, 2014, 2013 and 2012 expense attributable to 401(k) plans amounted to $2.5 million, $1.7
million and $709 thousand, respectively.
The Company has adopted a Deferred Compensation Plan under Section 401 of the Internal Revenue Code. The purpose of this
plan is to provide specified benefits to a select group of management and highly compensated employees. Participants may
elect to defer compensation, which accrues interest quarterly at the prime rate as reflected in The Wall Street Journal as of the
last business day of the prior quarter. The Company does not make contributions to the Plan.
Employee Equity Ownership Plan
The Company established the Employee Equity Ownership Plan (EEOP) effective October 15, 2013 for the benefit of
employees. The EEOP is administered under the Company’s 2013 Omnibus Stock Incentive Plan and the awards thereunder are
issued upon the terms and conditions and subject to the restrictions of the Company’s 2013 Omnibus Stock Incentive Plan. The
EEOP provides that employees eligible to receive awards under the EEOP are any employees with titles below Assistant Vice
President or any employees who are not otherwise given shares pursuant to any other Company-sponsored equity program. The
Company issued 324,540 shares of restricted stock awards and units under the EEOP.
Employee Stock Ownership Plan
The Company maintained the Employee Stock Ownership Plan (ESOP) for the benefit of its employees. The Company issued
423,200 shares of common stock to the ESOP in exchange for a ten-year note in the amount of approximately $5.1 million. The
$5.1 million for the ESOP purchase was borrowed from the Company. The ESOP was terminated effective December 2011 and
was completely distributed in October 2013. The ten-year note was paid in full at December 31, 2011.
Shares issued to the ESOP were allocated to ESOP participants based on principal repayments made by the ESOP on the loan
from the Company. The loan was secured by shares purchased with the loan proceeds and was repaid by the ESOP with funds
from the Company’s contributions to the ESOP and earnings on ESOP assets. Principal payments were scheduled to occur over
a ten-year period. Dividends on allocated and/or unearned shares first reduced accrued interest and secondly principal.
During 2011 and 2010, 42,320 shares of stock with an average fair value of $14.29 and $10.75 per share were committed to be
released, resulting in ESOP compensation expense of $605 thousand and $455 thousand, respectively, for each year. As of
December 31, 2012, the remaining shares committed to be released were fully allocated to participants. There was no ESOP
compensation expense recorded during 2012. During 2011 and 2010, 1,861, and 144 shares were forfeited, respectively. There
were no shares forfeited during 2012. Per the terms of the ESOP plan, the forfeited shares were sold out of the plan and the
proceeds were used to reduce the Company’s contribution resulting in a reduction of compensation expense. The ESOP was
completely liquidated in October 2013.
171
NOTE 18 – STOCKHOLDERS’ EQUITY
Warrants
On November 1, 2010, the Company issued warrants to TCW Shared Opportunity Fund V, L.P. for up to 240,000 shares of non-
voting common stock at an original exercise price of $11.00 per share, subject to certain adjustments to the number of shares
underlying the warrants as well as certain adjustments to the warrant exercise price as applicable. These warrants are
exercisable from the date of original issuance through November 1, 2015.
On November 1, 2010, the Company also issued warrants to COR Advisors LLC, an entity controlled by Steven A. Sugarman,
who became a director of the Company on that date and later became President and Chief Executive Officer of the Company, to
purchase up to 1,395,000 shares of non-voting common stock at an exercise price of $11.00 per share, subject to certain
adjustments to the number of shares underlying the warrants as well as certain adjustments to the warrant exercise price as
applicable. As a result of transfers of these warrants subsequent to their original issuance, warrants for the right to purchase
960,000 shares of non-voting common stock are now held by Mr. Sugarman and his spouse through a living trust, and warrants
for the right to purchase 435,000 shares of non-voting common stock are now held by Jeffrey T. Seabold, Executive Vice
President and Chief Lending Officer of the Bank. These warrants vested in tranches, with the first tranche vesting on January 1,
2011 and the last tranche vesting on July 1, 2013 and with each respective tranche being exercisable for five years after the
tranche's vesting date.
The warrants are exercisable for voting common stock in lieu of non-voting common stock following the transfer of the
warrants in a widely dispersed offering or in other limited circumstances. Based on automatic adjustments to the original
$11.00 exercise price, the Company has determined that the exercise price for these warrants was $9.32 per share as of
December 31, 2014. The terms and issuance of the foregoing warrants were approved by the Company's stockholders at a
special meeting held on October 25, 2010.
Common Stock
On June 21, 2013, the Company issued 2,268,000 shares of its voting common stock in an underwritten public offering for
gross proceeds of approximately $29.5 million and 1,153,846 shares of voting common stock to two institutional investors in a
registered direct offering for gross proceeds of approximately $15 million.
On July 2, 2013, the Company issued an additional 360,000 shares of voting common stock upon the exercise in full by the
underwriters of the underwritten public offering of their 30-day over-allotment option, for additional gross proceeds of
approximately $4.4 million.
On December 10, 2013, the Company completed the issuance and sale of an aggregate of 1,509,450 shares of common stock in
a private placement to Patriot Financial Partners, L.P. and Patriot Financial Partners Parallel, L.P. at $13.25 per share, in
exchange for aggregate cash consideration of approximately $20 million.
On May 21, 2014, the Company issued 5,150,000 shares of its voting common stock in an underwritten public offering and for
gross proceeds of approximately $50.4 million and 772,500 shares of voting common stock upon the exercise in full by the
underwriters of the underwritten public offering of their 30-day over-allotment option, for additional gross proceeds of
approximately $7.6 million.
On November 7, 2014, the Company completed the issuance and sale of 3,288,947 shares of its voting common stock to OCM
BOCA Investor, LLC (Oaktree), an entity owned by investment funds managed by Oaktree Capital Management, L.P., and
1,900,000 shares of its voting common stock to Patriot Financial Partners, L.P., Patriot Financial Partners Parallel, L.P., Patriot
Financial Partners II, L.P. and Patriot Financial Partners Parallel II, L.P, for gross proceeds of $49.9 million.
Perpetual Preferred Stock
On June 12, 2013, in an underwritten public offering, the Company sold 1,400,000 depositary shares, each representing a
1/40th interest in a share of its 8.00 percent Non-Cumulative Perpetual Preferred Stock, Series C, par value $0.01 per share and
liquidation preference of $1,000 per share, at an offering price of $25.00 per depositary share, for gross proceeds of $33.9
million. The Company also granted the underwriters a 30-day option to purchase up to an additional 210,000 depositary shares
to cover over-allotments, if any, at the same price, for potential additional gross proceeds of $5.1 million, which the
underwriters exercised in full on July 8, 2013.
As discussed under Note 2, on July 1, 2013, the Company completed its previously announced acquisition of PBOC. Upon
completion of the acquisition, each share of preferred stock issued by PBOC as part of the Small Business Lending Fund
(SBLF) program of the United States Department of Treasury (10,000 shares in the aggregate with a liquidation preference
172
amount of $1,000 per share) was converted automatically into one substantially identical share of preferred stock of the
Company with a liquidation preference amount of $1,000 per share, designated as the Company’s Non-Cumulative Perpetual
Preferred Stock, Series B. The terms of the preferred stock issued by the Company in exchange for the PBOC preferred stock
are substantially identical to the preferred stock previously issued by the Company as part of its own participation in the SBLF
program (32,000 shares in aggregate with a liquidation preference amount of $1,000 per share), designated as the Company’s
Non-Cumulative Perpetual Preferred Stock, Series A.
Tangible Equity Units
On May 21, 2014, the Company completed an underwritten public offering of 1,380,000 of its tangible equity units (TEUs),
which included 180,000 TEUs issued to the underwriter upon the full exercise of its over-allotment option, resulting in net
proceeds of $65.0 million. Each TEU is comprised of a prepaid stock purchase contract (each, a Purchase Contract) and a
junior subordinated amortizing note due May 15, 2017 issued by the Company (each, an Amortizing Note). Unless settled early
at the holder’s option, each Purchase Contract will automatically settle and the Company will deliver a number of shares of its
voting common stock based on the then-applicable market value of the voting common stock, ranging from an initial minimum
settlement rate of 4.4456 shares per Purchase Contract (subject to adjustment) if the applicable market value is equal to or
greater than $11.247 per share to an initial maximum settlement rate of 5.1124 shares per Purchase Contract (subject to
adjustment) if the applicable market value is less than or equal to $9.78 per share.
From the first business day following the issuance of the TEUs to but excluding the third business day immediately preceding
May 15, 2017, a holder of a Purchase Contract may settle its Purchase Contract early, and the Company will deliver to the
holder 4.4456 shares of voting common stock. The holder also may elect to settle its Purchase Contract early in connection with
a “fundamental change,” in which case the holder will receive a number of shares of voting common stock based on a
fundamental change early settlement rate. The Company may elect to settle all Purchase Contracts early by delivering to each
holder 5.1124 shares of voting common stock or, under certain circumstances, by delivering 4.4456 shares of voting common
stock. As of December 31, 2014, a total of 656,692 Purchase Contracts had been settled early by their holders, resulting in the
issuance by the Company of 2,919,390 shares of voting common stock. As of December 31, 2014, 723,308 Purchase Contracts
remained outstanding.
Each Amortizing Note has an initial principal amount of $10.604556 per Amortizing Note, bears interest at a rate of 7.50% per
annum and has a scheduled final installment payment date of May 15, 2017. On each August 15, November 15, February 15
and May 15, commencing on August 15, 2014, the Company will pay holders of Amortizing Notes equal quarterly cash
installments of $1.00 per Amortizing Note (or, in the case of the installment payment due on August 15, 2014, $0.933333 per
Amortizing Note) (such installments, the installment payments), which installment payments in the aggregate will be
equivalent to a 8.00% cash distribution per year with respect to each $50.00 stated amount of TEUs. Each installment payment
will constitute a payment of interest (at a rate of 7.50% per annum) and a partial repayment of principal on each Amortizing
Note. The Company has the right to defer installment payments at any time and from time to time, subject to certain
restrictions, so long as such deferral period does not extend beyond May 15, 2019. If the Company elects to settle the Purchase
Contracts early, the holders of the Amortizing Notes will have the right to require the Company to repurchase the Amortizing
Notes. As of December 31, 2014, the Amortizing Notes totaled $12.0 million, net of unamortized discounts, and were included
in Notes Payable on the Consolidated Statements of Financial Condition.
173
Change in Accumulated Other Comprehensive Income
The Company’s accumulated other comprehensive income includes unrealized gain (losses) on available-for-sale investment
securities and unrealized gain on cash flow hedge. Changes to other accumulated other comprehensive income are presented
net of tax effect as a component of equity. Reclassifications from accumulated comprehensive income are recorded on the
statements of operations either as a gain or loss.
The following table presents changes to accumulated other comprehensive income for the periods indicated:
Balance at December 31, 2011
Unrealized gain(loss) arising during the period
Reclassification adjustment from other comprehensive income
Tax effect of current period changes
Total changes, net of taxes
Balance at December 31, 2012
Unrealized gain(loss) arising during the period
Reclassification adjustment from other comprehensive income
Tax effect of current period changes
Total changes, net of taxes
Balance at December 31, 2013
Unrealized gain(loss) arising during the period
Reclassification adjustment from other comprehensive income
Tax effect of current period changes
Total changes, net of taxes
Balance at December 31, 2014
Unrealized
Gain (Loss)
on AFS
Securities
Cash Flow
Hedge
(In thousands)
Total
$
$
$
$
$
$
(939) $
2,253
83
—
2,336
1,397
$
(1,892) $
(331)
—
(2,223)
(826) $
3,487
$
(1,183)
(969)
1,335
509
$
— $
—
—
—
—
— $
226
$
—
—
226
226
$
(461) $
—
99
(362)
(136) $
(939)
2,253
83
—
2,336
1,397
(1,666)
(331)
—
(1,997)
(600)
3,026
(1,183)
(870)
973
373
174
NOTE 19 – REGULATORY CAPITAL MATTERS
The Company and the Bank are subject to regulatory capital requirements administered by federal banking agencies. Capital
adequacy guidelines and, prompt corrective action regulations involve quantitative measures of assets, liabilities, and certain
off-balance-sheet items calculated under regulatory accounting practices. Capital amounts and classifications are also subject to
qualitative judgments by regulators. Failure to meet capital requirements can initiate regulatory action. Management believes as
of December 31, 2014, the Company and the Bank met all capital adequacy requirements to which they were then subject. With
respect to the Bank, prompt corrective action regulations provide five classifications: well capitalized, adequately capitalized,
undercapitalized, significantly undercapitalized, and critically undercapitalized, although these terms are not used to represent
overall financial condition. If only adequately capitalized, regulatory approval is required to accept brokered deposits. If
undercapitalized, capital distributions are limited, as is asset growth and expansion, and capital restoration plans are required.
At December 31, 2014, the most recent regulatory notifications categorized the Bank as well capitalized under the regulatory
framework for prompt corrective action. There are no conditions or events since that notification that management believes
have changed the institution’s category.
The following table presents the capital amounts and ratios for the Company and the Bank as of dates indicated:
Amount
Minimum Capital
Requirements
Minimum Required
to Be Well
Capitalized Under
Prompt Corrective
Action Provisions
Amount
Ratio
Amount
Ratio
Amount
Ratio
($ in thousands)
$
473,656
11.28% $
335,829
442,307
442,307
10.54%
8.57%
167,914
206,502
8.00%
4.00%
4.00%
N/A
N/A
N/A
$
503,727
12.04% $
334,834
8.00% $
418,543
472,378
472,378
11.29%
9.17%
167,417
206,095
4.00% $
251,126
4.00% $
257,619
$
307,457
12.45% $
197,503
281,786
281,786
11.41%
8.02%
98,752
140,463
8.00%
4.00%
4.00%
N/A
N/A
N/A
$
360,634
14.65% $
196,998
8.00% $
246,247
334,963
334,963
13.60%
9.58%
98,499
139,874
4.00%
4.00%
147,748
174,842
N/A
N/A
N/A
10.00%
6.00%
5.00%
N/A
N/A
N/A
10.00%
6.00%
5.00%
December 31, 2014
Banc of California, Inc.
Total risk-based capital ratio
Tier 1 risk-based capital ratio
Tier 1 leverage ratio
Banc of California, NA
Total risk-based capital ratio
Tier 1 risk-based capital ratio
Tier 1 leverage ratio
December 31, 2013
Banc of California, Inc.
Total risk-based capital ratio
Tier 1 risk-based capital ratio
Tier 1 leverage ratio
Banc of California, NA
Total risk-based capital ratio
Tier 1 risk-based capital ratio
Tier 1 leverage ratio
Through December 31, 2014, the FRB required bank holding companies such as the Company to maintain a minimum ratio of
qualifying total capital to risk-weighted assets of 8.0 percent and a minimum ratio of Tier 1 capital to risk-weighted assets of
4.0 percent. In addition to the risk-based guidelines, through December 31, 2014 the FRB required bank holding companies to
maintain a minimum ratio of Tier 1 capital to average total assets, referred to as the leverage ratio, of 4.0 percent. Through
December 31, 2014, in order to be considered “well capitalized,” federal bank regulatory agencies required depository
institutions such as the Bank to maintain a minimum ratio of qualifying total capital to risk-weighted assets of 10.0 percent, a
minimum ratio of Tier 1 capital to risk-weighted assets of 6.0 percent and a minimum ratio of Tier 1 capital to average total
assets, referred to as the leverage ratio, of 5.0 percent.
In July 2013, the Federal banking regulators approved a final rule to implement the revised capital adequacy standards of the
Basel Committee on Banking Supervision, commonly called Basel III, and to address relevant provisions of the Dodd-Frank
Wall Street Reform and Consumer Protection Act (the Dodd-Frank Act). The final rule strengthens the definition of regulatory
capital, increases risk-based capital requirements, makes selected changes to the calculation of risk-weighted assets, and adjusts
175
the prompt corrective action thresholds. The Company and the Bank became subject to the new rule on January 1, 2015 and
certain provisions of the new rule will be phased in over the period of 2015 through 2019.
The final rule:
•
Permits banking organizations that had less than $15 billion in total consolidated assets as of December 31, 2009, to
include in Tier 1 capital trust preferred securities and cumulative perpetual preferred stock that were issued and
included in Tier 1 capital prior to May 19, 2010, subject to a limit of 25 percent of Tier 1 capital elements, excluding
any non-qualifying capital instruments and after all regulatory capital deductions and adjustments have been applied to
Tier 1 capital.
• Establishes new qualifying criteria for regulatory capital, including new limitations on the inclusion of deferred tax
assets and mortgage servicing rights.
Increases the minimum Tier 1 capital to risk-weighted assets ratio requirement from 4 percent to 6 percent.
• Requires a minimum ratio of common equity Tier 1 capital to risk-weighted assets of 4.5 percent.
•
• Retains the minimum total capital to risk-weighted assets ratio requirement of 8 percent.
• Establishes a minimum leverage ratio requirement of 4 percent.
• Changes the prompt corrective action standards so that in order to be considered well-capitalized, a depository
institution must have a ratio of common equity Tier 1 capital to risk-weighted assets of 6.5 percent (new), a ratio of
Tier 1 capital to risk-weighted assets of 8 percent (increased from 6 percent), a ratio of total capital to risk-weighted
assets of 10 percent (unchanged), and a leverage ratio of 5 percent (unchanged).
• Retains the existing regulatory capital framework for one-to-four family residential mortgage exposures.
•
Permits banking organizations that are not subject to the advanced approaches rule, such as the Company and the
Bank, to retain, through a one-time election, the existing treatment for most accumulated other comprehensive income,
such that unrealized gains and losses on securities available for sale will not affect regulatory capital amounts and
ratios.
Implements a new capital conservation buffer requirement for a banking organization to maintain a common equity
capital ratio more than 2.5 percent above the minimum common equity Tier 1 capital, Tier 1 capital and total risk-
based capital ratios in order to avoid limitations on capital distributions, including dividend payments, and certain
discretionary bonus payments. The capital conservation buffer requirement will be phased in beginning on January 1,
2016 at 0.625 percent and will be fully phased in at 2.50 percent by January 1, 2019. A banking organization with a
buffer of less than the required amount would be subject to increasingly stringent limitations on such distributions and
payments as the buffer approaches zero. The new rule also generally prohibits a banking organization from making
such distributions or payments during any quarter if its eligible retained income is negative and its capital conservation
buffer ratio was 2.5 percent or less at the end of the previous quarter. The eligible retained income of a banking
organization is defined as its net income for the four calendar quarters preceding the current calendar quarter, based on
the organization’s quarterly regulatory reports, net of any distributions and associated tax effects not already reflected
in net income.
Increases capital requirements for past-due loans, high volatility commercial real estate exposures, and certain short-
term commitments and securitization exposures.
•
•
• Expands the recognition of collateral and guarantors in determining risk-weighted assets.
• Removes references to credit ratings consistent with the Dodd Frank Act and establishes due diligence requirements
for securitization exposures.
Dividend Restrictions
The Company’s principal source of funds for dividend payments is dividends received from the Bank. Federal banking laws
and regulations limit the amount of dividends that may be paid without prior approval of regulatory agencies. Under these
regulations, in the case of the Bank, the amount of dividends that may be paid in any calendar year is limited to the current
year’s net profits, combined with the retained net profits of the preceding two years, subject to the capital requirements
described above. For the year of 2014, the Bank had $36.1 million plus any net profits generated in 2014 available to pay
dividends to the Company.
176
NOTE 20 – EARNINGS PER COMMON SHARE
Net income (loss) allocated to common stockholders is computed by subtracting income allocated to participating securities,
participating securities dividends and preferred stock dividend from net income. Participating securities are instruments granted
in share-based payment transactions that contain rights to receive nonforfeitable dividends or dividend equivalents, which
includes the SARs as they confer dividend equivalent rights, as described under “Stock Appreciation Rights” in Note 16. Basic
earnings (loss) per common share (EPS) is computed by dividing net income allocated to common stockholders by the
weighted average number of shares outstanding, including the minimum number of shares issuable under purchase contracts
relating to the tangible equity units. Diluted EPS is computed by dividing net income (loss) allocated to common stockholders
by the weighted average number of shares outstanding, adjusted for the dilutive effect of the restricted stock units, the
potentially issuable shares in excess of the minimum under purchase contracts relating to the tangible equity units, outstanding
stock options, and warrants to purchase common stock.
Computations for basic and diluted EPS are provided below:
Year Ended December 31,
2014
Class B
Common
Stock
Common
Stock
Total
Common
Stock
2013
Class B
Common
Stock
Total
Common
Stock
2012
Class B
Common
Stock
Total
($ in thousands, except per share data)
$
29,670
$
648
$
30,318
$
75
$
4
$
79
$
5,442
$
554
$
5,996
(497)
(531)
(3,562)
(11)
(12)
(78)
(508)
(543)
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
(3,640)
(2,070)
(115)
(2,185)
(1,234)
(125)
(1,359)
$
25,080
27,444,878
$
0.91
$
$
547
$
25,627
$
(1,995)
$
(111)
$
(2,106)
$
4,208
$
429
$
4,637
599,563
28,044,441
14,481,060
805,774
15,286,834
10,622,577
1,080,754
11,703,331
0.91
$
0.91
$
(0.14)
$
(0.14)
$
(0.14)
$
0.40
$
0.40
$
0.40
$
25,080
$
547
$
25,627
$
(1,995)
$
(111)
$
(2,106)
$
4,208
$
429
$
4,637
(106)
106
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
$
24,974
$
653
$
25,627
$
(1,995)
$
(111)
$
(2,106)
$
4,208
$
429
$
4,637
Basic:
Net income
Less: income allocated to participating
securities
Less: participating securities dividends
Less: preferred stock dividends
Net income (loss) allocated to common
stockholders
Weighted average common shares outstanding
Basic earnings (loss) per common share
Diluted:
Net income (loss) allocated to common
stockholders
Additional income allocation for class B
dilutive shares
Adjusted net income (loss) allocated to common
stockholders
Weighted average common shares outstanding
27,444,878
599,563
28,044,441
14,481,060
805,774
15,286,834
10,622,577
1,080,754
11,703,331
Add: Dilutive effects of restricted stock units
Add: Dilutive effects of purchase contracts
Add: Dilutive effects of stock options
Add: Dilutive effects of warrants
52,286
26,807
8,692
—
—
—
52,286
26,807
8,692
—
115,997
115,997
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
9,176
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
9,176
—
—
—
Average shares and dilutive common shares
27,532,663
715,560
28,248,223
14,481,060
805,774
15,286,834
10,631,753
1,080,754
11,712,507
Diluted earnings (loss) per common share $
0.91
$
0.91
$
0.91
$
(0.14)
$
(0.14)
$
(0.14)
$
0.40
$
0.40
$
0.40
For the years ended December 31, 2014, 2013 and 2012, there were 658,054, 1,560,172 and 410,476 stock options and stock
awards, respectively, 0, 1,635,000, 3,036,959 warrants, respectively, that were not considered in computing diluted earnings
(loss) per common share, because they were anti-dilutive.
177
NOTE 21 – LOAN COMMITMENTS AND OTHER RELATED ACTIVITIES
Some financial instruments such as loan commitments, credit lines, letters of credit, and overdraft protection are issued to meet
customer financing needs. These are agreements to provide credit or to support the credit of others, as long as conditions
established in the contract are met, and usually have expiration dates. Commitments may expire without being used. Risk of
credit loss exists up to the face amount of these instruments. The same credit policies are used to make such commitments as
are used for loans, including obtaining collateral at exercise of the commitment.
The contractual amount of financial instruments with off-balance-sheet risk was as follows for the dates indicated:
Commitments to extend credit
Unused lines of credit
Letters of credit
As of December 31,
2014
2013
Fixed
Rate
Variable
Rate
Fixed
Rate
Variable
Rate
(In thousands)
$
87,517
$
82,818
$
35,425
$
20,631
825
295,626
10,411
3,403
10
61,613
268,669
6,289
Commitments to make loans are generally made for periods of 30 days or less.
As of December 31, 2014, total forward commitments were $422.3 million. These commitments consisted of jumbo mortgage
loan sale commitments of $54.2 million, TBAs of $328.0 million, best efforts of $40.0 million, and other commitments of $0.
Additionally, the Company had IRLCs of $190.0 million at December 31, 2014.
Litigation
In the normal course of business, we are involved in various legal claims. Management has reviewed all pending legal claims
against us with in-house or outside legal counsel and has taken into consideration the views of such counsel as to the outcome
of the claims. In management’s opinion, the final disposition of all such claims will not have a material adverse effect on our
financial position or results of operations.
178
NOTE 22 – SEGMENT REPORTING
The Company utilizes an internal reporting system to measure the performance of various operating segments within the Bank
and the Company overall. The Company has identified four operating segments for purposes of management reporting: 1)
Banking; 2) Mortgage Banking; 3) Financial Advisory and Asset Management; and 4) Corporate/Other. These four business
divisions meet the criteria of an operating segment. the segment engages in business activities from which it earns revenues and
incurs expenses and whose operating results are regularly reviewed by the Company’s chief operating decision-maker, the
Company's President and Chief Executive Officer or his delegate, to make decisions about resources to be allocated to the
segment and assess its performance and for which discrete financial information is available.
The principal business of the Banking segment consists of attracting deposits and investing these funds primarily in
commercial, consumer and real estate secured loans. The principal business of the Mortgage Banking segment is originating
conforming SFR loans and selling these loans in the secondary market. Financial Advisory and Asset Management segment is
operated by The Palisades Group and provides services of purchase, sale and management of SFR mortgage loans. The
Corporate/Other segment includes the holding company and PTB, an entity formed to hold real estate. The Corporate/Other
operating segment engages in business activities through the sale of other real estate owned and loans held at the holding
company and incurs interest expense on debt as well as non-interest expense for corporate related activities. The operating
segment results do not include allocation of centralized costs that are currently recorded in the Banking and Corporate/Other
segment. The Company is currently in the process of determining the basis for calculating allocations.
The prior periods’ measurement of operating segment performance may be restated for comparability for changes in the
Company’s management structure or reporting methodologies unless it is not deemed practicable to do so. The following table
represents the operating segments’ financial results and other key financial measures as of or for the years ended December 31,
2014, 2013, and 2012:
As of or For the Year Ended
Banking
Mortgage
Banking
Financial
Advisory and
Asset
Management
Corporate/
Other
Inter-segment
Elimination
Consolidated
(In thousands)
December 31, 2014
Net interest income
$
154,322
$
8,455
$
— $
(7,500) $
— $
155,277
Provision for loan and lease losses
Noninterest income
Noninterest expense
10,976
34,122
151,228
Income (loss) before income taxes
$
26,240
Total assets
December 31, 2013
Net interest income
Provision for loan and lease losses
Noninterest income
Noninterest expense
Income (loss) before income taxes
Total assets
December 31, 2012
Net interest income
Provision for loan and lease losses
Noninterest income
Noninterest expense
Income (loss) before income taxes
$ 5,649,260
$
$
96,222
7,963
26,740
89,018
25,981
$ 3,395,954
$
$
47,593
5,500
15,785
48,215
9,663
Total assets
$ 1,556,099
$
$
$
$
$
$
$
$
$
$
$
$
$
$
$
$
—
98,322
96,103
10,674
309,241
7,792
—
69,687
76,210
1,269
222,269
1,017
—
21,220
15,291
6,946
119,243
179
—
19,697
11,071
8,626
14,957
—
217
12,480
—
(6,721)
(6,721)
10,976
145,637
264,161
$
$
(19,763) $
— $
25,777
60,593
$
(62,480) $ 5,971,571
— $
(6,785) $
—
5
13,624
— $
—
(2,521)
(2,521)
97,229
7,963
96,743
178,670
$
$
(20,404) $
— $
7,339
33,974
$
(27,050) $ 3,628,023
—
2,832
2,339
493
2,876
— $
(2,058) $
— $
—
48
8,488
—
(434)
(434)
(10,498) $
— $
—
—
—
— $
— $
46,552
5,500
36,619
71,560
6,111
71,469
$
(64,109) $ 1,682,702
NOTE 23 – PARENT COMPANY FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
The parent company only condensed statements of financial condition as of December 31, 2014 and 2013, and the related
condensed statements of operations and condensed statements of cash flows for the years ended December 31, 2014, 2013, and
2012 are presented below:
Condensed Statements of Financial Condition
ASSETS
Cash and cash equivalents
FHLB and other bank stock
Loans and leases receivable
Other assets
Investment in bank subsidiaries
Total assets
LIABILITIES AND STOCKHOLDERS’ EQUITY
Notes payable, net
Accrued expenses and other liabilities
Stockholders’ equity
December 31,
2014
2013
(In thousands)
$
31,362
$
25,220
78
635
42,892
533,654
$
608,621
$
93,569
11,463
503,589
78
6,043
7,385
378,005
416,731
82,320
9,542
324,869
416,731
Total liabilities and stockholders’ equity
$
608,621
$
Condensed Statements of Operations
Year Ended December 31,
2014
2013
2012
(In thousands)
Income
Dividends from subsidiary
Interest income on loans
Interest income on deposits in other financial institutions
Gain on sale of loans
Other operating income
Total income
Expenses
Interest expense for notes payable
Other operating expense
Total expenses
Income (loss) before income taxes and equity in undistributed earnings of bank
subsidiary
Income tax expense (benefit)
Income (loss) before equity in undistributed earnings of bank subsidiary
Equity in undistributed earnings of bank subsidiary
$
— $
— $
361
—
209
8
578
7,861
12,478
20,339
(19,761)
(18,226)
(1,535)
31,853
159
—
—
5
164
6,941
14,015
20,956
(20,792)
20
(20,812)
20,891
Net income
$
30,318
$
79
$
—
—
104
—
—
104
2,162
8,010
10,172
(10,068)
(458)
(9,610)
15,606
5,996
180
Condensed Statements of Cash Flows
Cash flows from operating activities:
Net income
Year Ended December 31,
2014
2013
2012
(In thousands)
$
30,318
$
79
$
5,996
Adjustments to reconcile net income to net cash used in operating activities
Equity in undistributed earnings of bank subsidiary
(31,853)
(20,891)
(15,606)
Stock option compensation expense
Stock award compensation expense
Stock appreciation right expense
Amortization of debt
Net gain on sale of loans
Amortization of premiums and discounts on purchased loans
Deferred income tax (benefit) expense
Net change in other assets and liabilities
Net cash used in operating activities
Cash flows from investing activities:
Loan purchases from bank and principal collections, net
Proceeds from principal repayments of securities available-for-sale
Proceeds from sale of loans held for investment
Capital contribution to bank subsidiary
Capital contribution to non-bank subsidiary
Investment in acquired business
Net cash used in investing activities
Cash flows from financing activities:
Net proceeds from debt issuance
Net proceeds from issuance of tangible equity units
Net proceeds from issuance of common stock
Net proceeds from issuance of preferred stock
Payment of Amortizing Debt
Purchase of treasury stock
Proceeds from exercise of stock options
Tax expense from restricted stock vesting
Dividends paid on stock appreciation rights
Dividends paid on common stock
Dividends paid on preferred stock
Net cash provided by financing activities
Net change in cash and cash equivalents
Cash and cash equivalents at beginning of year
Cash and cash equivalents at end of year
260
1,824
1,889
686
(209)
(298)
(1,298)
(26,471)
(25,152)
568
—
5,347
(127,000)
—
—
(121,085)
—
64,959
103,656
—
(2,157)
(280)
993
—
(471)
(10,669)
(3,652)
152,379
6,142
25,220
121
806
1,072
385
—
—
—
8,601
(9,827)
(6,043)
—
—
(81,000)
(100)
(29,465)
(116,608)
—
—
67,792
37,943
—
(5,005)
540
—
—
(6,736)
(2,185)
92,349
(34,086)
59,306
$
31,362
$
25,220
$
148
75
1,039
135
—
—
—
3,725
(4,488)
—
1,813
—
(4,750)
—
(53,182)
(56,119)
81,800
—
—
(7)
—
(565)
—
(17)
—
(4,656)
(1,359)
75,196
14,589
44,717
59,306
181
NOTE 24 – QUARTERLY RESULTS OF OPERATIONS (UNAUDITED)
The following table presents the unaudited quarterly results for the periods indicated:
Three Months Ended,
March 31,
June 30,
September 30,
December 31,
($ in thousands, except per share data)
$
42,776
$
43,634
$
46,649
$
2014
Interest income
Interest expense
Net interest income
Provision for loan losses
Noninterest income
Noninterest expense
Income before income tax
Income tax expense (benefit)
Net income
Dividends on preferred stock
$
$
$
$
$
$
Net income (loss) available to common stockholders
Basic earnings (loss) per common share
Diluted earnings (loss) per common share
Basic earnings (loss) per class B common share
Diluted earnings (loss) per class B common share
2013
Interest income
Interest expense
Net interest income
Provision for loan losses
Noninterest income
Noninterest expense
Income (loss) before income tax
Income tax expense (benefit)
Net income (loss)
Dividends on preferred stock
Net income (loss) available to common stockholders $
Basic earnings (loss) per common share
Diluted earnings (loss) per common share
Basic earnings (loss) per class B common share
Diluted earnings (loss) per class B common share
$
$
$
$
55,080
8,749
46,331
4,159
40,889
78,371
4,690
(5,524)
10,214
910
9,304
0.25
0.25
0.25
0.25
40,756
7,454
33,302
1,768
34,517
57,214
8,837
5,516
3,321
951
2,370
0.13
0.12
0.13
0.13
7,591
35,185
1,929
25,278
57,768
766
9
757
910
(153) $
(0.01) $
(0.01) $
(0.01) $
(0.01) $
19,168
$
3,809
15,359
2,168
17,928
29,558
1,561
632
929
288
641
0.05
0.05
0.05
0.05
$
$
$
$
$
8,059
35,575
2,108
35,372
60,465
8,374
253
8,121
910
7,211
0.27
0.27
0.27
0.25
26,741
5,116
21,625
1,918
26,072
39,594
6,185
1,822
4,363
—
4,363
0.36
0.36
0.36
0.36
$
$
$
$
$
$
$
$
$
$
$
8,463
38,186
2,780
44,098
67,557
11,947
721
11,226
910
10,316
0.31
0.30
0.31
0.31
33,846
6,903
26,943
2,109
18,226
52,304
(9,244)
(710)
(8,534)
946
$
$
$
$
$
$
(9,480) $
(0.53) $
(0.53) $
(0.53) $
(0.53) $
182
NOTE 25 – RELATED-PARTY TRANSACTIONS
The Bank has granted loans to certain officers and directors and their related interests. Loans outstanding to officers and
directors and their related interests amounted to $200 thousand and $748 thousand at December 31, 2014 and 2013,
respectively, each of which were performing in accordance with their respective terms. These loans are made in the ordinary
course of business and on substantially the same terms and conditions, including interest rates and collateral, as those of
comparable transactions with non-insiders prevailing at the time, in accordance with the Bank’s underwriting guidelines, and
do not involve more than the normal risk of collectability or present other unfavorable features. The Bank has an Employee
Loan Program (the Program) which offers executive officers, directors and principal stockholders that meet the eligibility
requirements the opportunity to participate on the same terms as employees generally, provided that any loan to an executive
officer, director or principal stockholder must be approved by the Bank’s Board of Directors. The sole benefit provided under
the Program is a reduction in loan fees.
Deposits from principal officers, directors, and their related interests amounted to $4.5 million and $10.5 million at
December 31, 2014 and 2013, respectively.
Transactions Involving Steven A. Sugarman. The following is a description of transactions involving the Company and
certain entities affiliated with or relatives of Steven A. Sugarman, President and Chief Executive Officer of the Company and
the Bank and a member of the Board of Directors of the Company and the Bank.
The Palisades Group Lease Payment Reimbursements. The Company acquired its subsidiary, The Palisades Group, LLC (The
Palisades Group) on September 10, 2013, at which time Palisades occupied premises in Santa Monica, California leased by
COR Securities Holding, Inc. (CORSHI), of which Mr. Sugarman is the Chief Executive Officer as well as a stockholder (both
directly and indirectly). In light of the benefit received by The Palisades Group of its occupancy of the Santa Monica premises,
the non-interested directors of the Company’s Board ratified reimbursement to CORSHI for rental payments made for the Santa
Monica premises for the period commencing September 16, 2013 through the last date The Palisades Group occupies the
premises. The Palisades Group negotiated with an unaffiliated third party a lease for new premises and occupied those premises
on June 27, 2014. On the same date, The Palisades Group vacated the Santa Monica CORSHI premises.
The aggregate rent payments reimbursed to CORSHI from September 16, 2013 through December 30, 2013 were $39,972
comprised of: (i) $5,661, the pro-rated base rent amount for the partial month of September 2013; (ii) $11,324 per month in
base rent for the months of October and November 2013; and (iii) $11,663 per month in base rent for the month of December
2013.
Regarding the security deposit for the premises, after The Palisades Group occupied the CORSHI premises, the Company
reimbursed CORSHI relating to a security deposit amount for the premises of $33,844. The Company received reimbursement
of this security deposit amount from The Palisades Group. For the months of January 1, 2014 through June 27, 2014, CORSHI
granted The Palisades Group a rent abatement equal to the $33,844 security deposit and combined with additional payments,
The Palisades Group paid leasing costs totaling $57,616 to CORSHI for that same time period. The Board’s Compensation,
Nominating and Corporate Governance Committees have monitored all the reimbursement costs reviewed the aggregate
reimbursement costs.
The Palisades Group Consulting Agreement. As discussed above, the Company acquired its subsidiary, The Palisades Group,
on September 16, 2013. Effective July 1, 2013, The Palisades Group entered into a consulting agreement with Jason Sugarman,
Mr. Sugarman’s brother. Jason Sugarman provides advisory services to financial institutions and other institutional clients
related to investments in residential mortgages, real estate and real estate related assets and The Palisades Group entered into
the agreement with Jason Sugarman to provide these types of consulting services. The consulting agreement is for a term of 5
years, with a minimum payment of $30,000 owed at the end of each quarter for consulting services Jason Sugarman has
provided The Palisades Group. There is also the potential for additional bonus payments based on the nature of work performed
and the financial results of The Palisades Group. The aggregate amount of identified payments that will be paid by The
Palisades Group to Jason Sugarman under the five-year term of the consulting agreement will exceed $600,000 as that is the
minimum amount owed under the agreement, but does not include any bonuses that may be earned under the agreement. For
the year ended December 31, 2013 and the year ended December 31, 2014, base and bonus amounts earned by Jason Sugarman
under the consulting agreement totaled $120,662 and $1,240,000, respectively. The bonus amount paid to Jason Sugarman for
2014 will be credited in satisfaction and full discharge of all currently accrued but unpaid, and further quarterly payments
specified under the consulting agreement, but not against any future discretionary incentive compensation payments. The
consulting agreement may be terminated at any time by either The Palisades Group or Jason Sugarman upon 30 days prior
written notice. The consulting agreement with Jason Sugarman was reviewed as a related party transaction and approved by the
Compensation, Nominating and Corporate Governance Committee and approved by the disinterested directors of the Board.
183
St. Cloud Investment. Based on a Schedule 13-G amendment filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission on February
14, 2012, St. Cloud Capital, LLC (St. Cloud) holds 700,538 shares of the Company’s Voting Common Stock. On November 24,
2014, the Bank invested as a limited partner in an affiliate of St. Cloud. The affiliate is St. Cloud Capital Partners III SBIC, LP
(the Partnership), which applied for a license granted by the U.S. Small Business Administration to operate as a debenture
Small Business Investment Company (SBIC) under the Small Business Investment Act of 1958 and the regulations
promulgated thereunder. The Community Reinvestment Act of 1977 expressly identifies an investment by a bank in an SBIC as
a type of investment that is presumed by the regulatory agencies to promote economic development.
The Boards of Directors of the Company and the Bank approved the Bank’s investment. The Bank has agreed to invest a
minimum of $5 million, but up to $7.5 million as long as the Bank’s limited partnership interest in the Partnership remains
under 9.9 percent.
Other affiliated funds of St. Cloud have previously invested in COR Securities Holdings, Inc., of which Mr. Sugarman is the
Chief Executive Officer as well as a stockholder (both directly and indirectly). St. Cloud Capital Partners III SBIC, LP has
provided oral representations to the Bank that the Partnership will not make any investments in COR Securities Holdings, Inc.
CS Financial Acquisition. Certain relatives and entities affiliated with Mr. Sugarman received benefits as part of the CS
Financial acquisition described in detail below under “—Transactions Involving Jeffrey T. Seabold.”
Transactions Involving Jeffrey T. Seabold. The following is a description of transactions involving the Company and certain
entities affiliated with Jeffrey T. Seabold, who currently is employed as Executive Vice President, Chief Lending Officer of the
Bank and previously served as a director of the Company and the Bank.
CS Financial Acquisition. Effective October 31, 2013, the Company acquired CS Financial Inc. (CS Financial), a California
corporation and Southern California-based mortgage banking firm controlled by Jeffrey T. Seabold and in which certain
relatives and entities affiliated with Mr. Sugarman also owned certain minority, non-controlling interests. The following is a
description of the transaction.
CS Financial Services Agreement. On December 27, 2012, the Company entered into a Management Services Agreement
(Services Agreement) with CS Financial. On December 27, 2012, Mr. Seabold was then a member of the Board of
Directors of each of the Company and the Bank. Under the Services Agreement, CS Financial agreed to provide the Bank
such reasonably requested financial analysis, management consulting, knowledge sharing, training services and general
advisory services as the Bank and CS Financial mutually agreed upon with respect to the Bank’s residential mortgage
lending business, including strategic plans and business objectives, compliance function, monitoring, reporting and
related systems, and policies and procedures, at a monthly fee of $100,000. The Services Agreement was recommended
by disinterested members of management of the Bank and negotiated and approved by special committees of the Board of
Directors of each of the Company and the Bank (Special Committees), comprised exclusively of independent,
disinterested directors of the Boards. Each of the Boards of Directors of the Bank and the Company also considered and
approved the Services Agreement, upon the recommendation of the Special Committees.
On May 13, 2013, the Bank hired Mr. Seabold as Managing Director and Chief Lending Officer by entering into a three-
year employment agreement with Mr. Seabold (the Employment Agreement). Simultaneously, the Bank terminated, with
immediate effect, its Services Agreement with CS Financial. For the year ended December 31, 2013, the total
compensation paid to CS Financial under the Services Agreement was $439,000.
Option to Acquire CS Financial. Under the Employment Agreement, Mr. Seabold granted to the Company and the Bank
an option (CS Call Option), to acquire CS Financial for a purchase price of $10 million, payable pursuant to the terms
provided under the Employment Agreement. Based upon the recommendation of the Special Committees, with the
assistance of outside financial and legal advisors and consultants, the Boards of Directors of the Company and the Bank,
with Mr. Sugarman recusing himself from the discussions and vote due to previously disclosed conflicts of interest,
approved the recommendation of the Special Committees and, pursuant to a letter dated July 29, 2013, the Company
indicated that the CS Call Option was being exercised by the Bank, subject to the negotiation and execution of definitive
transaction documentation consistent with the applicable provisions of the Employment Agreement and the satisfaction of
the terms and conditions set forth therein.
Merger Agreement. After exercise of the CS Call Option as described above, the Company and the Bank entered into an
Agreement and Plan of Merger (Merger Agreement) with CS Financial, the stockholders of CS Financial (Sellers) and
Mr. Seabold, as the Sellers’ Representative, and completed its acquisition of CS Financial on October 31, 2013.
Subject to the terms and conditions set forth in the Merger Agreement, which was approved by the Board of Directors of
each of the Company, the Bank and CS Financial, at the effective time of the Merger, the outstanding shares of common
184
stock of CS Financial were converted into the right to receive in the aggregate: (1) upon the closing of the Merger,
(a) 173,791 shares (Closing Date Shares) of voting common stock, par value $0.01 per share, of the Company (Voting
Common Stock), and (b) $1,500,000 in cash and $3,150,000 in the form of a noninterest-bearing note issued by the
Company to Mr. Seabold that was due and paid by the Company on January 2, 2014; and (2) upon the achievement of
certain performance targets by the Bank’s lending activities following the closing of the Merger that are set forth in the
Merger Agreement, up to 92,781 shares (Performance Shares) of Voting Common Stock ((1) and (2), together, Merger
Consideration).
Seller Stock Consideration. The Sellers under the Merger Agreement included Mr. Seabold, and the following relatives of
Mr. Sugarman, Jason Sugarman (brother), Elizabeth Sugarman (sister-in-law), and Michael Sugarman (father), who each
owned minority, non-controlling interests in CS Financial.
Upon the closing of the Merger and pursuant to the terms of the Merger Agreement, the aggregate shares of Voting
Common Stock issued as the consideration to the Sellers was 173,791 shares, which was allocated by the Sellers and
issued as follows: (i) 103,663 shares to Mr. Seabold: (ii) 16,140 shares to Jason Sugarman; (iii) 16,140 shares to Elizabeth
Sugarman; (iv) 3,228 shares to Michael Sugarman; and (v) 34,620 shares to certain employees of CS Financial. Of the
103,663 shares to be issued to Mr. Seabold, as allowed under the Merger Agreement and in consideration of repayment of
a certain debt incurred by CS Financial owed to an entity controlled by Elizabeth Sugarman, Mr. Seabold requested the
Company to issue all 103,663 shares directly to Elizabeth Sugarman, and such shares were so issued by the Company to
Elizabeth Sugarman.
On October 31, 2014, a certain portion of the Performance Shares were issued as follows: (i) 28,545 shares to Mr.
Seabold; (ii) 1,082 shares to Jason Sugarman; (iii) 1,082 shares to Elizabeth Sugarman; and (iv) 216 shares to Michael
Sugarman.
Approval of the CS Call Option, Merger Agreement and Merger. All decisions and actions with respect to the exercise of
the CS Agreement Option, the Merger Agreement and the Merger (including without limitation the determination of the
Merger Consideration and the other material terms of the Merger Agreement) were subject to under the purview and
authority of special committees of the Board of Directors of each of the Company and the Bank, each of which was
composed exclusively of independent, disinterested directors of the Boards of Directors, with the assistance of outside
financial and legal advisors. Mr. Sugarman abstained from the vote of each of the Boards of Directors of the Company
and the Bank to approve the Merger Agreement and the Merger.
Transaction Involving Halle Benett. On May 21, 2014, the Company issued 5,150,000 shares of its Voting Common Stock in
an underwritten public offering and 772,500 shares of Voting Common Stock upon the exercise in full by the underwriters of
the underwritten public offering of their 30-day over-allotment option. Halle Benett, a director of the Company and the Bank,
became employed on April 1, 2014 as a Managing Director and Co-head of the Diversified Financials Group at Keefe,
Bruyette & Woods, Inc., a Stifel company. Mr. Benett, who became a director of the Bank on January 28, 2014, was elected to
the Board of Directors of the Company on May 15, 2014. On May 15, 2014, the Company entered into an underwriting
agreement pursuant to which Keefe, Bruyette & Woods, Inc., acted as one of the underwriters of the public offering and
received gross underwriting fees and commissions from the Company of approximately $520,644 for its services as an
underwriter (less expenses, the amount was $481,166).
Transaction Involving Former Chairman Timothy R. Chrisman. On May 15, 2014, the disinterested members of the Board
of Directors of the Company approved a strategic advisor agreement with Chrisman & Co. pursuant to which Chrisman & Co.
would provide strategic advisory services for the Company. Mr. Chrisman, who retired from the Company Board on May 15,
2014 upon the expiration of the term of his directorship after the Company’s 2014 Annual Meeting of Stockholders, is the Chief
Executive Officer and founding principal of Chrisman & Co. The initial term of the strategic advisor agreement is for a period
of one year and, thereafter, the agreement may be extended on a month-to-month basis. For services performed during the
initial term, a fixed annual advisory fee of $200,000 was paid to Chrisman & Co. during 2014.
Transactions with Greater Than 5 Percent Stockholders Who are Not Executive Officers
Exchange Agreement with TCW Shared Opportunity Fund V, L.P. and its Assignees. TCW Shared Opportunity Fund V, L.P.
(SHOP V Fund), an affiliate of The TCW Group, Inc., initially became a holder of the Company’s Voting Common Stock and
non-voting common stock (Non-Voting Common Stock) as a lead investor in the November 2010 recapitalization of the
Company (the Recapitalization). In connection with its investment in the Recapitalization, SHOP V Fund also was issued by
the Company an immediately exercisable five-year warrant (the SHOP V Fund Warrant) to purchase 240,000 shares of Non-
Voting Common Stock or, to the extent provided therein, shares of Voting Common Stock in lieu of Non-Voting Common
Stock. SHOP V Fund was issued shares of Non-Voting Common Stock in the Recapitalization because at that time, a
185
controlling interest in TCW Asset Management Company, the investment manager to SHOP V Fund, was held by a foreign
banking organization, and in order to prevent SHOP V Fund from being considered a bank holding company under the Bank
Holding Company Act of 1956, as amended, the number of shares of Voting Common Stock it purchased in the
Recapitalization had to be limited to 4.99 percent of the total number of shares of Voting Common Stock outstanding
immediately following the Recapitalization. For the same reason, the SHOP V Fund Warrant could be exercised by SHOP V
Fund for Voting Common Stock in lieu of Non-Voting Common Stock only to the extent SHOP V Fund’s percentage ownership
of the Voting Common Stock at the time of exercise would be less than 4.99 percent as a result of dilution occurring from
additional issuances of Voting Common Stock subsequent to the Recapitalization.
In 2013, the foreign banking organization sold its controlling interest in TCW Asset Management Company, eliminating the
need to limit SHOP V Fund’s percentage ownership of the Voting Common Stock to 4.99 percent. As a result, on May 29, 2013,
the Company and SHOP V Fund entered into a Common Stock Share Exchange Agreement, dated May 29, 2013 (Exchange
Agreement), pursuant to which SHOP V Fund may from time to time exchange its shares of Non-Voting Common Stock for
shares of Voting Common Stock issued by the Company on a share-for-share basis, provided that immediately following any
such exchange, SHOP V Fund’s percentage ownership of Voting Common Stock does not exceed 9.99 percent. The shares of
Non-Voting Common Stock that may be exchanged by SHOP V Fund pursuant to the Exchange Agreement include the shares
of Non-Voting Common Stock it purchased in the Recapitalization, the additional shares of Non-Voting Common Stock SHOP
V Fund acquired subsequent to the Recapitalization (and may in the future acquire) pursuant to the Company’s Dividend
Reinvestment Plan and any additional shares of Non-Voting Common Stock that SHOP V Fund acquires pursuant to its
exercise of the SHOP V Fund Warrant.
On December 10, 2014, SHOP V Fund and two affiliated entities, Crescent Special Situations Fund Legacy V, L.P. (CSSF
Legacy V) and Crescent Special Situations Fund Investor Group, L.P. (CSSF Investor Group), entered into a Contribution,
Distribution and Sale Agreement pursuant to which SHOP V Fund agreed to transfer shares of Non-Voting Common Stock and
portions of the SHOP V Fund Warrant to CSSF Legacy V and CSSF Investor Group. Also on December 10, 2014, SHOP V
Fund, CSSF Legacy V, CSSF Investor Group and the Company entered into an Assignment and Assumption Agreement
pursuant to which all of SHOP V Fund’s rights and obligations under the Exchange Agreement with respect to the shares of
Non-Voting Common Stock transferred by it to CSSF Legacy V and CSSF Investor Group pursuant to the Contribution,
Distribution and Sale Agreement were assigned to CSSF Legacy V and CSSF Investor Group, including the right of SHOP V
Fund to exchange such shares for shares of Voting Common Stock on a one-for-one basis.
On June 3, 2013, January 5, 2015, and January 20, 2015, SHOP V Fund or CSSF Legacy V or CSSF Investor Group exchanged
550,000 shares, 522,564 shares and 86,620 shares, respectively, of Non-Voting Common Stock for the same number of shares
of Voting Common Stock. As a result of these exchanges, the Company believes that as of February 27, 2015 The TCW Group,
Inc. and its affiliates held 1,687,646 shares of Voting Common Stock and 934 shares of Non-Voting Common Stock, plus the
SHOP V Fund Warrant under which up to 240,000 shares of Non-Voting Common Stock may be issued upon exercise and may
thereafter be exchanged for shares of Voting Common Stock pursuant to the Exchange Agreement.
Securities Purchase Agreement with Patriot Financial Partners, L.P. and Patriot Financial Partners Parallel, L.P. As reported in a
Schedule 13-D amendment filed on November 10, 2014 with the SEC, Patriot Financial Partners, L.P and Patriot Financial
Partners Parallel, L.P. (Patriot) hold 3,100,564 shares of the Company’s Voting Common Stock. As previously disclosed, on
April 22, 2014, the Company entered into a Securities Purchase Agreement (SPA) with Patriot to raise a portion of the capital
to be used to finance the previously announced acquisition of select assets and assumption of certain liabilities comprising
BPNA’S network of 20 California branches by the Bank. The SPA with Patriot was due to expire by its terms at the end of the
day on October 31, 2014. Prior to such expiration, the Company and Patriot Financial Partners, L.P., Patriot Financial Partners
Parallel, L.P., Patriot Financial Partners II, L.P. and Patriot Financial Partners Parallel II, L.P. (together referred to as Patriot
Partners) entered into a Securities Purchase Agreement, dated as of October 30, 2014 (New SPA). Pursuant to the New SPA,
concurrently with the Bank's BPNA Branch Acquisition, which closed on November 8, 2014, Patriot Partners simultaneously
purchased from the Company (i) 1,076,000 shares of its voting common stock at a price of $9.78 per share and (ii) 824,000
shares of its voting common stock at a price of $11.55 per share, for an aggregate purchase price of $20,040,480. In
consideration for Patriot’s commitment under the New SPA and pursuant the terms of the New SPA, on that same date
concurrently with the closing of the sale of shares, the Company paid Patriot an equity support payment of $538,000 and also
reimbursed Patriot $100,000 in out-of-pocket expenses.
Agreement with Oaktree Capital Management. As reported in a Schedule 13-G filed with the SEC on January 16, 2015,
OCM BOCA Investor, LLC (OCM), an affiliate of Oaktree Capital Management, L.P., owns 3,288,947 shares of the
Company’s Voting Common Stock. OCM purchased these 3,288,947 shares of Voting Common Stock (representing 9.9 percent
of total shares outstanding as of the dates set forth in the Schedule 13-G) from the Company on November 7, 2014 at a price of
$9.78 per share pursuant to a securities purchase agreement entered into on April 22, 2014 (and amended on October 28, 2014)
to raise a portion of the capital needed for the BPNA Branch Acquisition, which was completed on November 8, 2014. In
186
consideration for its commitment under the securities purchase agreement, OCM was paid at closing an equity support payment
from the Company of $1.6 million.
Before OCM became a stockholder, The Palisades Group, and certain affiliates of Oaktree Capital Management, L.P.
(collectively, the Oaktree Funds), entered into a management agreement, effective as of January 30, 2014 (Management
Agreement), pursuant to which The Palisades Group serves as the credit manager of pools of single family residential mortgage
loans held in securitization trusts or other vehicles beneficially owned by the Oaktree Funds. The Palisades Group is paid a
monthly management fee primarily based on the amount of certain designated pool assets and may earn additional fees for
advice related to financing opportunities. Payments under the Management Agreement to The Palisades Group during 2014
totaled $5.3 million, which in some instances represents fees for partial year services. In addition, in the future and from time to
time we may enter into lending transactions with portfolio companies of investment funds managed by Oaktree Capital
Management, L.P.
NOTE 26 – SUBSEQUENT EVENTS
Management has evaluated subsequent events through the date of issuance of the financial data included herein. There have
been no subsequent events occurred during such period that would require disclosure in this report or would be required to be
recognized in the Consolidated Financial Statements as of December 31, 2014.
187
Item 9. Changes in and Disagreements With Accountants on Accounting and Financial Disclosure
None
Item 9A. Controls and Procedures
Evaluation of Disclosure Controls and Procedures
An evaluation of the Company’s disclosure controls and procedures (as defined in Rule 13a-15(e) under the Securities
Exchange Act of 1934 (the Act) as of December 31, 2014 was carried out under the supervision and with the participation of
the Company’s Chief Executive Officer, Chief Financial Officer and other members of the Company’s senior management. The
Company's Chief Executive Officer and Chief Financial Officer concluded that as of December 31, 2014, the Company’s
disclosure controls and procedures were effective in ensuring that the information required to be disclosed by the Company in
the reports it files or submits under the Act is (i) accumulated and communicated to the Company’s management (including the
Chief Executive Officer and Chief Financial Officer) to allow timely decisions regarding required disclosure, and (ii) recorded,
processed, summarized and reported within the time periods specified in the SEC’s rules and forms.
Management’s Report on Internal Control over Financial Reporting
Our management is responsible for establishing and maintaining adequate internal control over financial reporting, as such term
is defined in Exchange Act Rule 13a-15(f). Our internal control over financial reporting is a process designed by, or under the
supervision of, our Chief Executive Officer and Chief Financial Officer, to provide reasonable assurance regarding the
reliability of financial reporting and the preparation of the financial statements for external purposes in accordance with
accounting principles generally accepted in the United States of America.
Internal control over financial reporting includes those policies and procedures that:
•
•
•
pertain to the maintenance of records that, in reasonable detail, accurately and fairly reflect the transactions and
dispositions of the assets of the Company;
provide reasonable assurance that transactions are recorded as necessary to permit preparation of financial statements
in accordance with accounting principles generally accepted in the United States of America, and that receipts and
expenditures of the Company are being made only in accordance with authorizations of management and directors of
the Company; and
provide reasonable assurance regarding prevention or timely detection of unauthorized acquisition, use, or disposition
of the Company’s assets that could have a material effect on the financial statements.
Because of its inherent limitations, internal control over financial reporting may not prevent or detect misstatements. All
internal control systems, no matter how well designed, have inherent limitations, including the possibility of human error and
the circumvention of overriding controls. Accordingly, even effective internal control over financial reporting can only provide
reasonable assurance with respect to financial statement preparation. Also, projections of any evaluation of effectiveness to
future periods are subject to the risk that controls may become inadequate because of changes in conditions, or that degree of
compliance with the policies or procedures may deteriorate.
Our management, including our Chief Executive Officer and our Chief Financial Officer, assessed the effectiveness of our
internal control over financial reporting as of December 31, 2014, based on framework issued by the Committee of Sponsoring
Organizations of the Treadway Commission (COSO) in Internal Control-Integrated Framework (1992). Based on this
assessment, our management concluded that our internal control over financial reporting was effective as of December 31,
2014 based on criteria established in Internal Control-Integrated Framework (1992).
The effectiveness of our internal control over financial reporting as of December 31, 2014, has been audited by KPMG LLP
(KPMG), an independent registered public accounting firm, as stated in their report entitled "Report of Independent Registered
Public Accounting Firm" which appears herein under "Item 8. Financial Statements and Supplementary Data."
Changes in Internal Control Over Financial Reporting.
During the three months ended December 31, 2014, we completed our remediation efforts related to certain control deficiencies
that, during 2013, when aggregated could have resulted in a material misstatement of our consolidated financial statements that
would not have been prevented or detected on a timely basis, and as such, the Company concluded these control deficiencies
resulted in a material weakness. The material weakness did not result in any material misstatement of the Company’s financial
statements and disclosures for the years ended December 31, 2013, 2012, and 2011.
As a result of the completed remediation efforts described below, there were improvements in internal control over financial
reporting during the three months ended December 31, 2014 that have materially affected, or are reasonably likely to materially
188
affect, the Company’s internal control over financial reporting. There were no other changes in internal control over financial
reporting during the three months ended December 31, 2014 that has materially affected, or is reasonably likely to materially
affect, our internal control over financial reporting.
In connection with the preparation of annual and quarterly financial statements, the Company’s management is responsible for
evaluating its internal controls and procedures. This evaluation includes an assessment of the Company’s internal control over
financial reporting, which are designed to provide reasonable assurance regarding the reliability of the Company’s financial
reporting and the preparation of the Company’s financial statements for external purposes in accordance with generally
accepted accounting principles. In connection with the audit of year-end financial statements, the Company’s independent
registered public accounting firm, KPMG LLP (KPMG), is responsible for auditing both (i) the financial statements to obtain
reasonable assurance about whether they are free of material misstatement, and (ii) the effectiveness of the Company’s internal
control over financial reporting.
During 2014, immaterial errors related to prior periods were identified that indicated certain deficiencies existed in the
Company’s internal control over financial reporting. Specifically, during 2013, financial reporting resources did not sufficiently
complete certain account level reviews that presented a low potential risk of material error to the Company’s financial
reporting, to ensure that the possibility that the aggregation of all potential errors in these accounts, which were more than
remote, could not result in a material misstatement.
The Company has concluded that in 2013 these deficiencies when aggregated could have resulted in a material misstatement of
the consolidated financial statements that would not have been prevented or detected on a timely basis, and as such, these
control deficiencies resulted in a material weakness.
Remediation Actions. In response to this material weakness, the Company implemented remediation actions during 2014 that
included:
• Appointing Robert Sznewajs as the new Audit Committee chairman and Ronald Nicolas as the Chief Financial Officer
of the Bank, as well as hiring additional accounting and finance resources and professionals, including a new Chief
Accounting Officer in March 2014, a new Controller in March 2014, and a Director of Accounting Policy in May
2014, together with other new hires in the accounting and finance departments;
• Designing new controls around the review and analysis of the allowance for loan and lease losses (ALLL) including
the addition of a new Credit Risk Analytics team to oversee the ALLL process;
•
Implementing a new automated accounting software platform for stock-based compensation that eliminates the
reliance on manual review of significant spreadsheets;
• Establishing a Sarbanes-Oxley Act steering committee that meets bi-weekly with the participation of the Chief
Executive Officer, the Chief Financial Officer, and the Chief Accounting Officer;
• Enhancing the review and controls around the development and analysis of the repurchase reserve including the hiring
of new staff and the cross-department review and coordination of key inputs and data gathering; and
• Hiring an internal model validation expert in the risk management group.
The Company and its Board of Directors are committed to maintaining a strong internal control environment and the focus of
the above actions was to remediate the control deficiencies. In addition, we believe that these actions strengthened our overall
control environment.
Management has determined that the remediation actions discussed above were effectively designed and demonstrated effective
operation for a sufficient period of time to enable the Company to conclude that the material weakness regarding its internal
controls had been remediated as of December 31, 2014.
The Company does not expect that its disclosure controls and procedures and internal control over financial reporting will
prevent all errors and fraud. A control procedure, no matter how well conceived and operated, can provide only reasonable, not
absolute, assurance that the objectives of the control procedure are met. Because of the inherent limitations in all control
procedures, no evaluation of controls can provide absolute assurance that all control issues and instances of fraud, if any, within
the Company have been detected. These inherent limitations include the realities that judgments in decision-making can be
faulty, and that breakdowns can occur because of simple error or mistake. Additionally, controls can be circumvented by the
individual acts of some persons, by collusion of two or more people, or by management override of the control. The design of
any control procedure also is based in part upon certain assumptions about the likelihood of future events, and there can be no
assurance that any design will succeed in achieving its stated goals under all potential future conditions; over time, controls
may become inadequate because of changes in conditions, or the degree of compliance with the policies or procedures may
deteriorate. Because of the inherent limitations in a cost-effective control procedure, misstatements due to error or fraud may
occur and not be detected.
189
Report of Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm
The Board of Directors and Stockholders
Banc of California, Inc.:
We have audited Banc of California, Inc.’s internal control over financial reporting as of December 31, 2014, based on criteria
established in Internal Control - Integrated Framework (1992) issued by the Committee of Sponsoring Organizations of the
Treadway Commission (COSO). Banc of California, Inc.’s management is responsible for maintaining effective internal control
over financial reporting and for its assessment of the effectiveness of internal control over financial reporting, included in the
accompanying Management’s Report on Internal Control over Financial Reporting. Our responsibility is to express an opinion
on the Company’s internal control over financial reporting based on our audit.
We conducted our audit in accordance with the standards of the Public Company Accounting Oversight Board (United States).
Those standards require that we plan and perform the audit to obtain reasonable assurance about whether effective internal control
over financial reporting was maintained in all material respects. Our audit included obtaining an understanding of internal control
over financial reporting, assessing the risk that a material weakness exists, and testing and evaluating the design and operating
effectiveness of internal control based on the assessed risk. Our audit also included performing such other procedures as we
considered necessary in the circumstances. We believe that our audit provides a reasonable basis for our opinion.
A company’s internal control over financial reporting is a process designed to provide reasonable assurance regarding the reliability
of financial reporting and the preparation of financial statements for external purposes in accordance with generally accepted
accounting principles. A company’s internal control over financial reporting includes those policies and procedures that (1) pertain
to the maintenance of records that, in reasonable detail, accurately and fairly reflect the transactions and dispositions of the assets
of the company; (2) provide reasonable assurance that transactions are recorded as necessary to permit preparation of financial
statements in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles, and that receipts and expenditures of the company are
being made only in accordance with authorizations of management and directors of the company; and (3) provide reasonable
assurance regarding prevention or timely detection of unauthorized acquisition, use, or disposition of the company’s assets that
could have a material effect on the financial statements.
Because of its inherent limitations, internal control over financial reporting may not prevent or detect misstatements. Also,
projections of any evaluation of effectiveness to future periods are subject to the risk that controls may become inadequate because
of changes in conditions, or that the degree of compliance with the policies or procedures may deteriorate.
In our opinion, Banc of California, Inc. maintained, in all material respects, effective internal control over financial reporting as
of December 31, 2014, based on criteria established in Internal Control - Integrated Framework (1992) issued by the Committee
of Sponsoring Organizations of the Treadway Commission (COSO).
We also have audited, in accordance with the standards of the Public Company Accounting Oversight Board (United States), the
consolidated statements of financial condition of Banc of California, Inc. and subsidiaries as of December 31, 2014 and 2013, and
the related consolidated statements of operations, comprehensive income (loss), stockholders’ equity, and cash flows for each of
the years in the three-year period ended December 31, 2014, and our report dated March 16, 2015 expressed an unqualified opinion
on those consolidated financial statements.
Irvine, California
March 16, 2015
/s/ KPMG LLP
KPMG LLP
190
Item 9B. Other Information
None
PART III
Item 10. Directors, Executive Officers and Corporate Governance
Directors and Executive Officers. The information concerning directors and executive officers of the Company required by this
item is incorporated herein by reference from the Company’s definitive proxy statement for its 2015 Annual Meeting of
Stockholders, a copy of which will be filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission not later than 120 days after the end
of the Company’s fiscal year.
Audit Committee Financial Expert. Information concerning the audit committee of the Company’s Board of Directors required
by this item, including information regarding the audit committee financial experts serving on the audit committee, is
incorporated herein by reference from the Company’s definitive proxy statement for its 2015 Annual Meeting of Stockholders,
except for information contained under the heading “Report of the Audit Committee,” a copy of which will be filed not later
than 120 days after the close of the fiscal year.
Code of Ethics. The Company adopted a written Code of Business Conduct and Ethics based upon the standards set forth under
Item 406 of Regulation S-K of the Securities Exchange Act. The Code of Business Conduct and Ethics applies to all of the
Company’s directors, officers and employees. On October 28, 2014, the Company adopted a revised Code of Business Conduct
and Ethics (Code), to enhance the Company's governance, including among other things by: (i) adding a requirement that all
members of the Board annually agree to adhere to the Code; (ii) expanding the definition of the "Confidential Information";
and (iii) limiting certain financial arrangements to which directors may be party. A full text of the Code is available on the
Company’s website at www.bancofcal.com, by clicking "Investors" and then "Governance Documents."
Section 16(a) Beneficial Ownership Reporting Compliance. The information concerning compliance with the reporting
requirements of Section 16(a) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934 by directors, officers and ten percent stockholders of the
Company required by this item is incorporated herein by reference from the Company’s definitive proxy statement for its 2015
Annual Meeting of Stockholders, a copy of which will be filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission not later than
120 days after the end of the Company’s fiscal year.
Nomination Procedures. There have been changes to the procedures by which stockholders may recommend nominees to the
Company’s Board of Directors, including, among others, (i) additional disclosure requirements by stockholders proposing
business or submitting nominees at annual or special meetings of stockholders and (ii),changes made to the advance-notice
period for stockholder proposals and nominations, (a) first modified on October 28, 2014 from 90-120 days prior to the first
anniversary of the preceding year’s annual meeting to 120-150 days prior to the first anniversary of the preceding year’s annual
meeting and (b) most recently modified on February 24, 2015 from 120-150 days prior to the first anniversary of the preceding
year’s annual meeting to 150-180 days prior to the first anniversary of the preceding year’s annual meeting. The complete
nomination procedure is set forth in the Company’s Third Amended and Restated Bylaws, a copy of which was filed as an
exhibit to the Company's Current Report on Form 8-K filed on March 2, 2015.
Item 11. Executive Compensation
The information concerning compensation and other matters required by this item is incorporated herein by reference from the
Company’s definitive proxy statement for its 2015 Annual Meeting of Stockholders, except for information contained under the
headings “Compensation Committee report on Executive Compensation” a copy of which will be filed with the Securities and
Exchange Commission not later than 120 days after the end of the Company’s fiscal year.
191
Item 12. Security Ownership of Certain Beneficial Owners and Management and Related Stockholder Matters
The information concerning security ownership of certain beneficial owners and management required by this item is
incorporated herein by reference from the Company’s definitive proxy statement for its 2015 Annual Meeting of Stockholders,
a copy of which will be filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission not later than 120 days after the end of the
Company’s fiscal year.
The following table summarizes our equity compensation plans as of December 31, 2014:
Plan Category
Number of Securities to
be issued upon exercise
of outstanding options,
warrants and rights
Weighted-average
exercise price of
outstanding options,
warrants and rights (2)
Number of Securities
remaining available for
future issuance under
equity compensation
plans
Equity compensation plans approved by security holders
Equity compensation plans not approved by security holders
3,849,464
$
— $
11.62
—
540,606 (1)
—
(1) The 2013 Omnibus Stock Incentive Plan provides that the aggregate number of shares of Company common stock that may be subject
to awards under the 2013 Omnibus Stock Incentive Plan will be 20 percent of the then outstanding shares of Company common stock
(the Share Limit), provided that in no event will the Share Limit be less than the greater of 2,384,711 shares of Company common
stock and the aggregate number of shares of Company common stock with respect to which awards have been properly granted
under the 2013 Omnibus Plan up to that point in time. As of December 31, 2014, based on the number of shares then-registered for
issuance under the 2013 Omnibus Plan, 540,606 shares were available for future awards under the 2013 Omnibus Plan.
(2) The exercise price of included warrants to purchase 1,395,000 shares of non-voting common stock is subject to certain adjustments.
Item 13. Certain Relationships and Related Transactions and Director Independence
Information concerning certain relationships and related transactions and director independence required by this item is
incorporated herein by reference from the Company’s definitive proxy statement for its 2015 Annual Meeting of Stockholders,
a copy of which will be filed not later than 120 days after the close of the fiscal year.
Item 14. Principal Accountant Fees and Services
Information concerning principal accountant fees and services is incorporated herein by reference from the Company’s
definitive proxy statement for its 2015 Annual Meeting of Stockholders, a copy of such will be filed no later than 120 days after
the close of the fiscal year.
192
PART IV
ITEM 15. Exhibits and Financial Statement Schedules
(a)(1) Financial Statements: See Part II—Item 8. Financial Statements and Supplementary Data
(a)(2) Financial Statement Schedule: All financial statement schedules have been omitted as the information is not required
under the related instructions or is not applicable.
(a)(3) Exhibits
2.1
2.1A
2.2B
2.2C
2.2D
2.3
2.4
2.5
2.6
2.7
3.1
3.2
3.3
3.4
3.5
3.6
3.7
3.8
3.9
3.10
4.1
Stock Purchase Agreement, dated as of June 3, 2011, by and among Banc of California, Inc., (f/k/a First
PacTrust Bancorp, Inc.) (sometimes referred to below as the “Registrant” or the “Company”), Gateway
Bancorp, Inc. (“Gateway”), each of the stockholders of Gateway and the D & E Tarbell Trust, u/d/t dated
February 19, 2002 (in its capacity as the Sellers’ Representative)
Amendment No. 1, dated as of November 28, 2011, to Stock Purchase Agreement, dated as of June 3, 2011, by
and among The Registrant, Gateway Bancorp, the Sellers named therein and the D & E Tarbell Trust, u/d/t
dated February 19, 2002 (in its capacity as the Sellers’ Representative)
Amendment No. 2, dated as of February 24, 2012, to Stock Purchase Agreement, dated as of June 3, 2011, by
and among the Registrant, Gateway Bancorp, the Sellers named therein and the D & E Tarbell Trust, u/d/t dated
February 19, 2002 (in its capacity as the Sellers’ Representative)
Amendment No. 3, dated as of June 30, 2012, to Stock Purchase Agreement, dated as of June 3, 2011, by and
among the Registrant, Gateway Bancorp, the Sellers named therein and the D & E Tarbell Trust, u/d/t dated
February 19, 2002 (in its capacity as the Sellers’ Representative)
Amendment No. 4, dated as of July 31, 2012, to Stock Purchase Agreement, dated as of June 3, 2011, by and
among the Registrant, Gateway Bancorp, the Sellers named therein and the D & E Tarbell Trust, u/d/t dated
February 19, 2002 (in its capacity as the Sellers’ Representative)
Agreement and Plan of Merger, dated as of August 30, 2011, by and between the Registrant and Beach Business
Bank, as amended by Amendment No. 1thereto dated as of October 31, 2011
Agreement and Plan of Merger, dated as of August 21, 2012, by and among First
PacTrust Bancorp, Inc., Beach Business Bank and The Private Bank of California
Amendment No. 1, dated as of May 5, 2013, to Agreement and Plan of Merger, dated as of August 21, 2012, by
and among the Registrant, Beach Business Bank and The Private Bank of California
Agreement and Plan of Merger, dated as of October 25, 2013, by and among the Registrant, Banc of California,
National Association, CS Financial, Inc., the Sellers named therein and the Sellers’ Representative named
therein
Purchase and Assumption Agreement, dated as of April 22, 2014, by and between Banco Popular North
America and Banc of California, National Association
Articles of Incorporation of the Registrant
Articles of Amendment to the Charter of the Registrant increasing the authorized capital stock of the Registrant
Articles supplementary to the Charter of the Registrant containing the terms of the Registrant’s Senior Non-
Cumulative Perpetual Preferred Stock, Series A
Articles supplementary to the Charter of the Registrant containing the terms of the Registrant’s Class B Non-
Voting Common Stock
Articles of Amendment to Articles Supplementary to the Charter of the Registrant containing the terms of the
Registrant’s Class B Non-Voting Common Stock
Articles supplementary to the Charter of the Registrant containing the terms of the Registrant’s 8.00% Non-
Cumulative Perpetual Preferred Stock, Series C
Articles supplementary to the Charter of the Registrant containing the terms of the Registrant’s Non-
Cumulative Perpetual Preferred Stock, Series B
Articles of Amendment to the Charter of the Registrant changing the Registrant’s name
Articles of Amendment to the Charter of the Registrant increasing the authorized capital stock of the Registrant
Bylaws of the Registrant
Warrant to purchase up to 240,000 shares of the Registrant common stock originally issued on November 1,
2010
193
(a)
(a)(1)
(a)(2)
(a)(3)
(a)(4)
(b)
(c)
(x)
(y)
(aa)
(d)
(e)
(f)
(g)
(h)
(o)
(p)
(q)
(bb)
(ii)
(g)
4.2
4.3
4.4
4.5
4.6
4.7
4.8
10.1
10.1A
10.1B
10.1C
10.2
10.2A
10.3
10.4
10.5
10.6
10.7A
10.7B
10.7C
10.8
10.9
10.10
10.11
10.12
10.13
Warrant to purchase up to 1,395,000 shares of the Registrant common stock originally issued on November 1,
2010
Senior Debt Securities Indenture, dated as of April 23, 2012, between the Registrant and U.S. Bank National
Association, as Trustee
Supplemental Indenture, dated as of April 23, 2012, between the Registrant and U.S. Bank National
Association, as Trustee, relating to the Registrant’s 7.50% Senior Notes due April 15, 2020 and form of 7.50%
Senior Notes due April 15, 2020
Deposit Agreement, dated as of June 12, 2013, among the Registrant, Registrar and Transfer Company, as
Depositary and the holders from time to time of the depositary receipts described therein
Purchase Contract Agreement, dated May 21, 2014, between the Company and U.S. Bank National Association
Indenture, dated May 21, 2014, between the Company and U.S. Bank National Association
First Supplemental Indenture, dated May 21, 2014, between the Company and U.S. Bank National Association
Employment Agreement, dated as of August 21, 2012, by and between the Registrant and Steven Sugarman
Stock Appreciation Right Grant Agreement between the Registrant and Steven Sugarman dated August 21,
2012
Amendment dated December 13, 2013 to Stock Appreciation Right Grant Agreement between the Registrant
and Steven Sugarman dated August 21, 2012
Letter Agreement, dated as of May 23, 2014, by and between the Registrant and Steven Sugarman, relating to
Stock Appreciation Rights issued with respect to Tangible Equity Units
Employment Agreement, dated as of September 25, 2012, by and among the Registrant, Pacific Trust Bank and
Beach Business Bank and Robert M. Franko
Mutual Termination and Release Letter Agreement, dated September 25, 2012, relating to Executive
Employment Agreement, dated June 1, 2003, between Doctors’ Bancorp, predecessor-in-interest to Beach
Business Bank, and Robert M. Franko
Employment Agreement, dated as of August 22, 2012, by and among the Registrant and John C. Grosvenor
Employment Agreement, dated as of November 5, 2012, by and among the Registrant and Ronald J. Nicolas, Jr.
Employment Agreement, dated as of September 17, 2013, by and among the Registrant and Hugh F. Boyle
Registrant’s 2011 Omnibus Incentive Plan
Form of Incentive Stock Option Agreement under 2011 Omnibus Incentive Plan
Form of Non-Qualified Stock Option Agreement under 2011 Omnibus Incentive Plan
Form of Restricted Stock Agreement Under 2011 Omnibus Incentive Plan
Registrant’s 2003 Stock Option and Incentive Plan
Registrant’s 2003 Recognition and Retention Plan
Small Business Lending Fund-Securities Purchase Agreement, dated August 30, 2011, between the Registrant
and the Secretary of the United States Treasury
Management Services Agreement, dated as of December 27, 2012, by and between CS Financial, Inc. and
Pacific Trust Bank
Employment Agreement, dated as of May 13, 2013, by and among Pacific Trust Bank and Jeffrey Seabold
Registrant’s 2013 Omnibus Stock Incentive Plan
10.13A
Form of Incentive Stock Option Agreement under 2013 Omnibus Stock Incentive Plan
10.13B
Form of Non-Qualified Stock Option Agreement under 2013 Omnibus Stock Incentive Plan
10.13C
Form of Restricted Stock Agreement under 2013 Omnibus Stock Incentive Plan
10.13D
Form of Restricted Stock Unit Agreement under 2013 Omnibus Stock Incentive Plan
10.13E
Form of Restricted Stock Unit Agreement for Employee Equity Ownership Program under 2013 Omnibus
Stock Incentive Plan
194
(g)
(l)
(l)
(o)
(ee)
(ee)
(ee)
(i)
(i)
(ff)
(gg)
(i)
(i)
(i)
(i)
(cc)
(j)
(m)
(m)
(m)
(k)
(k)
(f)
(n)
(z)
(r)
(s)
(s)
(s)
(dd)
(dd)
10.13F
Form of Non-Qualified Stock Option Agreement for Non-Employee Directors under 2013 Omnibus Stock
Incentive Plan
10.13G
Form of Restricted Stock Agreement for Non-Employee Directors under 2013 Omnibus Stock Incentive Plan
Agreement to Assume Liabilities and to Acquire Assets of Branch Banking Offices, dated as of May 31, 2013,
between Pacific Trust Bank and AmericanWest Bank
Common Stock Share Exchange Agreement, dated as of May 29, 2013, by and between the Registrant and
TCW Shared Opportunity Fund V, L.P.
Assignment and Assumption Agreement, dated as of December 10, 2014, by and among Crescent Special
Situations Fund (Investor Group), L.P., Crescent Special Situations Fund (Legacy V), L.P., TCW Shared
Opportunity Fund V, L.P. and the Registrant.
Purchase and Sale Agreement and Escrow Instructions, dated as of July 24, 2013, by and between the
Registrant and Memorial Health Services
Assumption Agreement, dated as of July 1, 2013, by and between the Registrant and The Private Bank of
California
Securities Purchase Agreement, dated as of April 22, 2014, by and between the Registrant and OCM BOCA
Investor, LLC
Acknowledgment and Amendment to Securities Purchase Agreement, dated as of October 28, 2014 by and
between Banc of California, Inc. and OCM BOCA Investor, LLC.
Securities Purchase Agreement, dated as of October 30, 2014, by and among the Registrant, Patriot Financial
Partners, L.P. and Patriot Financial Partners Parallel L.P., Patriot Financial Partners II, L.P., and Patriot
Financial Partners Parallel II, L.P.
Statement regarding computation of per share earnings
Statement regarding ratio of earnings to combined fixed charges
Letter regarding change in accounting principles
Subsidiaries of the Registrant
Published report regarding matters submitted to vote of security holders
Consent of KPMG LLP
Power of Attorney
Rule 13a-14(a) Certification (Chief Executive Officer)
Rule 13a-14(a) Certification (Chief Financial Officer)
Rule 13a-14(a) Certification (Chief Accounting Officer)
Rule 13a-14(b) and 18 U.S.C. 1350 Certification
The following financial statements and footnotes from the Registrant’s Annual Report on Form 10-K for the
year ended December 31, 2014 formatted in Extensible Business Reporting Language (XBRL): (i)
Consolidated Statements of Financial Condition; (ii) Consolidated Statements of Operations; (iii) Consolidated
Statements of Comprehensive Income (Loss); (iv) Consolidated Statements of Stockholders’ Equity; (v)
Consolidated Statements of Cash Flows; and (vi) the Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements.
(gg)
(gg)
(t)
(u)
10.15A
(v)
(w)
(aa)
(hh)
(hh)
(jj)
12.0
None
21.0
None
23.0
(kk)
31.1
31.2
31.3
32.0
101.0
Filed as an exhibit to the Registrant’s Current Report on Form 8-K filed on June 9, 2011 and incorporated herein by reference.
Filed as an exhibit to the Registrant’s Current Report on Form 8-K filed on December 1, 2011 and incorporated herein by reference.
Filed as an exhibit to the Registrant’s Current Report on Form 8-K filed on February 28, 2012 and incorporated herein by reference.
Filed as an exhibit to the Registrant’s Current Report on Form 8-K filed on July 2, 2012 and incorporated herein by reference.
Filed as an exhibit to the Registrant’s Current Report on Form 8-K filed on August 2, 2012 and incorporated herein by reference.
Filed as Appendix A to the proxy statement/prospectus included in the Registrant’s Registration Statement on Form S-4 filed on
November 1, 2011 and incorporated herein by reference.
Filed as an exhibit to the Registrant’s Current Report on Form 8-K filed on August 27, 2012 and incorporated herein by reference.
Filed as an exhibit to the Registrant’s Registration Statement on Form S-1 filed on March 28, 2002 and incorporated herein by
reference.
Filed as an exhibit to the Registrant’s Current Report on Form 8-K filed on March 4, 2011 and incorporated herein by reference.
Filed as an exhibit to the Registrant’s Current Report on Form 8-K filed on August 30, 2011 and incorporated herein by reference.
Filed as an exhibit to the Registrant’s Current Report on Form 8-K/A filed on November 16, 2010 and incorporated herein by
reference.
195
10.14
10.15
10.15A
10.16
10.17
10.18
10.18A
10.19
11.0
12.0
18.0
21.0
22.0
23.0
24.0
31.1
31.2
31.3
32.0
101.0
(a)
(a)(1)
(a)(2)
(a)(3)
(a)(4)
(b)
(c)
(d)
(e)
(f)
(g)
(h)
(i)
(j)
(k)
(l)
(m)
(n)
(o)
(p)
(q)
(r)
(s)
(t)
(u)
(v)
(w)
(x)
(y)
(z)
(aa)
(bb)
(cc)
(dd)
(ee)
(ff)
(gg)
(hh)
(ii)
(jj)
(kk)
Filed as an exhibit to the Registrant’s Current Report on Form 8-K filed on May 12, 2011 and incorporated herein by reference.
Filed as an exhibit to the Registrant’s Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q for the quarter ended September 30, 2012 and incorporated
herein by reference.
Filed as an appendix to the Registrant’s definitive proxy statement filed on April 25, 2011 and incorporated herein by reference.
Filed as an appendix to the Registrant’s definitive proxy statement filed on March 21, 2003 and incorporated herein by reference.
Filed as an exhibit to the Registrant’s Current Report on Form 8-K filed on April 23, 2012 and incorporated herein by reference.
Filed as an exhibit to the Registrant’s Annual Report on Form 10-K for the year ended December 31, 2011 and incorporated herein
by reference.
Filed as an exhibit to the Registrant’s Current Report on Form 8-K filed on January 3, 2013 and incorporated herein by reference.
Filed as an exhibit to the Registrant’s Current Report on Form 8-K filed on June 12, 2013 and incorporated herein by reference.
Filed as an exhibit to the Registrant’s Current Report on Form 8-K filed on July 3, 2013 and incorporated herein by reference.
Filed as an exhibit to the Registrant’s Current Report on Form 8-K filed on July 17, 2013 and incorporated herein by reference.
Filed as an appendix to the Registrant’s definitive proxy statement filed on June 11, 2013 and incorporated herein by reference.
Filed as an exhibit to the Registrant’s Registration Statement on Form S-8 filed on July 31, 2013 and incorporated herein by
reference.
Filed as an exhibit to the Registrant’s Current Report on Form 8-K filed on June 3, 2013 and incorporated herein by reference.
Filed as an exhibit to the Registrant’s Current Report on Form 8-K filed on June 4, 2013 and incorporated herein by reference.
Filed as an exhibit to the Registrant’s Current Report on Form 8-K filed on July 30, 2013 and incorporated herein by reference.
Filed as an exhibit to the Registrant’s Current Report on Form 8-K filed on July 3, 2013 and incorporated herein by reference.
Filed as an exhibit to the Registrant’s Current Report on Form 8-K filed on May 6, 2013 and incorporated herein by reference.
Filed as an exhibit to the Registrant’s Current Report on Form 8-K filed on October 31, 2013 and incorporated herein by reference.
Field as an exhibit to the Registrant’s Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q for the quarter ended June 30, 2013 and incorporated herein
by reference.
Filed as an exhibit to the Registrant’s Current Report on Form 8-K filed on April 25, 2014 and incorporated herein by reference.
Filed as an exhibit to the Registrant’s Current Report on Form 8-K filed on November 22, 2013 and incorporated herein by
reference.
Field as an exhibit to the Registrant’s Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q for the quarter ended September 30, 2013 and incorporated
herein by reference.
Filed as an exhibit to the Registrant’s Annual Report on Form 10-K for the year ended December 31, 2013 and incorporated herein
by reference.
Filed as an exhibit to the Registrant’s Current Report on Form 8-K filed on May 21, 2014 and incorporated herein by reference.
Filed as an exhibit to the Registrant’s Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q for the quarter ended March 31, 2014 and incorporated herein
by reference.
Filed as an exhibit to the Registrant’s Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q for the quarter ended June 30, 2014 and incorporated herein
by reference.
Filed as an exhibit to the Registrant’s Current Report on Form 8-K filed on October 30, 2014 and incorporated herein by reference.
Filed as an exhibit to the Registrant's Current Report on Form 8-K filed on March 2, 2015 and incorporated herein by reference.
Refer to Note 20 of the Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements contained in Item 8 of this report.
Included on signatory pages of this report.
196
Pursuant to the requirements of Section 13 or 15 (d) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, the registrant has duly caused this
report to be signed on its behalf by the undersigned, and hereunto duly authorized.
SIGNATURES
Date: March 16, 2015
BANC OF CALIFORNIA, INC.
/s/ Steven A. Sugarman
Steven A. Sugarman
Chairman/President/Chief Executive Officer
(Duly Authorized Representative and Principal Executive Officer)
POWER OF ATTORNEY
We, the undersigned officers and directors of BANC OF CALIFORNIA, INC., hereby severally and individually constitute and
appoint Steven A. Sugarman and Ronald J. Nicolas, Jr., and each of them, the true and lawful attorneys and agents of each of us
to execute in the name, place and stead of each of us (individually and in any capacity stated below) any and all amendments to
this Annual Report on Form 10-K and all instruments necessary or advisable in connection therewith and to file the same with
the Securities and Exchange Commission, each of said attorneys and agents to have the power to act with or without the others
and to have full power and authority to do and perform in the name and on behalf of each of the undersigned every act
whatsoever necessary or advisable to be done in the premises as fully and to all intents and purposes as any of the undersigned
might or could do in person, and we hereby ratify and confirm our signatures as they may be signed by our said attorneys and
agents or each of them to any and all such amendments and instruments.
Pursuant to the requirements of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, this report has been signed below by the following
persons on behalf of the registrant and in the capacities and on the dates indicated.
Date: March 16, 2015
Date: March 16, 2015
Date: March 16, 2015
Date: March 16, 2015
Date: March 16, 2015
Date: March 16, 2015
Date: March 16, 2015
Date: March 16, 2015
Date: March 16, 2015
/s/ Steven A. Sugarman
Steven A. Sugarman
Chairman/President/Chief Executive Officer
/s/ Ronald J. Nicolas, Jr.
Ronald J. Nicolas, Jr.
Executive Vice President/Chief Financial Officer
/s/ Nathan Duda
Nathan Duda
Senior Vice President/Chief Accounting Officer
Chad T. Brownstein, Director
/s/ Robert Sznewajs
Robert Sznewajs, Director
/s/ Eric Holoman
Eric Holoman, Director
/s/ Jeffrey Karish
Jeffrey Karish, Director
/s/ Jonah Schnel
Jonah Schnel, Director
/s/ Halle Benett
Halle Benett, Director
197
[THIS PAGE INTENTIONALLY LEFT BLANK]
[THIS PAGE INTENTIONALLY LEFT BLANK]
[THIS PAGE INTENTIONALLY LEFT BLANK]
Shareholder
Information
Annual Meeting
May 15, 2015 8:00am PDT
The Pacific Club
4110 MacArthur Blvd.
Newport Beach, CA 92660
Investor Relations
To obtain information about the Company, including a
copy of our Annual Report on Form 10-K, please contact:
Banc of California, Inc.
c/o Investor Relations
18500 Von Karman Avenue
Suite 1100
Irvine, California 92612
(855) 361-2262
IR@Bancofcal.com
www.bancofcal.com/investor
Listing of Common Stock
Banc of California, Inc.’s common stock is traded on the
New York Stock Exchange under the symbol “BANC”.
Transfer Agent and Registrar for Common Stock
Computershare Shareholder Services
P.O. Box 30170
College Station, TX 77842
(800) 522-6645
www.computershare.com
Banc of California, Inc.
Board of Directors
Vice Chair & Lead Independent Director
Steven A. Sugarman Chair of the Board
Chad T. Brownstein
Halle J. Benett
Eric L. Holoman
Jeffrey Karish
Jonah F. Schnel
Robert D. Sznewajs
Executive Officers
Steven A. Sugarman President & Chief Executive Officer
Ronald J. Nicolas, Jr. Chief Financial Officer
Hugh F. Boyle
Nathan J. Duda
John C. Grosvenor
Matthew A. March
Chief Credit Officer & Chief Risk Officer
Chief Accounting Officer
General Counsel & Corporate Secretary
Chief Administrative Officer &
Chief Information Officer
Chief Lending Officer
Jeffrey T. Seabold
Select Community Partners & Programs
Affordable Housing Clearinghouse
Asian American Advancing Justice Center - Los Angeles
Clearinghouse CDFI
Community Housing Council
COR Community Development Corporation
El Sol Santa Ana Science and Arts Academy
Foster Care Counts
Fullerton Technology Foundation
Habitat for Humanity of Orange County
Heartview Global Foundation
Huntington Beach Council on Aging
Inner-City Arts
Jewish Vocational Services
Junior Achievement San Diego
Junior Achievement Southern California
LA Conservation Corps
Los Angeles Team Mentoring (LATM)
Mary Erickson Community Housing
Milken Institute
Minds Matter LA
National Asian American Coalition
Neighborhood Housing Services of Los Angeles
NeighborWorks Orange County
New Horizons Charter Academy
Oasis Center International
Orange County Community Housing Corporation
Pacific Palisades Turkey Trot
Partnership for Los Angeles Schools
Project Access Resource Centers
Promises 2 Kids
SDSU Financial Literacy Event
Senior Housing Crime Prevention Foundation
Small Business Financial Development Corporation of Orange County
Taller San Jose
Tourette Syndrome Association of Southern California
The Foundation for Living Beauty
USC Kid’s Corner Financial Literacy Event
USC Student Athletes Financial Literacy
Community Awards & Recognition
2014 “Civil to Silver Rights” Award
Presented to Steven Sugarman, CEO, Banc of California, N.A.
by the COR Community Development Corporation
2014 Outstanding Community Partner
Presented to Gary Dunn, SVP, Community Development Officer
by the Community Action Partnership of Orange County
2014 Community Partner of the Year
Presented to Banc of California
by the LA Conservation Corps
2014 Outstanding CEO of the Year
Presented to Steven Sugarman, CEO, Banc of California, N.A.
by the Korean American Chamber of Commerce of Orange County
877-770- 2262 • bancofcal.com